20-F
Table of Contents

 

 

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

Form 20-F

(Mark One)

¨ REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

or

 

þ ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014

or

 

¨ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

or

 

¨ SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

Commission file number: 1-10409

InterContinental Hotels Group PLC

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

England and Wales

(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

Broadwater Park,

Denham, Buckinghamshire UB9 5HR

(Address of principal executive offices)

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of each class

 

Name of each exchange on which registered

American Depositary Shares

  New York Stock Exchange

Ordinary Shares of 15 265/329 pence each

  New York Stock Exchange*

 

 

* Not for trading, but only in connection with the registration of American Depositary Shares, pursuant to the requirements of the Securities and Exchange Commission.

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

None

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act:

None

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual report:

 

Ordinary Shares of 15 265/329 pence each   236,117,256

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act:    Yes  þ    No  ¨

If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934:    Yes  ¨    No  þ

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports) and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days:    Yes  þ    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes  ¨    No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

 

Large accelerated filer  þ   Accelerated filer  ¨    Non-accelerated filer  ¨   Smaller reporting company  ¨
     (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)  

Indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow:

Item 17 ¨      Item 18 þ

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act):

Yes            ¨                     No            þ

Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:

 

US GAAP  ¨

  

International Reporting Standards as issued by

the International Standards Accounting Board  þ

   Other  ¨

 

 

 


Table of Contents

 

LOGO


Table of Contents
 
    

Contents

 

Strategic Report
2 IHG at a glance
4 Our preferred brands
6 Chairman’s statement
8 Chief Executive Officer’s review
10 Industry overview
12 Our business model
14 Our strategy for high-quality growth
16 Winning Model
18 Targeted Portfolio
20 Our Winning Model and Targeted Portfolio in action
22 Disciplined Execution
24 Doing business responsibly
26 Risk management
30 Key performance indicators
34 Performance
Governance
54 Chairman’s overview
55 Corporate Governance
57

Who is on our Board of Directors

60

Who is on our Executive Committee

65

Audit Committee Report

68

Corporate Responsibility Committee Report

69

Nomination Committee Report

70

Statement of compliance with the UK Corporate Governance Code

72 Directors’ Report
76 Directors’ Remuneration Report
Group Financial Statements
94 Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities
99 Independent Auditor’s US Report
100 Group Financial Statements
107 Accounting policies
114 Notes to the Group Financial Statements
Additional Information
162 Group information
171 Shareholder information
179 Useful information
181 Exhibits
182 Form 20-F cross-reference guide
184 Glossary
186 Forward-looking statements

Strategic Report

 

The Strategic Report on pages 2 to 51 was approved by the Board on 16 February 2015

George Turner, Company Secretary

 

 

Dream

 

LOGO

‘Guest Journey’ – Step One

The Dream phase of the ‘Guest Journey’ is one of the most exciting parts of travel for many of our guests as they research, seek inspiration, and dream, about their future trip.

 

 

 

Front cover: EVEN Hotel, Rockville, Maryland, US


Table of Contents
 
    

 

 

LOGO

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

1


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
IHG at a glance

 

 

Our strategy for high-quality growth

We focus on strengthening our portfolio of preferred and differentiated brands, building scale in key markets, creating a long-lasting relationship with our guests and delivering revenue to hotels through the lowest cost, direct channels. Our proposition to owners is highly competitive and drives superior returns.

We execute our asset-light strategy in the most attractive, high-growth markets and industry segments. We take a disciplined approach to capital allocation, investing for the future growth of our brands. This enables us to drive sustainable growth in our profitability and deliver superior shareholder returns over the long term.

 

 

Our strategy is detailed on pages 14 to 33.

 

 

 

Our business model

 

We predominantly franchise our brands to, and manage hotels on behalf of, third-party owners; our focus is therefore on building preferred brands and strong revenue delivery systems.

 

 

Franchised:

4,096 hotels (514,984 rooms)*

 

2013: 3,977 hotels (502,187 rooms)

 

 

Managed:

735 hotels (192,121 rooms)*

 

2013: 711 hotels (180,724 rooms)

 

 

Owned and leased:

9 hotels (3,190 rooms)*

 

2013: 9 hotels (3,962 rooms)

 

 

Our business model is detailed on pages 12 and 13.

Our portfolio of brands is detailed on pages 4 and 5.

Our revenue delivery systems are detailed on pages 17 and 22.

 

Hotels in the IHG System pay IHG:

 

• management and/or franchise fees; and

 

• assessments and contributions which are collected for specific use within the System Fund (this does not result in profit or loss for IHG).

 

 

Information on the System Fund is detailed on page 49.

 

Group highlights*

 

 

+6%: $23bn

Total gross revenue in IHG’s System (2013: $21.6bn)

Group Revenue down 2% to $1,858m (2013 : $1,903m§)

 

 

-3%: $651m

Total operating profit before exceptional items (2013: $668m§)

 

 

+10%: 77¢ (48.6p)

2014 Full-year dividend (2013: 70.0¢ (43.2p))

 

 

+6.1%

Revenue per available room** (2013: +3.8%)

710,295 rooms (4,840 hotels) operating in the IHG System

 

 

+7%

Fee revenue (2013: + 4%). Driven by 6.1% (2013: 3.8%) of RevPAR growth and 3.4% (2013: 1.6%) net IHG System size growth

 

 

Our global and regional performance is set out on pages 34 to 51.

 

*   Unless otherwise stated, all facts and figures as at 31 December 2014.

 

   This comprises total rooms revenue from franchised hotels and total hotel revenue from managed, owned and leased hotels. It is not revenue attributed to IHG.

 

   Includes two liquidated damages receipts in 2014: $7m, both in The Americas.

 

§   Includes three liquidated damages receipts in 2013; $31m in The Americas, $9m in Europe and $6m in AMEA.

 

   Subject to shareholder approval of 2014 final dividend.

 

**   Total IHG System rooms revenue divided by the number of room nights available.

 

  Group revenue excluding owned and leased hotels, managed leases and significant liquidated damages. Growth stated at constant currency.

 

 

 

2


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

Where we operate

We operate in nearly 100 countries globally.

 

LOGO

 

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

3


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Our preferred brands

Each of the brands in our portfolio are complementary and differentiated to meet the changing, multifaceted needs of our guests and be commercially compelling to third-party hotel owners.

 

 

 

Supported by the IHG brand and IHG Rewards Club (our loyalty programme), our portfolio of hotel brands is aimed at meeting evolving guests’ needs.

 

Driving brand preference for our guests

Each of our brand strategies revolves around guest research and insight, allowing us to develop each brand to deliver unique guest experiences against specific needs, occasions and price points.

 

To drive brand preference, our brands must deliver a truly holistic experience for our guests, from the moment travel plans are conceived, across the planning and booking experience, throughout the hotel stay and thereafter – we call this the ‘Guest Journey’ (see pages 17 and 22).

 

In January 2015, we acquired Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants, the world’s largest independent boutique hotel operator. This, alongside Hotel Indigo and EVEN Hotels, strengthens our brand portfolio and creates a leading boutique and lifestyle hotel business in one of the fastest growing industry segments (see page 21).

 

Delivering preferred brands by our people

We recognise that our people deliver the brand experience for our guests and we therefore invest heavily in our talented people (see page 23).

 

Having preferred brands for owners

Given our asset-light business model, strong owner relationships are vital to building scale (see pages 16 and 17). Integral to this, is a portfolio comprising strong, clearly defined brands enabling third-party hotel owners to choose the right IHG brand for their hotel.

 

    

 

 

LOGO

 

180

Hotels open

 

61,235

Rooms open

 

50

Hotels in the pipeline

 

15,664

Rooms in the pipeline

 

InterContinental® Hotels & Resorts

Our international luxury brand is located in most of the world’s key cities and many resort destinations across more than 60 countries worldwide. The brand’s ethos is to provide insightful, meaningful experiences to our guests to make their world feel bigger.

 

LOGO

 

24

Hotels in the pipeline

 

7,551

Rooms in the pipeline

 

HUALUXE® Hotels and Resorts

Launched in March 2012, it was the first luxury international hotel brand where every element has been designed specifically to suit the tastes and sensibilities of the Chinese guest. It focuses on the unique aspects of Chinese etiquette, the importance of rejuvenation, status recognition, local customs and heritage.

 

    

 

 

LOGO

 

406

Hotels open

 

113,562

Rooms open

 

92

Hotels in the pipeline

 

25,336

Rooms in the pipeline

 

Crowne Plaza® Hotels & Resorts

With hotels in major business centres around the world, Crowne Plaza is our modern business hotel dedicated to business travel that is ever more flexible, more connected, and more mobile. We enable our guests to be their most productive by simply making business travel work.

 

LOGO

 

61

Hotels open

 

6,731

Rooms open

 

63

Hotels in the pipeline

 

9,096

Rooms in the pipeline

 

Hotel Indigo®

Hotel Indigo artfully combines the unique design and authentic local experiences of a boutique hotel, with the ease and peace of mind of a recognised brand name. Each hotel reflects the local culture, character and history of the surrounding area.

 

 

 

 

4


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

    

 

 

LOGO

 

1,212*

Hotels open

 

225,159*

Rooms open

 

269§

Hotels in the pipeline

 

52,713§

Rooms in the pipeline

 

Holiday Inn®

At Holiday Inn, we believe the joy of travel is for everyone. Warm and friendly, Holiday Inn has been opening its doors to guests since 1952, affordably blending the familiar with the new, and putting everyone at ease no matter the reason for their stay.

 

Holiday Inn Resort® properties offer great value, warm and friendly service and the peace of mind of a trusted brand name. The Holiday Inn Resort brand champions the family holiday.

 

Holiday Inn Club Vacations® is a vacation ownership club that opens the door to the joy of owning a vacation home. The portfolio is a collection of resorts in the US, offering spacious villa accommodation for families in great vacation destinations.

 

 

LOGO

 

2,365

Hotels open

 

229,110

Rooms open

 

522

Hotels in the pipeline

 

62,954

Rooms in the pipeline

 

Holiday Inn Express®

Holiday Inn Express champions smart and simple travel for everyone. We support guests without hassle, without complication, without extravagance – but always with a warm smile. Our mantra is ‘everything you need, nothing you don’t’.

*   Includes 12 Holiday Inn Club Vacations properties (4,027 rooms) and 42 Holiday Inn Resort properties (9,904 rooms).

 

§   Includes 18 Holiday Inn Resort properties (4,412 rooms).

 

    

 

 

LOGO

 

322

Hotels open

 

30,708

Rooms open

 

89

Hotels in the pipeline

 

7,717

Rooms in the pipeline

 

Candlewood Suites®

IHG’s extended-stay brand in North America aimed at providing guests with a relaxed, casual and home-like environment at a great value.

 

LOGO

 

205

Hotels open

 

22,409

Rooms open

 

99

Hotels in the pipeline

 

10,908

Rooms in the pipeline

 

Staybridge Suites®

IHG’s extended-stay brand for business and leisure travellers who are spending an extended time away from home and prefer a warm, home-like and community environment.

 

    

 

 

LOGO

 

2

Hotels open

 

296

Rooms open

 

3

Hotels in the pipeline

 

584

Rooms in the pipeline

 

EVENTM Hotels

Launched in February 2012, the brand was created to meet the large and growing demand for a hotel brand to help wellness-minded travellers maintain their balance on the road.

 

LOGO

 

62

Hotels open

 

11,300

Rooms open

 

16

Hotels in the pipeline

 

3,000

Rooms in the pipeline

 

Kimpton® Hotels & Restaurants

Acquired by IHG in January 2015, this is a leading collection of boutique hotels and award-winning destination restaurants in the US. The brand is renowned for its distinctive design and personal approach to guest service, using thoughtful perks and amenities and a sense of fun to make them feel truly at home.

   As at 31 December 2014.

 

   These were part of the acquisition which completed on 16 January 2015.

 

IHG System size of 4,840 hotels (710,295 rooms) includes 87 hotels (21,085 rooms) that are unbranded.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

5


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Chairman’s statement

We have continued to execute our strategy to deliver high-quality growth. Our strong performance was underpinned by our successful Winning Model, which is our framework for delivering value for our shareholders and owners through our portfolio of preferred brands, talented people and leading revenue delivery systems.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

“We made excellent progress against our well-established strategy to deliver high-quality growth and returned over $1 billion to shareholders.”

 

 

Patrick Cescau

 

Chairman

Our highlights in 2014 included the opening of the first two hotels under the EVEN Hotels brand, and the progress made in both strengthening our digital offer and enhancing our loyalty programme, IHG Rewards Club, with the aim of building lifetime loyalty with our guests and enhancing their experience with our brands before, during, and after, their stay. We also continued our strong track record of delivering attractive returns for shareholders, with over $1 billion (including ordinary dividends) returned in the year.

 

We ended the year on a high, with the announcement that we had agreed to acquire Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants, making IHG the clear market leader in the boutique segment.

 

I have seen, first hand, this momentum in the business. I have visited many hotels in our established markets, as well as our growth markets, and I continue to be enormously impressed. Our continued success is testament to our strong relationship with our owners and the passion and commitment our 350,000 colleagues globally bring to the business on a daily basis.

 

   Views on the year as a

   whole

With hotels in nearly 100 countries around the world, our scale position has been a key driver of our consistently strong performance. It allowed us to allocate resources in a focused way to grow in our attractive markets (described on page 18), whilst ensuring we maintain a strong presence in growth markets of the future.

One of IHG’s greatest strengths is our ability to adapt and evolve in a changing global landscape. We are a dynamic business. In 2014, we saw some of the world’s biggest economies return to growth and others faced uncertainty in the shape of natural, economic and political upheaval. In this context, our expertise and discipline was critical to us delivering consistently good results.

 

   Shareholder returns

We remain committed to delivering long-term shareholder value, returning surplus funds to our shareholders and thereby maintaining an efficient balance sheet with an investment grade credit rating. In the 11 years since IHG became a standalone business, we have consistently delivered superior and sustainable returns for our shareholders. In May 2014, we announced a $750 million special dividend with share consolidation which we paid on 14 July 2014. During the year, we also successfully completed our $500 million share buyback programme. In total, we have now returned $10.4 billion (including ordinary dividends) to shareholders since our 2003 demerger.

 

I am pleased to announce that the Board is recommending a final dividend of 52 cents (33.8 pence) per ordinary share, an increase of 11 per cent on the final dividend for 2013, resulting in a full-year dividend of 77 cents (48.6 pence) per share, up 10 per cent on 2013.

 

Total Shareholder Return was 32 per cent in the year; the 10th best performance in the FTSE 100.

 

 

 

6


Table of Contents
 
    
 

InterContinental Paris - Le Grand, France                                       Crowne Plaza Costa Mesa Orange County, California, US

 

LOGO

 

 

 

 

The Board and its areas of focus

IHG is an ambitious company with an impressive scale position and a proven strategy for high-quality growth. Ensuring we have the right balance of skills, style and expertise at both the Board level and across the business is an important factor in supporting our future growth (see pages 57 to 62).

In last year’s Annual Report, I said how impressed I was by the strength and diversity of the IHG Board. This continues to be the case. I also stressed the importance of evolving the composition of the Board to best support the business as it grows and develops.

In 2014, a key priority for me was to appoint a Non-Executive Director with a strong background in consumer-facing technology. On 1 September 2014, we were therefore delighted to welcome Jo Harlow to the Board and as a member of the Audit, Nomination and Remuneration Committees. Jo has a wealth of experience and knowledge, particularly on the role digital technology plays in driving consumer behaviour.

On 31 December 2014, Jonathan Linen retired from the Board and I would like to thank him for his tremendous contribution to IHG. In December 2014, we announced that Kirk Kinsell would step down from the Board and his role as President of our Americas business on 13 February 2015. Kirk was succeeded by Elie Maalouf as Chief Executive Officer, The Americas, who became a member of IHG’s Executive Committee. We are also pleased that, effective from 1 March 2015, Anne Busquet will be joining the Board as a Non-Executive Director and she will also sit on the Audit, Nomination and Corporate Responsibility Committees. Anne has an impressive breadth of experience in digital commerce, hospitality, finance and marketing.

During the year, the Board remained focused on IHG’s strategy and the execution of our Winning Model, as well as on maintaining our deep understanding of both the risks facing the business and the controls we have in place. These are further described on pages 14 to 33.

Governance

High standards of corporate governance are fundamental to the way IHG operates and reflect our values and commitment to being a truly responsible business. In last year’s Annual Report, we explained how we had commissioned a formal evaluation of the Board from an external independent consultant. This year we undertook an internal Board effectiveness evaluation and internal performance evaluations of each Director. The Board also considered the performance of each of its Committees. It was confirmed that the Board and its Committees were operating effectively, and that each Director continues to bring relevant knowledge, diversity of perspective, an ability and willingness to challenge and retains a strong commitment to the role. The progress against our 2013 evaluation, and details of our 2014 evaluation and action plan, can be found on pages 63 and 64.

Detailed information on our Board and governance processes, including the Directors’ Remuneration Report, can be found on pages 54 to 91.

In line with our commitment to responsible business practices (see pages 24 and 25), this year, we have decided to produce a broader Responsible Business Report in place of the Corporate Responsibility Report, which can be downloaded at www.ihgplc.com/responsiblebusiness.

Outlook

We continue to remain confident in the long-term growth prospects of the hotel industry. There are some major structural tailwinds and socio economic trends which mean that the hotel industry will experience significant growth into the future. Our proven strategy for high-quality growth means that we are well placed to continue to outperform.

 

LOGO

Patrick Cescau

Chairman

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

7


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Chief Executive Officer’s review

2014 was an excellent year for IHG. We made significant progress in delivering our winning strategy for high-quality growth, and reported strong financial and operational performance. We also made good progress with our
asset-light strategy.

 

 

 

LOGO

“IHG is in a position of strength, a position which has been enhanced by another year of delivery against our strategic priorities.”

 

 

Richard Solomons

Chief Executive Officer

IHG is in a position of strength, a position which has been enhanced by another year of excellent delivery against our strategic priorities. We remained focused on building our compelling scale position in what is a growing global marketplace, as we continued to build, develop, and shape our business and our brands for the future. We achieved strong RevPAR performance, opened the highest number of hotels since 2009 and reported growth in net System size.

We also made good progress with our asset-light strategy with the sale of InterContinental Mark Hopkins San Francisco and the disposal of 80 per cent of our interest in InterContinental New York Barclay, as well as the acceptance of a binding offer for InterContinental Paris – Le Grand.

Our Winning Model

The Winning Model is our framework for delivering value for our shareholders and owners through our portfolio of preferred brands, talented people and leading revenue delivery systems. We are focused on delivering against all components of this model, combining it with a targeted approach to building our portfolio and disciplined execution, all underpinned by our commitment to being a responsible business. On pages 16 and 17, we have set out why each element of the model is so critical to our business and have provided more detail on the excellent progress we made during the course of 2014. This includes our superior owner proposition. On our website, www.ihgplc.com/ihgowners, you will find a message from Buggsi Patel, 2014 Chairman of the IHG Owners Association, on his highlights from the year.

Our acquisition of Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants (see page 21), which completed in January 2015, is an example of how each element of the model came into play and will help support our ambitions for the brand in the medium term.

Our Winning Model in action

Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants is a well-established and highly successful business that has grown to become the world’s leading boutique hotel business with a portfolio of world-class hotels and destination restaurants. This distinctive and innovative brand fits perfectly into our brand family, alongside our highly successful Hotel Indigo and EVEN Hotels brands, creating the world’s largest boutique hotel business. We will use our scale, network of owner relationships and powerful digital platforms to accelerate its growth both within the US and globally
(see page 21).

Our scale

With a five per cent share of the global industry supply of rooms and 13 per cent of the active industry pipeline, IHG enjoys significant scale advantages in what is a competitive industry. During 2014, we continued to build our scale, focusing on our priority markets such as the United States and Greater China (see page 18). This resulted in us achieving a series of milestones in the year, including our highest ever number of hotel openings in Greater China
(see pages 19 and 46 to 48).

 

 

 

 

8


Table of Contents
 
    
 

Epic Miami, A Kimpton Hotel, Florida, US               EVEN Hotel Rockville, Maryland, US              HUALUXE Hotels and Resorts, People’s Republic of China

 

LOGO

 

 

Our brands

Our award-winning preferred brands continued to go from strength to strength. InterContinental Hotels & Resorts is twice the size of any other luxury hotel brand and the Holiday Inn brand family is the largest global mainstream brand. We also opened the 400th Crowne Plaza hotel and 200th Staybridge Suites hotel during the year.

The number of awards our brands receive externally is remarkable, reflecting the work we have been doing to build awareness, recognition and guest satisfaction. In 2014 alone, our brands won over 300 global, regional and hotel level awards.

For the sixth consecutive year, InterContinental Hotels & Resorts was named ‘World’s Leading Hotel Brand’ at the 2014 World Travel Awards; and for the tenth consecutive year, IHG Rewards Club has been recognised as ‘Best Hotel Rewards Programme in the World’ by Global Traveler magazine. IHG as a company also had a successful year – we were listed as one of FORTUNE Magazine’s ‘World’s Most Admired Companies’, named as the ‘Best British Business’ in China and came third in The Sunday Times ‘25 Best Big Companies to Work For’ list.

Innovating for the future

We have continued to build on our long history of innovation to help us both navigate and evolve our business for success in what is a changing world. This is supported by our focus on delivering preferred brands, building lifetime relationships with our guests and developing our strong direct channels.

In 2014, we opened the first two EVEN Hotels (see page 20) to critical acclaim, and in February 2015, we opened the first hotel for the HUALUXE Hotels and Resorts brand. Both of these new brands address previously unmet guests’ needs.

We have also taken an innovative approach to evolving our loyalty and digital offer around the ‘Guest Journey’ with the launch of initiatives such as Mobile Check-in and Check-out and further improvements to our number one rated mobile app. Continuing to evolve and enhance our digital capabilities will be a key area of focus for us over the coming years.

Trust

In the context of this changing landscape, the theme of ‘Trust’ was more important than ever and was the main theme of our 2015 Trends Report (see page 10 for more details). The report argues that ‘Trust Capital’ is now the ‘4th C’ of organisational value – alongside Human, Financial and Intellectual Capital – and is a key factor for consumers in making brand choices. Our people play a critical role in building trust with our guests and owners. They are responsible for delivering a differentiated brand experience for our guests (see pages 16 and 23) and as such we work hard to build our ‘winning culture’ and our employer brand and maintain our high Employee Engagement survey scores
(see page 32).

Responsible Business

Operating as a Responsible Business underpins each of our strategic priorities and is a commitment everyone working at IHG is responsible for delivering (see page 24 and 25). We made excellent progress with each of our three corporate responsibility programmes during the course of the year. We announced the global roll-out of our environmental sustainability tool, IHG Green Engage, as a brand standard, which was a powerful demonstration of our commitment to protecting the environment. More recently, we announced the opening of our 600th IHG Academy. Launched in 2006, the programme provides local people with bespoke skills-development and employment opportunities. Finally,

our disaster relief programme, IHG Shelter in a Storm, responded to 18 disasters in nine countries.

Finally, I would like to take this opportunity to thank those who work across IHG and its brands globally for the energy and enthusiasm they bring to the business. With their support, and together with our owners, we can look forward to another excellent year ahead.

 

LOGO

Richard Solomons

Chief Executive Officer

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

9


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Industry overview

 

 

Where the industry is now

 

The global hotel industry

The global hotel industry comprises approximately 15.5 million rooms and is broadly segmented into branded (multiple hotels under the same brand name) and independent (non-branded) hotels. Growth in demand is driven by economic growth and an increasing trend for domestic and global travel, resulting in part from favourable demographics and the globalisation of travel.

Over the long term, the lodging industry has grown broadly in line with Gross Domestic Product (GDP). In the US market (which is the largest market in terms of number of rooms), growth in consumer spend on lodging has exceeded GDP growth by two percentage points per annum over the last 50 years.

There are a number of industry metrics that are widely recognised and used to track performance and we actively monitor these. These include revenue per available room (RevPAR), average daily rate and rooms supply growth.

 

 

Global industry RevPAR growth (2014 v 2013)

 

LOGO

 

 

IHG’s Key performance indicators (KPIs) are set out on pages 30 to 33.

The branded hotel market

The branded hotel market is estimated to account for 53 per cent of the total hotel market. We benchmark our performance against the largest branded players that we consider to be our peer group, with a similar system size and pipeline to ours and who operate in similar market segments to us (as explained on page 18).

Five of the leading branded hotel companies (IHG, Accor, Hilton, Marriott and Starwood) account for approximately 30 per cent of the total branded hotel market in terms of open rooms, and 65 per cent of the development pipeline (hotels in planning and under construction but not yet open).

In the US, around 70 per cent of the industry supply is branded. In fast developing markets, such as China and India, penetration of international brands is, however, lower, at around 45 to 55 per cent. This level of international brand penetration is expected to increase significantly over the coming decades, as large global branded hotels gain traction due to the advantages of reliability, guest safety and security, consistency of standards and the ability to invest in customer experience and technology. IHG has measures in place for all of these – see Our Strategy and Managing Risks on pages 14 to 29.

 

 

Source: Smith Travel Research for all of the above industry facts.

 

The different business models within the hotel industry

The global hotel industry operates under a number of different business models, depending on whether a hotel is branded or independent. The four models typically seen are owned, leased, managed and franchised:

 

  owned hotels are owned and operated by an owner who bears all the costs associated with the hotel but also benefits from all of the income;

 

  a leased model is similar, except that the owner-operator of a hotel does not have outright ownership of the hotel but pays rental fees to the ultimate owner of the property;

 

  under a managed model, the owner of a hotel uses a third-party manager to operate the hotel on its behalf and pays the manager management fees and, if the hotel is operated under a third-party brand name, brand licensing fees; and

 

  a franchised hotel is owned and operated by an owner under a third-party brand name, and the owner pays a brand licensing fee to the brand owner.

Other models, such as pay-for-performance or commission-based, are sometimes used by independent hotels to benefit from a brand’s booking distribution system (for example, hotel collections).

Whilst an owner-operated hotel enables the owner to have full control over the hotel operation, it requires high capital investment. In contrast, for hotel brand owners, a managed or franchised model enables quicker rooms growth due to the lower capital investment, but this requires strong relationships with third-party hotel owners. As a franchisor and manager, we therefore recognise that our owner proposition is a key part of our strategy.

 

 

IHG’s business model, which is a predominantly managed and franchised model, is set out on pages 12 and 13.

 

 

IHG’s 2015 Trends Report: Building Trust Capital: The new business imperative in the Kinship Economy – released in January 2015

 

LOGO   

The third in our series of Trends Reports focused on consumer insights impacting the hospitality industry and business in general.

 

Our 2015 Report identifies

the importance for companies to build brand and organisational trust. It demonstrates how to build Trust Capital with different demographics and across different geographies, unveiling a blueprint of seven principles for making it the core driver of an organisation.

 

Further details about all three Trends Reports can be found at www.ihgplc.com/trends_report

 

 

 

 

 

10


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

Where the industry is heading

 

Short-term drivers and global trends

Short-term industry trends are shaped by differing economic, political or physical factors impacting local geographical markets. Since the economic crisis of 2008/09, GDP growth has returned to key economies, leading to an increase in disposable income and an increase in demand for hotel rooms. Typically, the industry would meet this demand through an increase in the supply of rooms.

In developed markets, recent industry revenue growth has been driven largely by an increase in the room rate as occupancy levels have returned to previous peak levels, but the growth in supply of rooms has been below the long-term average. In emerging markets, growth has been a result of both an increase in room rate and the supply of rooms. The industry is also impacted in the short term by local market economic or political factors.

 

 

 

 

Long-term drivers and global trends

In the long term, growth in the hotel industry is driven by a number of trends:

Economic

The travel and hotel industries have benefited substantially from long-term macroeconomic trends. Global GDP growth in the last 10 years of approximately 3.6 per cent per annum has contributed to increasing disposable income and a greater number of middle-class households, particularly in emerging markets such as Greater China, with a greater propensity to travel.

Improvements in physical infrastructure, particularly in emerging markets, have allowed hotels to meet the needs of guests more effectively and to open up new destinations for travel.

 

 

Our growth strategy focuses on 10 priority markets comprising both developed and emerging ones.

Demographic

Traveller demographics are continuously evolving. Many travellers travel for a variety of reasons and no longer for a singular purpose, such as only business or leisure. Across the globe, the types of traveller can range from single people to multi-generation families. The younger workforce is driving more diverse and informal working patterns, with an expectation that hotels can cater for flexible working arrangements. A growing ageing population with the desire, and means, to travel is also expected to significantly increase travel flows and lead to an overall increase in demand for travel services.

 

 

Having a portfolio of distinct and complementary brands enables IHG to meet a range of guests’ needs and occasions at differing price points.

Social

Other trends also provide new opportunities for increased travel. Growing competition and capacity amongst airlines, lower air fares and more relaxed travel restrictions in many regions have made international travel a viable option for an increasing number of people. Worldwide, international tourist travel is expected to increase by 3.3 per cent a year from 2010 to 2030 reaching 1.8 billion by 2030, according to the UNWTO.

Increasingly, travellers are concerned about the sustainability of hotels and their impact on the environment and local communities.

 

 

We are committed to responsible business practices from environmental sustainability to supporting our local communities.

Technology

Technology is playing an increasingly important role in both shaping the travel industry and in guests’ appreciation of their entire travel experience. The internet, increasingly accessed through mobile devices, has established itself as the preferred method to research, plan and book travel. In emerging markets, consumers are bypassing desktop PCs and going straight to mobile – there are twice as many smartphone users in China than internet users in the US.

The development of social networking has changed the way in which people think about travel, with the sharing of experiences, reviews and recommendations influencing research and decision-making. Travellers can make more informed decisions, and book their travel options with greater control and immediacy, leading to an increase in travel to a variety of destinations.

The ‘Internet of Things’ is an emerging trend that offers enormous potential. 75 billion devices are forecast to be internet-enabled by 2020 offering the potential to transform the in-hotel guest experience.

 

 

We focus on delivering across the entirety of the ‘Guest Journey’ and invest in developing strong technology platforms.

Competitors

These long-term drivers and global trends are changing the competitive landscape within the travel industry. Competitors are no longer simply branded or independent hotels, but also include companies offering alternative lodging solutions and search options, providing inspiration for travel ideas and aggregating a range of travel solutions. The consumer peer-to-peer rental market, which is largely unbranded, has also opened up a large supply of travel accommodation. However, many of these businesses are not subject to regulations such as fire and life safety, food safety and local industry regulations, which apply to traditional hotel operators.

For booking and distribution, hotel companies also compete with the increasingly sizeable travel intermediaries.

 

 

Our channel management strategic priority considers both direct and indirect booking and distribution channels.

 

 What is IHG doing in light of these trends?

 

 See Our Strategy on pages 14 to 33

 

 

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

11


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Our business model

We predominantly franchise our brands to, and manage hotels on behalf of, third-party owners. Our asset-light strategy enables us to grow our business whilst generating high returns on invested capital.

 

 

We franchise and/or manage hotels depending largely on market maturity, owner preference and, in certain cases, on the particular brand. For example, in the US, a mature market, we operate a largely franchised business, working together with our owners to deliver preferred brands. By contrast, in Greater China, an emerging market, we operate a predominantly managed business where we are responsible for operating the hotel on behalf of our owners. We adapt this business model by market as necessary, for example, we also have managed leases (properties structured for legal reasons as operating leases but with the same characteristics as management contracts), partnerships and joint ventures.

The key differences in our three main models are summarised below:

 

     Number   % of our   Hotel   IHG capital   Employees*   Brand ownership,
     of hotels   portfolio   ownership   intensity        marketing and distribution
Franchised   4,096   84.6%   Third party   Low   Third party  
Managed   735   15.2%   Third party   Low   IHG and third party     IHG
Owned and leased     9   Less than 1%   IHG   High   IHG    

 

*  For information on who are our employees and how we invest in our talent, see page 23.
  We are committed to delivering a compelling and preferred offer to our hotels owners through our owner proposition – see page 17.

In 2014, over 90 per cent of our operating profit was generated from our asset-light management and franchise contracts. In addition, approximately 85 per cent of our fee-based income was derived from hotel revenues, and 15 per cent was principally from management fees linked to hotel profits.

The asset-light approach, and franchised and managed business model:

 

  is highly cash-generative, with a high return on capital employed; and

 

  means IHG benefits from the reduced volatility of fee-based income streams and allows us to focus on growing our fee revenues and fee margins with limited requirements for IHG’s capital.

 

 

IHG Revenue and the System Fund

Third-party hotel owners pay: (i) fees to IHG in relation to licensing of our brands and/or our hotel management services; and (ii) assessments and contributions which are collected by IHG for specific use within the System Fund.

 

LOGO

 

 

 

12


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

Disciplined approach to allocation of capital

Our focus on an asset-light business model is supported by a disciplined, long-term approach to allocating capital and reducing the asset intensity of the business. We seek to maintain an efficient balance sheet with an investment grade credit rating.

Our business is highly cash-generative, and we have three primary uses of the cash we generate:

 

  Invest in the business to drive growth: This includes acquisitions of businesses and our day-to-day capital expenditures (see below).

 

  Maintain sustainable growth in the ordinary dividend: Our 2014 full-year dividend will be 77 cents (48.6 pence) per share (subject to shareholder approval of the 2014 final dividend) – up 10 per cent on 2013 (see page 50).

 

  Return surplus funds to shareholders: During 2014, we announced a $750 million return to shareholders via special dividend with share consolidation, and completed our $500 million share buyback (see page 50).

 

In support of our asset-light strategy, during 2014 we:

Disposals

 

    completed the disposal of 80 per cent of our interest in InterContinental New York Barclay for $274 million;

 

    sold InterContinental Mark Hopkins San Francisco for $120 million; and

 

    announced a binding offer in respect of InterContinental Paris – Le Grand for 330 million ($406 million).

Acquisitions

 

    announced the acquisition of Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants for $430 million – a fully asset-light business. This acquisition completed in January 2015.

IHG’s philosophy to capital expenditure

Capital expenditure incurred by IHG can be summarised as follows:

 

Capital expenditure    Examples
 

Maintenance capital expenditure and key money to access strategic growth, particularly into high-quality and sought-after opportunities

 

  

•  Maintenance of our owned and leased hotels, which will reduce as we become increasingly asset-light.

•  Corporate infrastructure maintenance, for example, in respect of our offices and systems.

•  Deployment of key money, which is used to access strategic opportunities, particularly in high-quality and sought-after locations when returns are financially and/or strategically attractive.

 

Recyclable investments to drive the growth of our brands and our expansion in priority markets

 

  

 

•  Through the acquisition of real estate, investment through joint ventures or via an equity stake.

•  We aim to seek to recycle this capital by selling these assets when the time is right and to reinvest elsewhere in the business and across our portfolio – we are currently doing this for our EVEN Hotels brand, just as we previously did for the Staybridge Suites and Hotel Indigo brands.

 

System funded capital investments for strategic investment to drive growth at hotel level

 

  

 

•  The development of tools and systems that hotels use to drive performance.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

 

 

For definitions, please refer to the Glossary on pages 184 and 185.

 

 

13


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Our strategy for high-quality growth

We focus on strengthening our portfolio of preferred and differentiated brands, building scale in key markets, creating a long-lasting relationship with our guests and delivering revenue to hotels through the lowest cost, direct channels. Our proposition to owners is highly competitive and drives superior returns.

We execute our asset-light strategy in the most attractive, high-growth markets and industry segments. We take a disciplined approach to capital allocation, investing for the future growth of our brands. This enables us to drive sustainable growth in our profitability and deliver superior shareholder returns over the long term.

 

LOGO

 

 

 

14


Table of Contents
 
    

 

 

LOGO

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

15


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Winning Model

Our Winning Model is our framework for delivering value for our shareholders and owners through our portfolio of preferred brands, talented people and leading revenue delivery systems.

 

 

 

Key performance indicators (KPIs) and What we have done in 2014

 

See pages 30 to 33

 

How we manage principal risks

See pages 28 to 29

 

    

Our portfolio of preferred brands

 

See pages 4 and 5

 

Where we operate and detailed global and regional Performance

 

See pages 34 to 51

 

 

LOGO    Preferred brands delivered through our people

 

Why we think this is important

Having a strong portfolio of preferred brands is fundamental to our success. In a highly competitive industry, powerful well-defined, consistent and well-known brands assist both guests and owners in choosing an IHG brand over a competitor’s, as well as deciding which IHG brand meets their specific needs. Our people are critical in providing the guest experience, and our ‘winning culture’ encourages and empowers them to bring each of our differentiated brand experiences to life and provide high standards of guest service.

The value of building strong preferred brands results in increased RevPAR, as occupancy will be higher and guests will pay a higher rate to stay at their preferred brand, which, in turn, delivers better returns for our owners through an increase in total gross revenue.

What we are doing

We build brand preference by defining each of our brands so that they can provide a differentiated experience to meet both the targeted guest need and occasion and be consistent in the experience they deliver.

We have sharpened each of our brand strategies looking at a number of areas, from the brand ambition and position to the brand platform and strategic brand pillars, to ensure our portfolio meets the needs of the evolving guest and owner. We are also refreshing the brand standards for each of our brands to ensure they are up to date and relevant to drive consistency.

We invest in our talented people who are the face of our brands and help us build brand preference (see page 23).

 

How we measure it

 

KPIs – Guest HeartBeat, RevPAR, Employee engagement, Total gross revenue

 

LOGO    Build and leverage scale

 

Why we think this is important

Scale provides significant advantages in the hotel industry at the global, national and city level. The size of the IHG System, and our concentration on priority markets and key gateway cities, allows us to benefit from economies of scale, which lead to higher margins and operating leverage. With scale, we can invest in our brands and the technology required to support their continued growth, and deliver efficient sales and marketing and procurement practices, thereby increasing the advantages an IHG brand brings to owners. Scale also enables us to invest in, and grow, new brands and take them global, for example Hotel Indigo.

What we are doing

IHG already benefits from substantial scale advantages. With over 710,000 rooms open at the end of 2014, we delivered our strongest net IHG System size growth since 2009 of 3.4 per cent, opening over 41,000 rooms. Our brand portfolio also reached some significant milestones in 2014 – opening the 400th Crowne Plaza hotel, the 200th Staybridge Suites hotel and the 60th Hotel Indigo hotel in its 10th anniversary year. Our scale has also enabled us to commit $150 million of investment behind the EVEN Hotels brand, opening the first two properties in 2014. We focus on developing our scale in 10 priority markets, where we currently have 85 per cent of our open rooms (see page 18). Benefiting from the strong growth in these markets, Group fee margins were up 1.5 percentage points to 44.7 per cent in 2014 and total gross revenue was up 6 per cent to $23 billion.

 

 

For details on how we maximise the scale and efficiency of our operations, see page 22.

 

How we measure it

 

KPIs – Net rooms supply, Fee revenues, Total gross revenue, Fee margin

 

 

 

 

 

16


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

LOGO    Strong brand portfolio and loyalty programme
LOGO    Effective channel management
LOGO    Superior owner proposition
 

Why we think this is important

A portfolio of strong, complementary brands allows us to offer solutions for each guest need, which increases cross-selling across different brands. Combined with a strong loyalty programme, it also increases awareness and recognition of the IHG brand, and of each of the individual hotel brands, helping us to drive business. Guests who have an increased loyalty to IHG and its portfolio have also proven to have a higher spend per stay. Both of these result in higher RevPAR premiums, thereby increasing total gross revenue and strengthening our owner proposition.

What we are doing

Our brands are complementary across the segments in which they operate (midscale, upscale and luxury), catering to different guest needs and occasions. One of our newest brands, EVEN Hotels, caters to an identified guest need for maintaining wellness while travelling and the acquisition of the Kimpton brand has a strong strategic fit with our Hotel Indigo and EVEN Hotels brands (see pages 20 and 21). Recognising the importance of a strong loyalty programme, we encourage guests to stay across the portfolio and build lifetime relationships through the IHG Rewards Club programme, which has 84 million members. We continue to evolve our loyalty programme to ensure that it is not just the largest in the market, but also the most preferred – refreshing and reviewing the rewards and benefits available to increase its attractiveness to our guests. We recognise our loyal guests and aim to personalise their experiences.

 

How we measure it

 

KPIs – Total gross revenue, RevPAR, System contribution to revenue, Guest HeartBeat

 

 

Why we think this is important

As a franchisor and manager of hotels, we aim to drive demand to our hotel brands and reduce distribution costs for our owners through strong brand awareness and effective yield-management practices, delivering better returns for our owners. Our direct channels (digital and voice) are less costly to owners than third-party intermediaries. Our strong brands are a significant driver of bookings through indirect channels (online travel intermediaries (OTIs) and business and leisure travel agents). We therefore aim to drive demand for our hotels through our direct channels and manage revenue per booking, thereby delivering the highest quality revenues to IHG hotels at the lowest possible cost, increasing RevPAR and owner returns.

What we are doing

Our direct and indirect channels delivered 71 per cent of total rooms revenue to our hotels in 2014. Our digital business has significant scale and is growing fast, accounting for $4 billion in revenue in 2014. We continue to invest in features that enhance the digital experience, with branded and personalised offerings to encourage guests to book via our direct channels.

We recognise the impact of OTIs as an indirect booking channel, mainly used by comparison-site shopping leisure travellers searching for a competitive deal. We have therefore leveraged our global footprint to secure better terms with the OTIs on behalf of our owners, whilst leveraging OTIs as a complementary distribution channel.

 

 

For details on our investment in developing strong technology platforms, see page 22.

 

How we measure it

 

KPIs – System contribution to revenue, RevPAR

 

 

Why we think this is important

We recognise that hotel owners have a choice of brand, if any, to choose for their property. A strong owner proposition, preferred brands and effective operational support, play a vital part in making us the brand choice for owners. Relationships with new and existing owners therefore have a significant impact on our ability to build scale. A strong owner proposition and relationships with our owners also enable us to deliver the brand promise for our guests and continue building preferred brands.

What we are doing

We are committed to delivering a compelling and preferred owner offer. We continually review and enhance our owner proposition in many ways, including:

 

  ensuring a profitable return on investment for our owners, assisting them along the lifecycle of their investment, from identifying the right site to operating a profitable business;

 

  providing a range of revenue-driving tools and services, including booking and distribution channels;

 

  seeking to price our fees to reflect our services, tools and brand value;

 

  having strong owner relationship management and working with the IHG Owners Association (which represents the interests of our hotel owners globally) to deliver joint initiatives – www.ihgplc.com/ihgowners;

 

  recognising the importance of responsible business practices to all stakeholders, and developing tools which support both our commitment to doing business responsibly and delivering superior returns to our owners (see pages 24 and 25).

 

How we measure it

 

KPIs – All KPIs measure the strength of our owner proposition

 

 

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

17


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Targeted Portfolio

Our Targeted Portfolio means we operate in the most attractive markets for IHG and in the highest opportunity segments based on guests’ occasion needs, with an asset-light business model – franchising and managing hotels rather than owning them.

 

 

 

 

Key performance indicators (KPIs) and What we have done in 2014

See pages 30 to 33

 

How we manage principal risks

See pages 28 and 29

 

 

Where we operate and detailed global and regional Performance

See pages 34 to 51

 

Managed and franchised model (our asset-light business model)

See pages 12 and 13

*Source: Smith Travel Research.

Attractive markets

Why we think this is important

Achieving scale and driving growth requires us to focus on those markets that are most attractive and where there is the best fit with our strategy and business model. These markets have large inbound and domestic demand for branded hotels or show great potential to have this in the future.

What we are doing

Whilst we operate in nearly 100 countries and territories and continue to expand our presence globally, we primarily focus our efforts on 10 priority markets in which we either have a strong existing competitive position or have a compelling opportunity to build one. These include a number of key emerging and more developed markets – US, Middle East, Germany, UK, Canada, Greater China, India, Russia and the Commonwealth of Independent States, Mexico and Indonesia. These currently represent 85 per cent of the IHG System and 89 per cent of the pipeline. We focus our brand building efforts and prioritise the investment in infrastructure in these markets, for instance, by adapting our websites to the local language and deploying dedicated sales teams. Depending on the market, we will adapt our model and proposition to owners to take into account local market characteristics.

The Performance section provides details of how we have performed in each of our regions and priority markets.

 

 

How we measure it

 

KPIs – Net rooms supply, Total gross revenue

 

Highest opportunity segments

Why we think this is important

Typically, the traditional hotel industry is segmented according to price point, and IHG is focused on the three segments that generate over 66 per cent* of branded hotels revenue – namely, midscale, upscale and luxury. We believe these segments have the highest growth opportunity and strongest resilience to the industry/economic cycle. However, we also recognise that guests choose a hotel based on their needs and the occasion, resulting in the possibility of the same guest staying across multiple hotel segments.

What we are doing

Our portfolio of brands is targeted around differing occasion segments. We tailor each of our brands to meet guests’ needs, looking at the differing occasion they are travelling for and their need for travelling.

We used this segmentation analysis to develop the brand proposition for both the HUALUXE Hotels and Resorts and EVEN Hotels brands (see page 20). It was also a consideration in the acquisition of Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants (see page 21).

 

 

How we measure it

 

KPIs – Guest HeartBeat, RevPAR

 

 

LOGO

Holiday Inn Manhattan – Financial District, New York, US

 

 

 

 

18


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

              HUALUXE Hotels and Resorts, People’s Republic of China

 

LOGO

              Crowne Plaza Beijing Lido, People’s Republic of China

 

Our Targeted Portfolio in action:

Greater China – a priority market

In 2014, IHG celebrated our 30th anniversary of operating in Greater China, one of our priority markets. We were the first international hotel company to enter the country in 1984, and we have developed a leading business in the region with 78,194 rooms open (241 hotels) and a further 54,338 rooms (189 hotels) in our development pipeline. In 2014, Greater China contributed 11 per cent of our Group operating profit before central overheads and exceptional items.

We originally developed our business in China’s tier 1 cities and along the eastern seaboard, and have more rooms today in tier 1 cities than our major international competitors. However, our more recent growth has focused on tier 2 and 3 cities, which are expected to generate significant long-term demand growth and, by 2022, nearly 80 per cent of the fast growing Chinese middle-class are expected to live in these cities. We achieved several key milestones for our Greater China business in 2014, for example, we:

 

    opened Crowne Plaza Beijing Lido with the same owner as our first hotel in the region (Holiday Inn Beijing Lido), demonstrating our established track record and the strength of our owner relationships in the region;  

 

    opened 10,648 rooms (34 hotels), our highest number of room openings since we started our business in the region, growing the IHG System size by 14 per cent;  

 

    signed 15,754 rooms (64 hotels), our best year for hotel signings since 2007; and  

 

    opened our 50th Holiday Inn Express hotel and signed our 50th pipeline hotel, making Holiday Inn Express the largest international limited-service brand in China.  

In February 2015, we opened our first hotel for the HUALUXE Hotels and Resorts brand in Yangjiang, slightly later than expected. As at 31 December 2014, we had 24 hotels (7,551 rooms) in the pipeline for the brand, which we will continue to build.

In addition to driving growth in Greater China, we are focused on establishing hotels that cater for Chinese guests in other locations outside China. Our China-Ready programme ensures we will be able to cater for the growing number of Chinese guests around the world through cultural and food and beverage training for hotel teams. We currently have 84 hotels in AMEA, The Americas and Europe that have signed up for the programme.

 

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

19


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Our Winning Model and

Targeted Portfolio in action

 

EVENTM Hotels

 

LOGO

“The EVEN Hotels brand allows owners to diversify their portfolio in a unique guest occasion segment.”

 

 

 

We announced the launch of a new hotel brand, EVEN Hotels, in February 2012. In June 2014, we opened our first hotels under the brand in Norwalk, Connecticut and in Rockville, Maryland.

Winning Model

 

LOGO Preferred brands delivered through our people

As part of having a portfolio of preferred brands, we continually review our portfolio of brands in light of the evolving needs and preferences of our guests. As part of this, EVEN Hotels was launched in 2012 as the first wellness lifestyle hotel brand. We developed the brand based on a large and growing traveller need for maintaining wellness routines while travelling. More than two years of research into consumer insights showed that there are 17 million wellness-minded travellers in the US alone who struggle to maintain healthy eating and exercise habits, get proper sleep and be productive when they are travelling away from home. Therefore, the brand was developed to meet a guest’s holistic wellness needs in the areas of exercise, food, work and rest. For example, an EVEN branded hotel offers nutritious menus and amenities, such as guest rooms designed for in-room workouts.

 

LOGO

Build and

leverage scale

IHG has committed up to $150 million of its own capital to the development of the EVEN brand over the next few years. In the future, we will look to recycle this capital, just as we did for both the Staybridge Suites and Hotel Indigo brands. As part of matching the brand to the right location, we are looking at core urban areas, dense office parks and suburban markets as well as considering the expansion of the brand beyond the US. As at 31 December 2014, we had three hotels (584 rooms) signed into our development pipeline and two hotels (296 rooms) open.

LOGO

Strong brand portfolio

and loyalty programme

We have been using our loyalty programme, IHG Rewards Club, to introduce our members to the EVEN Hotels brand, specifically targeting our communications at those guests who travel to, or have expressed an interest in, the locations of our first hotels, wellness or the brand itself.

 

LOGO

Effective channel

management

As with our other brands, we have leveraged our existing booking platforms to create a brand-specific webpage targeted via the app. We have specifically customised it to be brand specific to EVEN Hotels, focusing on wellness needs with relevant content and healthy lifestyle features such as fitness videos, ambient sounds, a diary of wellness-focused events organised by the hotel, and ‘wellness travel tips’.

 

LOGO

Superior owner

proposition

The EVEN Hotels brand allows owners to diversify their portfolio with a new IHG brand in a unique guest occasion segment. IHG, through its own capital investment, currently owns and manages the first two open EVEN hotels. Three additional hotels are currently in development. Owning and operating our first hotels enables us to showcase the brand to other potential owners.

Targeted Portfolio

Attractive markets

The US is one of our priority markets, and we opened the first EVEN hotels in cities where we have existing brand presence.

Highest opportunity segments

The EVEN Hotels brand has a strategic fit in our brand portfolio alongside Hotel Indigo, and now Kimpton, in the boutique and lifestyle segment. The brand is targeted at the unique segment of wellness and lifestyle.

Managed and franchised

We have used our own capital to develop the brand and will look to recycle this in the future. We will seek to accelerate growth for the brand through our managed and franchising model.

 

LOGO

EVEN Hotel Rockville, Maryland, US

 

 

 

 

20


Table of Contents
 
    
 

Acquisition of Kimpton® Hotels & Restaurants

 

LOGO

“We believe the Kimpton brand has enormous potential for growth.”

 

 

 

Our acquisition of Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants, the world’s largest independent boutique hotel operator, completed in January 2015. Kimpton is a highly successful business with a US-based portfolio comprising 62 managed hotels (11,300 rooms) and a further 16 hotels (3,000 rooms) in the pipeline (as at 16 January 2015). A sophisticated food and beverage operator, Kimpton also runs 71 hotel-based destination restaurants and bars.

Winning Model

 

LOGO Preferred brands delivered through our people

The Kimpton brand is renowned for having distinctive and innovative hotels located in attractive urban and resort locations. Each hotel aims to deliver a deeply personal, genuine and authentic service for guests and, whilst each hotel is unique, the brand has a number of common design and service principles and hallmarks. The Kimpton brand caters for a broad and varied range of guest needs.

 

LOGO

The Lumen, A Kimpton Hotel, Dallas, Texas, US

LOGO

Build and

leverage scale

The boutique segment, in which Kimpton operates, is the fastest growing in our industry over the last five years, and there is significant opportunity for future growth based on high levels of demand growth. We also believe the brand has enormous potential for growth outside the US and plan to capitalise on our scale, powerful distribution systems and owner networks to support its growth globally. We did this previously for our Hotel Indigo brand which started with a well-established base in the US and has now been expanded globally to 21 countries (including hotels in the pipeline).

 

LOGO

Strong brand portfolio

and loyalty programme

The Kimpton brand has a strong strategic fit within our existing brand portfolio at the upper upscale price point. It is also highly complementary with our Hotel Indigo and EVEN Hotels brands, creating a leading boutique and lifestyle hotel business, with over 200 open and pipeline hotels across 21 countries.

We plan to leverage Kimpton’s market-leading insight and strong track record in operational excellence, food and beverage, and design, to add value across our brand portfolio. Kimpton’s loyalty programme (Kimpton Karma) members account for 25 per cent of its room bookings.

 

LOGO

Effective channel

management

A large proportion of Kimpton’s business already comes through direct channels, driven by its most loyal guests. Each hotel has a dedicated website with engaging content, reflecting the boutique nature of the brand. We will leverage our digital platforms to accelerate Kimpton’s growth, whilst maintaining the uniqueness of Kimpton’s existing channels.

LOGO

Superior owner

proposition

The addition of Kimpton to IHG’s brand portfolio offers owners another attractive option in the boutique segment and access to a brand with a strong track record at the upper upscale price point. Its presence in the most attractive markets in the US has delivered excellent financial performance for both the business and its hotel owners. It also enables IHG to raise awareness of other IHG brands among owners of Kimpton branded hotels. Kimpton’s strong brand, combined with our scale and booking and distribution channels, will drive superior returns for owners.

Targeted Portfolio

Attractive markets

The US is one of our priority markets and Kimpton hotels currently have presence in the most attractive urban and resort locations, as well as the highest RevPAR markets such as San Francisco and New York.

Highest opportunity segments

The boutique hotel segment has been the fastest growing in our industry over the last five years, with demand, supply and RevPAR growth in boutique hotels in the US each significantly outperforming the overall industry.

Managed and franchised

Kimpton is a fully asset-light brand, operating hotels under management contracts.

 

 

More information on the acquisition of Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants can be found at www.ihgplc.com/kimpton

 

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

21


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Disciplined Execution

We recognise that successful delivery of our strategy for high-quality growth requires Disciplined Execution. We prioritise investment in our technology platforms and our people as well as delivering operational efficiencies.

 

 

 

Scale and efficiency

of operations

Investment in developing strong technology platforms

 

Why we think it is important

Driving efficient operational processes and managing our costs allows us to contribute to hotel performance through efficient practices, tools and systems. It also helps us strengthen our revenue delivery systems which means an increase in system contribution to hotel revenue, supporting our owner proposition and maximising our investment in building preferred brands. Careful cost management, leveraging our scale and focusing on productivity improvements also allows us to drive continued improvement in our margin.

What we are doing

To maximise the scale and efficiency of our operations, we:

 

  focus on spending in a way which enables further investment in our strategic priorities. Our procurement team has tools and processes which allow us to monitor and control spend and use our scale to deliver buying advantage. Our focus on cost efficiency and continuous improvement ensures we deploy our resources effectively, concentrating on the key priorities and activities that drive our business;

 

  introduced a new human resources system to streamline and improve the automation of our human resources processes in 2014 – see page 32; and

 

  continue to benefit from off-shoring our Business Service Centre in Gurgaon, India. This provides centralised accounting services for IHG corporate offices, and owned and managed hotels.

 

 

How we measure it

 

KPI – Fee margins

 

See page 32 for the KPI and
What we have done in 2014

 

Why we think it is important

As identified on page 11, technology, as used by travellers, is playing an increasingly important role in shaping the travel industry. The internet, which is now more than ever accessed through mobile devices, is used extensively to research, plan and book travel. In emerging markets, consumers are going straight to mobile devices, and there are now twice as many mobile internet users in China than internet users in the US. Guests are also seeking greater levels of personalisation, and are sharing their experiences instantly via social media.

We believe that keeping abreast of the evolving traveller trends and investing in technology systems will assist us in building brand preference, strengthen our loyalty programme and deliver compelling and engaging digital content across the ‘Guest Journey’ (which comprises five steps – Dream, Plan, Book, Stay and Share), thereby enabling us to build lifetime relationships with our guests.

What we are doing

To deliver the highest quality digital content for our guests, we are ensuring that we have the right technology foundations and infrastructure in place. In 2014, we:

 

  standardised on property hardware for all IHG hotels in the US, providing a consistent platform that allows us to develop solutions such as Mobile Check-in and Check-out (now available in over 500 hotels);

 

  piloted enhanced customer relationship management capability that allows us to utilise our IHG Rewards Club members’ profiles to drive personalisation and guest recognition in our hotels;

 

  implemented new digital marketing capabilities that allow us to target potential guests more effectively through the internet; and

 

  announced our strategic partnership with Amadeus, the leading provider of advanced technology solutions for the global travel industry, to explore technology solutions.

Improving our technology infrastructure gives us the foundation to transform the guest experience and make it more interactive through digital content. In 2014, we:

 

  increased mobile bookings by 50 per cent to $900 million and downloads of the IHG app grew by 80 per cent;

 

  made numerous improvements to our award-winning mobile app, including the launch of IHG translator, a learning tool which engages our guests and drives greater interaction; and

 

  created benefits for our IHG Rewards Club members, including multi-brand campaigns that include over one million automatically tailored offers generated using specific insights from each guest’s profile and stay history – $360 million in revenue was generated by the 2014 ‘Big Win’ IHG Rewards Club promotion.

 

 

How we measure it

 

KPI – System contribution to delivery

 

See page 30 for the KPI and
What we have done in 2014

 

 

 

 

 

22


Table of Contents

 

 

        InterContinental Sydney Double Bay, Australia

 

LOGO

 

 

 

Investment in developing great talent

 

Who are our employees?

 

 

Why we think it is important

Our people bring our brands to life on a daily basis, delivering on each individual brand promise to enhance the guest experience. They are, therefore, a critical part of our success. Accordingly, we recognise the importance of attracting, retaining and developing the very best talent in the industry to service our guests and bring our brands to life.

 

What we are doing

To achieve this, the four pillars of our people strategy have consistently been:

 

1. To develop a BrandHearted culture

Each of our brands delivers a differentiated guest experience dependent upon the brand’s strategy. This is delivered by our people who place brands at the centre of this helping to drive guest satisfaction and brand preference, which we measure through Guest HeartBeat – a KPI.

 

2. To make IHG a great place to work

Building a strong employer brand assists us in attracting the best possible talent to meet our strategic objectives:

 

  we ask our people to live our Winning Ways (set out above) and act in a responsible way – see pages 24 and 25 for how acting responsibly is part of our culture; and

 

  we offer our people our Room to be yourself commitment, which is brought to life by four promises:

 

–  Room to have a great start: This assists us in recruiting the right people for each brand and role. New recruits are offered a structured orientation programme to provide them with an understanding of IHG’s strategy and values.

 

–  Room to be involved: We communicate with employees on matters relating to the Group’s business and performance and share information on people, policies and news across IHG through various channels, including conferences, team meetings and our intranet site. We encourage employees to give regular feedback

to ensure IHG meets expectations and delivers on its commitments – this is formally done twice a year through the Employee Engagement survey, the results of which are a KPI.

 

–  Room to grow: Our people are given access to the required support, experience and training and provided with development opportunities.

 

–  Room for you: We recognise achievements and communicate these throughout our business.

 

3. To deliver world-class People Tools to our owners and hotels

Our People Tools are industry-leading best practices tailored specifically for our brands, and assist hotel management and human resources teams to hire, train, involve and recognise our colleagues. By working to increase employee retention and performance, guest satisfaction and drive efficiencies, they help increase revenue for our owners (helping us with our owner proposition).

 

4. Building a strong leadership and performance culture

We have established a ‘winning culture’ at IHG, this starts with building a strong leadership from the top – see pages 57 to 69 for our Board and Executive Committee leadership.

 

For alignment of our performance culture with our strategic priorities and KPIs in our corporate offices for our senior executives, – see the Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 76 to 91.

 

Having a predominantly managed and franchised estate means that not all of those people who work at our hotels are our employees. When the Group’s entire estate is taken into account (including those working in our franchised and managed hotels), over 350,000 people worked globally across IHG’s brands as at 31 December 2014.

 

IHG employed the following as at 31 December 2014:

 

  7,797 people worldwide (including those in our corporate offices, central reservations offices and owned hotels (excluding those in a category below)), whose costs were borne by the Group;

 

  4,975 people who worked directly on behalf of the System Fund and whose costs were borne by the System Fund;

 

  602 General Managers who work in our managed hotels and whose costs were borne by those hotels; and

 

  11,848 other hotel workers who work in our managed hotels, who have contracts or letters of service with IHG and whose costs were borne by those hotels.

 

See pages 120 and 152 for more information.

 

 
    

 

How we measure it

 

KPIs – Employee engagement, Guest HeartBeat

 

See pages 31 and 32 for KPIs and What we have done in 2014

 

 
    

 

Diversity and inclusion

 

 

 

As a global organisation operating in nearly 100 countries around the world, we recognise the importance and benefit of ensuring our workforce fully represents the communities in which we operate and the guests who stay in our hotels. As at 31 December 2014:

 

  5 of the 13 Directors on the Board were female (38%);

 

  32 out of 127 of the senior managers employed by the Group (including directors of subsidiaries) were female (25%); and

 

  7,069 out of the 12,772 employed by the Group and whose costs were borne by the Group or the System Fund were female (55%).

 

See page 62 for further information on our approach to diversity (including our diversity policies) from the Board level and throughout the organisation.

 

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

23


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Doing business responsibly

A commitment to responsible business practices underpins our entire strategy and the way we work. We recognise the importance it has for all of our stakeholders in making IHG and its brands their preferred choice.

 

 

 

Why we think it is important

We believe that by ensuring our business is committed to responsible business practices we will enhance and protect the reputation of IHG and our brands. It provides us with the opportunity to protect the environment, create job opportunities, improve community resilience and make us more innovative. Doing the right thing in the right way enables us to make an even greater contribution to the locations where we operate. It also ensures we act in a manner that benefits all of our stakeholders, including employees, guests, corporate customers, owners and the local community, who are increasingly considering whether the businesses with which they interact share their values. This provides us with a competitive edge, assisting us to deliver profitable growth and create shared value for all stakeholders in the long term.

 

 

How we measure it and

What we have done in 2014

 

KPIs – Employee engagement and all those KPIs set out on page 33

 

Our commitment to responsible business underpins our whole strategy and contributes to our success across all areas.

 

See pages 32 and 33 for progress against our KPIs.

 

Five-year corporate responsibility targets

These were released in September 2013, and are centred on measuring our impact on the environment and community (at both global and local level) and demonstrating our commitment to doing business responsibly and creating shared value for IHG and its stakeholders:

 

  some of these are KPIs; and

 

  the progress against others can be found in our Responsible Business Report.

 

 

 

Further information, including our Responsible Business Report, can be found at www.ihgplc.com/responsiblebusiness

 

What we are doing

Our commitment to responsible business is part of our culture. Our responsible business practices include:

Governance and leadership

Our Chairman, the Board and its Committees provide a strong leadership and governance structure. They promote responsible business behaviour by maintaining high standards of corporate governance, internal controls and risk management and compliance with relevant laws and regulations.

 

 

For information on our Board and governance processes, see pages 54 to 91.

Commitment to responsible business practices

We have a reputation for delivering a consistent and superior guest experience, we provide a safe and secure environment and we actively engage with our communities. Our brands are valuable assets and doing business responsibly enhances their reputation and builds trust and brand preference.

Responsible procurement

Our Vendor Code of Conduct sets out standards to which we require our supply chain partners to operate. We are committed to promoting diversity across our responsible procurement agenda and have set targets to ensure corporate responsibility criteria are integrated into the selection and evaluation process for preferred suppliers.

Health, safety and security

A safe and secure environment for our guests, employees and those working at or visiting our hotels and corporate offices is important. IHG has therefore established a set of policies, procedures and measures, and complies with relevant legislation. We ensure the protection and well-being of those working for IHG through suitable work-based strategies, minimise the risk of injury from work activity, ensure that sufficient information is provided and systems are in place to address health and safety concerns, and involve employees in the continuous improvement, reporting and review of health and safety matters.

Risk management

We have in place an effective system of internal controls and risk management to identify, assess, prioritise and mitigate risks to our business, guests and employees, which enables us to achieve our shared objectives. This is an essential part of being a responsible business.

 

 

For information on our risk management practices and systems of internal controls, see pages 26 to 29.

People

Being a responsible business cannot be achieved without the support and active engagement of our people. They are fundamental to ensuring we operate an ethical business. Our Winning Ways (see page 23) are a set of behaviours that we internally promote to assist with how we interact with our guests and colleagues.

As part of acting responsibly and putting in place a responsible business ethos, we have policies and training in place to ensure our people are kept aware of and understand the key legal and regulatory areas affecting them in their roles, such as competition, anti-bribery and data privacy laws and procedures, crisis management and brand safety standards. We do this through a range of programmes, policies and training, which we regularly keep under review and which are communicated via e-learning and face-to-face training modules.

Our Code of Conduct consolidates and clarifies expected standards of behaviour and communicates the ethical values of the Group. It is applicable to all Directors, officers and employees and is available at www.ihgplc.com/investors under corporate governance.

We also have a confidential disclosure channel to provide employees with a means to report any ethical concerns they may have.

 

 

For information on our investment in developing our talent and who are our employees, see page 23.

 

 

 

 

24


Table of Contents

 

IHG Academy - Holiday Inn Express Stoke On Trent, UK

 

LOGO

 

 

 

Human rights

We focus on those areas of human rights most relevant to our business, ensuring the rights of the local people where we operate are protected. We are working to raise further awareness of our human rights approach in our hotels through embedding it as a brand standard, and will continue to develop our training materials. We are a signatory to the UN Global Compact, aligning our operations and strategies with the 10 universal principles that include commitments to human rights and labour standards. We are part of the Business in the Community cross industry working group on human rights as well as the International Tourism Partnership’s Human Trafficking Working Group. We are also working with our internal procurement team to embed further our human rights approach into our contracts.

 

Corporate responsibility

Our global scale provides us with an opportunity to make a positive impact on the environment and communities in which we operate. Our five-year corporate responsibility targets, released in September 2013, focus on measuring this impact.

Each one of our hotels is a central part of its community, from creating jobs and stimulating local economic opportunities, to managing their environmental impact in a responsible way and providing shelter in times of need. We work to develop new and better ways to assist owners to build and operate IHG branded hotels, creating sustainable value for our brands, business and stakeholders, as well as addressing social and environmental challenges. Our three bespoke corporate responsibility programmes are a key part of this and we

work very closely with our owners and colleagues to maximise the positive impact of these initiatives:

 

  IHG Green EngageTM system: Helps us minimise our impact on the environment by tracking and managing the use of energy, carbon and water and waste in our hotels. This assists us in delivering both more environmentally sustainable hotels and cost efficiencies for owners.

 

  IHG® Academy: A collaboration between our hotels and local schools, colleges and community organisations to help people develop the skills they need to improve their employability and secure a job in the hotel industry.

 

  IHG® Shelter in a Storm: Empowers our hotels to support guests, colleagues and local communities in times of disaster with financial support, vital supplies and accommodation.
 

 

 

IHG’s global greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions

 

By delivering more environmentally sustainable hotels, we can drive cost efficiencies for owners as well as meet the expectations of all our stakeholders. We recognise the importance of reducing our global greenhouse gas emissions for corporate offices and hotels – our target is to reduce our carbon footprint per occupied room by 12% across our entire estate by 2017 (against a 2012 baseline). See page 33 for progress.

 

    

 

Scope

We report Scope 1 and 2 emissions as defined by the GHG protocol as follows:

 

•  Scope 1 (Direct emissions): combustion of fuel and operation of facilities; and

 

•  Scope 2 (Indirect emissions): electricity, heat, steam and cooling purchased for own use.

 

Methodology

We have worked with external consultants to give us an up-to-date picture of IHG’s carbon footprint and assess the performance over the past few years. The external consultants use a sampling and extrapolation methodology to estimate our GHG emissions.

 

For 2014, in line with the methodology set out in the GHG Protocol Corporate Standard, the sample covered 1,402 of our 4,840 hotels. As IHG System size is continually changing and the hotels reporting data to the IHG Green Engage system increases annually, we are restating the impacts for all years from the baseline year 2012 annually to enable comparisons to be made.

 

 

Reporting boundary

Measure

 

20141   

 

 

20131   

 

 

Global – corporate offices and managed, franchised, owned and leased hotels2 (a KPI and part of our five-year targets)

 

Scope 1 Direct emissions 1,365,883   1,280,973  
Scope 2 Indirect emissions 3,792,771   3,683,737  
Total GHG emissions (tCO2e) 5,158,654   4,964,710  

 

IHG’s chosen intensity measurement GHG emissions per occupied room (kgCO2e per occupied room)

32.3   33.4  

Global – corporate offices and managed, owned and leased hotels2 (as required under the Companies Act 2006)

 

Scope 1 Direct emissions 496,316   486,086  
Scope 2 Indirect emissions 1,921,077   1,847,304  
Total GHG emissions (tCO2e) 2,417,393   2,333,390  

IHG’s chosen intensity measurement GHG emissions per occupied room (kgCO2e per occupied room)

 

59.2   62.2  

 

1   Reporting period commencing on 1 October and ending on 30 September – due to the delay in hotels receiving their energy bills it is not possible to report accurately GHG emissions from 1 January to 31 December.

2   Includes all of our branded hotels but does not include emissions from 88 hotels. We do not have sufficient data to estimate their emissions and believe them to be immaterial.

 
 
                       

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

25


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Risk management

IHG believes that an essential part of being a responsible business is having in place robust and effective risk management and internal controls. This supports our business to be resilient, successful and trusted.

 

 

 

IHG’s approach to risk management

The Board is ultimately accountable for risk management across the organisation. It is supported by the Audit Committee, the Executive Committee and other delegated committees who collectively set the tone and appetite for risk management at IHG.

This is cascaded down to the day-to-day activities of IHG corporate offices and hotels through well-established and continuously improving policies, processes, systems and controls which set out clear accountability, and are supported by tools, training and communication to ensure risks are effectively managed.

Risks are further identified, assessed, mitigated and monitored by functional specialists and, where deemed necessary, periodically reviewed by internal and external auditors. These activities are typically grouped into ‘Three Lines of Defence’ as shown on the right. IHG’s Global Risk Management team provide subject matter expertise, leadership and support across all these activities.

Embedded risk management processes

IHG has in place a Major Risk Review process to:

 

  enable the business to identify, assess, manage and monitor the principal risks and uncertainties affecting the Group (the Major Risks); and

 

  support the Executive Committee, Audit Committee and the Board to monitor, review and reflect upon the progress of risk management activities across the portfolio of Major Risks on a biannual basis.

The Major Risks align closely with our strategy and business priorities, and also identify those issues which are most likely to significantly affect other operational, commercial or reputational matters and, as such, are regularly discussed at senior leadership team and committee meetings.

Our Risk Working Group (RWG) ensures there is sufficient focus and effective management of the Major Risks, and seeks to improve cross-functional working and effective risk management of the highest priority and emerging risks affecting IHG. The RWG is chaired by the General Counsel and Company Secretary and comprises the heads of Global Risk Management, Global Strategy, Programme Office and Global Internal Audit.

Underpinning the Group’s Major Risk Review process, each of the regions and functions have their own risk profiles that are updated quarterly in line with the activities of the strategic planning cycle. During the interim periods, continuous dialogue takes place between risk owners and risk subject-matter experts to develop, execute and monitor detailed risk assessments, risk mitigation strategies, controls and key risk indicators.

LOGO

 

 

 

 

26


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

Holistic approach to risk assessment

IHG conducts risk assessments to identify, prioritise and inform decisions on risk mitigation. Risks are first assessed from an inherent or gross risk perspective (unmitigated risk). Then, internal controls and mitigation activities are identified and developed resulting in a residual or net risk assessment (mitigated risk, net of controls). This is informed by the performance monitoring of internal key risk indicators, which provide objective evidence as to how effectively the risk is being managed. IHG and its Board think broadly and holistically about potential risks to the business, across the following categories:

 

  Risk What are these?

 

Who manages them?

 

 
  Strategic

Risks arising from IHG’s relationship with the external environment that can impact on IHG’s ambition and strategy over the long term.

 

Include major market and environmental changes or events that could impact our reputation across key stakeholder groups.

•  Leadership is provided by the Board, the Executive Committee, the Regional Operating Committees and functional leadership teams.

 

•  Expertise, co-ordination and oversight is provided by Global Strategy in conjunction with Global Risk Management to drive IHG’s leadership to make decisions around its portfolio of brands, key markets, business model and approach to ethics and other reputational matters.

 

 
  Tactical

Risks that could impact the delivery of IHG’s one to three-year commitments.

 

Include, but are not limited to, factors influencing IHG’s ability to sign and open new hotels, the performance of existing hotels and the delivery of projects that align with strategic planning processes.

•  Performance and delivery risks are managed by senior leaders and reported to the Regional Operating Committees and functional leadership teams.

 

•  Project risks are managed by project management teams with oversight provided by our internal Programme Office and supported by Global Risk Management.

 

 
  Operational

Risks which include a wide spectrum of day-to-day risks that frontline hotel colleagues and corporate teams face when dealing with guests or ensuring corporate systems and processes are running smoothly.

 

Include, but are not limited to, those managing the safety and security of our people and assets, the continuity of the business, third-party service providers and the wider supply chain.

•  Operational risks are managed by frontline hotel colleagues.

 

•  Oversight is provided, in the context of the managed and franchised business models, by specialist functional teams, with leadership provided by the Regional Operating Committees.

 

•  Due to the nature of operational risks, IHG typically mitigates these through policies, operational and business processes and other internal controls supported by systems, tools and training. Subject-matter expertise, leadership and co-ordination is provided by Global Risk Management and functional specialists.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

27


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Risk management continued

 

 

Managing risks in a changing environment

We continue to experience an increasingly risk aware and dynamic external risk environment with changes in political, economic, social, technological, legal and environmental risks. However, the Group’s asset-light business model, diversity of brand portfolio and wide geographical spread contribute to IHG’s resilience to events that could affect specific hotels or local areas.

The table below sets out the principal risks and uncertainties (the Major Risks) in the context of delivering against our strategy for high-quality growth (as described on pages 14 to 25). Whilst the external risk environment is increasingly volatile, uncertain and competitive, this is offset by our decision-making and strengthening risk culture, and efforts to continuously improve controls and mitigation actions (some of which is summarised below). These Major Risks align to our strategic priorities and are therefore proactively managed and monitored by senior management. They complement the wider comprehensive risk factors set out on pages 162 to 165.

 

   

 

Risk description

 

 

 

Controls and mitigations

 
   

Preferred brands

 

Having a portfolio of brands with a clear, distinct brand proposition aimed at meeting increasingly personalised guest needs and the occasions they are travelling for, and delivering a consistent experience, is crucial to creating brand preference, loyalty and advocacy.

 

Failure to achieve this could impact on IHG’s competitive position and our reputation with guests, owners and investors.

 

LOGO   LOGO

 

•  Each of the brands in our portfolio of brands is designed to meet specific guest needs and occasions through distinct and complementary brand propositions (see pages 4, 5 and 18). Our recent acquisition of Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants adds to the strength of our portfolio and, together with EVEN and Hotel Indigo, enhances our boutique and lifestyle business (see pages 20 and 21).

 

•  We will continue to deliver on the growth of the Kimpton brand, running it as a standalone business to preserve its uniqueness.

 

•  We continually review ways to increase awareness and loyalty towards our brands through our loyalty programme, IHG Rewards Club, as well as a blend of global and local marketing promotions, sponsorships and brand initiatives to create synergies across the brand portfolio.

 

•  We manage brand consistency through the entire hotel life cycle supported by clear contractual terms, new hotel opening processes, brand standard requirements and compliance processes. This is supported by tools, training and guidance to assist those working at our hotels and owners to enable them to deliver brand consistency.

 

 
   

Leadership and talent

 

IHG must recruit and retain the right people and give them the tools, guidance and support to be successful in order to deliver a preferred brand promise. Recruiting and retaining people to work in its hotels, especially in rapidly growing emerging markets, is a particular challenge and ensuring we have the right leadership is crucial.

 

Failure to manage these could impact on IHG’s service delivery and IHG’s brands, result in increased cost of recruitment and have a broader impact on performance and delivery.

 

LOGO   LOGO   LOGO

 

•  We have in place a comprehensive global people strategy (see page 23) to ensure we are able to recruit, retain and develop talent at our hotels, corporate offices and central reservations offices. This includes our Room to be yourself commitment underpinned by a set of globally consistent policies, guidance, systems and tools, with localisation where appropriate.

 

•  Supplementing the global strategy, we have developed local people strategies for some of our priority markets to ensure we are best placed to be the employer of choice in these markets. These strategies make necessary adjustments to meet local languages, laws, customs and cultural nuances and to effectively leverage local recruitment channels.

 

•  IHG Academy assists us to fill our talent pipeline whilst supporting the local communities (see page 25).

 

•  Our leadership framework, support tools, and training and development programmes help our people grow their careers, thereby managing internal talent. We proactively manage and monitor succession planning at all levels. We consider the diversity (more broadly than gender) of our people and leadership, reviewing it in light of our guests and the local communities in which we operate (see page 62).

 

   
 

How each Major Risk links to our strategic priorities (described on pages 16 to 25)

 

LOGO Winning Model

 

LOGO Targeted Portfolio

 

LOGO Disciplined Execution

 

LOGO Responsible Business

 

 

 

 

 

28


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

 

 

Risk description

 

Controls and mitigations
 
 

Channel management and technology platforms

 

Booking and distribution channels and technological systems are a key part of delivering across the ‘Guest Journey’ and an important value driver for our owners. This is also an area where there is rapid change in terms of technology, guest expectations and relationships, with online travel intermediaries and travel agents impacting guests booking direct.

 

Threats to information security, from payment card information and other information held in IT systems, paper format and other formats, is a growing concern which could impact our operations, result in fines and other incremental costs, and undermine stakeholder trust in our business.

 

Failure to effectively manage and keep under review our channels and information technology infrastructure to optimise performance and resilience could impact on IHG’s revenue delivery systems, guest experience, return for our owners and investors, and IHG’s future performance.

 

LOGO   LOGO   LOGO

 

•  We recognise that technological advances and changing guest expectations mean that we must continually invest in, and improve, our technological systems (see page 22) to deliver across the ‘Guest Journey’ to build lifetime relationships with our guests. Our focus is on encouraging guests to use direct booking channels. However, recognising that some travellers use online travel agencies and intermediaries, IHG seeks to secure better terms with them on behalf of our owners.

 

•  Our Global Technology function works collaboratively with specialist third-party technology partners to continuously monitor, manage and optimise our systems and channels, including their resilience through backup systems and business continuity practices, to enhance all aspects of the ‘Guest Journey’.

 

•  Operating in nearly 100 countries and territories, IHG takes information security very seriously and has applied risk-based methods to build capability and resilience into our systems and processes. We manage data security to contain the risk and reduce the Group’s exposure, tightly controlling sensitive data through limited and monitored access.

 

•  We continue to aim to be fully compliant with Payment Card Industry – Data Security Standards (PCI-DSS) using tools and services from a leading specialist third-party provider with respect to payment-card processing.

 

 

Owner proposition

 

As a result of IHG’s predominantly franchised and managed business model and the increasingly competitive market for deals, maintaining strong relationships with owners, having a compelling value proposition, and demonstrating attractive returns on investment for our existing, new and potential owners is critical to sustaining IHG’s growth.

 

Failure to manage the owner proposition may result in the poor retention of hotels, and impact on IHG’s System size and development pipeline.

 

LOGO   LOGO   LOGO   LOGO

 

 

•  IHG’s regional teams build relationships with owners through a variety of methods, including formal and informal communications and owner conferences. We continually review and update our central support tools and systems, to offer a compelling owner proposition (see page 17).

 

•  IHG works closely with the IHG Owners Association, to ensure we have an understanding and insight into owners’ perspectives, particularly with respect to new programmes and initiatives (see www.ihgplc.com/ihgowners for a message from the 2014 Chairman of the IHG Owners Association).

 

•  The System Fund (described on page 49) is managed by IHG for the benefit of all our hotels with the objective of driving revenue for them, and its use is reviewed annually in collaboration with the IHG Owners Association.

 

•  Long-term franchise and management contracts, owner due diligence, new hotel opening teams and processes, Hotel Solutions (our internal online portal which provides tools and guidance to hotels across a number of operational areas) and the wider corporate infrastructure are put in place to leverage scale, support our hotels and maintain relationships with owners throughout the life cycle of the hotel.

 

 

Reputation and brand protection

 

IHG recognises the importance of its brands and reputation as important assets for the business. Societal and legal changes are increasingly holding organisations accountable for activities associated with their extended enterprise. With digital technology, news and the media, including social media, heighten the need for IHG, all those working in our hotels and corporate offices, owners and business partners to behave responsibly. Reputation is a complex matter that involves all areas of business.

 

Failure to safeguard the reputation of IHG and our brands could have a severe impact on the Group’s future performance.

 

LOGO   LOGO

 

 

•  Our commitment to responsible business underpins our strategy and is embedded in our culture throughout the organisation (see pages 24 and 25).

 

•  We have in place a comprehensive set of internal policies, processes and other internal controls supported by tools, training, monitoring and reporting.

 

•  Leadership in this area is provided by IHG’s Business Reputation and Responsibility function comprising lawyers, brand standard compliance managers, chartered secretaries, corporate responsibility specialists, risk managers and internal auditors who work together with the rest of the business to champion and protect the trusted reputation of IHG and our brands.

 

•  Our proactive risk-based approach to safety and security, intellectual property, regulatory compliance, litigation, crisis management and human rights are examples of the activities in place to manage reputational risk.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

29


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Key performance indicators (KPIs)

We measure our performance through a set of carefully selected KPIs which monitor our success in achieving our strategy and the progress of our Group to deliver high-quality growth. The KPIs are organised around the framework of our strategy – our Winning Model and Targeted Portfolio, underpinned by Disciplined Execution and Doing Business Responsibly.

 

 

 

Winning Model and Targeted Portfolio

 

KPIs    2014 progress       2015 priorities

 

Net rooms supply1,2

 

LOGO

 

Net total number of IHG

rooms in the IHG System.

 

 

Growth in fee revenues1,2

 

LOGO

 

At constant currency

 

Group revenue excluding revenue from owned and leased hotels, managed leases and significant liquidated damages.

 

  

 

In line with our 2014 priorities, in relation to:

 

•   growth, particularly in priority markets (as at 31 December 2014):

 

-   IHG System size – 710,295 rooms (4,840 hotels), reflecting 3.4% net IHG System size growth in 2014, the strongest since 2009;

 

-   610,274 rooms (4,351 hotels) of the IHG System are in our priority markets – 85%;

 

-   IHG’s pipeline – 193,772 rooms (1,221 hotels), with 2014 having the highest signings in six years; and

 

-   173,252 rooms (1,117 hotels) of our pipeline are in our priority markets – 89%.

 

•   supporting the growth of the HUALUXE Hotels and Resorts and EVEN Hotels brands, we:

 

-   opened our first 2 EVEN hotels in 2014 (see page 20) and, in February 2015, the first HUALUXE hotel (see page 19); and

 

-   had 3 EVEN hotels (one of which is owned) and 24 HUALUXE hotels in the pipeline (as at 31 December 2014).

     

 

¿ Continue to accelerate growth strategies in priority markets, and key locations in agreed scale markets, and continue to leverage scale.

 

¿ Continue to support the growth of the EVEN and HUALUXE brands.

 

LOGO Drive growth of the Kimpton brand in the US and create the foundation to establish the brand globally.

 

 

Total gross revenue from hotels in IHG’s System

 

LOGO

 

Actual $bn

 

Total rooms revenue from franchised hotels and total hotel revenue from managed, owned and leased hotels. It is not revenue attributable to IHG, as it is derived from hotels owned by third parties. It is an indicator of the scale and reach of IHG’s brands.

 

 

System contribution to revenue1,2

 

LOGO

 

The per cent of room revenue delivered through IHG’s direct and indirect systems and channels.

 

  

 

In line with our 2014 priorities, in relation to:

 

•   continuing to drive loyalty to our portfolio of brands and driving awareness of IHG Rewards Club, we:

 

-   enrolled 7m new IHG Rewards Club members (up 9% on 2013), taking the total to 84m members;

 

-   continued to win awards including the ‘Best Hotel Rewards Programme in the World’ by Global Traveler magazine (see www.ihgplc.com/ourbrands);

 

-   extended free internet access for all IHG Rewards Club members across our hotels globally;

 

-   launched the first global promotion by IHG Rewards Club, ‘Big Win’, aimed at encouraging members to stay at more hotels within IHG’s portfolio; and

 

-   enhanced our ancillary programmes such as Business Rewards, Dining Rewards and co-branded credit cards to extend our relationship with guests.

 

•   continuing with investment in technology systems and platforms:

 

-   we launched Mobile Check-in and Check-out at more than 500 hotels; and

 

-   see page 22 for further initiatives undertaken in 2014.

 

•   continuing to strengthen our revenue delivery, we delivered 71% system contribution to revenue, including $4bn of digital revenues with 50% growth in mobile bookings to over $900m.

 

•   continuing to drive the adoption and impact of our performance tools, systems and processes amongst our owners – there was an increase of over 20% in the adoption of Revenue Management for Hire.

 

     

 

¿ Continue to drive adoption and impact of our performance tools, systems and processes amongst our owners.

 

LOGO Continue to enhance the functionality and performance of our direct channels to make these the preferred way to book.

 

LOGO Drive preference for IHG Rewards Club and leverage this to build deeper, lifetime relationships with our guests.

 

LOGO Continue with investment in technology systems and platforms and embed leading-edge digital technology and enhanced capabilities.

 

 

 

 

30


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

Link between KPIs and Directors’ remuneration

KPIs which could have an impact on the performance measures for remuneration plans:

1 Annual incentive plan (Annual Performance Plan)

2 Long-term incentive plan (Long Term Incentive Plan)

 

 

For more information see Directors’ Remuneration Report pages 76 to 91.

Explanation as to how 2015 priorities have evolved from 2014 priorities:

¿ Same priority as 2014

LOGO  Specific progress made in 2014 against 2014 priority, the priority has accordingly been updated for 2015

LOGO  New priority for 2015 in line with changes to our business

 

 

 

 

KPIs 2014 progress   2015 priorities

 

Global RevPAR growth1,2

 

LOGO

 

Comparable hotels, at constant currency

 

Revenue per available room: Rooms revenue divided by the number of room nights that are available (can be mathematically derived from occupancy rate multiplied by average daily rate).

 

 

Guest HeartBeat1

 

LOGO

 

IHG’s guest satisfaction measurement tool to measure brand preference and guest satisfaction.

 

 

In line with our 2014 priorities, in relation to:

 

•   strengthening the quality and consistency of the brand experience, delivering guest journeys that are differentiated by brands, we:

 

-   clarified each of the brand propositions (see pages 4, 5 and 16);

 

-   recorded improvements in guest satisfaction scores in every region for our brands, leading to a global Guest HeartBeat score of 83.83%; and

 

-   received external recognition for our brands and hotels through winning over 300 global, regional and hotel level awards – see www.ihgplc.com/ourbrands.

 

•   continuing to progress with our standards refresh across the brands, we launched the Holiday Inn Express, Holiday Inn, EVEN, Crowne Plaza and InterContinental standards manuals online.

 

•   supporting the openings of the first EVEN and HUALUXE hotels (see pages 19 and 20).

 

•   continuing to invest in building long-term brand preference across our brands in line with segmentation by guest needs and occasions:

 

-   for the Crowne Plaza Hotels & Resorts brand, we introduced a new, innovatively designed guest room focused on meeting the changing needs of today’s modern business traveller;

 

-   for the InterContinental Hotel & Resorts brand, we rolled out the new signature InterContinental Planet Trekkers menu, created exclusively for children, across our properties;

 

-   to deliver the Holiday Inn brand experience, we continued to roll out the ‘Open Lobby’ concept across the brand, having opened five in the UK;

 

-   we further delivered on meeting guests’ changing needs by introducing a new Holiday Inn Express prototype design, which was co-created with hotel owners and through guest insights; and

 

-   we acquired Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants in January 2015 (see page 21).

 

•   empowering our frontline teams with the tools and training to consistently deliver great guest experiences that build brand preference:

 

-   2,000 hotel General Managers globally have participated in our Journey to Brand Manager programme; and

 

-   we embedded the IHG General Manager Programme for new hotel General Managers, with nearly 1,200 hotel General Managers having participated.

 

 

 

¿ Strengthen frontline training and capabilities to consistently deliver great guest experiences that build brand preference.

 

LOGO Continue to strengthen the quality and consistency of the brand experience, delivering guest journeys that are differentiated by brand and building long-term brand preference across our brands.

 

LOGO Embed refreshed brand standards across our brands.

 

LOGO Continue to operate the Kimpton brand successfully as part of the IHG portfolio.

 

 

 

 

Our regional priorities and progress in each of the regions are set out on pages 37, 40, 43 and 46.

 

 

LOGO

 

 

31


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Key performance indicators (KPIs) continued

 

 

Disciplined Execution

 

KPIs    2014 progress       2015 priorities

Fee margins1

 

LOGO

 

*   Restated for IAS19R ‘Employee Benefits’

 

Operating profit as a percentage of revenue, excluding revenue and operating profit from owned and leased hotels, managed leases and significant liquidated damages.

 

  

•   In line with our 2014 priority to continue to focus on sustainable fee margin progression over the medium term, we delivered Group fee margins of 44.7%, up 1.5 percentage points on 2013, benefiting from slightly higher than usual strong growth in our scale markets.

 

•   Through leveraging our scale and focusing on productivity improvements, we intend to continue growing fee margins over the medium term. However, we will balance this with investing behind critical business capabilities to maximise top-line growth as well.

 

     

LOGO  Continue to focus on sustainable fee margin progression over the medium term.

 

 

Employee Engagement survey scores1

 

LOGO

 

Average of a twice-yearly employee engagement survey, completed by employees and those who work in our managed hotels (excluding our joint ventures).

 

  

 

In line with our 2014 priorities, in relation to:

 

•   delivering our people strategy (see page 23), we increased our Employee Engagement survey score by 3 percentage points on 2013 and we continue to be recognised externally as an employer of choice – see page 9 and www.ihgplc.com/aboutus under our awards.

 

•   strengthening our approach to developing leaders and investing in tools and training that build leadership capabilities we:

 

-   launched new global leadership development programmes;

 

-   increased leadership succession through new appointments and internal promotions at senior levels and internal organisational changes in line with business priorities; and

 

-   improved our human resources systems and services through the introduction of a single system creating a streamlined, globally consistent approach to how we manage our people globally.

 

•   continuing to build a ‘winning culture’ (a high performing culture) through strong leadership and performance management, we:

 

-   introduced a new approach to performance management driving closer alignment of our global objectives, with stronger team collaboration and a simpler connection between achievement and reward;

 

-   rolled out a global metrics approach which requires each area of the business to align to their highest priorities; and

 

-   built a ‘winning culture’ champions network from our senior leadership population, to shape and deliver this approach globally.

 

•   improving the leadership capability of our frontline managers and supervisors, we launched a new frontline manager and a supervisor programme aimed at building critical skills to drive performance within our hotels.

 

Responsible business activities continue to drive high levels of pride in our employees with 92% of respondents of our Employee Engagement survey saying overall they felt more positive about IHG as a result of its responsible business initiatives and/or programmes.

 

     

 

LOGO  Continue to focus on developing our ‘winning culture’ through our leaders, in particular on how we build a higher level of feedback and coaching to drive performance.

 

LOGO  Review our learning practices across our corporate and hotel operations to shape the way we leverage learning over the next five years in line with business priorities.

 

LOGO  Review how we develop and retain talent and use our new human resources system to deliver better talent analytics and insight.

 

 

 

 

32


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

Doing business responsibly

 

KPIs   2014 progress   2015 priorities

Number of people

participating in IHG

Academy programmes

 

LOGO

 

In line with our 2014 priorities to expand the IHG Academy:

 

•   6,666 people benefited from our global IHG Academy programmes in 2014, taking the total to 13,057 people since 2013; and

 

•   we expanded our IHG Academy to 626 programmes (as at 31 December 2014), which includes participation by 409 hotels in 58 countries – an increase of 325 programmes from 2013.

 

¿ Provide skills and improved employability to a total of 20,000 people via the IHG Academy over a five-year period (2013-2017).

 

¿ Continue to expand the IHG Academy throughout our hotel estate and work to ensure the programmes deliver positive results for participants, IHG and our hotels.

 

Value of monetary

donations and in-kind

support to communities,

including through IHG

Shelter in a Storm

 

LOGO

 

In line with our 2014 priorities to contribute to communities, we:

 

•   contributed a total of $6.18m in 2014, taking the total to $8.10m since 2013, to communities through monetary donations and in-kind support, including through IHG Shelter in a Storm;

 

•   have raised $840,000 for the IHG Shelter Fund during 2014; and

 

•   responded to 18 disasters in 9 countries in 2014, including Mexico, China, Egypt and the UK, allocating funds to help with financial support, vital supplies and accommodation.

 

¿ Contribute a total of $10m over a five-year period (2013-2017) to communities through monetary donations and in-kind support, including through IHG Shelter in a Storm.

 

¿ Further increase awareness of, and engagement with, IHG Shelter in a Storm, ensuring our hotels are prepared for disaster and able to respond quickly and effectively to help colleagues, guests and local communities when needed.

 

Carbon footprint per

occupied room

 

LOGO

 

*  Restated

 

See page 25 for further information on scope and methodology.

 

In line with our 2014 priorities to reduce our carbon footprint and drive the IHG Green EngageTM system, we:

 

•   reduced carbon footprint per occupied room to 32.3 kg CO2e (reduction of 3% on 2012 baseline) across our entire estate. Year-on-year, our carbon footprint increased by 0.6% per occupied room from 2012 to 2013 but reduced by 3.5% per occupied room from 2013 to 2014;

 

•   reported a Carbon Disclosure Project disclosure rating of 92B (this represents a significant increase on our score from the previous year (85B)); and

 

•   introduced a brand standard for all IHG hotels to be enrolled in the IHG Green Engage system.

 

¿ Reduce carbon footprint per occupied room by 12% across our entire estate (over a five-year period (2013-2017) using 2012 baseline).

 

¿ Continue to drive quality of use of the IHG Green Engage system to reduce impact on the environment, enable cost savings and drive revenue.

 

¿ Support all our hotels to meet the IHG Green Engage standard.

 

Water use per occupied

room in water-stressed

areas

 

LOGO

 

* Restated

 

In line with our 2014 priorities to reduce water use per occupied room in water-stressed areas, we:

 

•   reduced water use per occupied room by 0.03m3 (reduction of 4.2% on 2012 baseline) in water-stressed areas. Year-on-year, water use in water-stressed areas increased by 0.5% per occupied room from 2012 to 2013 and decreased by 4.2% per occupied room from 2013 to 2014; and

 

•   launched a water stewardship programme to understand our risks and impacts allowing us to develop strategies to assist hotels at a local level.

 

¿ Reduce water use per occupied room by 12% in water-stressed areas across our estate (over a five-year period (2013-2017) using 2012 baseline).

 

¿ Launch phase two of the water stewardship programme.

 

¿ Improve a hotel’s understanding of water stress and pollution, and their relationship with local communities.

 

 

Our regional priorities and progress in each of the regions are set out on pages 37, 40, 43 and 46.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

33


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 
Performance

 

 

 

Group

 

Group results

            12 months ended 31 December  
     2014
$m
    2013
$m
   

2014 vs
2013 %

change

   

20121

$m

   

2013 vs
2012 %

change

 
Revenue                                        

Americas

    871        916        (4.9     837        9.4   

Europe

    374        400        (6.5     436        (8.3

AMEA

    242        230        5.2        218        5.5   

Greater China

    242        236        2.5        230        2.6   

Central

    129        121        6.6        114        6.1   
Total     1,858        1,903        (2.4     1,835        3.7   
Operating profit                                        

Americas

    544        550        (1.1     486        13.2   

Europe

    89        105        (15.2     112        (6.3

AMEA

    84        86        (2.3     88        (2.3

Greater China

    89        82        8.5        81        1.2   

Central

    (155     (155            (162     4.3   
Operating profit before exceptional items     651        668        (2.5     605        10.4   
Exceptional operating items     29        5        480.0        (4     225.0   
      680        673        1.0        601        12.0   
Net financial expenses     (80     (73     (9.6     (54     (35.2
Profit before tax     600        600               547        9.7   
Earnings per ordinary share                                        
Basic     158.3¢        140.9¢        12.3        187.1¢        (24.7
Adjusted     158.3¢        158.3¢               139.0¢        13.9   
Average US dollar to sterling exchange rate    

 

$1:

£0.61

  

  

   

 

$1:

£0.64

  

  

    (4.7    

 

$1:

£0.63

  

  

    1.6   

 

1  With effect from 1 January 2013 the Group adopted IASI9 (Revised) ‘Employee Benefits’ resulting in an additional charge to operating profit before exceptional items of $9m for the year ended 31 December 2012.

 

Accounting principles

The Group results are prepared under International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS). The application of IFRS requires management to make judgements, estimates and assumptions and those considered critical to the preparation of the Group results are set out on pages 112 and 113 of the Group Financial Statements.

The Group discloses certain financial information both including and excluding exceptional items. For comparability of the periods presented, some of the performance indicators in this Performance review are calculated after eliminating these exceptional items. Such indicators are prefixed with ‘adjusted’. An analysis of exceptional items is included in note 5 on page 121 of the Group Financial Statements.

Highlights for the year ended 31 December 2014

Revenue decreased by $45m (2.4%) to $1,858m and operating profit before exceptional items decreased by $17m (2.5%) to $651m during the year ended 31 December 2014, due in part to the disposal of owned hotels in line with the Group’s asset-light strategy.

On 27 March 2014, IHG completed the disposal of its freehold interest in InterContinental Mark Hopkins San Francisco for gross proceeds of $120m and a long-term contract to manage the hotel. On 31 March 2014, IHG completed the disposal of 80% of its interest in InterContinental New York Barclay for gross proceeds of $274m and a 30-year management contract with two 10-year extension rights, retaining the remaining 20% in a joint venture set up to own and refurbish the hotel (see page 49).

On 7 August 2014, the Group received a binding offer to acquire InterContinental Paris – Le Grand for gross proceeds of 330m and a 30-year management contract with three 10-year extension rights. The offer was subsequently accepted on 8 December 2014, with the transaction expected to complete by the end of the first half of 2015, subject to the satisfaction of certain standard conditions.

On an underlying1 basis, revenue and operating profit increased by $94m (6.0%) and $57m (9.6%) respectively. The underlying results exclude InterContinental Mark Hopkins San Francisco and InterContinental New York Barclay whilst under IHG ownership, the results of managed lease hotels, and the benefit of $7m liquidated damages receipts in 2014 and $46m liquidated damages receipts in 2013.

Comparable Group RevPAR (see Glossary on pages 184 and 185) increased by 6.1% (including an increase in average daily rate of 2.7%), led by particularly strong growth of 7.4% in The Americas. Group System size increased by 3.4% to 710,295 rooms whilst Group fee revenue2 increased by 6.7%.

At constant currency, net central overheads decreased by $3m (1.9%) to $152m compared to 2013 (but at actual currency remained flat at $155m), helped by continued cost control, as well as additional technology fee income.

Group fee margin was 44.7%, up 1.5 percentage points on 2013, after adjusting for owned and leased hotels, managed leases and significant liquidated damages. Group fee margin benefited from strong growth in IHG’s scale markets.

Profit before tax of $600m was unchanged on 2013. Basic earnings per ordinary share increased by 12.3% to 158.3¢, whilst adjusted earnings per ordinary share remained flat at 158.3¢.

 

 

 

 

34


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

Highlights for the year ended 31 December 2013

Group revenue increased by $68m (3.7%) to $1,903m and operating profit before exceptional items increased by $63m (10.4%) to $668m.

On 1 May 2013, IHG completed the disposal of its leasehold interest in InterContinental London Park Lane for gross proceeds of $469m and a 30-year management contract with three 10-year extension rights.

On an underlying1 basis, defined as reported results, excluding those from the InterContinental London Park Lane whilst under IHG ownership, results from managed lease hotels, together with the benefit of $46m liquidated damages receipts in 2013 and a $3m liquidated damages receipt in 2012, revenue and operating profit increased by $68m (4.2%) and $44m (7.8%) respectively when translated at constant currency and applying 2012 exchange rates.

Fee revenue2 increased by 4.3%, with comparable Group RevPAR growth of 3.8% over the period (including an increase in average daily rate of 1.8%) and IHG System size growth of 1.6% to 686,873 rooms.

At constant currency, net central overheads decreased from $162m to $157m in 2013 ($155m at actual currency), helped by continued tight cost control, as well as additional technology fee income.

Group fee margin was 43.2%, up 1.3 percentage points on 2012, after adjusting for owned and leased hotels, managed leases and significant liquidated damages.

Profit before tax increased by $53m to $600m. Adjusted earnings per ordinary share increased by 13.9% to 158.3¢.

 

Global total gross revenue

      12 months ended 31 December  
      2014
$bn
     2013
$bn
     % change  

InterContinental

     4.7         4.5         4.4   

Crowne Plaza

     4.2         4.0         5.0   

Hotel Indigo

     0.3         0.2         50.0   

Holiday Inn

     6.4         6.2         3.2   

Holiday Inn Express

     5.7         5.2         9.6   

Staybridge Suites

     0.7         0.6         16.7   

Candlewood Suites

     0.6         0.6           

Other

     0.2         0.3         (33.3
Total      22.8         21.6         5.6   

One measure of IHG System performance is the growth in total gross revenue, defined as total room revenue at franchised hotels and total hotel revenue at managed, owned and leased hotels. Total gross revenue is not revenue attributable to IHG, as it represents revenue generated mainly at hotels owned by third parties.

Total gross revenue increased by 5.6% (7.4% increase at constant currency) to $22.8bn, primarily driven by strong comparable RevPAR growth across the Group of 6.1% compared to 2013, coupled with an increase in System size of 3.4%.

 

 

1  Underlying excludes the impact of owned asset disposals, managed leases, significant liquidated damages and exceptional items translated at constant currency by applying prior year exchange rates.

 

2  Fee revenue is defined as Group revenue excluding revenue from owned and leased hotels, managed leases and significant liquidated damages.
 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

35


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 
Performance continued

 

 

 

Global hotel and room count

              Hotels             Rooms  
At 31 December    2014      Change
over 2013
    2014      Change
over 2013
 
Analysed by brand                                   

InterContinental

     180         2        61,235         1,132   

Crowne Plaza

     406         15        113,562         4,671   

Hotel Indigo

     61         6        6,731         532   

EVEN Hotels

     2         2        296         296   

Holiday Inn1

     1,212         (4     225,159         582   

Holiday Inn Express

     2,365         107        229,110         14,513   

Staybridge Suites

     205         9        22,409         891   

Candlewood Suites

     322         10        30,708         930   

Other

     87         (4     21,085         (125
Total      4,840         143        710,295         23,422   
Analysed by ownership type                                   

Franchised

     4,096         119        514,984         12,797   

Managed

     735         24        192,121         11,397   

Owned and leased

     9                3,190         (772
Total      4,840         143        710,295         23,422   

 

1  Includes 42 Holiday Inn Resort properties (9,904 rooms) and 12 Holiday Inn Club Vacations (4,027 rooms) (2013: 38 Holiday Inn Resort properties (8,818 rooms) and 10 Holiday Inn Club Vacations (3,701 rooms)).

During 2014, the global IHG System (the number of hotels and rooms which are franchised, managed, owned or leased by the Group) increased by 143 hotels (23,422 rooms) to 4,840 hotels (710,295 rooms).

The Group continued to expand its global footprint, opening hotels in nearly 30 different countries and territories and delivering its highest net System size growth since 2009. 40% of 2014 openings were in developing markets, as classified by The World Bank, with 22% of the closing rooms balance located in these markets representing an increase of one percentage point from 31 December 2013. 123 hotels (17,630 rooms) were removed in 2014, a decrease from the previous year (142 hotels, 24,576 rooms).

Openings of 266 hotels (41,052 rooms) were 15.7% higher than in 2013. This included 140 hotel openings (15,190 rooms) in the Holiday Inn brand family in The Americas and four hotels (834 rooms) as part of the US government’s Privatisation of Army Lodgings (PAL) initiative, as well as the first two hotels (296 rooms) for the wellness-focused EVEN Hotels brand. 34 hotels (10,648 rooms) were opened in Greater China in 2014, up 38.8% from last year and the region’s highest on record, with the Europe and AMEA regions contributing openings of 35 hotels (5,353 rooms) and 19 hotels (4,228 rooms) respectively.

Global pipeline

              Hotels             Rooms  
At 31 December    2014      Change
over 2013
    2014      Change
over 2013
 
Analysed by brand                                   

InterContinental

     50         (1     15,664         (1,196

HUALUXE

     24         3        7,551         747   

Crowne Plaza

     92         (2     25,336         (3,033

Hotel Indigo

     63         12        9,096         2,289   

EVEN Hotels

     3         (2     584         (296

Holiday Inn1

     269         5        52,713         2,472   

Holiday Inn Express

     522         49        62,954         8,210   

Staybridge Suites

     99         19        10,908         2,180   

Candlewood Suites

     89         9        7,717         803   

Other

     10         9        1,249         1,135   
Total      1,221         101        193,772         13,311   
Analysed by ownership type                                   

Franchised

     843         65        94,730         7,945   

Managed

     377         38        98,838         5,662   

Owned and leased

     1         (2     204         (296
Total      1,221         101        193,772         13,311   
Global pipeline signings      463         19        69,696         4,235   

 

1  Includes 18 Holiday Inn Resort properties (4,412 rooms) and nil Holiday Inn Club Vacations (2013: Includes 14 Holiday Inn Resort properties (3,163 rooms) and one Holiday Inn Club Vacations (120 rooms)).

At the end of 2014, the global pipeline totalled 1,221 hotels (193,772 rooms), an increase of 101 hotels (13,311 rooms) on 31 December 2013. The IHG pipeline represents hotels where a contract has been signed and the appropriate fees paid. 89% of the closing pipeline at 31 December 2014 was in IHG’s 10 priority markets.

The continued global demand for IHG brands is demonstrated by the Group signing hotels in 35 different countries and territories in 2014, 35% of which were in developing markets. 48% of the closing pipeline at 31 December 2014 was in developing markets, down by three percentage points compared to the previous year. 28% of the closing pipeline at 31 December 2014 was in Greater China.

Group signings increased from 444 hotels (65,461 rooms) in 2013 to 463 hotels (69,696 rooms) in 2014, the strongest level in six years. This included 307 hotels (45,522 rooms) signed for the Holiday Inn brand family, up by 15.1% compared to 2013, nearly a quarter of which were contributed by Greater China (45 hotels, 10,860 rooms). The Greater China region signed a further 19 hotels (4,894 rooms) across other IHG brands. The pipeline for HUALUXE Hotels and Resorts increased by three hotels (747 rooms) to 24 hotels (7,551 rooms).

Active management of the pipeline to remove deals that have become dormant or no longer viable reduced the pipeline by 96 hotels (15,333 rooms), compared to 140 hotels (18,563 rooms) in 2013.

 

 

 

 

36


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

The Americas

Maximise the performance and growth of our portfolio of preferred brands, focusing on our core upper midscale and upscale segments, mostly through franchise agreements, over the next three years.

 

LOGO

 

 

Industry performance in 2014

In 2014, industry RevPAR in The Americas grew by 8.4% driven by a 4.2% increase in demand and a 5.0% increase in average daily rate. On the supply side, the number of rooms increased by 1.0%, the fourth year with growth of 1.0% or less. All segments experienced strong growth, with the upper midscale segment, where the Holiday Inn and Holiday Inn Express brands operate, having a 7.5% growth in RevPAR.

The US lodging industry also saw strong growth as the economy continued to recover with GDP up 2.4%. In December, demand reached record highs for the 46th consecutive month, while supply growth of 0.9% remained well below the 1.9% per annum historic average. Average daily rate growth of 4.6% combined with strong demand drove US RevPAR up 8.3%. RevPAR in the US upper midscale segment was up 8.2%, with the US upscale segment up by 8.4%.

 

 

 

IHG’s regional performance in 2014

IHG’s comparable RevPAR increased 7.4% with 3.7% rate growth. The region is predominantly represented by the US, where comparable RevPAR increased 7.5%. Our upper midscale brands in the US performed broadly in line with the segment, with RevPAR for the Holiday Inn brand increasing 8.1% whilst that for the Holiday Inn Express brand was at 7.2% due to higher absolute occupancies than the industry. Our US upscale brands (Crowne Plaza and Hotel Indigo) were also in line with the upscale segment with both brands increasing RevPAR by 8.3%. We strengthened our 20-year relationship with Grupo Presidente to expand the footprint and diversity of our brands in key cities and resort destinations.

We continued to demonstrate our commitment to quality with 12,230 rooms leaving the IHG System. Strong demand for IHG branded hotels continued with 38,108 rooms signed, with the pipeline increasing by 10,177 rooms over 2013.

 

Americas comparable RevPAR

movement on previous year

                  

12 months ended

31 December 2014

 

Franchised

             

Managed

        

Crowne Plaza

     6.9%        

InterContinental

     6.9%   

Holiday Inn

     7.9%        

Crowne Plaza

     12.7%   

Holiday Inn Express

     7.0%        

Holiday Inn

     9.0%   

All brands

     7.2%        

Staybridge Suites

     9.7%   
       

Candlewood Suites

     11.7%   
       

All brands

     8.9%   
       

Owned and leased

        
       

All brands

     11.2%   
 

 

 

Progress against 2014 regional priorities

In line with our 2014 regional priorities, we:

 

  continued to strengthen our preferred brands and provide best-in-class revenue delivery to hotels – the Holiday Inn brand rolled out revenue-driving food and beverage options to address guest needs, whilst the Holiday Inn Express brand introduced an innovative, cost effective design solution that resonated well with owners;

 

  strengthened our Holiday Inn brand family with the opening of 140 new hotels;

 

  continued to execute our multi-year programme to strengthen the Crowne Plaza brand by focusing on brand differentiation, performance initiatives and signing 10 hotels into the pipeline; and

 

  opened our first two hotels for the EVEN Hotels brand, which have consistently received excellent guest feedback.

IHG’s 2015 regional priorities

1. Continue to increase IHG System size growth through working with owners to accelerate openings, assisting low-performing hotels to improve, and continuing to support our high-performing hotels.

 

2. Continue to deliver against our multi-year plan for the Crowne Plaza Hotels & Resorts brand by enhancing the guest experience and driving brand differentiation through innovations.

 

3. Continue to strengthen the Holiday Inn brand family position through the delivery of innovations and consistency across our hotels.

Source: Smith Travel Research for all of the above industry facts.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

37


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 
Performance continued

 

 

 

Americas results

      12 months ended 31 December  
      2014
$m
    2013
$m
    2014 vs
2013 %
change
    2012
$m
    2013 vs
2012 %
change
 
Revenue                                         

Franchised

     630        576        9.4        541        6.5   

Managed

     103        128        (19.5     97        32.0   

Owned and leased

     138        212        (34.9     199        6.5   
Total      871        916        (4.9     837        9.4   
Percentage of Group Revenue      46.9        48.1        (1.2     45.6        2.5   
Operating profit before exceptional items                                         

Franchised

     544        499        9.0        466        7.1   

Managed

     47        74        (36.5     48        54.2   

Owned and leased

     18        30        (40.0     24        25.0   
       609        603        1.0        538        12.1   
Regional overheads      (65     (53     (22.6     (52     (1.9
Total      544        550        (1.1     486        13.2   
Percentage of Group Operating profit before central overheads and exceptional items      67.5        66.8        0.7        63.4        3.4   

Highlights for the year ended 31 December 2014

With 3,699 hotels (460,017 rooms), The Americas represented 65% of the Group’s room count and 68% of the Group’s operating profit before central overheads and exceptional operating items for the year ended 31 December 2014. The key profit producing region is the US, although the Group is also represented in Latin America, Canada, Mexico and the Caribbean. 91% of rooms in the region are operated under the franchise business model, primarily in the upper midscale segment (Holiday Inn brand family). In the upscale segment Crowne Plaza is predominantly franchised whereas in the luxury segment InterContinental branded hotels are operated under both franchise and management agreements. Eight of the Group’s nine hotel brands are represented in The Americas, including the wellness-focused EVEN Hotels brand, which made its global debut in the region during the year, with two owned hotels (296 rooms) open at 31 December 2014.

Revenue and operating profit before exceptional items decreased by $45m (4.9%) to $871m and by $6m (1.1%) to $544m respectively. On an underlying1 basis, revenue increased by $71m (9.7%), while operating profit increased by $39m (7.8%) driven predominantly by strong RevPAR growth in the fee business and an increase in net rooms. Regional overheads increased by 22.6% to $65m following investment in IHG’s development and quality teams and unusually high healthcare costs. Revenue and operating profit were negatively impacted by the disposal of an 80% interest in InterContinental New York Barclay and the disposal of InterContinental Mark Hopkins San Francisco during the year, by a combined $95m and $21m respectively compared to 2013. Conversely, revenue and operating profit were positively impacted by the benefit of $7m liquidated damages receipts in 2014 in the franchised business relating to two exited hotels, compared to $31m in the managed business in 2013.

 

Franchised revenue increased by $54m (9.4%) to $630m including the benefit of the $7m liquidated damages receipts (8.2% excluding these liquidated damages). Royalties growth of 7.6% was driven by comparable RevPAR growth of 7.2% including 7.9% for Holiday Inn and 7.0% for Holiday Inn Express, together with 2.0% rooms growth. Operating profit increased by $45m (9.0%) to $544m.

Managed revenue decreased by $25m (19.5%) to $103m and operating profit decreased by $27m (36.5%) to $47m. Revenue and operating profit included $38m (2013 $34m) and $nil (2013 $nil) respectively from one managed lease property. Excluding results from this hotel, as well as the $31m liquidated damages in 2013 (2014 $nil), revenue increased by $3m (4.8%) and operating profit increased by $4m (9.3%) on a constant currency basis.

Owned and leased revenue decreased by $74m (34.9%) to $138m and operating profit decreased by $12m (40.0%) to $18m. The decrease in revenue and operating profit were driven by the disposal of an 80% interest in InterContinental New York Barclay, and the disposal of InterContinental Mark Hopkins San Francisco (combined negative impact of $95m and $21m respectively). Excluding these two hotels, owned and leased revenue and operating profit increased by $21m and $9m respectively reflecting strong trading at InterContinental Boston and post refurbishment performance at Holiday Inn Aruba.

Highlights for the year ended 31 December 2013

Revenue and operating profit before exceptional items increased by $79m (9.4%) to $916m and by $64m (13.2%) to $550m respectively. On an underlying1 basis, revenue and operating profit increased by $52m (6.5%) and $36m (7.5%) respectively. Revenue and operating profit were adversely impacted by $8m lower fees on the exit of eight Holiday Inn hotels owned by FelCor Lodging Trust but were positively impacted by the benefit of a $31m liquidated damages receipt in 2013 in the managed business, compared to $3m in 2012.

The franchise business drove most of the growth in the region (excluding the liquidated damages in the managed estate). Franchised revenue increased by $35m (6.5%) to $576m. Royalties growth of 4.7% was driven by RevPAR growth of 3.2%, including 3.4% for Holiday Inn Express, together with a 0.7% increase in available rooms. Operating profit increased by $33m (7.1%) to $499m. Fees from initial franchising, relicensing and termination of hotels also increased by $6m compared to 2012.

Managed revenue increased by $31m (32.0%) to $128m and operating profit increased by $26m (54.2%) to $74m. Revenue and operating profit included $34m (2012 $34m) and $nil (2012 $nil) respectively from one managed lease property. Excluding results from this hotel, as well as the benefit of the $31m liquidated damages in 2013 and the $3m in 2012, revenue grew by $4m (6.7%) and operating profit decreased by $2m (4.4%) on a constant currency basis.

Owned and leased revenue increased by $13m (6.5%) to $212m and operating profit grew by $6m (25.0%) to $30m. The increase in revenue was driven by RevPAR growth of 6.0%.

 

 

 

 

38


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

Americas hotel and room count

              Hotels             Rooms  
At 31 December    2014      Change
over 2013
    2014      Change
over 2013
 
Analysed by brand                                   

InterContinental

     50         (1     16,897         (556

Crowne Plaza

     181         5        48,366         1,309   

Hotel Indigo

     39         2        4,551         207   

EVEN Hotels

     2         2        296         296   

Holiday Inn1

     770         (16     136,280         (2,550

Holiday Inn Express

     2,060         75        182,601         8,170   

Staybridge Suites

     197         9        21,200         891   

Candlewood Suites

     322         10        30,708         930   

Other

     78         (3     19,118         (104
Total      3,699         83        460,017         8,593   
Analysed by ownership type                                   

Franchised

     3,477         83        417,215         8,340   

Managed

     217                41,172         1,025   

Owned and leased

     5                1,630         (772
Total      3,699         83        460,017         8,593   
Percentage of Group hotel and room count      76.4         (0.6     64.8         (0.9

 

1  Includes 20 Holiday Inn Resort properties (4,864 rooms) and 12 Holiday Inn Club Vacations (4,027 rooms) (2013: 18 Holiday Inn Resort properties (4,438 rooms) and 10 Holiday Inn Club Vacations (3,701 rooms)).

The Americas System size increased by 83 hotels (8,593 rooms) to 3,699 hotels (460,017 rooms) during 2014. 178 hotels (20,823 rooms) opened in the year, compared to 173 hotels (19,775 rooms) in 2013 and included four hotels (834 rooms) as part of the US government’s PAL initiative (33 hotels with 4,061 rooms in 2013). Openings included 140 hotels (15,190 rooms) in the Holiday Inn brand family, representing more than 70% of the region’s openings. 23 hotels (2,130 rooms) opened as Staybridge Suites hotels and Candlewood Suites hotels, IHG’s extended-stay brands. The first two hotels (296 rooms) were opened under the wellness-focused EVEN Hotels brand.

95 hotels (12,230 rooms) were removed from The Americas System in 2014, demonstrating IHG’s continued commitment to quality, compared to 112 hotels (17,968 rooms) in 2013. 45% of 2014 room removals were Holiday Inn rooms in the US (34 hotels, 5,499 rooms) compared to 61% in 2013 (53 hotels, 10,933 rooms).

 

Americas pipeline

              Hotels             Rooms  
At 31 December    2014      Change
over 2013
    2014      Change
over 2013
 
Analysed by brand                                   

InterContinental

     7         1        2,337         900   

Crowne Plaza

     18         2        3,206         (22

Hotel Indigo

     31         8        4,259         1,141   

EVEN Hotels

     3         (2     584         (296

Holiday Inn1

     139                20,155         811   

Holiday Inn Express

     389         31        37,125         3,637   

Staybridge Suites

     90         19        9,594         2,099   

Candlewood Suites

     89         9        7,717         803   

Other

     10         9        1,218         1,104   
Total      776         77        86,195         10,177   
Analysed by ownership type                                   

Franchised

     740         62        78,980         6,961   

Managed

     35         17        7,011         3,512   

Owned and leased

     1         (2     204         (296
Total      776         77        86,195         10,177   

1 Includes nine Holiday Inn Resort properties (1,916 rooms) and nil Holiday Inn Club Vacations (2013: five Holiday Inn Resort properties (694 rooms) and one Holiday Inn Club Vacations (120 rooms)).

At 31 December 2014, The Americas pipeline totalled 776 hotels (86,195 rooms), representing an increase of 77 hotels (10,177 rooms) over the prior year. Strong signings of 319 hotels (38,108 rooms) were ahead of last year by 14 hotels (4,224 rooms) and the highest for six years, demonstrating continued demand for IHG branded hotels. Signings included 14 hotels (2,012 rooms) signed as part of the US government’s PAL initiative. The majority of 2014 signings were within the Holiday Inn brand family (208 hotels, 24,037 rooms), up by 17.0% compared to 2013, and included the 777-room Holiday Inn Nickelodeon Suites Orlando. Staybridge Suites and Candlewood Suites together contributed signings of 73 hotels (7,091 rooms), up by 31.2% compared to 2013. Crowne Plaza Atlanta – Midtown, which was signed and opened in the year, is one of 10 signings for the brand. Other notable signings included the 900-room InterContinental Downtown Los Angeles, the largest for the brand in the US.

64 hotels (7,108 rooms) were removed from the pipeline in 2014, significantly down in terms of both hotels and rooms from 2013 (103 hotels, 10,664 rooms).

 

1  Underlying excludes the impact of owned asset disposals, managed leases, significant liquidated damages and exceptional items translated at constant currency by applying prior year exchange rates.
 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

39


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 
Performance continued

 

 

 

Europe

Continue to grow in priority markets and across key cities, and improve underlying margin through operational excellence over the next three years.

LOGO

 

 

Industry performance in 2014

Europe is a diverse region and industry figures are driven by the larger markets, in particular the UK and Germany. RevPAR growth was 6.0%, average daily rate grew by 3.5% and demand grew by 3.5%.

RevPAR growth in the UK reached 7.9% due to a 10.5% increase in the UK provinces, which was driven by a 6.5% increase in average daily rate and 4.9% increase in demand. However, RevPAR growth in other European countries was more moderate, with RevPAR

increasing in Germany by 3.8%. In contrast, the RevPAR in Russia declined steeply by 14.8%, as growth was depressed by ongoing conflict between Russia and the Ukraine and the resulting geopolitical instability throughout this area. Although there was a 5.1% decline in demand, supply continued to grow by 8.9%.

 

 

 

IHG’s regional performance in 2014

IHG’s comparable RevPAR increased by 5.1% with the UK particularly strong at 8.9%. Germany was also strong at 4.1%. IHG’s hotels in Russia and the Commonwealth of Independent States (CIS) were, however, impacted by the geopolitical instability in the region but our hotels outperformed the industry with a RevPAR decline of 4.0%.

Europe comparable RevPAR

movement on previous year

      12 months ended
31 December 2014
 
Franchised         

All brands

     5.3%    
Managed         

All brands

     5.4%    
Owned and leased         

InterContinental

     (4.7)%   
 

 

 

 

Progress against 2014 regional priorities

In line with our 2014 regional priorities, we:

 

  grew in our priority markets and key gateway cities with the signing of 48 hotels of which 17 were in the UK, 12 in Germany, and seven in Russia and the CIS;

 

  continued to expand the Hotel Indigo brand across the region in key gateway cities, opening four new properties in Paris, Madrid, Rome and St Petersburg, and as at 31 December 2014, had 17 open hotels and a further 12 in the pipeline for the brand;

 

  launched the Holiday Inn Express brand in Russia and the CIS (having localised the brand) with the opening of Holiday Inn Express Voronezh - Kirova, a debut for the brand in Russia;

 

  continued to improve guest experience and increase satisfaction at our hotels in the region by creating a culture focused on quality, accelerating the rollout of innovation and building a suite of tools that enables hotels to deliver operational excellence (see progress against KPIs set out on pages 30 to 33); and

 

  embedded our revenue and sales tools at our hotels, driving our commercial delivery and people platforms (see progress against KPIs set out on pages 30 to 33), helping us to deliver RevPAR outperformance in our three priority markets.

IHG’s 2015 regional priorities

1. Continue to build IHG System size through driving growth in our priority markets of UK, Russia and the CIS, and Germany, localising our brands as necessary.

 

2. Continue to improve guest experience and increase satisfaction by focusing on quality and driving innovation to ensure our brands are preferred.

 

3. Drive operational excellence and hotel outperformance by delivering a focused and targeted hotel support model, and best-in-class operational tools and training.

 

Source: Smith Travel Research for all of the above industry facts.

 

 

 

 

40


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

Europe results

     

12 months ended 31 December

 
      2014
$m
    2013
$m
    2014 vs
2013 %
change
    2012
$m
    2013 vs
2012 %
change
 
Revenue                                         

Franchised

     104        104               91        14.3   

Managed

     159        156        1.9        147        6.1   

Owned and leased

     111        140        (20.7     198        (29.3
Total      374        400        (6.5     436        (8.3
Percentage of Group Revenue      20.1        21.0        (0.9     23.8        (2.8
Operating profit before exceptional items                                         

Franchised

     78        79        (1.3     65        21.5   

Managed

     30        30               32        (6.3

Owned and leased

     14        30        (53.3     50        (40.0
       122        139        (12.2     147        (5.4
Regional overheads      (33     (34     2.9        (35     2.9   
Total      89        105        (15.2     112        (6.3
Percentage of Group Operating profit before central overheads and exceptional items      11.0        12.8        (1.8     14.6        (1.8

Highlights for the year ended 31 December 2014

Comprising 647 hotels (104,208 rooms) at the end of 2014, Europe represented 15% of the Group’s room count and 11% of the Group’s operating profit before central overheads and exceptional operating items for the year ended 31 December 2014. Revenues are primarily generated from hotels in the UK and continental European gateway cities. The largest proportion of rooms in Europe are operated under the franchise business model primarily in the upper midscale segment (Holiday Inn and Holiday Inn Express). Similarly, in the upscale segment, Crowne Plaza is predominantly franchised, whereas in the luxury segment the majority of InterContinental branded hotels are operated under management agreements.

Revenue and operating profit before exceptional items decreased by $26m (6.5%) to $374m and by $16m (15.2%) to $89m respectively. On an underlying1 basis, revenue and operating profit increased by $4m (1.4%) and $3m (3.5%) respectively. Overall, comparable RevPAR in Europe increased by 5.1%. The UK achieved a particularly strong comparable RevPAR growth of 8.9%, with double-digit growth in the first and third quarters. Comparable RevPAR in Germany was also strong, increasing by 4.1%, driven by continued growth in domestic output and a rise in employment, whilst IHG hotels in the Commonwealth of Independent States (CIS) collectively experienced a comparable RevPAR decline of 4.0%, reflecting a challenging economic climate in the region during 2014.

Franchised revenue remained flat at $104m, whilst operating profit decreased by $1m (1.3%) to $78m. Excluding the benefit of a $9m liquidated damages receipt in 2013, revenue and operating profit increased by $8m (8.4%) and $8m (11.4%) respectively at constant currency. This underlying growth was mainly driven by an increase in royalties of 8.0%, reflecting comparable RevPAR growth of 5.3%, together with 5.7% rooms growth.

Managed revenue increased by $3m (1.9%) to $159m, whilst operating profit was flat with 2013 at $30m. Revenue and operating profit included $90m (2013 $89m) and $2m (2013 $2m) respectively from managed leases. Excluding properties operated under this arrangement and on a constant currency basis, revenue increased by $3m (4.5%), whilst operating profit was flat. At the end of 2014, IHG commenced a process to restructure the majority of its UK managed hotels to new franchised contracts.

In the owned and leased estate, revenue decreased by $29m (20.7%) to $111m and operating profit decreased by $16m (53.3%) to $14m. At constant currency and excluding the impact of the disposal of InterContinental London Park Lane (which contributed revenue and operating profit of $22m and $8m respectively in 2013), owned and leased revenue and operating profit both decreased by $7m. These declines were driven by InterContinental Paris – Le Grand due to the refurbishment of the Salon Opera ballroom in the first half of 2014. The hotel delivered revenue and operating profit of $111m and $15m respectively, a decrease of 5.9% and 34.8% compared to 2013, whilst RevPAR decreased by 4.7%.

Highlights for the year ended 31 December 2013

Revenue and operating profit before exceptional items decreased by $36m (8.3%) to $400m and by $7m (6.3%) to $105m respectively. On an underlying1 basis, revenue and operating profit increased by $9m (3.4%) and $8m (10.4%) respectively. Overall, RevPAR in Europe increased by 1.7%. The UK achieved RevPAR growth of 3.0%, with particularly strong performance in the final quarter of 2013 with RevPAR increasing 7.3%. RevPAR in Germany increased by 0.8% despite a weaker year-on-year trade fair calendar, whilst IHG hotels in the CIS collectively achieved RevPAR growth of 2.7%.

Franchised revenue increased by $13m (14.3%) to $104m, whilst operating profit increased by $14m (21.5%) to $79m. Excluding the benefit of a $9m liquidated damages receipt in 2013, revenue and operating profit increased by $4m (4.4%) and $5m (7.7%) respectively. Growth was mainly driven by an increase in royalties of 7.0% (6.3% at constant currency) reflecting RevPAR growth of 1.5%, partly offset by a 0.2% decline in available rooms.

 

1  Underlying excludes the impact of owned asset disposals, managed leases, significant liquidated damages and exceptional items translated at constant currency by applying prior year exchange rates.
 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

41


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 
Performance continued

 

 

 

Managed revenue increased by $9m (6.1%) to $156m and operating profit decreased by $2m (6.3%) to $30m. Revenue and operating profit included $89m (2012 $80m) and $2m (2012 $2m) respectively from managed leases. Excluding properties operated under this arrangement and on a constant currency basis, revenue was flat and operating profit decreased by $1m (3.3%).

In the owned and leased estate, revenue decreased by $58m (29.3%) to $140m and operating profit decreased by $20m (40.0%) to $30m. At constant currency and excluding the impact of the disposal of InterContinental London Park Lane, the owned and leased estate delivered a revenue increase of $5m (4.6%) with RevPAR growth of 5.3%. Operating profit increased by $4m (23.5%), benefiting from a one-off $3m property tax recovery in the year.

Europe hotel and room count

              Hotels             Rooms  
At 31 December    2014      Change
over 2013
    2014      Change
over 2013
 
Analysed by brand                                   

InterContinental

     30         (1     9,372         (153

Crowne Plaza

     83                19,395         (127

Hotel Indigo

     17         4        1,568         325   

Holiday Inn1

     284         2        45,722         101   

Holiday Inn Express

     226         11        27,138         1,767   

Staybridge Suites

     5                784           

Other

     2         2        229         229   
Total      647         18        104,208         2,142   
Analysed by ownership type                                   

Franchised

     565         37        84,016         4,499   

Managed

     81         (19     19,722         (2,357

Owned and leased

     1                470           
Total      647         18        104,208         2,142   
Percentage of Group hotel and room count      13.4                14.7         (0.2

 

1  2014 and 2013 include 2 Holiday Inn Resort properties (212 rooms).

During 2014, Europe System size increased by 18 hotels (2,142 rooms) to 647 hotels (104,208 rooms). The Group opened 35 hotels (5,353 rooms) in Europe in 2014, compared to 21 hotels (3,528 rooms) in 2013. 2014 openings included two landmark InterContinental hotels; the 197-room InterContinental Dublin and the 331-room InterContinental Lisbon. Four further Hotel Indigo properties (325 rooms) opened in 2014, in prime city locations of Paris, Madrid, Rome and St Petersburg. Additionally, the Group opened Holiday Inn Express Voronezh - Kirova during 2014, a debut for the brand in Russia.

17 hotels (3,211 rooms) left the Europe System in the period, compared to 20 hotels (3,489 rooms) in the previous year.

Europe pipeline

              Hotels             Rooms  
At 31 December    2014      Change
over
2013
    2014      Change
over
2013
 
Analysed by brand                                   

InterContinental

     3         1        845         192   

Crowne Plaza

     14         2        2,917         293   

Hotel Indigo

     12         (3     1,368         (208

Holiday Inn

     37         2        6,944         332   

Holiday Inn Express

     44         1        6,374         358   

Staybridge Suites

     4         1        414         116   

Other

                    31         31   
Total      114         4        18,893         1,114   
Analysed by ownership type                                   

Franchised

     95         (2     13,996         (123

Managed

     19         6        4,897         1,237   
Total      114         4        18,893         1,114   

The Europe pipeline totalled 114 hotels (18,893 rooms) at 31 December 2014, representing an increase of four hotels (1,114 rooms) over 31 December 2013. New signings of 48 hotels (7,804 rooms), compared to 50 hotels (7,542 rooms) in 2013, included 16 hotel signings in the UK (2,234 rooms). The Group also signed 12 hotels (2,323 rooms) in Germany and seven new hotels (867 rooms) in countries in the CIS. Notable signings in Europe included the 162-room InterContinental Baku, the first for the brand in Azerbaijan.

Nine hotels (1,337 rooms) were removed from the pipeline in 2014, compared to 10 hotels (1,419 rooms) in 2013.

 

 

 

 

42


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

Asia, Middle East and Africa (AMEA)

Execute our strategic plans to strengthen our brands and increase our revenue share through operational excellence and outperformance over the next three years.

 

 

LOGO

 

 

Industry performance in 2014

AMEA is the largest region in geographic terms, and performance varies across the countries that comprise the region.

The strongest of the larger markets in AMEA, in which we operate, are Australia, Japan and the Middle East. Australia experienced RevPAR growth of 4.1% due to both occupancy, which increased by 2.1%, and daily rate growth, which increased by 2.0%. Despite its economic contraction in the third quarter of 2014, Japan’s RevPAR grew 9.4% as a result of an 8.2% increase in daily rate. Occupancy growth was 1.1%.

Performance in the smaller AMEA markets, in which we operate, was less consistent. RevPAR in Saudi Arabia experienced an overall increase of 6.0%. Indonesia saw RevPAR growth for the year of 4.3%, primarily driven by a 6.9% increase in daily rate, and RevPAR in India grew by 0.8%.

 

 

 

IHG’s regional performance in 2014

Across this large and diverse geographic region, IHG is widely represented both geographically and by brand, and as such comparisons across the industry are hard to make. Overall IHG RevPAR increased 3.8% driven predominantly through rate growth with performance led by the Middle East (5.6% RevPAR growth) and positive trading in our mature markets of Japan (6.7% RevPAR growth) and Australia (3.9% RevPAR growth). India and Southeast Asia exhibited steady growth, with the exception of Thailand, which was impacted by political instability in the first half of 2014. Indonesia saw RevPAR growth of 9.1%.

AMEA comparable RevPAR

movement on previous year

      12 months ended
31 December 2014
 
Franchised         

All brands

     1.7%   
Managed         

All brands

     4.4%   
 

 

 

Progress against 2014 regional priorities

In line with our 2014 regional priorities, we:

 

  strengthened our position in the region’s priority markets and key gateway cities, opening 19 hotels (9 in Indonesia and India), taking the region’s System size to a total of 253 hotels (as at 31 December 2014) with notable openings including InterContinental Sydney Double Bay, the second for the brand in Sydney;

 

  accelerated the growth of our core brands across the region with the signing of 32 new hotels into the pipeline – including 21 hotels for the Holiday Inn brand family (9 hotels for the Holiday Inn Express brand) and 19 in the region’s emerging markets;

 

  continued to deliver operational excellence to improve guest satisfaction and deliver high-quality revenues by embedding our revenue tools, system delivery platforms, responsible business practices and People Tools (see progress against KPIs set out on pages 30 to 33); and

 

  accelerated a ‘winning culture’ with further alignment between operations and corporate teams and increased leadership capability to embed the systems, processes and competencies to deliver high performance.

IHG’s 2015 regional priorities

1. Continue to accelerate IHG System size growth across the region, focusing on any brand gaps in key cities and driving secondary city growth in our priority markets of the Middle East, India and Indonesia.

 

2. Focus on strong RevPAR growth through building preferred brands that deliver guest satisfaction.

 

3. Following the launch of the Hotel Indigo brand in the region, support the growth of the brand in AMEA.

Source: Smith Travel Research for all of the above industry facts.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

43


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 
Performance continued

 

 

 

AMEA results

      12 months ended 31 December  
      2014
$m
    2013
$m
    2014 vs
2013 %
change
    2012
$m
    2013 vs
2012 %
change
 
Revenue                                         

Franchised

     16        16               18        (11.1

Managed

     187        170        10.0        152        11.8   

Owned and leased

     39        44        (11.4     48        (8.3
Total      242        230        5.2        218        5.5   
Percentage of Group Revenue      13.0        12.1        0.9        11.9        0.2   
Operating profit before exceptional items                                         

Franchised

     12        12               12          

Managed

     88        92        (4.3     90        2.2   

Owned and leased

     3        4        (25.0     6        (33.3
       103        108        (4.6     108          
Regional overheads      (19     (22     13.6        (20     (10.0
Total      84        86        (2.3     88        (2.3
Percentage of Group Operating profit before central overheads and exceptional items      10.5        10.4        0.1        11.5        (1.1

Highlights for the year ended 31 December 2014

Comprising 253 hotels (67,876 rooms) at 31 December 2014, AMEA represented 9% of the Group’s room count and contributed 10% of the Group’s operating profit before central overheads and exceptional operating items during the year. 82% of rooms in AMEA are operated under the managed business model. The region’s hotels are in the luxury, upscale and upper midscale segments.

Revenue increased by $12m (5.2%) to $242m whilst operating profit before exceptional items decreased by $2m (2.3%) to $84m. On an underlying1 basis, revenue increased by $5m (2.5%) and operating profit increased by $4m (5.1%). The results included a $6m benefit from liquidated damages received in 2013 (2014 $nil). AMEA is a geographically diverse region and performance was impacted by political and economic factors affecting different countries.

Comparable RevPAR increased 3.8% driven by 2.4% rate growth. Performance was led by the Middle East, up 5.6%, driven by a solid performance in Saudi Arabia and a recovery in Egypt. This was supported by positive trading in the mature markets of Japan, which grew by 6.7%, and Australia, which grew by 3.9%. Elsewhere, both India and South East Asia exhibited steady growth, with the exception of Thailand which suffered from political instability in the first half of the year.

Franchised revenue and operating profit remained flat at $16m and $12m respectively.

 

Managed revenue increased by $17m (10.0%) to $187m whilst operating profit decreased by $4m (4.3%) to $88m. Revenue and operating profit included $41m (2013 $21m) and $4m (2013 $1m) respectively from one managed lease property. Excluding results from this hotel, as well as the benefit of $6m liquidated damages in 2013 (2014 $nil), revenue increased by $7m (4.9%) whilst operating profit increased by $2m (2.4%) on a constant currency basis. Comparable RevPAR increased by 4.4%, with room count increasing by 5.9%.

In the owned and leased estate, revenue and operating profit decreased by $5m (11.4%) to $39m and by $1m (25.0%) to $3m respectively, due to a 6.3% decrease in RevPAR.

Highlights for the year ended 31 December 2013

Revenue increased by $12m (5.5%) to $230m and operating profit decreased by $2m (2.3%) to $86m. On an underlying1 basis, revenue and operating profit decreased by $6m (2.8%) and $7m (8.0%) respectively. The results included a $6m benefit from liquidated damages in 2013 (2012 $nil). RevPAR increased by 6.1%, with 3.0% growth in average daily rate. AMEA is a geographically diverse region and performance is impacted by political and economic factors affecting different countries. The Middle East delivered RevPAR growth of 2.9%, driven by strength in the United Arab Emirates and Saudi Arabia, whilst continuing political uncertainty impacted some of our other markets in the region, particularly Egypt and Lebanon. Performance in Japan was strong, with RevPAR increasing by 9.6%, whilst Australia also achieved solid RevPAR growth of 2.8%. RevPAR growth in developing markets remained buoyant, led by 12.2% RevPAR growth in Indonesia. Revenue and operating profit growth were muted by a $6m negative year-on-year impact from the renewal of a small number of long-standing contracts onto current commercial terms. In addition, there was a $4m negative impact from similar contracts that were not renewed.

Franchised revenue decreased by $2m (11.1%) to $16m, whilst operating profit was flat at $12m.

Managed revenue and operating profit increased by $18m (11.8%) to $170m and by $2m (2.2%) to $92m respectively. During 2013, a new property opened under an operating lease structure, with the same characteristics as a management contract, contributing revenue of $21m and operating profit of $1m. Excluding this property together with the benefit of the $6m liquidated damages receipt in 2013, revenue and operating profit decreased by $4m (2.6%) and $4m (4.4%) respectively at constant currency. RevPAR increased by 5.6%, with AMEA System size up 2.6%.

In the owned and leased estate, revenue and operating profit decreased by $4m (8.3%) to $44m and by $2m (33.3%) to $4m respectively, driven by a 7.3% RevPAR decline.

 

 

 

 

44


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

AMEA hotel and room count

              Hotels             Rooms  
At 31 December    2014      Change
over 2013
    2014      Change
over 2013
 
Analysed by brand                                   

InterContinental

     67                21,424         41   

Crowne Plaza

     69         2        19,688         610   

Holiday Inn1

     85         4        19,750         1,286   

Holiday Inn Express

     24         8        5,295         1,795   

Staybridge Suites

     3                425           

Other

     5         (5     1,294         (694
Total      253         9        67,876         3,038   
Analysed by ownership type                                   

Franchised

     50         (1     11,569         (42

Managed

     201         10        55,720         3,080   

Owned and leased

     2                587           
Total      253         9        67,876         3,038   
Percentage of Group hotel and room count      5.2                9.5         0.2   

 

1  Includes 14 Holiday Inn Resort properties (3,003 rooms) (2013: 14 Holiday Inn Resort properties (2,965 rooms)).

The AMEA System size increased by nine hotels (3,038 rooms) to 253 hotels (67,876 rooms) as at 31 December 2014. The level of openings decreased marginally to 19 hotels (4,228 rooms) in 2014 from 20 hotels (4,495 rooms) in 2013. Openings in 2014 included two hotels (417 rooms) for the InterContinental brand, including the 140-room InterContinental Sydney Double Bay, the second for the brand in Sydney, and four hotels (1,039 rooms) in India.

10 hotels (1,190 rooms) were removed from the AMEA System in 2014, compared to eight hotels (2,394 rooms) in 2013.

AMEA pipeline

              Hotels             Rooms  
At 31 December    2014      Change
over 2013
    2014      Change
over 2013
 
Analysed by brand                                   

InterContinental

     22         1        5,804         426   

Crowne Plaza

     16         2        4,412         364   

Hotel Indigo

     10         2        1,823         431   

Holiday Inn1

     50         1        13,230         889   

Holiday Inn Express

     39         0        8,177         197   

Staybridge Suites

     5         (1     900         (35
Total      142         5        34,346         2,272   
Analysed by ownership type                                   

Franchised

     8         5        1,754         1,107   

Managed

     134                32,592         1,165   
Total      142         5        34,346         2,272   

 

1  Includes seven Holiday Inn Resort properties (1,729 rooms) (2013: six Holiday Inn Resort properties (1,579rooms)).

At 31 December 2014, the AMEA pipeline totalled 142 hotels (34,346 rooms) compared to 137 hotels (32,074 rooms) as at 31 December 2013. Signings in AMEA of 32 hotels (8,030 rooms) were slightly below the level seen in 2013 (36 hotels, 8,687 rooms). Signings in 2014 included 21 hotels (5,507 rooms) in the Holiday Inn brand family, notably including the 1,000-room Holiday Inn Newport City in Manila. Four InterContinental hotels (999 rooms) were signed during 2014.

Eight hotels (1,530 rooms) were removed from the pipeline in 2014, compared to 11 hotels (2,475 rooms) in 2013.

 

 

1  Underlying excludes the impact of owned asset disposals, managed leases, significant liquidated damages and exceptional items translated at constant currency by applying prior year exchange rates.
 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

45


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 
Performance continued

 

 

 

Greater China

Maximise scale and strength and establish multi-segment local operating expertise to drive margin and expand our strong portfolio of brands over the next three years.

LOGO

 

 

Industry performance in 2014

The Chinese economy achieved GDP growth of 7.4% in 2014, a slowdown against the average of 8.9% growth in the period from 2009 to 2013. This slowdown was attributable to several factors, including lessening domestic demand and manufacturing output, a correction in the real estate market and declining inflation. Growth is expected to reduce further in 2015 and 2016.

Hotel industry RevPAR in Greater China decreased by 0.9% in the year. Whilst overall occupancy increased by 1.9%, average daily

rates decreased by 2.8%. Much of this decrease in the region is due to changes in the industry structure due to growth in tier 2 and 3 cities as well as from growth of economy brands.

RevPAR in the People’s Republic of China (excluding Taiwan) decreased by 1.5%. Many major cities, such as Shanghai and Guangzhou, experienced an increase in RevPAR driven by strong occupancy gains. However, RevPAR in Beijing and surrounding North China, East China and South China saw a decrease in year-on-year RevPAR growth.

 

 

 

IHG’s regional performance in 2014

IHG’s comparable RevPAR increased 1.6% in 2014, significantly ahead of the overall industry. Trading was strongest in tier 1 cities, whilst tier 2 and 3 cities were softer, impacted by new supply as these markets develop. Our RevPAR growth was driven by occupancy which increased by 2.4%, whilst rate decreased by 2.3% – both ahead of the industry, reflecting our scale and management strength in the region.

 

Greater China comparable RevPAR

movement on previous year

      12 months ended
31 December 2014
 
Managed         

All brands

     1.3%    
Owned and leased         

InterContinental

     (1.0)%   
 

 

 

Progress against 2014 regional priorities

In line with our 2014 regional priorities, we:

 

  grew distribution of our brands in the region with 34 hotel openings and 64 hotels signed into our pipeline;

 

  opened 19 hotels during the year for the Holiday Inn brand family (Holiday Inn and Holiday Inn Express), including the opening of the 50th Holiday Inn Express hotel, and signed a further 45 hotels into the pipeline for the Holiday Inn brand family;

 

  continued to make progress with the HUALUXE Hotels and Resorts brand, with 24 hotels in the pipeline as at 31 December 2014 – one of which we opened in February 2015 (see page 19);

 

  continued to grow our talent (see page 23); and

 

  continued to localise IHG brands, systems, tools, processes and responsible business practices to increase efficiency and margin performance (see progress against KPIs set out on pages 30 to 33).

IHG’s 2015 regional priorities

1. Further increase IHG System size, with deeper penetration in tier 2 and 3 cities and strengthen the distribution of the Holiday Inn and Holiday Inn Express brands to capture the growing midscale segment opportunity.

 

2. Build a strong pipeline for the HUALUXE Hotels and Resorts brand and support the subsequent hotel openings.

 

3. Continue to grow our talent and build a strong local talent pipeline, particularly in tier 2 and 3 cities.

Source: Smith Travel Research for all of the above industry facts.

 

 

 

 

 

 

46


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

Greater China results

      12 months ended 31 December  
      2014
$m
    2013
$m
    2014 vs
2013 %
change
    2012
$m
    2013 vs
2012 %
change
 
Revenue                                         

Franchised

     4        3        33.3        3          

Managed

     99        92        7.6        89        3.4   

Owned and leased

     139        141        (1.4     138        2.2   
Total      242        236        2.5        230        2.6   
Percentage of Group Revenue      13.0        12.4        0.6        12.5        (0.1
Operating profit before exceptional items                                         

Franchised

     5        5               4        25.0   

Managed

     63        51        23.5        51          

Owned and leased

     42        47        (10.6     45        4.4   
       110        103        6.8        100        3.0   
Regional overheads      (21     (21            (19     (10.5
Total      89        82        8.5        81        1.2   
Percentage of Group Operating profit before central overheads and exceptional items      11.0        10.0        1.0        10.6        (0.6

Highlights for the year ended 31 December 2014

Comprising 241 hotels (78,194 rooms) at 31 December 2014, Greater China represented 11% of the Group’s room count and contributed 11% of the Group’s operating profit before central overheads and exceptional operating items for the year ended 31 December 2014. 97% of rooms in Greater China are operated under the managed business model. The region’s hotels are in the luxury, upscale and upper midscale segments.

Revenue and operating profit before exceptional items increased by $6m (2.5%) to $242m and by $7m (8.5%) to $89m respectively. Overall, the region achieved comparable RevPAR growth of 1.6%, slightly stronger than the 1.0% growth achieved in 2013. This performance was significantly ahead of the industry, reflecting IHG’s scale and management strength in the region, and was achieved in a challenging environment with slower macro-economic conditions, government austerity measures and protests in Hong Kong. Trading was strongest in tier 1 cities, especially Shanghai and Guangzhou, with good levels of transient and corporate business. Performance in tier 2 and 3 cities continues to be impacted by new supply as these markets develop. Total RevPAR in the region decreased by 3.4% as hotels opened in these lower RevPAR markets.

Franchised revenue increased by $1m (33.3%) to $4m whilst operating profit was flat at $5m. Operating profit was higher than revenue in both 2014 and 2013 due to joint venture dividend income received from a hotel in Hong Kong.

Managed revenue increased by $7m (7.6%) to $99m, whilst operating profit increased by $12m (23.5%) to $63m, reflecting improvements in operating margin, net rooms growth, and a small number of one-off items that contributed approximately $5m to the result. Comparable RevPAR increased by 1.3%, whilst the Greater China System size grew by 14.7%, driving a 8.5% increase in total gross revenue derived from rooms business. Total gross revenue derived from non-rooms business increased by 7.8%.

Owned and leased revenue decreased by $2m (1.4%) to $139m, driven by a RevPAR decrease of 1.0% at InterContinental Hong Kong. Operating profit decreased by $5m (10.6%) to $42m. The decrease in revenue and operating profit at the hotel was driven primarily by the ongoing development of the area adjacent to the hotel and protests in central Hong Kong.

Highlights for the year ended 31 December 2013

Revenue and operating profit before exceptional items increased by $6m (2.6%) to $236m and by $1m (1.2%) to $82m respectively. On an underlying basis, revenue and operating profit increased by $6m (2.6%) and $2m (2.5%) respectively.

Franchised revenue was flat at $3m and operating profit increased by $1m (25.0%) to $5m.

Managed revenue increased by $3m (3.4%) to $92m and operating profit was flat at $51m. RevPAR increased by 0.6%, whilst the Greater China System size grew by 11.8%, driving a 9.2% increase in total gross revenue derived from rooms business. Total gross revenue derived from non-rooms business increased by 3.0%. Operating profit was partly offset by increased investment to drive future growth.

Owned and leased revenue at InterContinental Hong Kong increased by $3m (2.2%) to $141m, driven by a 4.5% increase in total gross revenue derived from non-rooms business, although this was partly offset by a RevPAR decline of 0.1%. Operating profit increased by $2m (4.4%) to $47m.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

47


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 
Performance continued

 

 

 

Greater China hotel and room count

              Hotels              Rooms  
At 31 December    2014      Change
over 2013
     2014      Change
over 2013
 
Analysed by brand                                    

InterContinental

     33         4         13,542         1,800   

Crowne Plaza

     73         8         26,113         2,879   

Hotel Indigo

     5                 612           

Holiday Inn1

     73         6         23,407         1,745   

Holiday Inn Express

     55         13         14,076         2,781   

Other

     2         2         444         444   
Total      241         33         78,194         9,649   
Analysed by ownership type                                    

Franchised

     4                 2,184           

Managed

     236         33         75,507         9,649   

Owned and leased

     1                 503           
Total      241         33         78,194         9,649   
Percentage of Group hotel and room count      5.0         0.6         11.0         1.0   

 

1  Includes six Holiday Inn Resort properties (1,825 rooms) (2013: four Holiday Inn Resort properties (1,203 rooms)).

The Greater China System size increased by 33 hotels (9,649 rooms) in the year to 241 hotels (78,194 rooms). 34 hotels (10,648 rooms) opened during 2014, 11 hotels and 2,979 rooms higher than 2013 and a record year for the region. Recent growth in the region has focused on tier 2 and 3 cities, which now represent approximately two-thirds of IHG’s open rooms. The InterContinental brand System size increased by four hotels (1,800 rooms) to 33 hotels (13,542 rooms) during the year, including the addition of the 990-room InterContinental Chengdu Global Centre. 19 Holiday Inn brand family hotels (4,445 rooms) were also added in the year, including the 50th Holiday Inn Express, nine hotels (1,078 rooms) higher than in 2013. Nine Crowne Plaza hotels (3,498 rooms) were also added during the year, including the 466-room Crowne Plaza Beijing Lido, increasing the Crowne Plaza System size to 73 hotels (26,113 rooms).

One hotel (999 rooms) was removed in 2014, compared to two hotels (725 rooms) in 2013.

Greater China pipeline

              Hotels             Rooms  
At 31 December    2014      Change
over 2013
    2014      Change
over 2013
 
Analysed by brand                                   

InterContinental

     18         (4     6,678         (2,714

HUALUXE

     24         3        7,551         747   

Crowne Plaza

     44         (8     14,801         (3,668

Hotel Indigo

     10         5        1,646         925   

Holiday Inn1

     43         2        12,384         440   

Holiday Inn Express

     50         17        11,278         4,018   
Total      189         15        54,338         (252
Analysed by ownership type                                   

Managed

     189         15        54,338         (252
Total      189         15        54,338         (252

 

1  Includes two Holiday Inn Resort properties (767 rooms) (2013: three Holiday Inn Resort properties (890 rooms)).

At 31 December 2014, the Greater China pipeline totalled 189 hotels (54,338 rooms) compared to 174 hotels (54,590 rooms) at 31 December 2013. Signings of 64 hotels (15,754 rooms) increased from 53 hotels (15,348 rooms) in 2013. Three InterContinental hotels (930 rooms) were signed, together with five Crowne Plaza hotels (1,400 rooms), whilst the total pipeline for the HUALUXE Hotels and Resorts brand increased to 24 hotels (7,551 rooms). 45 hotels (10,860 rooms) were signed for the Holiday Inn brand family, with the Holiday Inn Express brand pipeline increasing to 50 hotels.

15 hotels (5,358 rooms) were removed from the pipeline in 2014, compared to 16 hotels (4,005 rooms) in 2013.

 

 

Central

 

Central results

      12 months ended 31 December  
      2014
$m
    2013
$m
    2014 vs
2013 %
change
    2012
$m
    2013 vs
2012 %
change
 
Revenue      129        121        6.6        114        6.1   
Gross central costs      (284     (276     (2.9     (276       
Net central costs      (155     (155            (162     4.3   

Highlights for the year ended 31 December 2014

Central revenue, which mainly comprises technology fee income, increased by $8m (6.6%) to $129m, driven by increases in both comparable RevPAR (6.1%) and IHG System size (3.4%) in 2014 compared to 2013. At constant currency, gross central costs increased by $4m (1.4%) compared to 2013 (an $8m or 2.9% increase at actual currency).

Highlights for the year ended 31 December 2013

Central revenue, mainly comprising technology fee income, increased by $7m (6.1%) to $121m, driven by increases to both RevPAR and IHG System size over 2012. Gross central costs were flat at $276m in 2013, reflecting continued tight cost control.

 

 

 

 

48


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

System Fund

System Fund assessments

      12 months ended 31 December  
      2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2014 vs
2013 %
change
     2012
$m
     2013 vs
2012 %
change
 
Assessment fees and contributions received from hotels      1,271         1,154         10.1         1,106         4.3   
Proceeds from sale of IHG Rewards Club points      196         153         28.1         144         6.3   
Total      1,467         1,307         12.2         1,250         4.6   

In addition to management or franchise fees, hotels within the IHG System pay assessments and contributions which are collected by IHG for specific use within the System Fund. The System Fund also receives proceeds from the sale of IHG Rewards Club points. The System Fund is managed for the benefit of hotels in the IHG System with the objective of driving revenues for the hotels.

The System Fund is used to pay for marketing, the IHG Rewards Club loyalty programme and the global reservation system. The operation of the System Fund does not result in a profit or loss for the Group and consequently the revenues and expenses of the System Fund are not included in the Group Income Statement.

Highlights for the year ended 31 December 2014

In the year to 31 December 2014, System Fund income increased by 12.2% to $1,467m primarily as a result of a 10.1% increase in assessment fees and contributions from hotels resulting from increased hotel room revenues, reflecting increases in RevPAR and IHG System size. Continued strong performance in co-branded credit card schemes drove the 28.1% increase in proceeds from the sale of IHG Rewards Club points.

Highlights for the year ended 31 December 2013

In the year to 31 December 2013, System Fund income increased by 4.6% to $1,307m primarily as a result of growth in hotel room revenues due to increases in RevPAR and IHG System size. The increase in proceeds from the sale of IHG Rewards Club points mainly reflects the continued strong performance of co-brand credit card schemes.

Other financial information

Exceptional operating items

Exceptional operating items totalled a net gain of $29m. The exceptional gain of $130m related to the sale of InterContinental Mark Hopkins San Francisco and the disposal of an 80% interest in InterContinental New York Barclay. Exceptional charges included $14m foreign exchange losses resulting from recent changes to the Venezuelan exchange rate mechanisms and the adoption of the SICAD II exchange rate; $29m relating primarily to structural change programmes across the Global Human Resources and Global Technology functions; $6m arising from a partial cash-out of the UK unfunded pension arrangements; $45m relating to the cost of securing a restructuring of the UK hotel portfolio; and $7m Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants acquisition transaction costs. See note 5 to the Group Financial Statements for further detail.

Exceptional operating items are treated as exceptional by reason of their size or nature and are excluded from the calculation of adjusted earnings per ordinary share in order to provide a more meaningful comparison of performance.

Net financial expenses

Net financial expenses increased by $7m to $80m reflecting an increase in average net debt levels and the translation of interest on the two sterling bonds.

Financing costs included $2m (2013 $2m) of interest costs associated with IHG Rewards Club where interest is charged on the accumulated balance of cash received in advance of the redemption of points awarded. Financing costs in 2014 also included $19m (2013 $19m) in respect of the InterContinental Boston finance lease.

Taxation

The effective rate of tax on operating profit excluding the impact of exceptional items was 31% (2013 29%). Excluding the impact of prior year items the equivalent tax rate would be 35% (2013 32%). This rate is higher than the average UK statutory rate of 21.5% (2013 23.25%) due mainly to certain overseas profits (particularly in the US) being subject to statutory rates higher than the UK statutory rate, unrelieved foreign taxes and disallowable expenses.

Taxation within exceptional items totalled a charge of $29m (2013 $51m). In 2014 the charge comprised $56m relating to the disposal of an 80% interest in InterContinental New York Barclay offset by a credit of $27m relating to a restructuring of the UK hotel portfolio and other reorganisation costs. In 2013 the charge comprised $6m relating to the exceptional operating items and $64m consequent upon the disposal of InterContinental London Park Lane, offset by a credit of $19m relating to an internal restructuring.

Net tax paid in 2014 totalled $136m (2013 $97m) including $nil (2013 $5m) in respect of disposals. Tax paid represents an effective rate of 23% (2013 16%) on total profits and is lower than the effective income statement tax rate of 31% primarily due to the impact of deferred taxes (including the realisation of assets such as tax losses), the receipt of refunds in respect of prior years and provisions for tax for which no payment of tax has currently been made.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

49


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 
Performance continued

 

 

 

    

    

IHG pursues a tax strategy that is consistent with its business strategy and its overall business conduct principles. This strategy seeks to ensure full compliance with all tax filing, payment and reporting obligations on the basis of communicative and transparent relationships with tax authorities. Policies and procedures related to tax risk management are subject to regular review and update and are approved by the Board.

Tax liabilities or refunds may differ from those anticipated, in particular as a result of changes in tax law, changes in the interpretation of tax law, or clarification of uncertainties in the application of tax law. Procedures to minimise risk include the preparation of thorough tax risk assessments for all transactions carrying tax risk and, where appropriate, material tax uncertainties are discussed and resolved with tax authorities in advance.

IHG’s contribution to the jurisdictions in which it operates includes a significant contribution in the form of taxes borne and collected, including taxes on its revenues and profits and in respect of the employment its business generates.

IHG earns approximately 70% of its revenues in the form of franchise, management or similar fees, with 85% of IHG branded hotels being franchised. In jurisdictions in which IHG does franchise business, the prevailing tax law will generally provide for IHG to be taxed in the form of local withholding taxes based on a percentage of fees rather than based on profits. Costs to support the franchise business are normally incurred regionally or globally and therefore profits for an individual franchise jurisdiction cannot be separately determined.

Dividends

The Board has proposed a final dividend per ordinary share of 52¢ (33.8p). With the interim dividend per ordinary share of 25¢ (14.8p), the full-year dividend per ordinary share for 2014 will total 77¢ (48.6p), an increase of 10.0% over 2013.

On 2 May 2014, the Group announced a $750m return to shareholders by way of special dividend and share consolidation. The dividend was paid to shareholders on 14 July 2014.

Under the $500m share buyback programme announced on 7 August 2012, which commenced on 12 November 2012 and completed on 29 May 2014, a total of 17.3m shares have been repurchased for total consideration of $500m.

Earnings per ordinary share

Basic earnings per ordinary share increased by 12.3% to 158.3¢ from 140.9¢ in 2013. Adjusted earnings per ordinary share remained unchanged at 158.3¢.

Share price and market capitalisation

The IHG share price closed at £25.95 on 31 December 2014, up from £20.13 on 31 December 2013. The market capitalisation of the Group at the year end was £6.4bn.

Liquidity and capital resources

Sources of liquidity

The Group is financed by a $1.07bn syndicated bank facility which expires in November 2016 (the Syndicated Facility), £250m of public bonds which are repayable on 9 December 2016 and £400m of public bonds which are repayable on 28 November 2022. $361m was drawn under the $1.07bn Syndicated Facility at the year end. The bonds are issued under the Group’s £750m Medium Term Notes programme. Short-term borrowing requirements are met from drawings under bilateral bank facilities. Additional funding is provided by the 99-year finance lease (of which 91 years remain) on InterContinental Boston and other uncommitted bank facilities (see note 21 to the Group Financial Statements). In the Group’s opinion, the available facilities are sufficient for the Group’s present liquidity requirements.

The Syndicated Facility contains two financial covenants; interest cover and net debt divided by earnings before interest, tax, depreciation and amortisation. The Group is in compliance with all of the financial covenants in its loan documents, none of which is expected to present a material restriction on funding in the near future.

Net debt of $1,533m (2013 $1,153m) is analysed by currency as follows:

 

      2014
$m
    20131
$m
 
Borrowings                 

Sterling

     1,028        671   

US dollar

     557        709   

Euros

     103        11   

Other

     7        10   
Cash and cash equivalents                 

Sterling

     (21     (87

US dollar

     (54     (40

Euros

     (25     (15

Canadian dollar

     (14     (25

Chinese renminbi

     (8     (15

Other

     (40     (66
Net debt2      1,533        1,153   
Average debt levels      1,322        985   

 

1  Restated for the adoption of ‘Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities’ (Amendments to IAS 32), see page 107.
2  Including the impact of currency derivatives.

Borrowings included bank overdrafts of $107m (2013 $114m) which were matched by an equivalent amount of cash and cash equivalents under the Group’s cash pooling arrangements. Under these arrangements, each pool contains a number of bank accounts with the same financial institution and the Group pays interest on net overdraft balances within each pool. The cash pools are used for day-to-day cash management purposes and are managed daily as closely as possible to a zero balance on a net basis for each pool. Overseas subsidiaries are typically in a cash positive position, with the most significant balances in the US and Canada, and the matching overdrafts are held by the Group’s central treasury company in the UK.

 

 

 

 

50


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents include $4m (2013 $12m) that is not available for use by the Group due to local exchange controls.

Information on the maturity profile and interest structure of borrowings is included in notes 20 and 21 to the Group Financial Statements.

The Group had net liabilities of $717m at 31 December 2014 reflecting that its brands are not recognised in the Group statement of financial position. At the end of 2014 the Group was trading significantly within its banking covenants and facilities.

Cash from operating activities

Net cash from operating activities totalled $543m for the year ended 31 December 2014 down $81m on the previous year largely due to increased cash flows relating to exceptional operating items.

Cash flow from operating activities is the principal source of cash used to fund the ongoing operating expenses, interest payments, maintenance capital expenditure and normal dividend payments of the Group. The Group believes that the requirements of its existing business and future investment can be met from cash generated internally, disposition of assets and external finance expected to be available to it.

Cash from investing activities

Net cash inflows due to investing activities totalled $123m, a decrease of $52m over 2013. Capital expenditure on property, plant and equipment decreased from $159m in 2013 to $84m as the prior year included significant investment in hotel properties that were in the process of being converted to the Group’s EVEN Hotels brand. $394m of disposal proceeds primarily related to the disposal of InterContinental Mark Hopkins San Francisco and the disposal of an 80% interest in InterContinental New York Barclay.

The Group had committed contractual capital expenditure of $117m at 31 December 2014 (2013 $83m).

Cash used in financing activities

Net cash used in financing activities totalled $736m, which was $121m lower than in 2013. Returns to shareholders of $1,052m, comprising ordinary dividends, special dividends and share buybacks, were $236m higher than in 2013. $68m (2013 $44m) was spent on share purchases in order to fulfil share incentive awards.

Overall net debt increased during the year by $380m to $1,533m at 31 December 2014.

Off-sheet balance sheet arrangements

At 31 December 2014, the Group had no off-balance sheet arrangements that have or are reasonably likely to have a current or future effect on the Group’s financial condition, revenues or expenses, results of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources that is material to investors.

Contractual obligations

The Group had the following contractual obligations outstanding as of 31 December 2014:

 

      Total
amounts
committed
     Less
than
1 year
     1-3
years
     3-5
years
     After 5
years
 
      $m  
Long-term debt obligations1, 2      1,378         3         751                 624   
Interest payable2      248         52         76         47         73   
Derivatives      2         2                           
Finance lease obligations3      3,364         16         32         32         3,284   
Operating lease obligations      349         40         62         47         200   
Agreed pension scheme contributions4      6         6                           
Capital contracts placed      117         117                           
Kimpton acquisition      430         430                           
Total      5,894         666         921         126         4,181   

 

1  Repayment period classified according to the related facility maturity date.
2  Excluding bank overdrafts.
3  Represents the minimum lease payments related to the 99-year lease (of which 91 years remain) on InterContinental Boston. Payments under the lease step up at regular intervals over the lease term.
4  Largely relates to US pension obligations.

As explained in note 33 to the Group Financial Statements, the Group completed the acquisition of Kimpton Hotel & Restaurant Group, LLC for $430m on 16 January 2015.

The acquisition was primarily financed by a $400m bilateral term loan with a term of six months plus two six-month extension periods. A variable rate of interest is payable on the loan which has identical covenants to the Syndicated Facility.

Contingent liabilities

Contingent liabilities include performance guarantees with possible cash outflows totalling $29m, guarantees over the debt of equity investments of $20m and outstanding letters of credit of $40m. See note 30 to the Group Financial Statements for further details.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

51


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Governance

 

54 Chairman’s overview
55 Corporate Governance
55

Our Board and Committee governance structure

56

2014 Board meetings

57

Who is on our Board of Directors

60

Who is on our Executive Committee

61

Board composition and diversity

63

Director induction, training and development

63

Board effectiveness evaluation

64

Board engagement with shareholders

65

Audit Committee Report

68

Corporate Responsibility Committee Report

69

Nomination Committee Report

70

Statement of compliance with the UK Corporate Governance Code

72 Directors’ Report
76 Directors’ Remuneration Report
76

Remuneration Committee Chairman’s Statement

77

Governance

79

Strategic context

80

Summary of our Directors’ Remuneration Policy

82

Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration

91

Implementation of Directors’ Remuneration Policy in 2015

 

 

 

Plan

 

LOGO

‘Guest Journey’ – Step two

  The Plan phase of the ‘Guest Journey’ is where our guests narrow down their travel options.

 

  They do this in different ways; by searching and learning more about our brands online and reading guest reviews; through IHG Rewards Club offerings; or via interaction with call centres, travel agents and corporate travel departments.
 

 

52


Table of Contents
 
    

 

 

LOGO

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

53


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Chairman’s overview

 

 

LOGO

Dear Shareholder

We are committed to maintaining the highest standards of corporate governance. Our governance framework, led by the Board, supports IHG’s culture, values and our commitment to conducting business responsibly, further explained on pages 24 and 25. We have in place strong and effective practices and conduct regular reviews to ensure we are compliant.

Governance and strategy

The Board is accountable for the long-term success of the Group, as well as for setting the strategic priorities and objectives of the Group and its risk appetite. We consider the interests of all of our stakeholders at all times. Shaping and implementing IHG’s strategy is the most critical role of the Board and therefore the Board dedicates ample time to discussing the Group’s strategy, not least as part of our annual strategy meeting. Further information on how the Board spent its time during 2014 can be found on page 56.

Board changes and succession planning

A high-level structure of IHG’s Board and its Committees, along with biographies of current Board and Executive Committee members, can be found on pages 55 and 57 to 61.

As announced in our 2013 Annual Report, David Kappler retired on 31 May 2014 after spending over nine years as a Non-Executive Director at IHG. He was succeeded by Dale Morrison as Senior Independent Non-Executive Director on 31 May 2014. Ian Dyson took over David’s duties as Chairman of the Audit Committee on 1 April 2014. We also said goodbye to Jonathan Linen, who retired from the Board on 31 December 2014 after spending nine years with the business.

In August 2014, we announced the appointment of Jo Harlow to the Board and Audit, Nomination and Remuneration Committees effective as of 1 September 2014. Jo’s appointment fulfils one of the objectives I highlighted last year, which was to enhance the Board’s capabilities and competencies by appointing a Non-Executive Director with specific consumer-facing technology experience given the significance of this area in our strategy.

Finally, in December 2014, we announced Kirk Kinsell would step down from the Board on 13 February 2015. Kirk was succeeded as Chief Executive Officer, The Americas by Elie Maalouf, who sits on IHG’s Executive Committee. I would like to thank Kirk for his long-standing contribution to IHG, most recently as a Board member and President of The Americas region.

We are also pleased to welcome Anne Busquet to the Board as a Non-Executive Director effective as of 1 March 2015. Anne will sit on the Audit, Corporate Responsibility and Nomination Committees. Anne has an impressive breadth of experience in digital commerce, hospitality, finance and marketing.

Our Board Committees

We continually review the Board’s composition to ensure we have the right balance of skills to support the business both today and in the future. This includes a regular review of the

size, experience, diversity and gender of our Board, which is conducted by our Nomination Committee (see page 69 for its report). We value the benefits that diversity brings, having had at least 25 per cent female representation on our Board since 2012. Further details on our approach to diversity from Board level and throughout the organisation, including our policies in this area, can be found on pages 61 and 62.

The Audit Committee plays a substantial role in ensuring appropriate governance and challenge around our risk and assurance processes. In line with our 2014 priorities, a major focus area has been the risks relating to information security and technology. More information can be found in the Audit Committee Report on pages 65 to 67.

In 2014, the Corporate Responsibility Committee continued to drive engagement of our three corporate responsibility programmes and deliver against our five-year corporate responsibility targets (see page 68 for its report).

At our 2014 AGM, our Directors’ Remuneration Policy was approved with a 90.94 per cent vote in favour. We are not making any changes to this Policy this year, however, we have provided a summary of it in our Directors’ Remuneration Report, which can be found on pages 76 to 91. This includes information about the Committee, the Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration and Implementation of our Directors’ Remuneration Policy in 2015.

Board effectiveness

For 2014, we conducted an internal evaluation on Board effectiveness. During 2014, we progressed the actions that were highlighted from the 2013 external evaluation, which enabled us to further inform enhancements to our Board processes. Details of both the 2013 and 2014 evaluation, including the process and recommendations, can be found on pages 63 and 64.

Structure of the report

This year we have restructured our Corporate Governance Statement, setting out a review of our 2014 activities at the start, followed by each Board Committee’s report and finally details of how we have complied with the UK Corporate Governance Code published in September 2012 (the Code). We have aimed to provide greater transparency on compliance with the Code, making this easier to follow.

I am pleased to report that, during 2014, we complied fully with all principles and provisions of the Code, with the exception of the provision relating to audit tendering (see page 70), as we believe it would not be in the best interests of the Group to undertake an audit tender at this time (see pages 66 and 67).

Objectives for the year

My objectives for the Board this year are to ensure that the focus and composition of the Board continues to evolve to support the execution of our strategy and the opportunities and challenges we face. Our 2015 Board agenda will allow time for continued focus on our technology strategy and in-depth reviews of our brands and our priority markets. This year, our annual strategy meeting will be held in Greater China.

 

LOGO

Patrick Cescau

Non-Executive Chairman

16 February 2015

 

 

 

 

54


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

Compliance and our dual listing

 

As a dual listed company with a premium listing on the London Stock Exchange and a secondary listing on the New York Stock Exchange, we are required to file both an Annual Report in the UK, which complies with the Code, and an Annual Report on Form 20-F in the US, which complies with the NYSE rules, US securities laws and the rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC).

For 2014, to ensure continued consistency of information provided to both UK and US investors, we have for the second time produced a combined Annual Report and Form 20-F.

As required by the SEC, a statement outlining the differences between the Group’s UK corporate governance practices and those followed by US companies can be found on pages 173 and 174.

 

 

 

Corporate Governance

Our Board and Committee governance structure

The Board leads the strategic direction and long-term objectives and success of the Group through effective oversight and review, setting the Group’s strategic aims and monitoring the performance of the Group and its risk management controls.

A number of key decisions and matters are reserved for the Board’s approval and are not delegated to management, these include matters related to Group business and commercial strategy; significant investment proposals; maintaining an overview and control of the Group’s operating and financial performance; monitoring the Group’s overall system of internal controls and risk management and governance and compliance.

The Board delegates certain responsibilities to its Committees, namely the Audit Committee, Corporate Responsibility Committee, Nomination Committee and Remuneration Committee, to assist it in carrying out its functions.

 

LOGO

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

55


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Corporate Governance continued

2014 Board meetings

 

The Board held eight scheduled meetings during 2014 and attendance by each Director is set out in the table below. Attendance at Committee meetings is indicated in each Committee report. Unless otherwise indicated, all Directors held office throughout the year.

 

 

Board membership and attendance   
Director Attendance  
Patrick Cescau (Chairman)   8/8   
Richard Solomons (Chief Executive Officer)   8/8   
Executive Directors      
Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson1   8/8   
Kirk Kinsell   8/8   
Tracy Robbins   7/8 2 
Non-Executive Directors      
Ian Dyson   8/8   
Jo Harlow (appointed 1 September 2014)   3/3   
David Kappler (retired 31 May 2014)   3/3   
Jennifer Laing   8/8   
Jonathan Linen (retired 31 December 2014)   7/8 2 
Luke Mayhew   8/8   
Jill McDonald   7/8 2 

Dale Morrison

(Senior Independent Non-Executive Director)

  8/8   
Ying Yeh   8/8   
Total meetings held   8   

1 Tom Singer resigned and Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson became Chief Financial Officer effective as of 1 January 2014.

2 Tracy Robbins missed one Board meeting due to health reasons and Jonathan Linen and Jill McDonald missed one Board meeting due to a prior commitment known to the Board in advance.

 

What did the Board consider at its 2014 meetings

Strategy

The Board spends a substantial amount of time considering Group strategy. In addition to its annual strategy meeting, time was spent in 2014 discussing strategic areas and business updates, including:

 

  IHG strategic updates and priorities;

 

  industry and consumer updates;

 

  brands, regional and functional updates;

 

  implementation of our commercial strategy, which includes focusing on our preferred brands, our loyalty programme and our channel management and distribution strategy;

 

  development of our technological platforms; and

 

  consideration and approval of the acquisition of Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants, in line with our strategy.

Annual strategy meeting

We held our 2014 annual two-day strategy meeting in Singapore. This included:

 

  a review of industry trends, competitors and consumer trends;

 

  an in-depth discussion of our Group strategy and progress on its implementation;

 

  an in-depth review of the performance, opportunities and challenges in our AMEA and Greater China regions;

 

  meeting with AMEA Regional Operating Committee members, which comprises senior management in this region;

 

  visiting our corporate office in Singapore; and

 

  attending an informal evening event with the Singapore office and 30 members of the IHG I-Grad Future Leaders Programme.

A third day was added to give the Board the opportunity to visit hotels across our brand portfolio in Singapore and interact with general managers of our hotels and their teams.

Governance

  Reviewed our internal controls and risk management processes including the Major Risk Review, a Risk Management Effectiveness Review and updates on our global insurance programme.

 

  Discussed the composition and succession planning of the Board and its Committees and approved Dale Morrison becoming Senior Independent Non-Executive Director, Ian Dyson becoming Chairman of the Audit Committee and the appointment of Jo Harlow as a new Non-Executive Director.

 

  Reviewed the externally conducted 2013 Board performance evaluation and agreed the action plan for 2014.

 

  Considered the performance of each of the Board Committees, concluding each remained effective and reviewed each of their terms of reference, updating these as required.

 

  Received updates on the deliberations of each of the Board Committees (see each of their reports on their key activities and priorities during 2014).

 

  Updated on upcoming legislative and regulatory changes affecting our business and the Board and its Committees across areas including corporate reporting, governance guidelines, and institutional investor reports.

Investor relations

  Reviewed and approved a $750 million return to shareholders.

 

  Discussed reports on investor perceptions and shareholder relations, and considered analysts reports and media updates.

Regular agenda items

As part of general monitoring of the Group and its compliance with the governance framework, certain matters are regularly included on Board meeting agendas. These include an update on the business from the Chief Executive Officer, finance updates from the Chief Financial Officer (which includes a financial review of the Group), and deep dives on each region and function presented by Executive Committee members and other senior management.

Meetings without Executive Directors

During 2014, at the end of each Board meeting, our Non-Executive Directors met with the Chairman without the Executive Directors present. They also regularly met with the Chief Executive Officer without the other Executive Directors present.

 

 

 

 

56


Table of Contents
 
    
 

Who is on our Board of Directors

 

LOGO

Patrick Cescau

Non-Executive Chairman  LOGO

Appointed to the Board: 1 January 2013

 

Skills and experience: From 2005 to 2008, Patrick was Group Chief Executive of Unilever Group, having previously been Chairman of Unilever PLC, Vice-Chairman of Unilever NV and Foods Director, following a progressive career with the Company, which began in France in 1973. Prior to being appointed to the Board of Unilever PLC and Unilever NV in 1999, as Finance Director, he was Chairman of a number of the company’s major operating companies and divisions, including in the US, Indonesia and Portugal. He was formerly a Senior Independent Director and Non-Executive Director of Pearson plc and a Director at INSEAD.

Board contribution: Patrick has held board of director positions for nearly 15 years in leading global businesses and brings extensive international experience in brands, consumer products, as well as finance. As Chairman, Patrick is responsible for leading the Board and ensuring it operates in an effective manner and promoting constructive relations with shareholders. He is also Chairman of the Nomination Committee.

Other appointments: Currently a Non-Executive Director of International Consolidated Airlines Group S.A. and the Senior Independent Director of Tesco PLC. Patrick is also a trustee of The Leverhulme Trust.

LOGO

Richard Solomons

Chief Executive Officer  LOGO

Appointed to the Board: 10 February 2003

 

Skills and experience: During his tenure as Chief Executive Officer, Richard has led the continued growth of IHG, including the launch of our two newest brands, HUALUXE Hotels and Resorts and EVEN Hotels and IHG’s acquisition of Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants. Before being appointed Chief Executive Officer, Richard served as Chief Financial Officer and Head of Commercial Development. Richard was integral in shaping and implementing IHG’s asset-light strategy, which has helped the business grow significantly since it was formed in 2003, as well as supporting the return of $10.4 billion to shareholders. In 2008, he served as Interim President of our Americas region. Richard is a member of the Executive Committee of the World Travel and Tourism Council, a member of the Industry Real Estate Financing Advisory Council and a Governor of the Aviation and Travel Industry Group of the World Economic Forum.

Board contribution: Richard is responsible for the executive management of the Group and ensuring the implementation of Board strategy and policy.

 

 

LOGO

Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson

Chief Financial Officer

Appointed to the Board: 1 January 2014

 

Skills and experience: Paul is a chartered accountant and a fellow of the Institute of Chartered Accountants. He was previously Chief Financial Officer of IHG’s Europe and Asia, Middle East and Africa regions, a position he held since September 2011. He joined IHG in August 2004 and has held a number of senior level finance positions, including Head of Investor Relations, Head of Global Corporate Finance and Financial Planning & Tax and Head of Hotel Development, Europe. Paul also acted as Interim Chief Executive Officer of the Europe, Middle East and Africa regions.

Board contribution: Paul is responsible, together with the Board, for overseeing the financial operations of the Group and setting its financial strategy.

LOGO

Tracy Robbins

Executive Vice President,

Human Resources and

Group Operations Support

Appointed to the Board: 9 August 2011

 

Skills and experience: Tracy has nearly 30 years’ experience in human resources roles in service industries. She joined the Group in December 2005 from Compass Group PLC, a world-leading food service company, where she was Group Human Resources Leadership & Development Director. Previously, she acted as Group HR Director for Forte Group plc, a hotel company. Tracy also spent seven years at Tesco PLC as a Retail Human Resources Manager where she implemented a culture change and restructuring strategy across 150 stores.

Board contribution: Tracy has many years of experience in human resources and is responsible for global talent management, leadership development, employee reward strategy and implementation, organisational capability and operations support.

 

 

 

Board Committee membership key

LOGO Audit Committee member
LOGO Corporate Responsibility Committee member
LOGO Nomination Committee member
LOGO Remuneration Committee member

LOGO

 

Denotes Chairman of a Board Committee

 

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

57


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Corporate Governance continued

Who is on our Board of Directors continued

 

LOGO

Dale Morrison

Senior Independent

Non-Executive Director  LOGO   LOGO   LOGO

Appointed to the Board: 1 June 2011

 

Skills and experience: Dale is a founding partner of TriPointe Capital Partners, a private equity firm. Dale was previously President and Chief Executive Officer of McCain Foods Limited and President and Chief Executive Officer of Campbell Soup Company.

Board contribution: Dale has over 10 years’ experience in sales and marketing positions, and over 25 years’ experience in general management, having held senior positions in the branded foods sector. He was appointed as the Board’s Senior Independent Non-Executive Director on 31 May 2014.

Other appointments: Currently a Non-Executive Director of International Flavors & Fragrances Inc., a producer of flavours and fragrances, and Non-Executive Chairman of Findus Group, a frozen food company.

LOGO

Ian Dyson

Independent

Non-Executive Director  LOGO   LOGO   LOGO

Appointed to the Board: 1 September 2013

 

Skills and experience: Ian has held a number of senior executive and finance roles including Group Finance & Operations Director for Marks and Spencer Group plc for five years from 2005 to 2010, where he oversaw significant changes in the business. In addition, Ian was Chief Executive Officer of Punch Taverns plc, a pub and bar operator, Finance Director for the Rank Group Plc, a leading European gaming business, and Group Financial Controller and Finance Director for the hotels division of Hilton Group Plc.

Board contribution: Ian has gained significant experience from working in various senior finance roles predominantly in the hospitality sector. Ian became Chairman of the Audit Committee on 1 April 2014 and as such is responsible for leading the Committee to ensure effective internal controls and risk management systems are in place.

Other appointments: Currently a Non-Executive Director of Punch Taverns plc, a Non-Executive Director and Chairman of the Audit Committee of SSP Group plc and Senior Independent Non-Executive Director and Chairman of the Audit Committee of ASOS Plc and Betfair Group plc.

 

 

LOGO

Jo Harlow

Independent

Non-Executive Director  LOGO   LOGO   LOGO

Appointed to the Board: 1 September 2014

 

Skills and experience: Jo has held the position of Corporate Vice President of the Phones Business Unit at Microsoft Corporation since May 2014. She was previously Executive Vice President of Smart Devices at Nokia Corporation since February 2011, following a number of senior management roles at Nokia since 2003. Prior to that, she held marketing, sales and management roles at Reebok International Limited from 1992 to 2003 and at Procter & Gamble Company from 1984 to 1992.

Board Contribution: Jo has over 25 years’ experience working in various senior roles predominantly in the branded and technology sectors.

Other appointments: None.

LOGO

Jennifer Laing

Independent

Non-Executive Director  LOGO   LOGO   LOGO

Appointed to the Board: 25 August 2005

 

Skills and experience: Jennifer was Associate Dean, External Relations at London Business School, until 2007. A fellow of the Marketing Society and of the Institute of Practitioners in Advertising, she has over 30 years’ experience in advertising including 16 years with Saatchi & Saatchi where she rose to Chairman of the London office and subsequently Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of Saatchi & Saatchi North America. Until May 2014, she was also a Non-Executive Director of Hudson Global, Inc.

Board contribution: Jennifer has over 30 years’ experience in marketing and advertising and is Chairman of the Corporate Responsibility Committee, responsible for the Corporate Responsibility objectives and strategy and approach to sustainable development.

Other appointments: Currently a Non-Executive Director of Premier Foods plc, a branded food producer.

 

 

 

 

58


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

LOGO   

Luke Mayhew

Independent

Non-Executive Director  LOGO   LOGO   LOGO

Appointed to the Board: 1 July 2011

 

Skills and experience: Luke served for 12 years on the Board of John Lewis Partnership plc, including as Managing Director of the Department Store division. Luke also spent five years at British Airways Plc and seven years at Thomas Cook Group plc in senior positions. He was also a Non-Executive Director of WHSmith PLC and Chairman of Pets at Home Group Plc.

Board contribution: Luke has over 30 years’ experience in senior roles in the branded sector and was Remuneration Committee Chairman at Brambles Limited from 2006 to 2014. As Chairman of the IHG Remuneration Committee he is responsible for setting the remuneration policy.

Other appointments: Currently a Non-Executive Director of DFS Furniture Holdings plc, and a trustee of BBC Children in Need.

LOGO   

Jill McDonald

Independent

Non-Executive Director  LOGO   LOGO

Appointed to the Board: 1 June 2013

 

Skills and experience: Jill started her career at Colgate-Palmolive Company, spent 16 years with British Airways Plc and held a number of senior marketing positions in the UK and overseas.

Board contribution: Jill has nearly 30 years’ experience working with high-profile international consumer-facing brands at both marketing and operational level.

Other appointments: Currently Chief Executive Officer UK and President for the North West Europe Division for McDonald’s. Prior to that Jill was Chief Executive Officer UK and President for the Northern Division (2010 to 2013) and previously Senior Vice President, Chief Marketing Officer UK and Northern Division (2006 to 2010).

 

 

 

LOGO

 

Ying Yeh

Independent

Non-Executive Director LOGO   LOGO   LOGO

Appointed to the Board: 1 December 2007

 

Skills and experience: Ying was formerly Vice President and Chairman, Greater China Region, Nalco Company, and Chairman and President, North Asia Region, President, Business Development, Asia Pacific Region and Vice President, Eastman Kodak Company. She was previously a Non-Executive Director of AB Volvo, a transportation related products and services company, and for 15 years, a diplomat with the US Foreign Service in Hong Kong and Beijing until 1997.

Board contribution: Ying has over 20 years’ experience gained from working in senior positions in global organisations across a broad range of sectors.

Other appointments: Currently a Non-Executive Director of ABB Ltd, a global leader in power and automation technologies, and Samsonite International S.A.

 

 

LOGO

  

The Board is supported by the Company Secretary:

 

George Turner

Executive Vice President, General Counsel and Company Secretary

Appointed to the Executive Committee:

January 2009 (Joined the Group: 2008)

 

Skills and experience: George is a solicitor and qualified to private practice in 1995. Prior to joining the Group, George spent over 10 years with Imperial Chemical Industries where he held a number of key positions including Deputy Company Secretary. He was appointed Executive Vice President, General Counsel and Company Secretary in January 2009.

Key responsibilities: These include corporate governance, risk management, insurance, regulatory, internal audit, legal, corporate responsibility, public affairs and standards.

 

 

Changes to the Board

 

 

  Tom Singer

  

 

Tom resigned as Chief Financial Officer effective as of 1 January 2014.

 

 

 

  Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson

 

  

 

Paul joined the Board as Chief Financial Officer effective as of 1 January 2014.

 

 

  David Kappler

 

  

 

David retired as Senior Independent Non-Executive Director effective as of 31 May 2014.

 

 

  Jo Harlow

 

  

 

Jo joined the Board as a Non-Executive Director effective as of 1 September 2014.

 

 

  Jonathan Linen

 

  

 

Jonathan retired as a Non-Executive Director effective as of 31 December 2014.

 

 

  Kirk Kinsell

 

  

 

Kirk resigned as President, The Americas effective as of 13 February 2015.

 

 

  Anne Busquet

 

  

 

Anne will be joining as a Non-Executive Director effective as of 1 March 2015.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

59


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Corporate Governance continued

Who is on our Executive Committee

In addition to the Executive Directors and the General Counsel and Company Secretary, the Executive Committee comprises:

 

LOGO

Keith Barr

Chief Commercial Officer

Appointed to the Executive Committee:

April 2011 (Joined the Group: 2000)

 

Skills and experience: Keith has over 20 years’ experience in the hospitality industry. He has held senior appointments at IHG including Vice President of Sales and Revenue Management, Vice President of Operations, Chief Operating Officer, Australia, New Zealand and South Pacific, and Managing Director, Greater China. He became an Executive Committee member in April 2011 and prior to becoming Chief Commercial Officer, was Chief Executive, Greater China until May 2013. Keith is currently a member of Leland C. and Mary M. Pillsbury Institute for Hospitality Entrepreneurship Advisory Board.

Key responsibilities: These include global sales, marketing and brand functions, to drive consistent brand strategies across all regions and leverage IHG’s scale and systems to deliver continued industry outperformance.

LOGO

Angela Brav

Chief Executive, Europe

Appointed to the Executive Committee:

August 2011 (Joined the Group: 1988)

 

Skills and experience: Angela has over 25 years’ experience in the hospitality industry, including hotel operations, franchise relations and technology solutions. She has held various senior roles in IHG’s North American and European regions prior to becoming Chief Operating Officer, North America. She was appointed Chief Executive, Europe in August 2011.

Key responsibilities: These include business development and performance of all the hotel brands and properties in Europe.

 

 

LOGO

Elie Maalouf

Chief Executive Officer,

The Americas

Appointed to the Executive Committee:

February 2015 (Joined the Group: 2015)

 

Skills and experience: Elie was appointed Chief Executive Officer, The Americas at IHG in February 2015, having had over 15 years’ experience working in a major global franchise business. He joined the Group having spent six years as President and Chief Executive Officer of HMSHost Corporation, a global travel and leisure company, where he was also a member of the Board of Directors. Elie brings broad experience to IHG spanning development, branding, finance, real estate and operations management, as well as highly relevant food and beverage expertise. He was most recently a Senior Advisor with McKinsey & Company.

Key responsibilities: These include business development and performance of all the hotel brands and properties in The Americas region.

LOGO

Kenneth Macpherson

Chief Executive, Greater China

Appointed to the Executive Committee:

April 2013 (Joined the Group: 2013)

 

Skills and experience: Kenneth joined IHG as Chief Executive, Greater China in April 2013. Prior to joining the Group, he worked for Diageo plc, for nearly 20 years and has held senior management positions, including serving as Executive Managing Director of Diageo Greater China. Kenneth has extensive management experience, with a background in sales, marketing strategy, business development and operations. Kenneth also brings substantial knowledge and expertise in Chinese and international business operations.

Key responsibilities: These include business development and performance of all the hotel brands and properties in the Greater China region.

 

 

 

 

There are no family relationships between any of the Board or Executive Committee members (set out on pages 57 to 61). There are no arrangements or understandings with major shareholders, customers, suppliers or others, pursuant to which any of the Board or Executive Committee were selected as a Director or member of the Executive Committee.

 

 

 

 

60


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

LOGO

Eric Pearson

Executive Vice President

and Chief Information Officer

Appointed to the Executive Committee:

February 2012 (Joined the Group: 1997)

 

Skills and experience: Eric has a background in engineering and technology and started his career at IHG nearly 20 years ago. Since then he has held various senior positions in the field of emerging technologies and global e-commerce. Prior to being appointed Chief Information Officer, Eric most recently held the position of Chief Marketing Officer for The Americas region.

Key responsibilities: These include global technology, including IT systems and information management, throughout the Group.

LOGO

Jan Smits

Chief Executive,

Asia, Middle East and Africa

Appointed to the Executive Committee:

April 2011 (Joined the Group: 2002)

 

Skills and experience: Jan has 33 years’ experience in the hospitality industry. He held various senior positions in the Asia and Australasia region. He became Managing Director, Asia Australasia in June 2009. Following the amalgamation of our Middle East and Africa region with our Asia Australasia region, he became Chief Executive, Asia, Middle East and Africa in August 2011.

Key responsibilities: These include business development and performance of all the hotel brands and properties in Asia, Middle East and Africa.

 

 

 

 

Board composition and diversity

The Board believes that, in order to be most effective, objectively challenge management and encourage different perspectives for debate, it must have an appropriate mix of skills, experience, knowledge and diversity in line with our business. The Nomination Committee supports the Board in respect of reviewing Board composition and continuously monitors succession planning. See page 69 for the Nomination Committee Report.

 

Independence and tenure

The Board and Nomination Committee regularly review the independence of each Non-Executive Director. Jennifer Laing has served on the Board for over nine years and the Nomination Committee has specifically reviewed her independence and is satisfied that she continues to demonstrate independence in character and judgement and is independent as required under the Code. The Board has also considered this and reached the same conclusion. Excluding the Chairman, 70 per cent (as at 16 February 2015) and 67 per cent (as at 31 December 2014) of our Board comprise independent Non-Executive Directors.

 

As Ying Yeh has also been on the Board for over six years, both her and Jennifer’s continued appointments were the subject of particular review and scrutiny by the Nomination Committee and the Board. Our current Non-Executive Directors’ lengths of tenure as at 16 February 2015 are shown below:

 

LOGO

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

61


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Corporate Governance continued

Board composition and diversity continued

 

Board Diversity Policy (BDP) and Global Diversity and Inclusion Policy (GDIP)

With a presence in nearly 100 countries globally, we value the benefits of diversity, beyond gender, and strongly believe that our leadership should reflect the diversity of our employees, our guests and the local communities in which we operate. Therefore, the Board seeks diversity of skills, experience, geographical representation and gender both in its composition and throughout all levels of our business. In 2013, we introduced a Board Diversity Policy as well as a Global Diversity and Inclusion Policy to ensure that diversity in its broadest sense remains a key priority.

Progress against the objectives of each of these policies during 2014:

 

 

BDP objective: Whilst all appointments are made on merit, we seek to ensure that the Board maintains an appropriate balance through a diverse mix of experience, backgrounds, skills, knowledge and insight, to further strengthen the diversity of gender and experience already on the Board and improve it further

 

 

Our Board members bring multinational experience to IHG, having themselves worked across a number of countries. The diverse nationalities of our Board are reflected below:

 
LOGO
 
Collectively the Board also has a broad collection of industry skills and experience in line with IHG’s business and strategic focus, to enable it to discharge its duties and responsibilities effectively:
 

 

LOGO

 

 

 

BDP objective: We commit to having diverse and inclusive leadership which supports all colleagues in reaching their full potential, including the development of a pipeline of high-calibre candidates from within the business

 

GDIP objective: To strengthen female representation in our global senior leadership population, with a target of reaching 25% by the end of 2015

 

 
We have 52 people comprising our senior leadership population at our corporate offices and central reservations offices who are employed by the Group and are part of our senior leadership team, 14 of these people are females (27 per cent). This is in line with our 2015 target and is an increase from the 21 per cent in 2013. This reflects both external appointments and internal promotions of female talent during 2014. We have also worked with executive search firms to ensure we have better gender balance on shortlists for senior leadership appointments.
 

From 2015, each of our Executive Committee members will be mentoring our high-potential senior leaders.

 

 

BDP and GDIP objective: Maintain a level of at least 25% female directors on the Board over the short to medium term

 

 

We firmly believe in the importance of a diverse Board membership and fully support the Lord Davies Report on ‘Women on boards’. Jo Harlow joined our Board on 1 September 2014. Our Board currently comprises 11 Directors, five of whom are women. This continues our record since 2012 of having more than 25 per cent females on the Board:

 
LOGO
 

We remain committed to maintaining at least 25 per cent female representation on the Board over the short to medium term, but the Nomination Committee does recommend appointments based on merit, ensuring there is an appropriate mix on the Board (as set out above and in its report on page 69).

 

 

 

BDP objective: We will report annually against these objectives and other initiatives taking place in the Group which promote gender and other forms of diversity

 

GDIP objective: To sustain a healthy balance of gender in the whole employee organisation

 

 
We continue to take action to sustain a healthy gender balance and review diversity throughout our organisation. Out of the 12,772 people employed by the Group whose costs are borne by the Group or the System Fund (see pages 23, 120 and 152), 7,069 are female (55 per cent).
 

In 2014, initiatives promoting diversity (beyond gender) included:

•  establishing internal forums to increase support and mentoring for female colleagues and high-potential female employees;

 

•  actively participating in external diversity summits, conferences and events in all regions; and

 

•  continuing to review ways to increase local representation on the leadership and management teams in emerging markets. In Greater China, our Regional Operating Committee has three local leaders, thereby strengthening our local leadership talent.

 

 

 

 

 

62


Table of Contents
 
    
 

Director induction, training and development

 

New Director induction

New Directors receive a full and formal induction programme tailored to meet their individual needs and in accordance with best practice. This induction, led by the Chairman, includes the following key areas:

 

  familiarisation with the Group’s business, principal activities and strategy;

 

  an understanding of the Group’s governance, including the structure of the Board and its Committees and our approach to internal controls and risk management;

 

  meetings with senior executives and regional and central management from various functions across the Group, including Business Reputation and Responsibility, Human Resources, Corporate Affairs, Global Strategy, Global Internal Audit and Group Finance; and

 

  visits to our global corporate offices and hotels to provide a greater insight into our business.

Jo Harlow’s induction

Jo’s induction centred on providing her with an understanding of IHG and our business to enable her to contribute her knowledge, skills and experience effectively to the Board. The key areas included:

 

    information on the Group, including our history, brands, regional structure and operations; strategy and business model; KPIs; commercial strategy; the IHG Owners Association; and regulatory compliance;  

 

    information on the Board, its Committees and IHG’s governance processes with particular focus on the Audit, Nomination and Remuneration Committees in light of her appointment to these;  

 

    our approach to internal controls and risk management; and  

 

    meetings with members of the Board and the Executive Committee, senior management from functions across the Group and the external Auditor.  

Since her appointment, Jo has had the opportunity to visit our UK and US corporate headquarters, meet and address the Group’s senior leaders at our Senior Leaders Meeting held in Seattle, and tour hotels across our brands in Greater China, the US and the UK.

 

Ongoing Director training and development

The updating of Directors’ skills and knowledge, ongoing training and development, and understanding of the Group’s business and operations is a progressive exercise:

 

  Patrick Cescau regularly reviews and agrees training and development needs with each Director;

 

  the Board is made aware of training opportunities and additional information, as necessary, to enable them to keep up to date and enhance their knowledge of the business;

 

  Board and Committee meetings are used to formally keep Directors up to date on developments in the environment in which the business operates – for example, in 2014, in-depth presentations were given by senior management in the Group on key topical areas (see page 56);

 

  the Company Secretary regularly updates the Board on regulatory and legal matters as part of meetings; and

 

  Directors are encouraged to visit hotels across our brands both formally as part of meetings and informally. For example, in 2014, visits to our hotel were included as part of the annual Board strategy meeting (see page 56).

We also invite different Non-Executive Directors to attend our large annual conferences. In 2014, two Non-Executive Directors attended the IHG Americas Investors & Leadership Conference which took place in Las Vegas, US. This enables Directors to interact with current and potential owners and gain an insight first hand of the key areas of focus for the business.

 

 

Board effectiveness evaluation

IHG has always recognised the importance of evaluating the performance of the Board as a whole, its main Committees and its Directors, in line with the Code recommendations.

 

Progress against our 2013 evaluation

In 2013, we conducted an externally facilitated independent evaluation as detailed in our 2013 Annual Report.

Our progress in 2014 against the actions identified is set out below:

 

Observations   Action taken during 2014

 

Increase the Board’s oversight of new technology

 

 

The Board was regularly updated on new technology developments. Technology was an agenda item at Board meetings and the Board also received an evening presentation from external consultants entitled ‘Winning with Technology’. The Audit Committee also discussed the Group approach to information security – see page 66.

 

Enhance the Board’s use of time and gain a deeper understanding of priorities and risks

 

 

Board meeting agendas had an increased focus on industry and consumer trends, including information on our competitors, as well as regular updates on our progress on major projects.

 

Consider future Board composition and succession

 

 

Five Nomination Committee meetings were held in 2014 reflecting our focus on Board and Executive Committee succession planning and Board composition in light of IHG’s current and future focus (see page 69). We prioritised the search for a Non-Executive Director with experience in consumer-facing technology, which led to the appointment of Jo Harlow in September 2014.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

63


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Corporate Governance continued

 

Our 2014 evaluation process

Our 2014 evaluation was conducted internally. Each member of the Board completed an effectiveness questionnaire, which centred around the progress against actions identified in our 2013 Board effectiveness evaluation. Key areas included the regularity of meetings, appropriateness of location (especially in enabling us to gain a better understanding of our business), the decision-making process, executive management succession planning, impact of internal and external technology developments, and risk management and assurance oversight. It also invited Directors to make other general or specific observations. The results were analysed and the report was presented for discussion at the Board’s February 2015 meeting.

The Board considered the performance of its Committees and internal performance evaluations of Directors were undertaken as follows:

 

Director being appraised   Appraiser
Chairman   Non-Executive Directors excluding the Chairman and facilitated by the Senior Independent Non-Executive Director

 

Chief Executive Officer

 

 

Chairman and all Non-Executive Directors

 

Executive Directors

 

 

Chief Executive Officer

 

Non-Executive Directors

 

 

Chairman

2014 Board effectiveness evaluation observations and action plan:

 

Observations   Action to be taken
Increase the Board’s focus on brands   Deep dives into each brand strategy to be provided to the Board.
Enhance the Board’s understanding of competitors’ strategy and performance   Presentations on competitors’ strategies and offerings. Competitive analysis to be included in both financial results and strategic reviews.
Increase the Board’s exposure to the Group’s US business   Ensure opportunities are secured for meeting with the newly appointed Chief Executive Officer for The Americas region. Increase the Board’s understanding of the Kimpton brand. Deep dives into the strategy for core brands in the US. Firmer understanding of the EVEN Hotels brand’s growth strategy.

It was confirmed that the Board and its Committees were operating effectively, and that each Director continues to bring relevant knowledge, diversity of perspective, an ability and willingness to challenge and retains a strong commitment to the role.

 

 

 

 

Board engagement with shareholders

The Board takes its responsibility to represent and promote the interests of its shareholders seriously and believes it is very important to engage with them fully. A formal external review of investor perceptions is presented to the Board on an annual basis and both the Executive Committee and the Board receive regular updates on shareholder relations.

Engagement during the year

The Board engaged with shareholders in a number of ways during 2014, which included:

 

  meeting shareholders at the AGM;

 

  half-year and full-year formal reporting and telephone conferences after the release of the first and third quarter interim management statements;

 

  presentations by Richard Solomons and Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson to institutional investors, analysts and the media following results announcements;

 

  a programme of meetings with major institutional shareholders;

 

  an analyst presentation on Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants.

To enable as many shareholders as possible to access conferences and presentations, telephone dial-in facilities are made available in advance and live audio webcasts are made available after presentations, together with associated data and documentation. These can be found at www.ihgplc.com/investors under financial library.

Around 25 sell-side research analysts publish research on the Group; their details are available at www.ihgplc.com/investors under analysts’ details.

AGM

The AGM is an opportunity for shareholders to vote on certain aspects of Group business. The Board values this as it provides

a useful forum for one-to-one communication with private shareholders. At the AGM, shareholders receive presentations on the Company’s performance and may ask questions of the Board.

The 2015 AGM will be held at 11:00am on Friday, 8 May 2015. The notice convening this meeting has been sent to shareholders at the same time as publication of this Annual Report and Form 20-F, and is available at www.ihgplc.com/investors under financial library.

Meetings with major institutional shareholders

A programme of meetings throughout the year is arranged with major institutional shareholders. These meetings provide an opportunity to discuss, using publicly-available information, the progress of the business, its performance, plans and objectives. Patrick Cescau, Dale Morrison and other Non-Executive Directors are available to meet with major shareholders to understand their issues and concerns, and to discuss governance and strategy.

Facilitated, structured meetings are encouraged with shareholders, and any new Director is available for meetings with major shareholders as a matter of course.

Details of the Remuneration Committee’s engagement with shareholders is set out on page 76. During the year, Jennifer Laing also met with shareholders to discuss our corporate responsibility strategy.

Sharedealing programme

In 2014, we offered our small UK-resident retail shareholders a sharedealing service to buy or sell shares in IHG. As part of this, shareholders were given the option to donate the proceeds of any sale of their shares to IHG Shelter in a Storm (see page 179).

Re-engaging with ‘gone away’ shareholders

We continue to be supported by ProSearch to locate shareholders who haven’t kept their details up to date. To date, the programme has been very successful and many asset reunifications (both in terms of the shares themselves and unclaimed dividends) have been made. For further information, see page 179.

 

 

 

 

64


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

Audit Committee Report

 

LOGO

“Our priority is ensuring that standards of good governance are maintained across all areas of the business.”

 

 

Dear Shareholder

The Audit Committee continues to focus on the integrity of internal financial controls and risk management systems. As the new Chairman of the Committee, I have also sought to ensure that the Committee (i) has oversight of the Group’s risk management and assurance processes, looking at the processes and structures in place across the Group as a whole and how key projects are being delivered; and (ii) probes the significant risks, particularly in the area of technology, through a balance of presentations, papers and discussion.

Roles and responsibilities

The Committee’s responsibilities fall into five areas: (i) internal controls and risk management; (ii) financial reporting; (iii) internal audit; (iv) fraud and whistleblowing; and (v) external audit and compliance. While the Board has overall responsibility for the management of business risks, the Committee assists the Board in a number of ways.

Our main role and responsibilities are set out in our terms of reference (ToR), which are reviewed annually and no changes were made for 2015. The ToR are available on the Company’s website at www.ihgplc.com/investors under corporate governance/ committees or from the Company Secretary’s office on request.

Governance

All members have the experience and expertise necessary to meet the Committee’s responsibilities and all members are independent Non-Executive Directors as required under the ToR. During the year, Jo Harlow joined the Committee, and I replaced David Kappler as the Chairman of the Committee on 1 April 2014.

The Board is satisfied that both David (during his time on the Committee) and I are independent. The Code requires the Committee has at least one member with recent and relevant financial experience and Sarbanes-Oxley Act 2002 (SOX) necessitates a designated financial expert. The Board is satisfied that both David and I meet these requirements – David is a qualified accountant and former Chief Financial Officer of Cadbury Schweppes plc and I am also a qualified accountant and was formerly Group Finance and Operations Director at Marks and Spencer Group plc.

As Chairman of the Committee, after each meeting, I report to the Board on any key matters arising.

Internal controls and risk management

The Committee supports the Board in reviewing the effectiveness of the Group’s internal control and risk management system, having oversight of the risk and control activities in operation across the Group. Processes have been established which test and monitor:

 

  strategic plan achievement, through a comprehensive series of Group and regional strategic reviews;

 

  financial performance, within a comprehensive financial planning and accounting framework;

 

  capital investment performance, with detailed appraisal and authorisation processes; and

 

  risk management processes relying upon a Major Risk Review and assurance mapping process (through reports from the Head of Global Risk Management, the Head of Global Internal Audit (GIA), and, as appropriate, from management) providing assurance that the significant risks faced by the Group are being identified, assessed, prioritised, evaluated and appropriately managed and mitigated, having regard to the balance of risk, cost and opportunity.

 

 

Our approach to risk management and key risk mitigating activities in respect of the Major Risks are set out on pages 26 to 29 and the wider set of risk factors are set out on pages 162 to 165.

Financial reporting

The key financial controls across our business have been identified and evaluated, in particular, to comply with our US obligations, arising from SOX. The Committee reviews the approach to SOX compliance each year, and, in 2014, it took into consideration changes in legislation, and the transition from the 1992 to the 2013 Internal Control – Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Committee regularly reviews reports on the progress of the SOX programme and this has enabled appropriate representations regarding the effectiveness of internal financial controls to be made, concluding that no material weaknesses had been found in the internal control environment.

Internal Audit

The Committee is responsible for reviewing and monitoring the activities of the GIA department. In December each year, the Committee discusses the GIA Plan and approves its nature and scope for the forthcoming year. GIA also undertakes an agreed schedule of audits during which the Group’s internal controls are assessed and reported back to the Committee.

Fraud and whistleblowing

Fraud and whistleblowing reports are collated from information provided by the Group’s independent external provider, who facilitates the Group’s confidential disclosure process for employees with whistleblowing and fraud concerns, and fraud data from Global Risk Management, and are presented to the Committee biannually.

The Committee is advised, as appropriate, of any significant matters to ensure a proportionate and independent investigation is performed.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

65


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Corporate Governance continued

Audit Committee Report continued

 

Committee membership and attendance

 

Members1    Attendance  
Ian Dyson (Chairman from 1 April 2014)2      5/5   
David Kappler (Chairman to 1 April 2014)2      1/2 3 
Jo Harlow4      2/2   
Jennifer Laing      5/5   
Jill McDonald      4/5 3 
Dale Morrison      5/5   
Total meetings held      5   

 

  1  For full biographies of current members see pages 58 and 59.
  2  David Kappler retired from, and Ian Dyson was appointed to, the role of Chairman of the Committee effective as of 1 April 2014.
  3  David Kappler and Jill McDonald missed one meeting each due to a prior commitment known to the Committee in advance.
  4  Jo Harlow joined the Committee with effect from 1 September 2014.

At the invitation of the Committee, the Chairman of the Board, Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, Head of Global Internal Audit (GIA), Group Financial Controller and external Auditor, EY, attend meetings. EY attended all meetings in 2014 and provided a report on progress of, and insights from, the annual audit. Other attendees are invited to meetings as appropriate, to provide a deeper insight into, and understanding of, key decisions.

At each meeting, GIA and EY meet without the presence of management.

What did the Committee consider in 2014

In addition to those areas referred to above and routine items of business, during 2014, the Committee:

Internal controls and risk management

  Discussed and assessed IHG’s approach to risk management and assurance, looking in particular at the governance structure in place and how our ‘Three Lines of Defence’ operate in practice and the Major Risks affecting the Group in 2014 (the 2014 Major Risk Review) (summarised above and on pages 26 to 29).

 

  Approved the Risk Working Group’s terms of reference and were provided with minutes from its previous meetings.

 

  Reviewed the Group’s hotel safety and security procedures and received regular risk management incident and threat reports.

 

  Received a presentation from the Group’s Chief Information Officer (Eric Pearson) on the structure of the Global Technology team and the major technology risks faced by the Group and assessed the steps being taken to mitigate these risks. At another meeting, Eric and the Head of Information Security discussed: (i) the approach to, and the activities planned to mitigate against, emerging information security risks; and (ii) information security trends in the hotel industry.

 

  Was updated on material litigation at each meeting.

 

  Considered and approved a revised Gifts and Entertainment Policy, Anti-Bribery Policy and Antitrust Policy. Provided with an overview of IHG’s regulatory compliance programme (covering Anti-Bribery, Antitrust/Competition Law, Data Privacy, Sanctions and Code of Conduct), including the key projects carried out during 2014 and the areas of focus for 2015.

 

  Considered the findings from the 2014 post-project review of major capital projects, and agreed with management the actions that would be applied to future projects.

 

  Received a presentation on the treasury control environment and the Group’s financing strategy from the Group Treasurer
 

and a presentation on the Group’s tax position from the Head of Group Tax.

Financial reporting, issues and decision making

  Reviewed the Group’s Preliminary Results, quarterly interim management statements and Half-Year Results (see below for the areas of significance which received increased attention).

 

  Considered the Group’s Annual Report and Form 20-F and ancillary documentation (see below).

 

  Received an update on items discussed by the Disclosure Committee at each meeting.

Internal audit

  Assessed the quarterly report from GIA to monitor progress against the GIA Plan and evaluate findings, and to ensure coverage of emerging risks.

 

  Considered the 2014 GIA Effectiveness Review (which contains input from auditees, senior management and Non-Executive Directors and assessed GIA against the Institute of Internal Auditors Standards) and concluded that the Group’s systems of internal controls and risk management, including internal audit activities, were operating effectively.

 

  Monitored progress against outstanding actions.

 

  Invited the Group’s external technology co-assurance provider to a number of meetings to discuss and review the approach to technology assurance.

Fraud and whistleblowing

  Received the biannual reports on significant incidents of fraud and whistleblowing, which in 2014 included an overview of the fraud management team and the process for escalation of reviewing serious fraud.

External audit and compliance

  Reviewed the independence and objectivity of the external Auditor and the effectiveness of the external audit process.

 

  Considered EY’s key findings of audit and accounting issues, analysing EY’s audit and non-audit fees at each meeting and noting that fees incurred to date were in accordance with IHG’s Audit and Non-Audit Services Pre-Approval Policy (see below).

 

  Reviewed and approved the 2014 Group Audit Plan.

 

  Evaluated and recommended the re-appointment of EY on the basis of performance and an assessment of EY’s independence and objectivity (see below).

External Auditor – Ernst & Young LLP (EY)

EY has been the Group’s Auditor since IHG listed in 2003. While an audit tender has not been carried out since EY’s initial appointment, the Committee considers the appointment of its Auditor annually, specifically assessing EY’s performance (including its independence and objectivity).

To ensure EY’s independence is safeguarded, lead audit partners rotate every five years. The current lead audit partner has been in place for four years.

The Committee reviews the independence and effectiveness of EY on an ongoing basis, including the effectiveness of the relationship between EY and the Group’s management, and receives reports from it on its independence annually. An evaluation of EY takes place annually where questionnaires on EY’s services are completed by more than 30 senior IHG employees that work with EY. As well as Group policies and procedures, which aim to

 

 

 

 

66


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

safeguard EY’s independence and effectiveness, EY has its own protective policies and systems in place, which are explained in a Transparency Report issued by EY on an annual basis.

Following an in-depth review for the year ended 31 December 2014, the Committee was satisfied with the independence, objectivity and effectiveness of the relationship with EY as the external auditor, and with the external audit process as a whole.

Audit tender

During 2014, the Committee considered the requirements for audit tender in line with changes to legislation from the EU and the Competition and Markets Authority. Having reviewed legislative timescales and the effectiveness of the audit, we have concluded that no tender will be undertaken during 2015 but we will continue to monitor this.

Non-audit services

EY provide non-audit services to the Group, which are governed, so as to safeguard their objectivity and independence, by IHG’s Audit and Non-Audit Services Pre-Approval Policy:

 

  The policy is re-approved by the Audit Committee annually and, for the 2014 financial year, the policy was updated and approved at the December 2013 Audit Committee meeting.

 

  The policy requires that pre-approval is obtained from the Audit Committee for all services before any work can be commenced, in line with US SEC requirements. The Committee is prohibited from delegating non-audit services approval to management.

 

  Compliance with the policy is actively managed and an analysis of audit and non-audit services is reviewed by the Committee at each meeting.

The Committee is aware of, and sensitive to, investor body guidelines on non-audit fees. During 2014, 29 per cent of services provided to the Group were non-audit services; these included areas such as advisory work and corporate tax compliance.

 

 

For fees paid to EY for non-audit work during 2014, see page 120.

Significant matters in the 2014 Financial Statements

The Committee discussed with management the key judgements applied in the Financial Statements, the exceptional items arising in the year and the impact of any accounting developments or legislative changes. The main items discussed were:

 

  Accounting for the System Fund: the Committee reviewed the accounting approach adopted for the System Fund with management and EY, and concluded that the approach and the disclosures, including the key judgements noted on page 112, were appropriate.

 

  The IHG Rewards Club points liability: given the materiality of the IHG Rewards Club points liability, the Committee considered the approach to the valuation of the liability, including the results of the actuarial assessment of ‘breakage’ (see page 113) as at December 2014 and the expected cost of redemption of each point. Management was questioned on the consistency and robustness of the approach and the results of EY’s audit procedures were also considered before reaching the conclusion on the adequacy of the liability recorded.

 

  Impairment testing: the Committee reviewed a detailed management report supporting the conclusion that there were no impairment issues on hotel assets, goodwill or other
   

intangible assets. It challenged the key assumptions, including short and long-term growth rates, discount rates and underlying performance assumptions. The Committee also considered EY’s views on the work performed and concluded that the position taken was supportable.

 

  Litigation: given the judgement required in assessing the approach to be taken to material litigation, the Committee considered at each meeting an update report on major litigation matters and any provisioning for these matters. The factors taken into account by the Committee are set out on page 113.

 

  Deferred tax recognition: as noted on page 113, the recognition of deferred tax assets requires judgement and estimates primarily around the availability of future taxable profits. The Committee considered and approved the approach taken to the recognition of such profits, noting in particular EY’s reporting to the Committee in this area – deferred tax balances are analysed in note 7.

 

  Exceptional items: given the importance of showing a true underlying performance and being consistent in the definition of this year-on-year, the Committee challenged the appropriateness of the items disclosed as exceptional, in particular, the calculation of the profit on disposal of 80 per cent of our interest in InterContinental New York Barclay – focusing on the accounting for the remaining interest. The Committee also discussed the disclosures in note 5.

 

  Technology projects: as well as considering the process controls and overall governance of these projects, and based on discussions with management and EY’s audit findings and control observations on those matters, the Committee also assessed the appropriateness of the capitalisation of costs on the main projects and the need for any impairment on capitalised software assets.

Annual Report – Fair, balanced and understandable

At the request of the Board, a separate sub-committee meeting was held in February 2015 to consider whether the Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014 provided a fair, balanced and understandable view of the Group with the necessary information for shareholders to assess the Group’s performance, business model and strategy. Audit Committee members provided comments on the draft report that were then incorporated into the draft provided to the Audit Committee and Board for final comment and approval.

Effectiveness of the Committee

Effectiveness of the Committee is dependent on its overall efficiency as well as the efficacy of EY and GIA. The effectiveness of the Committee, EY and GIA is monitored and assessed annually through evaluation questionnaires and interviews.

Our priorities for 2015

During 2015, the Committee will specifically focus on: (i) the integrity of the internal financial controls and risk management systems; (ii) monitoring and continually assessing IHG’s information security arrangements; and (iii) overseeing the implementation of technology projects and the Global Finance function’s talent and succession plans.

Ian Dyson, Audit Committee Chairman

16 February 2015

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

67


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Corporate Governance continued

Corporate Responsibility Committee Report

 

LOGO

“Ensuring meaningful progress against our five-year targets will remain a key focus of the Committee.”

 

 

Dear Shareholder

Roles and responsibilities

The Committee advises the Board on the Group’s corporate responsibility objectives and strategy, its approach to sustainable development, and ensures that IHG’s responsible business priorities deliver against our core purpose, Great Hotels Guests Love.

Our role and responsibilities are set out in our terms of reference (ToR), which are reviewed annually and no changes were made for 2015. The ToR are available on the Company’s website at www.ihgplc.com/investors under corporate governance/ committees or from the Company Secretary’s office on request.

Governance

All members have the experience and expertise necessary to meet the Committee’s responsibilities and a majority of the Committee members are Non-Executive Directors, as required under the ToR.

What did the Committee consider in 2014

During the year, the Committee’s key activities included:

Targets and core programmes

  Continually monitoring progress against our five-year targets (2013-2017) – see page 33 and www.ihgplc.com/ responsiblebusiness for details.

 

  Receiving progress updates on the key achievements in 2014 across the three core corporate responsibility programmes: IHG Green Engage, IHG Academy and IHG Shelter in a Storm, including an in-depth case study of an IHG Academy set up by a franchised hotel, Holiday Inn Stoke On Trent, and in-depth reports on IHG Shelter in a Storm.

 

  Inviting external speakers to the meetings to explore key topics, including a presentation from CARE on its strategic relationship with IHG, and an overview of the landscape of responsible business by the Chief Executive of Business in the Community.

 

  Discussing the Group’s performance against the 2014 delivery plan and setting 2015 priorities.

 

  Reviewing proposals for implementing and applying a brand standard in respect of IHG Green Engage for all hotels in the IHG System (see page 33).

Committee membership and attendance

 

Members1    Attendance  
Jennifer Laing (Chairman)      3/3   
Luke Mayhew      3/3   
Dale Morrison      3/3   
Richard Solomons      3/3   
Ying Yeh      3/3   
Total meetings held      3   

 

  1  For full biographies see pages 57 to 59.

The Heads of Corporate Responsibility and the Chairman of the Board also attend the meetings.

Communication and awareness

  Evaluating the Responsible Business Communication Plan for 2014 and the results of the Employee Engagement survey, which had included questions in respect of the awareness and impact of our core corporate responsibility programmes. Responsible business activities continue to drive very high levels of pride in our employees, with 92 per cent of respondents saying they felt more positive about IHG as a result of corporate responsibility programmes.

 

  Considering methods to raise the levels of awareness and adoption of our corporate responsibility programmes in franchised hotels, such as our IHG Race Around the World event.

 

  Considering our corporate responsibility initiatives in the context of our broader responsible business practices and endorsing plans to have a broader IHG Responsible Business Report for 2014 (published in 2015).

 

LOGO

The Committee, along with our Corporate Responsibility team and the rest of the Board, also took part in an IHG Race Around the World event in Hyde Park in London, a fundraising event in support of, and building awareness for, IHG Shelter in a Storm.

Our priorities for 2015

During 2015, our priorities will be to: (i) continue to support IHG to ensure meaningful progress on our five-year corporate responsibility targets; (ii) further embed responsible business in the IHG brand and help to deliver external communications to support this; and (iii) further extend the success of IHG Shelter in a Storm by increasing IHG’s disaster preparedness capabilities and developing links with humanitarian agencies to grow IHG’s disaster relief capabilities.

Jennifer Laing, Corporate Responsibility Committee Chairman

16 February 2015

 

 

 

 

68


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

Nomination Committee Report

 

LOGO

“The Committee keeps under continuous review the talent pool within the business.”

 

 

Dear Shareholder

Roles and responsibilities

The Committee considers the structure, size and composition of the Board, advising on succession planning and making appropriate recommendations to ensure the Board retains an appropriate mix of skills, experience, knowledge and diversity. It is also responsible for reviewing the Group’s leadership needs.

Our role and responsibilities are set out in our terms of reference (ToR), which are reviewed annually and no changes were made for 2015. The ToR are available on the Company’s website at www.ihgplc.com/investors under corporate governance/committees or from the Company Secretary’s office on request.

Governance

All members have the experience and expertise necessary to meet the Committee’s responsibilities and are independent Non-Executive Directors (excluding myself), as required under the ToR. During 2014, David Kappler retired from, and Jo Harlow joined, the Committee. When the Committee is considering matters relating to my position, Dale Morrison, Senior Independent Non-Executive Director, acts as chairman of the Committee.

What did the Committee consider in 2014

During the year, the Committee’s key activities included:

Board appointments

  Continually reviewing the tenure and qualifications of the Non-Executive Directors to ensure the Board has an appropriate and diverse mix of skills, experience, knowledge and diversity.

 

  Recommending appointments to the Board in line with our strategic objectives. As identified in our 2013 Annual Report, our priority for 2014 was to strengthen the Board’s existing capabilities by looking to appoint a Non-Executive Director with experience in consumer-facing technology. Lygon Group, who have no connection to IHG, was engaged as an external search agent. The search was undertaken against a detailed job specification setting out the particular skills, knowledge and experience required for the particular position. The Committee nominated Jo Harlow, having considered her wealth of experience and knowledge, particularly in connection with the role digital technology plays in driving consumer behaviour. The Board approved Jo’s appointment with effect from 1 September 2014.

Succession planning

  Focusing, on behalf of the Board, on Board succession planning:

 

    In advance of David Kappler’s plans to retire on 31 May 2014, we recommended the appointment of Ian Dyson as Chairman

Committee membership and attendance

 

Members1    Attendance  
Patrick Cescau (Chairman)      5/5   
Ian Dyson      5/5   
Jo Harlow2      0/0   
David Kappler3      2/2   
Jennifer Laing      5/5   
Jonathan Linen4      5/5   
Jill McDonald      5/5   
Luke Mayhew      5/5   
Dale Morrison      5/5   
Ying Yeh      5/5   

Total meetings held

     5   

 

  1  For full biographies of current members see pages 57 to 59.
  2  Jo Harlow joined the Committee effective as of 1 September 2014.
  3  David Kappler retired from the Committee effective as of 31 May 2014.
  4  Jonathan Linen retired from the Committee effective as of 31 December 2014.

The Chief Executive Officer also attends the meetings.

 

    of the Audit Committee from 1 April 2014, and Dale Morrison as Senior Independent Non-Executive Director from 31 May 2014. As both Dale and Ian were already members of the Board, this allowed for a smooth transition of duties upon David’s retirement.

 

    On 31 December 2014, Jonathan Linen retired from the Board after nine years’ service.

 

    We announced on 2 December 2014 that Kirk Kinsell would step down from the Board and his role as President of IHG’s Americas business on 13 February 2015. An independent executive search agency, Egon Zehnder, was engaged to conduct a review of prospective candidates. Accordingly, Kirk was succeeded by Elie Maalouf as Chief Executive Officer, The Americas, who joined IHG in January 2015 to allow for a handover period with Kirk. While Elie does not sit on the Board, he is a member of IHG’s Executive Committee.

 

  Keeping under continuous review the development, succession planning and talent pool for the Executive Committee and other senior executive roles to identify both talent strengths and talent gaps. New senior hires were made in both global and regional leadership positions, and a number of internal promotions to the senior leader level below Executive Committee took place, further strengthening our internal pipeline.

We have also considered Jennifer Laing and Ying Yeh’s continued appointments on the Board, as both have been on the Board for over six years, and specifically reviewed Jennifer’s independence having been on the Board for over nine years.

Board diversity

We recognise the value of diversity in its broadest sense and, whilst all appointments are made on merit, we seek to ensure the Board maintains an appropriate balance through a diverse mix of skills, experience, knowledge, gender and background – see page 62 for details of our Board Diversity Policy.

Our priorities in 2015

During 2015, we aim to continue to: (i) refresh the Board and Committees in line with our priorities; and (ii) ensure we have the right capabilities for the future.

Patrick Cescau, Nomination Committee Chairman

16 February 2015

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

69


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Corporate Governance continued

Statement of compliance with the UK Corporate Governance Code

Our statement of compliance presents a summary of how the Group has implemented the principles and provisions laid down in the UK Corporate Governance Code as published in September 2012 (the Code). This should be read in conjunction with the Corporate Governance Statement (pages 54 to 72) and the Directors’ Remuneration Report as a whole. The Code is available to view in full on the Financial Reporting Council website (www.frc.org.uk).

The Board considers that the Group has complied in all material respects with the Code for the year ended 31 December 2014 with the exception of Code provision C.3.7, which requires external audit contracts to be put to tender at least every 10 years. The Group has not re-tendered within that period, but the Audit Committee monitors this in line with legislation (further details are provided on pages 66 and 67).

 

A. Leadership

A.1 The role of the Board

The Board leads IHG’s strategic direction and the long-term objectives and success of the Group. It approves strategic plans and capital and revenue budgets, and reviews significant investment proposals, maintaining an overview and control of IHG’s operating and financial performance. It monitors the Group’s overall system of internal controls and risk management, governance and compliance, considering regulatory changes and developments (where appropriate), while ensuring that the necessary financial and human resources are in place for the Group to meet its objectives. Decisions and matters reserved for the Board and not delegated to management are available on our website at www.ihgplc.com/investors under corporate governance.

The Board meets formally eight times each year, with additional meetings scheduled as necessary. One of the meetings includes a two-day strategy meeting, in which the Board considers the Group’s strategy and related issues. Details of 2014 Board meetings are set out on page 56. The attendance by Committee members at Committee meetings can be found in each of their respective reports.

All Directors are covered by the Group’s Directors’ & Officers’ Liability Insurance policy (see page 72).

A.2 Division of responsibilities

The roles of the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer are clearly established.

Chief Executive Officer

As Chief Executive Officer, Richard Solomons leads the development of the Company’s strategic direction and implementation of the agreed strategy. He oversees IHG’s business operations and manages its risks as well as building and leading an effective Executive Committee.

A.3 The Chairman

As Chairman of the Board, Patrick Cescau leads the operation and governance of the Board and its Committees as well as building and maintaining an effective Board. This includes ensuring that Directors receive timely, accurate and clear information on the Group’s business and that all Directors are fully informed of relevant matters. The Chairman oversees corporate governance matters, ensuring they are addressed, and leads the performance and effectiveness evaluations of the Board, its Committees and the Directors.

The Chairman was independent on appointment.

A.4 Non-Executive Directors

As a strong source of advice and judgement for IHG, our Non-Executive Directors constructively challenge and help develop proposals on strategy. They provide significant external commercial experience and a broad range of skills for the Board to draw on.

Senior Independent Non-Executive Director

As Senior Independent Non-Executive Director, Dale Morrison is available to liaise with shareholders who have concerns that they feel have not been addressed through the normal channels of the Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and other Executive Directors. He also leads the annual performance review of the Chairman with the other Non-Executive Directors, and provides advice and judgement for the Chairman as necessary.

After each Board meeting, our Non-Executive Directors and the Chairman meet without Executive Directors being present.

During the year, if any Director has unresolved concerns about the running of IHG or a proposed action, these would be recorded in the minutes of the meeting.

Further information on each of these roles can be found on our website at www.ihgplc.com/investors under corporate governance.

B. Effectiveness

B.1 The composition of the Board

The size and composition of the Board is regularly reviewed for the appropriate balance of skills, experience, independence and knowledge to ensure it can carry out its duties and responsibilities effectively.

The Board’s current composition meets the requirement under the Code for at least half of the Board, excluding the Chairman, to be independent Non-Executive Directors (see page 61). Further details of the composition of the Board are available on pages 57 to 59.

Jennifer Laing has served on the Board for over nine years and the Nomination Committee has specifically reviewed her independence and is satisfied that she continues to demonstrate independence in character and judgement and is independent as required under the Code. The Board has also considered this and reached the same conclusion.

B.2 Appointments

The Board has delegated a number of responsibilities to the Nomination Committee. The Nomination Committee leads the appointment of new Directors to the Board and senior executives in accordance with its terms of reference (available on our website at www.ihgplc.com/investors under corporate governance/ committees or from the Company Secretary’s office on request) and supports the Board in succession planning. Further details of the role of the Nomination Committee and what it did in 2014, including details of the appointment process of Directors, are set out in the Nomination Committee Report on page 69. The overall process of appointment and removal of Directors is overseen by the Board as a whole.

As Ying Yeh and Jennifer Laing have been on the Board for over six years, their continued appointments were the subject of particular review and scrutiny by the Nomination Committee and the Board.

 

 

 

 

70


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

B.3 Commitment

The terms of appointment of our Non-Executive Directors outlines the time commitment expected to fulfil their role. On appointment, Directors are advised of, and requested to make, the necessary time commitment required to discharge their responsibilities effectively. IHG’s Executive Directors are not permitted to take on more than one external non-executive directorship or chairmanship in addition to their role. Biographical details of all current Directors, including their external commitments, can be found on pages 57 to 59.

Details of Directors’ service contracts and appointment terms are set out on page 81.

The Chairman annually reviews the time each Non-Executive Director has dedicated to IHG as part of the internal performance evaluations of each Director (see page 64) and is satisfied that their other duties and time commitments do not conflict with those as Directors of the Company.

B.4 Development

A full, formal and tailored induction is developed for IHG’s new Directors (see page 63).

The Chairman and Company Secretary ensure that Directors continually update their skills and have the requisite knowledge and familiarity with the Group to fulfil their roles on the Board and its Committees (see page 63). All Directors are encouraged to request further information as they consider necessary to fulfil their role.

B.5 Information and support

The Chairman and the Company Secretary together ensure a good flow of information to the Board and its Committees and between the Executive Committee and the Non-Executive Directors. The Company Secretary also ensures that all Directors and Board Committees have access to independent advice when requested, at the expense of the Group, where it is necessary to discharge their responsibilities as Directors.

The role of the Company Secretary

George Turner, as Company Secretary, ensures a good flow of information to the Board and its Committees and between the Executive Committee and the Non-Executive Directors. He facilitates all new Director inductions. He advises the Board on corporate governance matters and keeps the Board up to date on all relevant legal, regulatory and other developments. The appointment and removal of the Company Secretary is a matter for the Board as a whole.

B.6 Evaluation

The Board undertakes either an internal or external annual Board effectiveness evaluation to inform further enhancements to our Board processes. In 2013, this was carried out externally and in 2014, it was carried out internally. Performance evaluations of all Directors, including the Chairman, are also carried out and the Board considers the effectiveness of each of its Committees. See pages 63 and 64 for further information.

B.7 Re-election

The Company’s amended Articles of Association (the Articles) approved by our shareholders on 28 May 2010 (see page 72) provide that each Director is subject to election at the first Annual General Meeting (AGM) following their appointment and re-election at least every three years if they wish to continue serving in office.

However, in accordance with the recommendations of the Code, all of IHG’s Directors retire and seek election or re-election at each AGM. All of IHG’s current Directors (biographies as set out on pages 57 to 59) will retire and seek election or re-election at the 2015 AGM (as set out in the Notice of Meeting for the AGM (see page 64)).

C. Accountability

C.1 Financial and business reporting

Our Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities (including the Board’s statement confirming that it considers that the Annual Report and Form 20-F, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s performance, business model and strategy) is set out on page 94.

The status of IHG as a going concern is set out in the Directors’ Report on page 75. An explanation of the Group’s performance, business model, strategy and the risks and uncertainties relating to IHG’s prospects is set out in the Strategic Report on pages 2 to 51.

The statement from our Auditor, Ernst & Young LLP, about its reporting responsibilities is set out on pages 95 to 99.

C.2 Risk management and internal control

The Board has ultimate responsibility for determining the nature and extent of the significant risks it is willing to take in line with the strategy.

The Board and Audit Committee monitor the Group’s risk management and internal controls systems and conducts an annual review of the effectiveness of the Group’s system of internal controls and risk management, and reviews the Group’s risk appetite. This review covers all material controls, including financial, operational and compliance controls. Further details are set out in the Strategic Report on pages 26 to 29, and also in the Audit Committee Report on pages 65 to 67.

C.3 Audit Committee and Auditors

The Board has delegated a number of responsibilities to the Audit Committee. The Committee comprises entirely of independent Non-Executive Directors, with at least one member having recent and relevant financial experience. Further details, including its role, responsibilities and activities in 2014, are set out in the Audit Committee Report on pages 65 to 67. The Audit Committee’s terms of reference are available on our website at www.ihgplc.com/investors under corporate governance/ committees or from the Company Secretary’s office on request.

Ernst & Young LLP has expressed its willingness to continue in office as Auditor of the Company and its reappointment will be put to shareholders at the AGM. Further details can be found in the Audit Committee Report on pages 65 to 67.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

71


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Corporate Governance continued

Statement of compliance with the UK Corporate Governance Code continued

 

D. Remuneration

D.1 The level and components of remuneration

The activities of the Remuneration Committee during 2014, a summary of our Directors’ Remuneration Policy approved at our 2014 AGM, and the Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration and Implementation of the Directors’ Remuneration Policy are set out in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 76 to 91.

D.2 Procedure

The Board has delegated a number of responsibilities to the Remuneration Committee including developing policy on executive remuneration and for fixing the remuneration packages of individual Directors. Further information can be found in the Director’s Remuneration Report.

The terms of reference of the Remuneration Committee can be found on our website at www.ihgplc.com/investors under corporate governance/committees, or from the Company Secretary’s office on request.

During 2014, no individual Director was present when their own remuneration was discussed.

E. Relations with shareholders

E.1 Dialogue with shareholders

The Board as a whole is responsible for ensuring satisfactory dialogue with all shareholders of the Company to promote mutual understanding of objectives. Further details of the Board’s approach to relations with our shareholders is set out on page 64.

E.2 Constructive use of the AGM

The next AGM of the Company will take place on Friday, 8 May 2015 and will provide an opportunity for shareholders to vote on certain aspects of Group business, as set out in the Notice of Meeting available at www.ihgplc.com/investors under financial library and which was sent out to shareholders at the same time as this Annual Report and Form 20-F.

The Board ensures where possible that all Board members, particularly the Chairmen of each of the Board Committees, attend the AGM and are available to answer questions from shareholders.

 

 

 

Directors’ Report

 

Much of the information previously provided as part of the Directors’ Report is now required under Company Law to be presented as part of the Strategic Report. This Directors’ Report includes the information required to be given in line with the Companies Act or, where provided elsewhere, an appropriate cross reference is given. The Corporate Governance Statement approved by the Board is provided on pages 54 to 72 and incorporated by reference herein.

Subsidiaries, joint ventures and associated undertakings

The Group has over 300 subsidiaries, joint ventures and associated undertakings.

Directors

During 2014 the following individuals served as Directors:

Patrick Cescau, Ian Dyson, Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson, Jo Harlow, David Kappler, Kirk Kinsell, Jennifer Laing, Jonathan Linen, Luke Mayhew, Jill McDonald, Dale Morrison, Tracy Robbins, Tom Singer, Richard Solomons and Ying Yeh.

Tom Singer resigned effective as of 1 January 2014, David Kappler retired effective as of 31 May 2014, Jo Harlow joined effective as of 1 September 2014, Jonathan Linen retired effective as of 31 December 2014 and Kirk Kinsell resigned effective as of 13 February 2015.

 

 

For biographies of the current Directors see pages 57 to 59.

Directors’ & Officers’ (D&O) Liability Insurance

The Company maintains the Group’s D&O Liability Insurance policy, which covers Directors and officers of the Company against defending civil proceedings brought against them in their capacity as a Director or officer of the Company (including those who served as Directors or officers during the year). There were no indemnity provisions relating to the UK pension plan for the benefit of the Directors during 2014.

Articles

The Company’s Articles may only be amended by special resolution and are available on the Company’s website at www.ihgplc.com/ investors under corporate governance. A summary is provided on pages 167 to 168.

Shares

Share capital

The Company’s issued share capital at 31 December 2014 consisted of 247,655,712 ordinary shares of 15265/329 pence each including 11,538,456 shares held in treasury, which constitutes 4.66 per cent of the total issued share capital (including treasury shares). There are no special control rights or restrictions on share transfers or limitations on the holding of any class of shares.

During 2014:

 

  the Company’s issued share capital was subject to a share consolidation effective as of 1 July 2014 (see page 73);

 

  60,370 new shares were issued under employee share plans; and

 

  the Company completed the share buyback programme (see page 73).

As far as is known to management, IHG is not directly or indirectly owned or controlled by another company or by any governments.

The Board focuses on shareholder value creation. When it decides to return capital to shareholders, it considers all the options, including share buybacks and special dividends.

 

 

 

 

72


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

Share issues and buybacks

On 29 May 2014, we completed our $500m share buyback programme which was announced on 7 August 2012 and commenced on 12 November 2012. The current share buyback authority remains in force until the 2015 AGM, and a resolution to renew the authority will be put to shareholders at that AGM.

The table below illustrates the transactions that took place during 2014 that affected the Company’s issued share capital:

 

Event    Ordinary shares  
12 for 13 share consolidation1 with a special dividend of 174.9p per share (293¢ per ADR)      n/a   
Share plan exercises      60,370   

Share buyback2

695,885 shares were bought back and cancelled and 2,726,088 shares were bought back and held in treasury

     3,421,973   
Other cancelled shares3      14   

 

1  The share consolidation, effective as of 1 July 2014, was on the basis of 12 ordinary shares of 15265/329 pence each for 13 ordinary shares of 14194/329 pence each.
2  Excludes 14 shares included in the ‘Other cancelled shares’ number below.
3  This comprises 8 shares bought-back and cancelled and 6 treasury shares cancelled as a result of the above-mentioned share consolidation.

Dividends

In 2014, the Company announced a $750m return of funds to shareholders via special dividend and share consolidation on the basis of 12 ordinary shares of 15265/329 pence each for 13 ordinary shares of 14194/329 pence each (effective as of 1 July 2014).

 

Dividend    Ordinary shares      ADR  

Special dividend

Paid on 14 July 2014

     174.9p         293¢   

Interim dividend

Paid 26 September 2014

     14.8p         25.0¢   

Final dividend

Subject to shareholder approval, payable on 15 May 2015 to shareholders on the Register of Members at the close of business on 7 April 2015

     33.8p         52.0¢   

 

 

For more information on IHG’s return of funds and dividends, see note 27 on page 149.

 

 

Major institutional shareholders

As at 16 February 2015, the Company had been notified of the following significant holdings in its ordinary shares under the UK Disclosure and Transparency Rules:

 

     As at 16 February 2015      As at 17 February 2014     As at 18 February 2013  
Shareholder    Ordinary
shares/ADSs
     %      Ordinary
shares/ADSs
    %     Ordinary
shares/ADSs
     %  
Cedar Rock Capital Limited      14,923,417         5.07         14,923,417        5.07        14,923,417         5.07   
BlackRock, Inc.      n/a         n/a         13,061,965 1      5.01 1      14,505,612         5.02   
The Capital Group Companies, Inc      8,557,888         3.30         8,557,888        3.30        n/a         n/a   
Boron Investments NV      7,500,000         3.18         n/a        n/a        n/a         n/a   

 

1  On 7 October 2013, BlackRock, Inc. notified the Company that its shareholding in the Company had increased to above 5% and this notification was announced by the Company on 8 October 2013. Subsequently, on 8 July 2014, BlackRock, Inc. notified the Company that its 7 October 2013 notification had been made in error and that, in fact, BlackRock, Inc. holds less than 5% in the Company. This error was announced by the Company on 8 July 2014.

The Company’s major shareholders have the same voting rights as other shareholders. The Company does not know of any arrangements, the operation of which may result in a change in its control.

 

For further details on shareholder profiles, see page 178.

2014 share awards and grants to employees

No awards or grants over shares were made during 2014 that would be dilutive of the Company’s ordinary share capital. Our current policy is to settle the majority of awards or grants under the Company’s share plans with shares purchased in the market, however, the Board continues to review its policy. Those options, which were previously granted up to 2005, have now all been exercised and therefore, as at 31 December 2014, no options were outstanding.

The Company has not utilised the authority given by shareholders at any of its AGMs to allot shares for cash without first offering such shares to existing shareholders.

Employee share ownership trust (ESOT)

IHG operates an ESOT for the benefit of employees and former employees. The ESOT purchases ordinary shares in the market and releases them to current and former employees in satisfaction of share awards. During the year, the ESOT released 163,130 shares and at 31 December 2014 it held 1,344,726 ordinary shares in the Company. The ESOT adopts a prudent approach to purchasing shares, using funds provided by the Group, based on expectations of future requirements.

 

 

LOGO

 

 

73


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Directors’ Report continued

 

Director and Executive Committee shareholdings

As at 16 February 2015, Directors and Executive Committee members had the same number of beneficial interests in shares as at 31 December 2014, as set out in the table below. These shareholdings include all Directors’ beneficial interests and those held by their spouses and other connected persons. As at 16 February 2015, no Director or Executive Committee member held more than 0.2% of the total issued share capital.

None of the Directors have a beneficial interest in the shares of any subsidiary. The shareholdings set out below do not include Executive Directors’ or Executive Committee members’ share awards under IHG’s share plans. These are set out separately in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on page 88 for the Executive Directors and on page 166 for Executive Committee members.

 

Directors    As at
31 December 2014
ordinary shares
    As at
31 December 2013
ordinary shares
 
Patrick Cescau (Chairman)               
Richard Solomons (Chief Executive Officer)      382,533        371,198   

 

Senior Independent Non-Executive Director

  

David Kappler1      n/a        1,308   
Dale Morrison      3,907 2      4,233 2 

Executive Directors

  

Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson3      10,583        n/a   
Kirk Kinsell4      117,640 5      127,444 6 
Tracy Robbins      51,418        85,703   
Tom Singer3      n/a        54,386   

 

Non-Executive Directors

  

Ian Dyson               
Jo Harlow7             n/a   
Jennifer Laing      2,905        3,148   
Jonathan Linen8      6,325 2      6,853 2 
Luke Mayhew      1,722        1,866   
Jill McDonald               
Ying Yeh               

 

Executive Committee

  

Keith Barr      22,522        24,399   
Angela Brav      32,724        19,286   
Elie Maalouf9             n/a   
Kenneth Macpherson      7,472        1,797   
Eric Pearson      1,998        65,293   
Jan Smits      30,476        106,350   
George Turner             3,277   

 

1  David Kappler retired as a Non-Executive Director effective as of 31 May 2014.
2  Shares held in the form of American Depositary Receipts.
3  Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson was appointed as Chief Financial Officer effective as of 1 January 2014 following the resignation of Tom Singer effective as of the same date.
4  Kirk Kinsell resigned as Executive Director effective as of 13 February 2015.
5  117,092 ordinary shares and 548 American Depositary Receipts.
6  126,850 ordinary shares and 594 American Depositary Receipts.
7  Jo Harlow was appointed as a Non-Executive Director effective as of 1 September 2014.
8  Jonathan Linen retired as a Non-Executive Director effective as of 31 December 2014.
9  Elie Maalouf was appointed to the Executive Committee effective as of 13 February 2015.

Future business developments of the Group

Further details on these are set out in the Strategic Report on pages 2 to 51.

Employees and Code of Conduct

Details of the average number of people IHG employed as at 31 December 2014 and the number of people working across the whole estate are set out on page 23.

We continue to focus on providing an inclusive environment, in which employees are valued for who they are and what they bring to the Group, and in which talented individuals are retained through all levels of the organisation – see page 62 for our Global Diversity and Inclusion Policy.

We also look to appoint the most appropriate person for the job and are committed to providing equality of opportunity to all employees without discrimination. Every effort is made to ensure that applications for employment from disabled employees are fully and fairly considered and that disabled employees have equal opportunities in training, career development and promotion.

The Code of Conduct applies to all Directors, officers and employees and complies with the NYSE rules as set out in section 406 of the US Sarbanes-Oxley Act 2002. Further details can be found on page 174.

 

 

For more information on the Group’s employment policies, including equal opportunities, employee communications and development, see pages 23 to 25.

Greenhouse gas emissions

The disclosures concerning greenhouse gas emissions required by law are included in the Strategic Report on page 25.

Finance

Political donations

The Group made no political donations under the Companies Act during the year and proposes to maintain this policy.

Financial risk management

The Group’s financial risk management objectives and policies, including its use of financial instruments, are set out in note 20 to the Group Financial Statements on pages 135 to 137.

Significant agreements and change of control provisions

The Group is a party to the following arrangements which could be terminated upon a change of control of the Company and which are considered significant in terms of their potential impact on the business of the Group as a whole:

 

  the five-year $1.07bn syndicated loan facility agreement dated 7 November 2011, under which a change of control of the Company would entitle each lender to cancel its commitment and declare all amounts due to it payable;

 

  the seven-year £250m bond issued by the Company on 9 December 2009, under which, if the bond’s credit rating was downgraded in connection with a change of control, the bond holders would have the option to require the Company to redeem or, at the Company’s option, repurchase the outstanding notes together with interest accrued;
 

 

 

 

74


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

  the 10-year £400m bond issued by the Company on 28 November 2012, under which, if the bond’s credit rating was downgraded in connection with a change of control, the bond holders would have the option to require the Company to redeem or, at the Company’s option, repurchase the outstanding notes together with interest accrued; and

 

  the six-month $400m term loan facility agreement dated 13 January 2015, under which a change of control of the Company would entitle the lender to declare all amounts due to it payable.

 

 

Further details on these are set out on pages 169 and 170.

Business relationships

During 2012, the Group entered into a five-year technology outsourcing agreement with International Business Machines Corporation (IBM), pursuant to which IBM operates and maintains the infrastructure of the Group’s reservations system. Otherwise, there are no specific individual contracts or arrangements considered to be essential to the business of the Group as a whole.

Existence of qualifying indemnity provisions

For details, see Directors’ and Officers’ Liability Insurance Policy on page 72.

Disclosure of information to the Auditor

For details, see page 94.

Events after the reporting period

On 13 January 2015, the Group raised a $400m bilateral term loan to help finance the acquisition of Kimpton Hotel & Restaurant Group, LLC; the term loan expires in July 2016.

On 16 January 2015, the Group completed the acquisition of Kimpton Hotel & Restaurant Group, LLC for $430m in cash (see page 153).

Listing Rules – compliance with LR 9.8.4C

 

Section    Applicable sub-paragraph
within LR 9.8.4C
   Location  
1    Interest capitalised     
 
Financial Statements,
note 6, page 122
  
  
2    Publication of unaudited financial information      n/a   
4    Details of long-term incentive schemes     
 
 
 
Directors’
Remuneration
Report, pages 79, 80
and 84 to 86
  
  
  
  
5    Waiver of emoluments by a Director      n/a   
6    Waiver of future emoluments by a Director     
 
 
Directors’
Remuneration
Report, page 91
  
  
  
7    Non pre-emptive issues of equity for cash      n/a   
8    Item (7) in relation to major subsidiary undertakings      n/a   
9    Parent participation in placing by a listed subsidiary      n/a   
10    Contracts of significance      n/a   
11    Provision of services by a controlling shareholder      n/a   
12    Shareholder waivers of dividends      n/a   
13    Shareholder waivers of future dividends      n/a   
14    Agreements with controlling shareholders      n/a   

Going concern

An overview of the business activities of IHG, including a review of the key business risks that the Group faces, is given in the Strategic Report on pages 2 to 51 and in the Group Information on pages 162 to 170. Information on the Group’s treasury management policies can be found in note 20 to the Group Financial Statements on pages 135 to 137. The Group refinanced its bank debt in November 2011 and put in place a five-year $1.07bn facility. In December 2009, the Group issued a seven-year £250m sterling bond and, in November 2012, a 10-year £400m sterling bond. Subsequent to the year end the Group raised a $400m term loan to help finance the acquisition of Kimpton Hotel & Restaurant Group, LLC; the term loan expires in July 2016.

At the end of 2014, the Group was trading significantly within its banking covenants and debt facilities.

The Group’s fee-based model and wide geographic spread means that it is well placed to manage through uncertain times and our forecasts and sensitivity projections, based on a range of reasonably possible changes in trading performance, show that the Group should be able to operate within the level of its current facilities.

After making enquiries, the Directors have a reasonable expectation that the Company and the Group have adequate resources to continue in operational existence for the foreseeable future and, accordingly, they continue to adopt the going concern basis in preparing the Financial Statements.

By order of the Board

George Turner, Company Secretary

InterContinental Hotels Group PLC

Registered in England and Wales, Company number 5134420

16 February 2015

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

75


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Directors’ Remuneration Report

Remuneration Committee Chairman’s Statement

 

LOGO

“Our Directors’ Remuneration Policy rewards the successful execution of the business strategy, as demonstrated by this year’s outcomes. So that it remains effective for the future, we will review it in 2015 and seek shareholders’ approval again in 2016.”

 

 

Dear Shareholder

2014 corporate performance and incentive outcomes

Executive Director remuneration has reflected another year of strong performance. Annual Performance Plan (APP) awards are comparable to last year, reflecting continued good growth of Earnings Before Interest and Tax (EBIT) as well as encouraging progress on guest satisfaction and Employee Engagement survey scores. Another three years of high Total Shareholder Return (TSR) was the main driver for the vesting under the 2012/14 Long Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) cycle, which is marginally below last year.

 

Corporate performance indicators    2014      2013     2012  
Operating profit before exceptional items     

 

-2.5%

$651m1

  

  

    

 

+10.4%

$668m

  

2 

   

 

+10.4%

$605m

  

3,4 

Full-year dividend per share (excluding any special dividends and capital returns)     

 

77.0¢

48.6p

  

  

    

 

70.0¢

43.2p

  

  

   

 

64.0¢

41.2p

  

  

Three-year total TSR (annualised)      +31.7%         +18.4%        +28.2%   

 

  1  Includes two liquidated damages receipts in 2014: $7m, both in The Americas.
  2  Includes three liquidated damages receipts in 2013: $31m in The Americas, $9m in Europe and $6m in AMEA.
  3  Includes one significant liquidated damages receipt in 2012 of $3m in The Americas.
  4  With effect from 1 January 2013, the Group adopted IAS 19 (Revised) ‘Employee Benefits’ resulting in the following additional charges to operating profit: $5m for the six months ended 30 June 2012 and $9m for the 12 months ended 31 December 2012.

 

Directors’ Remuneration Policy

At the 2014 AGM, shareholders approved our Directors’ Remuneration Policy (DR Policy), as set out in our 2013 Annual Report, with 90.94 per cent support. I mentioned in the 2013 Directors’ Remuneration Report the issues we had discussed at some depth with shareholders prior to the vote at the AGM. The two we know prompted some shareholders to vote against the

DR Policy were the use of relative TSR as a measure in the LTIP, and the fact that the DR Policy did not require Executive Directors to hold shares beyond the three-year vesting date.

I explained then that the outcome of the 2011/13 LTIP cycle was in line with performance and reflected shareholder value creation. I also pointed out that our Executive Directors had very substantial shareholdings and formally requiring further holding periods seemed unnecessary. Shareholders voted 94.01 per cent in favour of the 2013 Directors’ Remuneration Report.

We are not making any changes to the DR Policy itself for 2015. There is, however, one substantive change to how we will implement the DR Policy. We have introduced a three-year clawback clause post-vesting or payment of awards, applying to awards made relating to 2015 and future financial years. This will apply in addition to the existing malus provision in the DR Policy, which allows for awards to be reduced prior to vesting. The details are set out on pages 81 and 91 of the Annual Report.

Remuneration and business strategy

We feel strongly that we should make changes to the DR Policy in a coherent way if it is to retain credibility with management and serve its purpose of motivating and rewarding outstanding performance. Reward arrangements for senior executives of a global business are inevitably quite complicated and need to be communicated as an intrinsic part of the business strategy. We are keen to avoid, if possible, the introduction of ad-hoc changes, especially where there is no link to the business strategy.

The current executive reward structure was introduced five years ago. It includes the key performance measures at the heart of the current business strategy; an annual plan to incentivise and reward the delivery of good financial results, as well as from 2013, improvements in guest satisfaction and employee engagement; and a long-term plan to reward the delivery of strong shareholder returns and better-than-market number of rooms and RevPAR growth. All these measures remain relevant to future business strategy. However, after five years, it is right to revisit whether other measures and remuneration approaches could even better support the strategic priorities for the coming five years, as well as consider further questions shareholders have raised. Therefore, during 2015, the Remuneration Committee will revisit all aspects of the APP and LTIP to ensure they remain fit for purpose. This will include consideration of the following:

 

  the mix of short and long-term incentives and what is appropriate for different levels of senior executives;

 

  the performance measures most aligned with business strategy and shareholder returns over the next five years;

 

  executive shareholding requirements and post-vesting holding periods;

 

  how best to communicate the overall policy to senior executives globally to ensure it helps drive performance; and

 

  how to further improve communication on remuneration to shareholders, in particular the level of disclosure of targets and outcomes.

We will consult major shareholders and shareholder organisations during 2015 and put the new DR Policy to all shareholders at our 2016 AGM for approval.

 

 

 

 

76


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

Pension arrangements

For a number of years, we have been working to de-risk the potential liabilities of the Group’s legacy UK pension arrangements. The defined benefit pension closed to new members in 2002 and to future accrual in 2013, after which benefits were secured with an insurer.

One of the last elements of de-risking we announced was our intention to change the long-established enhanced early retirement arrangements. These terms were inappropriate in the current wider pensions context. The conditions were changed during the year and this will be phased out over the coming years, as explained on pages 85 and 87.

The main exceptional payment in this Directors’ Remuneration Report relates to the decision announced last year to seek to cash out the closed senior executive pension scheme – InterContinental Hotels Executive Top-Up Scheme (ICETUS). This was the final stage of the de-risking plan. I am pleased that we had a positive response from those members of the scheme with the most potential value. Richard Solomons was one of those who agreed to cash out this part of the pension. The value of the pension was substantial, reflecting his 22 years with the business. As a result, there is a one-off additional element in his overall remuneration for 2014 only. This is explained in the single remuneration figure section on page 82.

No other changes are proposed and the Board believes that any remaining UK pensions risk is not significant.

Board change

Kirk Kinsell left the Board and his role as President, The Americas on 13 February 2015, aged 60, after a total of 19 years’ service with the business.

Mr Kinsell was succeeded by Elie Maalouf who was appointed to the role of Chief Executive Officer, The Americas, effective as of 13 February 2015 and who also became a member of IHG’s Executive Committee.

The remuneration consequences of Mr Kinsell’s departure were determined in line with the DR Policy and the rules of the relevant incentive plans. Details of Mr Kinsell’s remuneration arrangements on departure are included in the Directors’ Remuneration Report and have been disclosed on the Company’s website at www.ihgplc.com/investors

About this report

This statement aims to set out the more significant parts of the report for those who want to know the headlines, main issues considered in 2014 and the priorities for 2015. The Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration contains more detailed disclosures, many of which are prescribed by legislation or regulation, but we have tried to make it easier to follow by also taking into account current thinking on best practice in remuneration reporting. We have included a summary of our approved DR Policy (see pages 80 and 81) for ease of reference only, as it provides investors with an understanding of the detail of the remuneration outcomes that follow. The full DR Policy is available at www.ihgplc.com/investors. We have also looked to simplify the graphs and tables wherever possible and ensure that the link between our strategy and remuneration is clear.

The 2012 Directors’ Remuneration Report won the PwC ‘Building Public Trust Award’ for Executive Remuneration Reporting in the FTSE 100 and the 2013 Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration received ‘Highly Commended’.

Conclusion

This Directors’ Remuneration Report was approved by the Board on 16 February 2015. The Board recommends this Directors’ Remuneration Report to shareholders.

The Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration and the Chairman’s Statement are subject to an advisory vote at the 2015 AGM.

Luke Mayhew, Remuneration Committee Chairman

16 February 2015

 

 

 

Governance

 

Roles and responsibilities

The Remuneration Committee agrees, on behalf of the Board, all aspects of the remuneration of the Executive Directors and the Executive Committee, and agrees the strategy, direction and policy for the remuneration of other senior executives who have a significant influence over the Company’s ability to meet its strategic objectives.

The Committee’s role and responsibilities are set out in the Terms of Reference (ToR) which are available on the Company’s website at www.ihgplc.com/investors under corporate governance/ committees or from the Company Secretary’s office on request. The ToR are reviewed annually and there were no changes to them during 2014.

Governance

All members are independent Non-Executive Directors, as required under the ToR. During 2014, Jo Harlow joined the Committee and both David Kappler and Jonathan Linen retired. All members have the necessary experience and expertise to meet the Committee’s responsibilities.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

77


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Directors’ Remuneration Report continued

Governance continued

 

Committee approach to managing risk

Our approach to remuneration is to directly link it to IHG’s strategy. Risk management is a key part of IHG’s responsible business practices and the Committee considers risk mitigation as central to the way that incentive arrangements are structured, for example:

 

  the APP and LTIP are structured so as to have a balance of measures that ensure senior executives are not incentivised to behave in a way that could adversely affect the sustainable growth of the Group and the long-term interests of its shareholders. For instance, in the 2014 and 2015 APP, the drive for short-term financial results is balanced by performance measures focused on guest satisfaction and employee engagement;

 

  the Committee reserves the discretion to determine that payouts in the LTIP be adjusted if they are not consistent with the Committee’s assessment of the Group’s earnings and the quality of the financial performance over the relevant performance period; and

 

  malus and post-vesting clawback provisions apply to certain awards made to Executive Directors under the APP and LTIP.

Remuneration Committee

 

Committee membership and attendance

 

Members1    Attendance  
Luke Mayhew      5/5   
Ian Dyson      5/5   
Jo Harlow2      2/2   
David Kappler3      1/1   
Jonathan Linen4      5/5   
Ying Yeh      5/5   
Total meetings held      5   

 

  1 For full biographies of current members see pages 57 to 59.
  2 Jo Harlow joined the Remuneration Committee as a Non-Executive Director on 1 September 2014.
  3 David Kappler retired as a Non-Executive Director on 31 May 2014.
  4 Jonathan Linen retired as a Non-Executive Director on 31 December 2014.

The Chairman of the Board, and Tracy Robbins (Executive Vice President, Human Resources and Group Operations Support) attended all meetings. The Chief Executive Officer attended four meetings.

Jean-Pierre Noël (Senior Vice President, Global Reward & HR Capability) provided advice to the Committee on remuneration issues as required.

What did the Committee consider in 2014

The Committee discussed the following key matters:

 

  setting of targets for the 2014 APP and the 2014/16 LTIP cycle;

 

  review of 2013 Executive Committee performance and 2014 remuneration review;

 

  setting key performance objectives for Executive Committee members for 2014;
  pensions review including Enhanced Early Retirement Facility (EERF) and ICETUS/Six Continents Executive Top Up Scheme (SCETUS) buy-out;

 

  review of external market developments;

 

  monitoring achievement against targets of the 2014 APP and ongoing LTIP cycles;

 

  evaluation of incentive arrangements for levels of management below Executive Committee level and discussion of proposals for change; and

 

  evaluation of achievement against targets for 2014 APP and the 2012/14 LTIP.

Remuneration advisers

The Committee continued to retain PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (PwC) throughout 2014 as independent advisers. Fees of £60,300 were paid to PwC in respect of advice provided to the Committee on executive remuneration matters in 2014. This was in the form of an agreed fee for support in preparation of papers and attendance at meetings, with work on additional items charged at hourly rates. PwC also provided tax and other consulting services to the Group during the year.

The terms of engagement for PwC are available from the Company Secretary’s office on request.

PwC was appointed following a competitive tender process. The Committee is satisfied that the advice received from PwC was objective and independent as PwC is a member of the Remuneration Consultants Group. Members of this group adhere to a voluntary code of conduct that sets out the role of executive remuneration consultants in the UK and the professional standards they have committed to adhere to when advising remuneration committees.

Voting at IHG AGMs

At the 2014 AGM, under the new reporting regulations, the new binding vote in respect of the Directors’ Remuneration Policy was as follows:

 

AGM    Votes for      Votes against      Abstentions  
2014     

 

155,440,907

(90.94%)

  

  

    

 

15,483,775

(9.06%)

  

  

     906,025   
At IHG’s most recent AGMs, the annual advisory vote in respect of the Directors’ Remuneration Report was as follows:    
AGM    Votes for      Votes against      Abstentions  
2014     

 

158,131,479

(94.01%)

  

  

    

 

10,076,027

(5.99%)

  

  

     3,623,200   
2013     

 

160,795,577

(85.73%)

  

  

    

 

26,762,429

(14.27%)

  

  

     1,226,617   
2012     

 

203,110,989

(95.46%)

  

  

    

 

9,651,718

(4.54%)

  

  

     1,750,533   
 

 

 

 

78


Table of Contents
 
    
 

Strategic context

 

Key remuneration principles

IHG’s remuneration principles are designed to drive the delivery of its strategic objectives. To do this, we need to:

 

  align rewards for senior executives with the achievement of business performance targets and strategy and with returns for our hotel owners and shareholders;

 

  attract and retain high-quality executives in an environment where compensation for multinational employers is based on global market practice;

 

  support equitable treatment between members of the same executive team; and

 

  facilitate global mobility and relocations.

IHG’s remuneration structure for senior executives places a strong emphasis on performance-related reward. The Committee believes that it is important to reward senior management, including the Executive Directors, for targets achieved, provided those targets are stretching and drive results.

Link to strategy

Our strategy for delivering high-quality growth (detailed on pages 14 to 25) and the Key performance indicators (KPIs) (set out on pages 30 to 33) through which we monitor and measure our success are the key drivers for the performance-related elements of our reward structure, the APP and LTIP (see below):

 

 

LOGO

 

 

LOGO

 

 

79


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Directors’ Remuneration Report continued

Summary of our Directors’ Remuneration Policy (DR Policy)

 

 

How to use this report

 

   
The 2014 Directors’ Remuneration Report uses colour coding throughout to denote different elements of remuneration, as follows:

LOGO Salary

LOGO  Benefits

LOGO  APP cash    

LOGO  APP deferred shares    

LOGO  LTIP

LOGO  Pension benefit

 

This is a brief summary of the DR Policy, which was approved at our 2014 AGM. The full DR Policy can be found at www.ihgplc.com/investors under corporate governance.

DR Policy table summary

 

Executive Directors

 

   Element Framework
Fixed LOGO Salary

Salaries increase generally in line with the range applying to the corporate UK and US employee population. They are reviewed annually and are fixed for 12 months from 1 April.

 

Newly appointed or recruited Executive Directors may, on occasion, have their salaries set below the benchmark policy level while they become established in role. In such cases, salary increases may be higher than the corporate UK and US employee population until the target positioning is achieved.

 

  LOGO Benefits

Benefits are restricted to the typical level in the relevant market for an Executive Director. They may include the cost of independent financial advice, car allowance/company car, private healthcare/medical assessments and relocation and expatriate or international assignment costs where appropriate.

 

Variable

LOGO LOGO APP

(50% cash and 50% IHG shares deferred for three years)

Maximum annual award is 200% of salary; target award is 115% of salary; threshold is 50% of target award for each measure.

 

This is reviewed annually with targets set in line with key strategic priorities:

 

•  70% EBIT

 

•  30% non-financial measures

 

They include regional or global measures or a combination of both.

 

The Committee may vary the relative weighting of EBIT and other metrics from year to year. Personal performance may also be taken into account in determining awards under the APP.

 

 

LOGO LTIP

(100% shares)

Maximum annual award is 205% of salary; 20% threshold vesting of net rooms and RevPAR if equal to average growth of comparator group; 20% threshold vesting of TSR if equal to global hotel index growth.

 

Measures and targets are reviewed and may be changed by the Committee annually to ensure alignment with strategic objectives:

 

•  25% relative net rooms growth

 

•  25% relative RevPAR growth

 

•  50% relative TSR

 

All targets are measured over a performance period of at least three years against an appropriate comparator group of companies, which the Committee determines annually.

 

Pension LOGO Pension benefit

Executive section of the UK Defined Contribution Plan, US 401(k) Plan and US Deferred Compensation Plan: employee contributions with matching Company contributions. A cash allowance in lieu of pension contributions is offered. Salary is the only part of remuneration that is pensionable.

 

 

 

 

80


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

Non-Executive Directors

 

   Element Framework
Fixed Fees and benefits (cash)

Maximum increase in annual fee in line with median FTSE 100 increases. Set by the Chairman of the Board and Executive Directors. The Chairman’s fees are set by the Committee. They are fixed for 12 months from 1 January. Non-Executive Directors are not eligible to participate in any performance-related incentive plans. IHG pays the cost of providing benefits as required.

 

Notes on DR Policy table summary

 

Use of discretion

The Committee reserves certain discretions under the Company’s incentive plans. These operate in two main respects:

 

  enabling the Committee to ensure that outcomes under these plans are consistent with the underlying performance of the business and the interests of shareholders; and

 

  enabling the Committee to treat leavers in a way that is fair and equitable to individuals and shareholders under the incentive plans.

The Committee will also use its judgement as to what is appropriate within the terms of the DR Policy to make decisions that do not involve the exercise of discretion.

In all cases, the discretions are reserved as part of the DR Policy in order to allow the Committee flexibility to ensure that remuneration outcomes for Executive Directors are consistent with business performance, at the same time as providing a high degree of clarity for shareholders as to remuneration structure and potential quantum. Any exercises of discretion by the Committee will be fully disclosed and explained in the relevant year’s Implementation of Remuneration Policy Report.

In relation to the LTIP, the Committee will review the vesting outcomes under all of the LTIP measures at the end of each three- year cycle against an assessment of Group earnings and the quality of financial performance over the period, including sustainable growth and the efficient use of cash and capital. If the Committee determines that the vesting outcomes do not appropriately reflect the financial performance of the Group, it may reduce the number of shares that vest.

In relation to malus, for awards made from January 2012, the APP and LTIP rules allow the Committee discretion to reduce the level of unvested share awards if circumstances occur that, in the reasonable opinion of the Committee, justify a reduction in one or more awards granted to any one or more participants. The malus provisions relate to unvested awards only. The circumstances in which the Committee may consider it appropriate to exercise its discretion include the following:

 

  misconduct that causes significant damage or potential damage to IHG’s prospects, finances or brand reputation; and/or

 

  actions that lead to material misstatement or restatement of accounts.

This may include, where appropriate, negligence on the part of Executive Directors.

These features help ensure alignment between executive reward and shareholder returns.

Policy on payment for loss of office

All current Executive Directors have a rolling service contract with a notice period from the Company of 12 months. As an alternative, the Company may, at its discretion, pay in lieu of that notice. Neither notice nor a payment in lieu of notice will be given in the event of gross misconduct.

Payment in lieu of notice could potentially include up to 12 months’ salary and the cash equivalent of 12 months’ pension contributions, and other contractual benefits. Where possible, the Company will seek to ensure that, where a leaver mitigates their losses by, for example, finding new employment, there will accordingly be a corresponding reduction in compensation payable for loss of office.

Further details on the policy for determination of termination payments are included in the DR Policy.

Approach to recruitment remuneration

The remuneration of any new Executive Director will be determined in accordance with the DR Policy. In addition, the Committee may, at its discretion, compensate a newly recruited Executive Director for incentives from a previous employment foregone as a result of their resignation. The Committee would seek validation of the value of any potential incentives foregone. Awards made by way of compensation for incentives foregone would be made on a comparable basis, taking account of performance achieved, or likely to be achieved, the proportion of the performance period remaining and the form of the award. Compensation would, as far as possible, be in the form of IHG LTIP or deferred share awards, in order to immediately align a new Executive Director with IHG’s performance.

Details of letters of appointment and notice periods for Non-Executive Directors

Non-Executive Directors have letters of appointment, which are available upon request from the Company Secretary’s office.

Patrick Cescau, Non-Executive Chairman, is subject to 12 months’ notice. All other Non-Executive Directors are not subject to notice periods.

All Non-Executive Directors’ appointments and subsequent re-appointments are subject to election and annual re-election by shareholders at the 2015 AGM (see page 71).

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

81


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Directors’ Remuneration Report continued

Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration

This Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration explains how the Directors’ Remuneration Policy (DR Policy) was implemented in 2014 and the resulting payments each of the Directors received. The notes to the single figure table provide further detail, including measures and outcomes for 2014 where relevant, for each of the elements that make up the total single figure of remuneration in respect of each of the Executive Directors. This report is subject to an advisory vote by shareholders at the 2015 AGM.

 

Single total figure of remuneration – Executive Directors (audited information)

 

LOGO

 

      Fixed pay      Variable pay      Pension                 
     

 

LOGO  Salary

     LOGO  Benefits      LOGO   LOGO  APP      LOGO  LTIP      LOGO  Pension benefit      LOGO  Total  
Executive Directors    2014
£000
     2013
£000
     2014
£000
     2013
£000
     2014
£000
     2013
£000
     2012/14
cycle (value
of shares)
£0001
     2011/13
cycle (value
of shares)
£0002
     2014
£000
    2013
£000
     2014
£000
    2013
£000
 

 

Richard

Solomons3

 

     759         735         30         34         1,128         1,098         1,425         1,018        
 

 

228
+2,958

3,186

  
3 

  

    246        
 

 

3,570
+2,958

6,528

  
3 

  

    3,131   

Paul Edgecliffe-

Johnson4

     420         n/a         28         n/a         619         n/a         403         n/a         126        n/a         1,596        n/a   
Kirk Kinsell5      479         492         27         85         365         532         941         850         111        114         1,923        2,073   
Tracy Robbins      434         421         20         21         644         631         814         644         130        126         2,042        1,843   
Tom Singer6      2         548         0         29         n/a         409         712         918         n/a        164         714        2,068   

 

  1  Share price of 2,449p is the average over the final quarter of 2014.  
  2  Restated using the VWAP (Volume Weighted Average Price) of 1,977p on the date of actual vesting on 19 February 2014. The corresponding values shown in the 2013 report (prior to the actual vesting) were an estimate and calculated using a share price as at 31 December 2013 of 2,013p.  
  3  Richard Solomons received a one-off cash payment in 2014 in lieu of any future entitlement to ICETUS benefits. The amount shown (£2.958m) is the gross cash payment (£9.405m) less amounts previously disclosed (£6.447m). It is included here but is not shown in the illustrative bar chart above as it was a one-off payment and was in respect of benefits already accrued.  
  4  Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson was appointed to the Board as Chief Financial Officer effective as of 1 January 2014.  
  5  Kirk Kinsell was paid in US dollars and the sterling equivalents were calculated using an exchange rate of $1 = £0.61. In accordance with the APP rules, Mr Kinsell will receive only the 50% cash portion of his 2014 APP award, as shown here.  
  6  As a result of Tom Singer’s resignation from IHG with effect from 1 January 2014, he only received the 50% cash portion of the 2013 APP award and will not receive a 2014 APP award. Following Mr Singer’s resignation, the Remuneration Committee determined that the 2011/13 LTIP award would vest without pro-ration in line with the terms of the LTIP Plan rules, as the performance period for this award would be completed by his departure date. This award was released on the normal vesting date and only to the extent the performance conditions were met. Mr Singer’s salary for 2014 was in respect of one day, 1 January 2014, after which his resignation took effect.  

 

 

 

82


Table of Contents
 
 

Notes to single total figure of remuneration – Executive Directors (audited information)

Kirk Kinsell – remuneration arrangements on departure

Kirk Kinsell left the Board and his role as President, The Americas effective as of 13 February 2015. The Remuneration Committee determined that Mr Kinsell would be treated as a Good Leaver for the purposes of the LTIP awards, in line with the DR Policy on termination of employment. He therefore retained all outstanding LTIP awards which will vest on the normal vesting dates, subject to the satisfaction of performance conditions, with the awards pro-rated to his leaving date. Mr Kinsell also received the cash portion of his 2014 APP award and the deferred share portion of his 2011 APP on the normal vesting date. Outstanding deferred awards under the 2012 and 2013 APPs lapsed, and no APP award will be made in respect of 2015. The Remuneration Committee has reserved the right to determine that, prior to the vesting of shares under each outstanding LTIP cycle, Mr Kinsell’s entitlement to shares under the LTIP will be forfeited in full if Mr Kinsell commits a breach of his continuing post-termination contractual obligations. The relevant figures will be included in next year’s report.

Fixed pay

LOGO   Salary: salary paid for the year (for Kirk Kinsell, who was paid in US dollars, this shows actual salary paid converted into sterling).

LOGO   Benefits: this includes taxable benefits such as company car, healthcare, life cover and other taxable benefits. Provision during 2014 was in line with previous years and the approved DR Policy, and no exceptional benefits were paid.

Variable Pay

LOGO   LOGO  2014 APP

The weighting, measures and targets relating to the APP are determined by the Committee, on an annual basis, in line with our strategic objectives. A combination of global and regional targets were used in 2014. Executive Directors with only global roles were subject to global measures. Kirk Kinsell was subject to partly regional measures, reflecting his regional role as President, The Americas.

The measures for 2014 were determined in accordance with the DR Policy and were as follows:

 

  Guest satisfaction as measured by the Guest HeartBeat score: year-on-year improvement;

 

  Employee Engagement survey score: year-on-year improvement; and

 

  EBIT achievement against target (corporate and regional).

Why do we use these measures?

  Guest HeartBeat score Employee Engagement survey score EBIT vs target

•  Guest HeartBeat is part of the guest satisfaction survey.

 

•  It is an overall guest satisfaction score relating to hotel visits.

 

•  It is a robust measure of the strength of our brands.

 

•  Inclusion in the APP provides executive focus on this key performance metric at global and regional level.

•  We measure employee engagement because our brands are, effectively, a promise by our people, as engaged colleagues, to deliver a great guest experience.

 

•  Engaged employees are key to our business.

 

•  Our Employee Engagement survey is a long-established tool in our business.

 

•  EBIT is a key measure of business performance for our shareholders.

 

•  It is a function of other critical measures: net rooms growth, RevPAR, operating profit and fee revenues.

Award levels relate to achievement against target under each of the measures. The link between our strategy and the performance measures of the APP is explained in more detail on page 79.

Threshold, target and maximum opportunity are shown on the graph on page 84, along with actual achievement on a global basis and further detail.

The actual award level was determined on a straight-line basis between threshold and target, and target and maximum, and relates to achievement vs target under each measure:

 

  Threshold is the minimum level that must be achieved for there to be an award in relation to that measure; for achievement below this, no award is made.

 

  Target is the target level of achievement and results in a target award for that measure (115% of salary).

 

  Maximum is the level of achievement at which a maximum award for that measure is received (200% of salary).

Threshold award was subject to a global EBIT affordability gate such that:

 

  if global EBIT was below 85% of target, no award would be made; and

 

  if global EBIT was between 85% and 90% of target, half of any award relating to the Guest HeartBeat and/or Employee Engagement survey measures would be made.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

83


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Directors’ Remuneration Report continued

Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration continued

 

LOGO

 

1  The EBIT element of Kirk Kinsell’s award was based 50/50 on Group/The Americas results; the EBIT achievement for the Americas was 99.0% against target. The Guest HeartBeat element of Mr Kinsell’s award was based wholly on The Americas results; achievement was 29.4% of target. The total award as a % of salary for Mr Kinsell was 151.4% and in accordance with the APP Plan rules he will only receive the 50% cash portion.
2  Maximum achievement under all three measures would result in an award of 230% of total salary. However, under the DR Policy, awards are capped at 200% of salary.

 

 

Outcome for 2014 (audited information)

Based on performance, the following table shows the level of 2014 awards for which 50% will be paid in cash and 50% in deferred IHG shares. These will vest after three years in February 2018. The deferred share awards are made in the form of forfeitable shares that receive dividends during the three-year vesting period and include the right to vote at shareholder meetings.

 

Executive Director

 

        Award as
% of salary
    

Total value of award

£0001

 
  Richard Solomons          147.4         1,128   
  Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson              147.4         619   
  Kirk Kinsell          75.7         365 2 
  Tracy Robbins          147.4         644   

 

1  As shown in the single figure of remuneration on page 82.
2  In accordance with the rules of the APP, Kirk Kinsell will receive only the 50% cash portion of his 2014 APP award, as shown here.

In relation to the APP 2014 measures, we have disclosed percentage achievement against target for each measure in the graph at the top of this page. We have also shown outcome vs opportunity. For the Guest HeartBeat and Employee Engagement survey measures, the 2014 outcome scores are detailed on pages 31 and 32 of the Annual Report. Detail on the financial targets set is not disclosed at this stage as it is, in the opinion of the Directors, commercially sensitive. Disclosure would risk providing IHG’s major competitors with an unfair commercial advantage as these companies are either unlisted or listed on a stock exchange other than the London Stock Exchange and, therefore, not subject to the same regulations. During 2015, we will consider what further transparency we can provide to shareholders without disadvantaging the business.

 

 

LOGO  2012/14 LTIP

The performance measures for each three-year LTIP cycle are set by the Committee. Awards are made annually and eligible executives will receive shares at the end of that cycle, subject to achievement of the performance measures. The performance measures for the 2012/14 cycle were as follows and in line with the DR Policy:

 

  relative growth in net rooms over three years;

 

  relative like-for-like RevPAR growth over three years; and

 

  IHG’s TSR relative to a global hotels index (see page 89 for further details).

Growth in net rooms and RevPAR is measured on a relative basis against the comparator group, comprising the following major, globally branded competitors: Accor, Choice Hotels, Hilton Worldwide, Hyatt, Marriott International Inc., Starwood Hotels and Wyndham Worldwide.

Why do we use these measures?

 

Net rooms growth    RevPAR growth    Relative TSR

 

This measures the net growth in the total number of IHG hotel rooms over the duration of the cycle relative to our major global competitors. Together with the RevPAR measure, it provides focus on ensuring a balance between the quality of IHG hotels and the speed at which IHG grows.

 

  

 

This measures success in growing our revenue per available room for the duration of the cycle relative to the RevPAR growth of our major global competitors.

  

 

This measures the return to shareholders by investing in IHG relative to our competitors in the appropriate comparator group of global hotels, as per data sourced from Thomson Datastream.

In order to generate higher returns for our shareholders, we need to increase revenue share, improve operating efficiency and grow margins through increasing the number of rooms we have available to sell, as well as increasing RevPAR for those rooms.

 

 

 

84


Table of Contents
 
 

By focusing on both net rooms growth and RevPAR growth, we are rewarding the balanced approach to growth that will support the long-term increase in shareholder value.

These performance measures are also used for the 2013/15 and 2014/16 LTIP cycles, granted in 2013 and 2014 respectively. Threshold, target and maximum opportunity for the 2012/14 cycle is shown in the graph below, along with actual achievement for 2014.

 

LOGO

Performance was below the average of the comparator group on the relative net rooms growth measure and therefore this element will not vest.

 

 

Outcome for 2012/14 cycle (audited information)

This cycle will vest on 18 February 2015, as follows:

 

Executive Director  

Maximum opportunity at grant

(number of shares)

   

% of maximum opportunity

vested

   

Outcome (number of shares

awarded at vest)

   

Total value of award1

£000

 
  Richard Solomons     103,722        56.1        58,188        1,425   
  Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson         29,322        56.1        16,449        403   
  Kirk Kinsell2     68,463        56.1        38,407        941   
  Tracy Robbins     59,270        56.1        33,250        814   
  Tom Singer3     77,684        56.1        29,053        712   

 

1  As shown in the single figure of remuneration. Share price used of 2,449p is the average over the final quarter of 2014.
2  In line with the DR Policy, the Remuneration Committee determined that Kirk Kinsell would retain his 2012/14 LTIP award in accordance with and subject to the terms of the LTIP Plan rules, as the performance period for this award was completed when Kirk Kinsell resigned effective as of 13 February 2015.
3  The Remuneration Committee determined that the 2012/14 LTIP award would vest in line with the terms of the LTIP Plan rules on a pro-rated basis for the proportion of the performance period in which Tom Singer remained in employment. This award will be released on the normal vesting date and only to the extent the performance conditions were fulfilled.

Net rooms and RevPAR growth were measured by reference to the three years ending 30 September 2014; TSR was measured by reference to the three years ending 31 December 2014.

 

 

Pensions

LOGO  Pension benefit: the value of Company contributions to pension plans and any cash allowances paid in lieu of pension contributions.

As published in the 2013 Annual Report, the Group commenced the phasing out of potential enhanced early retirement terms related to those defined benefit pensions in 2014 (see page 87 for further details). In addition, the planned cash out offer was made to the participants of the unfunded, unregistered, defined benefit top-up arrangement, ICETUS, which had previously provided the balance of any benefit accrual that was restricted in the tax-registered plan due to the annual or lifetime allowances. Payments associated with the cash out were made in the financial year and are therefore disclosed appropriately in this year’s Annual Report.

For 2014, the pension benefits for Richard Solomons include the payment of a cash out value in respect of his accrued, unfunded ICETUS benefit. Richard Solomons received a one-off gross cash payment of £9,405,362 in lieu of any future entitlement to ICETUS benefits. An amount of £6,447,000 in respect of his ICETUS benefit was included as part of the disclosure of his total accrued benefits in the 2013 Directors’ Remuneration Report based on the HM Revenue & Customs methodology of valuing pensions at 20 times their annual amounts, hence only the balance in excess of this (i.e. £2.958m) is shown in the single figure table. The actual payment was greater than 20 times the annual pension because the ICETUS benefit was valued using a more accurate actuarial calculation method, in line with that used for valuing the total ICETUS liabilities for accounting purposes. Following the cash out, Richard Solomons has no future entitlement to any benefit from ICETUS.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

85


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Directors’ Remuneration Report continued

Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration continued

Scheme interests awarded during 2014 (audited information)

During 2014, awards relating to shares were granted under the 2014/16 LTIP. Awards were made to each Executive Director over shares with a value of 205% of salary using the closing mid-market share price on 7 April 2014. These are in the form of conditional awards over IHG shares and do not carry the right to dividends or dividend equivalents during the vesting period.

These awards will vest, and the shares will be transferred to the award holder, in February 2017 to the extent performance targets are met. See pages 84 and 85 for an explanation of the performance measures.

 

Executive Director    Award date      Maximum shares
awarded
    

Market price per
share at grant1

£

     Face value of
award at grant
£000
     Number of shares
received if minimum
performance achieved2
 

2014/16 cycle

                                            

  Richard Solomons

     8 April 2014         82,193         19.08         1,568         16,439   

  Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson

     8 April 2014         45,125         19.08         861         9,025   

  Kirk Kinsell3

     8 April 2014         18,570         19.08         981         3,714   
  Tracy Robbins      8 April 2014         46,952         19.08         896         9,390   

 

1  Share price was the closing mid-market share price on 7 April 2014.
2  Minimum performance is equal to 20% of maximum award.
3  Following Kirk Kinsell’s resignation with effect from 13 February 2015, his award will vest in line with the LTIP Plan rules. His initial maximum shares awarded of 51,426 have been reduced accordingly on a pro-rated basis for the proportion of the performance period in which he remained in employment, as determined by the Committee. The pro-rated award is shown in the table above. Vesting will not be accelerated.

The vesting date for these awards is the day after the announcement of our Annual 2016 Preliminary Results in February 2017. Net rooms growth and RevPAR growth will be measured by reference to the three years ending 30 September 2016; TSR will be measured by reference to the three years ending 31 December 2016.

Other outstanding awards

During 2013, awards relating to shares were granted under the 2013/15 LTIP (shown below) on the same basis as the 2014/16 LTIP cycle (shown above). These awards will vest in February 2016 to the extent performance targets are met. See pages 84 and 85 for an explanation of the performance measures.

 

Executive Director    Award date      Maximum shares
awarded
    

Market price per
share at grant1

£

     Face value of
award at grant
£000
     Number of shares
received if minimum
performance achieved2
 
2013/15 cycle                                        

  Richard Solomons

     5 April 2013         76,319         19.85         1,515         15,263   

  Paul Edgecliffe-

  Johnson3

     24 February 2014         9,454         19.25         182         1,891   

  Kirk Kinsell4

     5 April 2013         36,839         19.85         1,053         7,367   

  Tracy Robbins

     5 April 2013         43,819         19.85         870         8,763   
  Tom Singer5      5 April 2013         56,883         19.85         1,129         0   

 

1  Share price was the closing mid-market share price on 4 April 2013. For Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson, this was the closing mid-market share price on 21 February 2014.
2  Minimum performance is equal to 20% of maximum award.
3  Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson received an increased award, pro-rated from 1 January 2014, for the 2013/15 LTIP in accordance with the DR Policy as a result of his appointment to the Board. He was awarded 18,322 shares on 5 April 2013 with a market price per share at grant of £19.85 prior to his appointment to the Board.
4  Following Kirk Kinsell’s resignation with effect from 13 February 2015, his award will vest in line with the LTIP Plan rules. His initial maximum shares awarded of 53,049 have been reduced accordingly on a pro-rated basis for the proportion of the performance period in which he remained in employment, as determined by the Committee. The pro-rated award is shown in the table above. Vesting will not be accelerated.
5  Tom Singer’s award lapsed as a result of his resignation with effect from 1 January 2014.

The vesting date for these awards is the day after the announcement of our Annual 2015 Preliminary Results in February 2016. Net rooms growth and RevPAR growth will be measured by reference to the three years ending 30 September 2015; TSR will be measured by reference to the three years ending 31 December 2015.

Current position on outstanding awards

Details of the performance measures and potential vesting outcomes for outstanding awards as at 31 December 2014 are as follows:

 

Performance measure    Threshold
performance
     Maximum
performance
     Threshold/
maximum
vesting
     Weighting      Maximum
award
(% of salary)
     Potential vesting outcome  
                                              2014/16 cycle      2013/15 cycle  

Net rooms growth

    
 
Average of the
comparator group
  
  
    
 
1st in the
comparator group
  
  
     20%/100%         25%         51.25%        
 
Below
threshold
  
  
    
 
Below
threshold
  
  

RevPAR growth

    
 
Average of the
comparator group
  
  
    
 
1st in the
comparator group
  
  
     20%/100%         25%         51.25%        
 
Above
average
  
  
    
 
Above
average
  
  

Relative TSR

    
 
 
Growth equal to
the global hotels
index
  
  
  
    
 
 
Growth exceeds
the index by 8%
per year or more
  
  
  
     20%/100%         50%         102.5%        
 
Maximum
performance
  
  
    
 
Maximum
performance
  
  

 

 

 

86


Table of Contents
 
 

Total pension entitlements (audited information)

The InterContinental Hotels UK Pension Plan (IC Plan) is a funded final salary occupational pension scheme with an additional defined contribution section.

Richard Solomons’ defined benefit pension accrual in both ICETUS and the IC Plan ceased on 30 June 2013 and the Trustee of the IC Plan subsequently entered into an insurance contract in August 2013 under which all defined benefit liabilities of the plan, plus the provision of increases to pensions which were previously only provided at the discretion of the Company, were fully insured (known as a ‘buy-in’). During 2014, arrangements were made to fully transfer the responsibility for the provision of benefits from the Trustee of the IC Plan to the insurance company, Rothesay Life. This process (known as a ’buy-out’) was completed on 31 October 2014.

Following the buy-out, Richard Solomons has no future benefit entitlement from the IC Plan and it is not considered necessary to make these disclosures in the future. In last year’s Annual Report, we published the Board’s plans to phase out the Company’s Enhanced Early Retirement Facility (EERF). However, during the period over which it is phased out, Richard Solomons remains eligible to benefit from the EERF, albeit at a reduced level. Under the EERF, executive participants of the defined benefit section of the IC Plan had an option, with the Company’s agreement, to retire without reduction to their pension if they are within five years of their normal retirement date and to retire on improved early retirement terms before this. As set out in the Remuneration Committee Chairman’s 2013 Statement, the phasing out of this facility commenced on 1 March 2014. As a result of the phasing out of the EERF, Mr Solomons could retire, with no reduction in his pension, from approximately age 58 and no earlier. Prior to the phasing out, Richard Solomons was eligible to retire without reduction from age 55. The terms of the EERF require an executive to obtain Company consent and would also require the payment by the Group of an additional insurance premium to secure the benefit entitlement for that executive.

 

Richard Solomons’ IC Plan pension, which formed part of the buy-out, was as follows:

 

      £pa
Accrued annual pension at 1 January 2014, assuming retirement at normal pension age (9 October 2021)    71,950
Accrued annual pension at 31 December 2014, assuming retirement at normal age (9 October 2021)    73,680

The increase in accrued pension represents the standard inflation increase provided for deferred pensions in the IC Plan rules. It does not, therefore, constitute a pension input amount and there is no requirement to disclose the value of this increase in the single figure.

 

For 2014, Richard Solomons received a cash allowance in lieu of pension contributions. The breakdown of the pension element of the single figure for 2013 and 2014 for Mr Solomons is as follows:

 

      2014
£000
     2013
£000
 
Pension benefit under defined benefit section of IC Plan              135   
ICETUS cash-out      2,9581           
Cash allowance in lieu of pension contribution      228         111   
Total      3,186         246   

 

  1 Richard Solomons received a one-off cash payment in 2014 in lieu of any future entitlement to ICETUS benefits. See page 85.
 

 

 

 

Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson participated in the defined contribution section of the IC Plan until March 2014, during which time he paid contributions of £7,875 and received Company contributions of £4,625 and a cash allowance in lieu of pension contributions of £26,875. For the period from April 2014, he did not participate in any IHG pension plan and instead received a cash allowance of £94,500.

Tracy Robbins did not participate in any IHG pension plan in 2014. Instead she received a cash allowance of £130,148.

Life assurance cover of four times pensionable salary was also provided for Tracy Robbins and Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson and, in accordance with the terms of the closure of the IC Plan to future defined benefit accrual, life assurance cover of six times salary was provided for Richard Solomons.

Kirk Kinsell participated in the US 401(k) Plan and the US Deferred Compensation Plan. The US 401(k) Plan is a tax qualified plan providing benefits on a defined contribution basis, with the member and relevant company both contributing. The US Deferred Compensation Plan is a non-tax qualified plan, providing benefits on a defined contribution basis, with the member and the relevant company both contributing.

Contributions made by, and in respect of, Kirk Kinsell in these plans for the year ended 31 December 2014 were:

 

      £1  
Director’s contributions to US Deferred   
Compensation Plan      136,199   
Director’s contributions to US 401(k) Plan      14,030   
Company contributions to US Deferred   
Compensation Plan      105,047   
Company contributions to US 401(k) Plan      6,280   
Age at 31 December 2014      59   

 

1  Sterling values have been calculated using an exchange rate of $1=£0.61.
 

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

87


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Directors’ Remuneration Report continued

Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration continued

Statement of Directors’ shareholdings and share interests (audited information)

The Committee believes that share ownership by Executive Directors and senior executives strengthens the link between the individual’s personal interests and those of shareholders.

Guideline Executive Director shareholding requirement

Executive Directors are expected to hold all shares earned (net of any share sales required to meet personal tax liabilities), until the guideline shareholding requirement is achieved. As can be seen from the graph below, with the exception of Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson, the shareholdings for the other Executive Directors are substantial and the guideline requirement exceeded. Percentages are based on shareholding and a share price of 2,595p per share as at 31 December 2014.

 

  Shares and awards held by Executive Directors as at 31 December 2014: % of salary

 

   LOGO

Shares held by Executive Directors as at 31 December 2014: number of shares (audited information)

 

Executive Director    Number of shares
held outright1
   

APP deferred

share awards2

     LTIP share awards
(unvested)3
    

Total number of

shares and awards held

 
      2014     2013     2014      2013      2014      2013      2014      2013  
Richard Solomons      382,533        371,198        81,240         90,068         262,234         267,275         726,007         728,541   
Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson4      10,583        n/a        12,860         n/a         102,223         n/a         125,666         n/a   
Kirk Kinsell      117,640 5      127,444 6      49,580         66,502         172,938         194,384         340,158         388,330   
Tracy Robbins      51,418        85,703        48,932         55,905         150,041         158,337         250,391         299,945   

 

1 These shareholdings include all Directors’ beneficial interests and those held by their spouses and other connected persons.
2 Awards not subject to performance conditions.
3 Awards still subject to performance conditions as set out on pages 84 and 85.
4 Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson was appointed to the Board on 1 January 2014.
5 Comprised 117,092 ordinary shares and 548 American Depositary Receipts.
6 Comprised 126,850 ordinary shares and 594 American Depositary Receipts.

 

 

Percentage change in remuneration of Chief Executive Officer

The table below shows the percentage change in the remuneration of the Chief Executive Officer compared with UK employees between 2013 and 2014:

 

      Chief Executive Officer      UK employees  
Salary      +3.5%         +3.0% 1 
Taxable benefits2      -11.8%         +4.5%   
Annual incentive      +2.7%         +7.6%   

 

1  The percentage change for UK employees shown is the budget for the 2014 annual pay review and promotions/market adjustments during 2014.
2  Based on P11D taxable benefits for tax year ending 5 April in relevant year.

We believe that an appropriate comparator group for salary and taxable benefits comparison is UK-based employees because the structure and composition of remuneration for that group most closely reflects that of the UK-based Chief Executive Officer. Therefore, the same UK market dynamics will apply to salary movements providing a like-for-like comparison.

For the annual incentive, the comparator group used is the grade of executives at and immediately below Executive Committee level, who are subject to the same performance measures as the Chief Executive Officer, and with a “very good” individual performance rating.

 

 

 

 

88


Table of Contents
 
 

Relative performance graph and table

Throughout 2014, IHG was a member of the FTSE 100 share index and for LTIP purposes used a TSR comparator group of a global hotels index. This consists of the companies that made up the Dow Jones Global Hotels index (DJGH). It continues to comprise the same companies, following the cessation of the former Dow Jones Index in 2014, and is sourced directly from Thomson Datastream for IHG. Accordingly, the Committee has determined that these are the most appropriate market indices against which to test the Group’s performance. The graph below shows IHG’s TSR performance from 31 December 2008 to 31 December 2014, assuming dividends are reinvested, compared with the TSR performance achieved by the FTSE 100 and global hotels indices. All indices are shown in sterling.

TSR: InterContinental Hotels Group PLC vs FTSE 100 and global hotels index

 

LOGO

Chief Executive Officer’s remuneration

The table below shows the single figure of total remuneration for the incumbent Chief Executive Officer for the six years to 31 December 2014:

 

         Financial year ended 31 December  
     Chief Executive Officer    2009        2010        20111        2012        2013        2014  

Single figure

£000

  Richard Solomons      n/a           n/a           4,724           4,881           3,149           6,528 2 
  Andrew Cosslett      1,953           5,430           3,770           n/a           n/a           n/a   

Annual incentive received

(% of maximum)

  Richard Solomons      n/a           n/a           83.0           68.0           74.0           74.0   
  Andrew Cosslett      nil 3         100.0           43.0 4         n/a           n/a           n/a   

Shares received under the LTIP

(% of maximum)

  Richard Solomons      n/a           n/a           73.9           100.0           59.0           56.1   
  Andrew Cosslett      46.0           73.8           61.6           n/a           n/a           n/a   

 

1  Andrew Cosslett retired on 30 June 2011 and Richard Solomons was appointed Chief Executive Officer effective as of 1 July 2011, having previously held the position of Chief Financial Officer and Head of Commercial Development; the single figure value is the total remuneration received by each of them for that year.
2  Includes a one-off cash payment in lieu of any future entitlement to ICETUS benefits. The amount included in respect of this (£2.958m) is the gross cash payment (£9.405m) less amounts previously disclosed (£6.447m).
3  There was no annual incentive award paid in respect of financial year ended 31 December 2009.
4  No deferred shares were awarded in respect of the 2011 Annual Bonus Plan (ABP). Andrew Cosslett received his award as 100% cash pro-rated to 30 June 2011.

Relative importance of spend on pay

The table below sets out the actual expenditure of the Group in 2012, 2013 and 2014 on corporate employee remuneration and distributions to shareholders and shows the difference in spend between those years:

 

Item    2014
$m
       % change        2013
$m
       % change        2012
$m
 
Remuneration paid to all corporate employees      657           0.2           656           5.0           626 1 

Distributions:

                      
Final dividend (previous year)      122                115                113   
Ordinary (interim) dividend      57                63                61   
Special dividend      763 2              355 3              505 4 
Repurchase of own shares      110 5                    283 6                    107 7 
Total distributions      1,052           28.9           816           3.8           786   

 

1  Restated for the adoption of IAS 19R ‘Employee Benefits’.
2  A special dividend of $2.93 per share was paid to shareholders on 14 July 2014.
3  A special dividend of $1.33 per share was paid to shareholders on 4 October 2013.
4  A special dividend of $1.72 per share was paid to shareholders on 22 October 2012.
5  Under the authority granted by shareholders at the AGMs held on 24 May 2013 and 8 May 2014, 3,421,973 shares were purchased in the period 1 January 2014 to 29 May 2014 (the date on which the share buyback programme was completed) for a total consideration of $110m.
6  Under the authority granted by shareholders at the General Meeting held on 8 October 2012 and the AGM held on 24 May 2013, 9,773,912 shares were purchased in the period 1 January 2013 to 31 December 2013 for a total consideration of $283m.
7  Under the authority granted by shareholders at the General Meeting held on 8 October 2012, 4,143,960 shares were purchased in the period 12 November 2012 (the date on which the share buyback programme commenced) to 31 December 2012 for a total consideration of $107m.

 

    

    

    

    

    

    

    

    

    

    

    

    

    

    

    

LOGO

 

 

89


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Directors’ Remuneration Report continued

Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration continued

 

Dividends paid to Executive Directors

An interim dividend of 14.8p per ordinary share (25¢ per ADR) was paid on 26 September 2014 to shareholders on the Register of members at the close of business on 22 August 2014.

A special interim dividend of 174.9p per ordinary share (293¢ per ADR) was paid on 14 July 2014 to shareholders on the Register of members at the close of business on 30 June 2014.

The 2014 special dividend was accompanied by a share consolidation to maintain comparability (as far as possible) of the share price before and after the payment of the special dividend. Neither LTIP award holders nor IHG Executive Share Option Plan holders were entitled to receive the special dividend. Executive Directors holding forfeitable shares under previous years’ annual incentive awards received the special dividend, and their share awards were subject to the share consolidation.

Kirk Kinsell’s deferred shares are held in the form of conditional awards, which were not eligible to receive the special dividend, rather than forfeitable shares. To ensure equity of treatment with other Executive Committee members, a dividend equivalent was paid in respect of these awards to Mr Kinsell, and his awards were subject to the share consolidation.

Payments for loss of office (audited information)

Tom Singer stepped down from the Board and his role as Group Chief Financial Officer on 1 January 2014. In line with his contractual agreement and the Remuneration Committee’s policy on termination of employment, Mr Singer was not paid any salary or benefits (or compensation in lieu) in respect of the period after 1 January 2014, and did not receive any compensation for loss of office.

The footnotes to the single total figure table on page 82 set out the impact of Mr Singer’s resignation on his APP and LTIP awards.

Payments to past directors – benefits (audited information)

Sir Ian Prosser, who retired as a Director on 31 December 2003, had an ongoing healthcare benefit of £1,379 during the year.

Payments to past directors – ICETUS cash out (audited information)

In 2014, the Company looked to reduce the risks and volatility from the remaining unfunded ICETUS pension arrangement by offering members an opportunity to cash out the ICETUS element of their pension on a basis that is fair and reasonable, both to them and to shareholders. This is part of the process of redrawing IHG’s pension arrangements and minimising the future risks to the Company.

A number of past directors received one-off payments, following which they will have no future entitlement to any benefit from ICETUS:

 

Former Director    Value in 2014
£
 
Andrew Cosslett1      No value to disclose   
Richard Hartman2      74,968   
Richard North3      3,386,296   
Sir Ian Prosser      8,597   

 

1  A gross cash payment of £5,114,920 was made in lieu of any future entitlement to ICETUS benefits, in respect of which £5,266,788 had been disclosed in the 2011 Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration based on the Cash Equivalent Transfer Value methodology of valuing pensions applicable at the time.
2  A gross cash payment of £497,987 in lieu of any future entitlement to ICETUS benefits, in respect of which £423,019 had been disclosed in the 2007 Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration based on the Cash Equivalent Transfer Value methodology of valuing pensions applicable at the time.
3  A gross cash payment of £6,444,041 was made in lieu of any future entitlement to ICETUS benefits, in respect of which £3,057,744 had been disclosed in the 2004 Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration based on the Cash Equivalent Transfer Value methodology of valuing pensions applicable at the time.

Share options

In 2013, the gain before tax, made by Richard Solomons on the exercise of options was £4,663,884.

 

 

 

Single total figure of remuneration: Non-Executive Directors (audited information)

 

                 Fees (£000)        Taxable benefits2
(£000)
       Total (£000)  
Non-Executive Director    Committee appointments1    Date of original appointment      2014        2013        2014        2013        2014        2013  
Patrick Cescau    LOGO      1 January 2013         412           400           15           14           427           414   
Ian Dyson3    LOGO   LOGO   LOGO      1 September 2013         88           23           2           1           90           24   
Jo Harlow4    LOGO   LOGO   LOGO      1 September 2014         23           n/a           0           n/a           23           n/a   
David Kappler5    LOGO   LOGO   LOGO      21 June 2004         47           109           1           2           48           111   
Jennifer Laing    LOGO   LOGO   LOGO      25 August 2005         83           80           3           2           86           82   
Jonathan Linen6    LOGO   LOGO      1 December 2005         71           69           81           90           152           159   
Jill McDonald7    LOGO   LOGO      1 June 2013         71           40           2           3           73           43   
Luke Mayhew    LOGO   LOGO   LOGO      1 July 2011         94           91           3           2           97           93   
Dale Morrison8    LOGO   LOGO   LOGO      1 June 2011         84           69           22           22           106           91   
Ying Yeh    LOGO   LOGO   LOGO      1 December 2007         71           69           72           72           143           141   

 

1  See page 57 for Board Committee membership key.
2  Benefits include taxable travel and accommodation expenses to attend Board meetings away from home location; under concessionary HM Revenue & Customs rules, non-UK based Non-Executive Directors are not subject to tax on travel expenses for the first five years. This is reflected in the taxable benefits figures for Jonathan Linen, Dale Morrison and Ying Yeh.
3  Ian Dyson was appointed as a Non-Executive Director on 1 September 2013 and became Chairman of the Audit Committee on 1 April 2014. His fee increased accordingly from that date.
4  Jo Harlow was appointed as a Non-Executive Director on 1 September 2014. Her fee was pro-rated accordingly from her start date.
5  David Kappler retired as a Non-Executive Director on 31 May 2014.
6  Jonathan Linen retired as a Non-Executive Director on 31 December 2014.
7  Jill McDonald was appointed as a Non-Executive Director on 1 June 2013. Her fee was pro-rated accordingly from her start date.
8  Dale Morrison became Senior Independent Non-Executive Director with effect from 31 May 2014 and his fee increased accordingly from that date.

 

 

 

90


Table of Contents
 
 

Implementation of Directors’ Remuneration Policy in 2015

This section explains how the DR Policy will be applied in 2015. It is subject to an advisory vote by shareholders at the 2015 AGM.

 

Salary: Executive Directors

Directors’ salaries are agreed annually in line with the DR Policy. The following salaries will apply from 1 April 2015:

 

Executive Director %
increase
  2015
£
  2015
$
  2014
£
  2014
$
 
Richard Solomons   3.5      792,000            765,000         
Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson1   9.5      460,000            420,000         
Kirk Kinsell2   n/a            n/a            793,500   
Tracy Robbins   2.5      448,000            437,000         

 

1  Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson was appointed to the Board and the role of Group Chief Financial Officer effective as of 1 January 2014. In line with the DR Policy for newly appointed or promoted Executive Directors, he was appointed on a salary set below benchmark policy level and, following strong performance in his first year in role, an increase higher than that of the corporate UK and US employee population has been agreed by the Remuneration Committee for 2015.
2  Kirk Kinsell was paid in US dollars and his annual salary for 2014 is shown in US dollars above. The equivalent sterling value calculated using an exchange rate of $1=£0.61 is £484,035. Mr Kinsell left the Board and IHG on 13 February 2015.

The overall budget for salary increases for 2015 for UK and US corporate employees is 3.0% and 3.5% respectively.

APP and LTIP performance measures and targets

The performance measures and targets for the 2015 APP and the 2015/17 LTIP cycle are the same as for the 2014 APP and the 2014/16 LTIP cycle respectively.

The actual targets under the performance measures for the APP for 2015 are not disclosed at this stage, as they are, in the opinion of the Directors, commercially sensitive. Disclosure would risk providing IHG’s major competitors with an unfair advantage as these companies are either unlisted or listed on a stock exchange other than the London Stock Exchange and therefore not subject to the same obligation to disclose incentive plan targets. We will consider during 2015 what further transparency we can provide shareholders without disadvantaging the business.

A clawback provision will be introduced in respect of the 2015 APP cash awards and 2015/17 LTIP cycle awards made to Executive Directors. The clawback provision will apply for three years from the date of payment (for the APP cash award) and the date of vesting (for the LTIP award). Clawback may be operated in the event of gross misconduct on the part of the employee and/or material misstatement in Company or Group financial statements.

These new provisions apply in addition to the existing malus provisions on the LTIP and APP deferred awards that provide for unvested awards to be reduced at the discretion of the Remuneration Committee in circumstances including:

 

  discovery of a material misstatement or restatement in the Company’s or any Group Company’s audited financial accounts (other than as a result of a change in accounting practice) for a period that was wholly or partly before the end of the performance period by reference to which the APP cash award was determined; and/or

 

  action or conduct of a participant that, in the reasonable opinion of the Committee, amounts to fraud or gross misconduct that causes significant damage or potential damage to IHG’s prospects, finances or brand reputation.

Fees: Non-Executive Directors

Non-Executive Directors’ fees are reviewed and agreed annually in line with the DR Policy.

Patrick Cescau waived any fee increase for 2015. The following annual fee levels will apply from 1 January 2015:

 

Non-Executive
Director
Role 2015
£
  2014
£
 
Patrick Cescau Chairman of the Board   412,000      412,000   
Ian Dyson1 Chairman of Audit Committee   96,550      93,750   
Jo Harlow2 Non-Executive Director   72,600      68,500   
David Kappler1 Senior Independent Non-Executive Director and Chairman of Audit Committee   n/a      111,750   
Jennifer Laing Chairman of Corporate Responsibility Committee   85,000      82,500   
Jonathan Linen3 Non-Executive Director   n/a      70,500   
Jill McDonald Non-Executive Director   72,600      70,500   
Luke Mayhew Chairman of Remuneration Committee   96,550      93,750   
Dale Morrison1 Senior Independent Non-Executive Director   96,550      93,750   
Ying Yeh Non-Executive Director   72,600      70,500   

 

1  David Kappler stepped down as Chairman of the Audit Committee on 1 April 2014, succeeded by Ian Dyson, and retired as Senior Independent Non-Executive Director on 31 May 2014, succeeded by Dale Morrisson.
2  Jo Harlow was appointed as Non-Executive Director effective as of 1 September 2014. Her % salary increase for 2015 brings her remuneration in line with the other Non-Executive Directors with similar roles.
3  Jonathan Linen retired as a Non-Executive Director on 31 December 2014.

Luke Mayhew, Remuneration Committee Chairman

16 February 2015

 

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

91


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

Group Financial Statements

 

94 Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities
99 Independent Auditor’s US Report
100 Group Financial Statements
100

Group income statement

101

Group statement of comprehensive income

102

Group statement of changes in equity

105

Group statement of financial position

106

Group statement of cash flows

107 Accounting policies
114 Notes to the Group Financial Statements

 

 

Book

 

LOGO

‘Guest Journey’ – Step three

  The Book phase of the ‘Guest Journey’ involves guests actually making a reservation.

 

  They can do this using a variety of methods; both direct (through digital and voice) and indirect (through online travel intermediaries, and business and leisure travel agents).
 

 

92


Table of Contents
 
    

 

 

LOGO

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

93


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities

 

Financial Statements and accounting records

The Directors are required to prepare financial statements for the Company and the Group at the end of each financial year in accordance with all applicable laws and regulations. Under company law the Directors must not approve the Financial Statements unless they are satisfied that they give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Group and the profit or loss of the Group for that period. In preparing these Financial Statements, the Directors are required to:

 

  select suitable accounting policies and apply them consistently;

 

  make judgements and accounting estimates that are reasonable;

 

  state whether the Consolidated Financial Statements have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB), for use in the EU and Article 4 of the EU IAS Regulation;

 

  state for the Company Financial Statements whether applicable UK accounting standards have been followed; and

 

  prepare the Financial Statements on the going concern basis unless it is inappropriate to presume that the Company and the Group will continue in business.

The Directors have responsibility for ensuring that the Group keeps proper accounting records which disclose with reasonable accuracy the financial position of the Group and the Company to enable them to ensure that the Financial Statements comply with the Companies Act 2006 and, as regards the Consolidated Financial Statements, Article 4 of the EU IAS Regulation. The Directors are also responsible for the system of internal control, for safeguarding the assets of the Company and the Group, and taking reasonable steps to prevent and detect fraud and other irregularities.

Disclosure and Transparency Rules

The Board confirms that to the best of its knowledge:

 

  the Financial Statements have been prepared in accordance with IFRS as issued by the IASB and IFRS as adopted by the EU, give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities, financial position and profit and loss of the Group taken as a whole; and

 

  the Annual Report, including the Strategic Report, includes a fair review of the development and performance of the business and the position of the Group taken as a whole, together with a description of the principal risks and uncertainties that it faces.

UK Corporate Governance Code

Having taken advice from the Audit Committee, the Board considers that this Annual Report and Form 20-F, taken as a whole is fair, balanced and understandable and that it provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Company’s performance, business model and strategy.

Disclosure of information to Auditor

The Directors who held office as at the date of approval of this report confirm that they have taken steps to make themselves aware of relevant audit information (as defined by Section 418(3) of the Companies Act 2006). None of the Directors are aware of any relevant audit information which has not been disclosed to the Company’s Auditor.

Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting

Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for the Group, as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 as a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with IFRS. The Group’s internal control over financial reporting includes policies and procedures that:

 

  pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the Group’s transactions and dispositions of assets;

 

  are designed to provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit the preparation of the Financial Statements in accordance with IFRS as issued by the IASB and the IFRS adopted by the EU, and that receipts and expenditure are being made only in accordance with authorisation of management and the Directors of the Company; and

 

  provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorised acquisition, use or disposition of the Group’s assets that could have a material effect on the Financial Statements.

Any internal control framework has inherent limitations and internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions or the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Management has undertaken an assessment of the effectiveness of the Group’s internal control over financial reporting at 31 December 2014 based on criteria established in the Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (2013 Framework) (the COSO criteria). Based on this assessment, management has concluded that as at 31 December 2014 the Group’s internal control over financial reporting was effective.

During the period covered by this document the Group transitioned from the 1992 to the 2013 Internal Control-Integrated Framework criteria issued by COSO. There were no other changes in the Group’s internal control over financial reporting that have materially affected or are reasonably likely to materially affect the effectiveness of the internal controls over financial reporting.

The Group’s internal control over financial reporting at 31 December 2014, together with the Group’s Consolidated Financial Statements, were audited by Ernst & Young LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm. Their report on internal control over financial reporting can be found on page 99.

For and on behalf of the Board

 

LOGO LOGO
Richard Solomons Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson
Chief Executive Officer Chief Financial Officer
16 February 2015 16 February 2015
 

 

 

 

94


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

[THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]

 

 

LOGO

 

 

95


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

 

 

[THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]

 

 

 

 
 

 

 

 

96


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

 

[THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]

 

 

LOGO

 

 

97


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

 

 

[THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]

 

 

 

 

 

98


Table of Contents
 
    
 

Independent Auditor’s US Report

 

Report of independent registered public accounting firm on internal control over financial reporting

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of InterContinental Hotels Group PLC.

We have audited InterContinental Hotels Group PLC’s internal control over financial reporting as of 31 December 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (2013 Framework) (the COSO criteria). InterContinental Hotels Group PLC’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in the Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Group’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorisations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorised acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, InterContinental Hotels Group PLC maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of 31 December 2014, based on the COSO criteria.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the accompanying Group statement of financial position of InterContinental Hotels Group PLC as of 31 December 2014 and 2013, and the related Group income statement, Group statement of comprehensive income, Group statement of changes in equity and Group statement of cash flows for each of the three years in

the period ended 31 December 2014, and our report dated 16 February 2015 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

ERNST & YOUNG LLP

London, England

16 February 2015

Report of independent registered public accounting firm

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of InterContinental Hotels Group PLC.

We have audited the accompanying Group statement of financial position of InterContinental Hotels Group PLC as of 31 December 2014 and 2013, and the related Group income statement, Group statement of comprehensive income, Group statement of changes in equity and Group statement of cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended 31 December 2014. These Financial Statements are the responsibility of the Group’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these Financial Statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the Financial Statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of InterContinental Hotels Group PLC at 31 December 2014 and 2013, and the consolidated results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended 31 December 2014, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), InterContinental Hotels Group PLC’s internal control over financial reporting as of 31 December 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (2013 Framework), and our report dated 16 February 2015 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

ERNST & YOUNG LLP

London, England

16 February 2015

Notes:

 

1.  The maintenance and integrity of the InterContinental Hotels Group PLC website is the responsibility of the Directors; the work carried out by the auditors does not involve consideration of these matters and, accordingly, the auditors accept no responsibility for any changes that may have occurred to the Financial Statements since they were initially presented on the website.

 

2.  Legislation in the United Kingdom governing the preparation and dissemination of financial statements may differ from legislation in other jurisdictions.
 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

99


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Group Financial Statements

Group income statement

 

 

For the year ended 31 December 2014

        2014         2013         2012  
       

 

Before

    Exceptional               Before     Exceptional               Before     Exceptional        
        exceptional     items               exceptional     items               exceptional     items        
        items     (note 5)     Total         items     (note 5)     Total         items     (note 5)     Total  
  Note     $m     $m     $m          $m     $m     $m          $m     $m     $m  
Revenue     2        1,858               1,858            1,903               1,903            1,835               1,835   
Cost of sales             (741            (741         (784            (784         (772            (772
Administrative expenses             (382     (101     (483         (374     (167     (541         (372     (16     (388
Share of (losses)/profits of associates and joint ventures     2        (4            (4         2        6        8            3               3   
Other operating income and expenses             16        130        146            6        166        172            5        (11     (6
              747        29        776            753        5        758            699        (27     672   
Depreciation and amortisation     2        (96            (96         (85            (85         (94            (94
Impairment reversal     2                                                                 23        23   
Operating profit     2        651        29        680            668        5        673            605        (4     601   
Financial income     6        3               3            5               5            3               3   
Financial expenses     6        (83            (83         (78            (78         (57            (57
Profit before tax             571        29        600            595        5        600            551        (4     547   
Tax     7        (179     (29     (208         (175     (51     (226         (151     142        (9
Profit for the year from continuing operations             392               392            420        (46     374            400        138        538   
Attributable to:                                                                                        
Equity holders of the parent             391               391            418        (46     372            399        138        537   
Non-controlling interest             1               1            2               2            1               1   
              392               392            420        (46     374            400        138        538   
Earnings per ordinary share     9                                                                                   
Continuing and total operations:                                                                                        
Basic                             158.3¢                            140.9¢                            187.1¢   
Diluted                             156.4¢                            139.3¢                            183.9¢   

Notes on pages 107 to 153 form an integral part of these Financial Statements.

 

 

 

100


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

Group statement of comprehensive income

 

 

                                      
For the year ended 31 December 2014    2014
$m
    2013
$m
    2012
$m
 
Profit for the year      392        374        538   
Other comprehensive income                         
Items that may be subsequently reclassified to profit or loss:                         

Gains on valuation of available-for-sale financial assets, net of related tax charge of $1m (2013 $nil, 2012 $nil)

     11        28        1   

Losses relating to cash flow hedges reclassified to financial expenses

                   1   

Exchange gains/(losses) on retranslation of foreign operations, net of related tax credit of $1m (2013 $2m, 2012 $3m)

     42        (35     24   

Exchange losses reclassified to profit on hotel disposal

            46          
       53        39        26   
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss:                         

Re-measurement (losses)/gains on defined benefit plans, net of related tax credit of $7m (2013 charge of $20m, 2012 credit of $5m)

     (18     20        (10

Tax related to pension contributions

     2               18   
       (16     20        8   
Total other comprehensive income for the year      37        59        34   
Total comprehensive income for the year      429        433        572   
Attributable to:                         
Equity holders of the parent      428        433        571   
Non-controlling interest      1               1   
       429        433        572   

Notes on pages 107 to 153 form an integral part of these Financial Statements.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

101


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Group Financial Statements continued

Group statement of changes in equity

 

 

      Equity
share
capital
$m
   

Capital
redemption
reserve

$m

    

Shares
held by
employee
share
trusts

$m

    Other
reserves
$m
    Unrealised
gains and
losses
reserve
$m
    

Currency

translation

reserve
$m

    

Retained
earnings

$m

   

IHG
share-

holders’

equity

$m

   

Non-

controlling

interest

$m

   

Total

equity

$m

 
At 1 January 2014      189        12         (38     (2,906     100         227         2,334        (82     8        (74
Profit for the year                                                   391        391        1        392   
Other comprehensive income:                                                                                    
Items that may be subsequently reclassified to profit or loss:                                                                                    

Gains on valuation of available-for-sale financial assets

                                  11                        11               11   

Exchange differences on retranslation of foreign operations

                                          42                42               42   
                                    11         42                53               53   
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss:                                                                                    

Re-measurement losses on defined benefit plans

                                                  (18     (18            (18

Tax related to pension contributions

                                                  2        2               2   
                                                    (16     (16            (16
Total other comprehensive income                                   11         42         (16     37               37   
Total comprehensive income for the year                                   11         42         375        428        1        429   
Repurchase of shares                                                   (110     (110            (110
Transaction costs relating to shareholder returns                                                   (1     (1            (1
Purchase of own shares by employee share trusts                     (58                                   (58            (58
Release of own shares by employee share trusts                     60                               (60                     
Equity-settled share-based cost                                                   28        28               28   
Tax related to share schemes                                                   12        12               12   
Equity dividends paid                                                   (942     (942     (1     (943
Exchange adjustments      (11             1        10                                               
At 31 December 2014      178        12         (35     (2,896     111         269         1,636        (725     8        (717

All items above are shown net of tax.

Notes on pages 107 to 153 form an integral part of these Financial Statements.

 

 

 

 

102


Table of Contents
 
    
 

Group statement of changes in equity continued

 

 

      Equity
share
capital
$m
    

Capital
redemption
reserve

$m

    

Shares
held by
employee
share
trusts

$m

    Other
reserves
$m
    Unrealised
gains and
losses
reserve
$m
    

Currency

translation

reserve
$m

   

Retained
earnings

$m

   

IHG share-

holders’

equity

$m

   

Non-

controlling

interest

$m

   

Total

equity

$m

 
At 1 January 2013      179         11         (48     (2,901     72         214        2,781        308        9        317   
Profit for the year                                                   372        372        2        374   
Other comprehensive income:                                                                                    
Items that may be subsequently reclassified to profit or loss:                                                                                    

Gains on valuation of available-for-sale financial assets

                                   28                       28               28   

Exchange differences on retranslation of foreign operations

                                           (33            (33     (2     (35

Exchange losses reclassified to profit on hotel disposal

                                           46               46               46   
                                     28         13               41        (2     39   
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss:                                                                                    

Re-measurement gains on defined benefit plans

                                                  20        20               20   
                                                    20        20               20   
Total other comprehensive income                                    28         13        20        61        (2     59   
Total comprehensive income for the year                                    28         13        392        433               433   
Issue of ordinary shares      5                                                     5               5   
Repurchase of shares                                                   (283     (283            (283
Purchase of own shares by employee share trusts                      (53                                  (53            (53
Release of own shares by employee share trusts                      64                              (61     3               3   
Equity-settled share-based cost                                                   27        27               27   
Tax related to share schemes                                                   11        11               11   
Equity dividends paid                                                   (533     (533     (1     (534
Exchange adjustments      5         1         (1     (5                                           
At 31 December 2013      189         12         (38     (2,906     100         227        2,334        (82     8        (74

All items above are shown net of tax.

Notes on pages 107 to 153 form an integral part of these Financial Statements.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

103


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Group Financial Statements continued

Group statement of changes in equity continued

 

 

      Equity
share
capital
$m
   

Capital
redemption
reserve

$m

    

Shares
held by
employee
share
trusts

$m

    Other
reserves
$m
    Unrealised
gains and
losses
reserve
$m
   

Currency

translation

reserve
$m

    

Retained
earnings

$m

   

IHG share-

holders’

equity

$m

   

Non-

controlling

interest

$m

    

Total

equity

$m

 
At 1 January 2012      162        10         (27     (2,893     71        189         3,035        547        8         555   
Profit for the year                                                  537        537        1         538   
Other comprehensive income:                                                                                    
Items that may be subsequently reclassified to profit or loss:                                                                                    

Gains on valuation of available-for-sale financial assets

                                  1                       1                1   

Losses reclassified to financial expenses on cash flow hedges

                                  1                       1                1   

Exchange differences on retranslation of foreign operations

                                  (1     25                24                24   
                                    1        25                26                26   
Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss:                                                                                    

Re-measurement losses on defined benefit plans

                                                 (10     (10             (10

Tax related to pension contributions

                                                 18        18                18   
                                                   8        8                8   
Total other comprehensive income                                   1        25         8        34                34   
Total comprehensive income for the year                                   1        25         545        571        1         572   
Issue of ordinary shares      10                                                    10                10   
Repurchase of shares      (1                                          (106     (107             (107
Transfer to capital redemption reserve             1                                      (1                      
Transaction costs relating to shareholder returns                                                  (2     (2             (2
Purchase of own shares by employee share trusts                     (84                                  (84             (84
Release of own shares by employee share trusts                     63                              (63                      
Equity-settled share-based cost                                                  27        27                27   
Tax related to share schemes                                                  20        20                20   
Equity dividends paid                                                  (679     (679             (679
Share of reserve in equity accounted investment                                                  5        5                5   
Exchange adjustments      8                       (8                                            
At 31 December 2012      179        11         (48     (2,901     72        214         2,781        308        9         317   

All items above are shown net of tax.

Notes on pages 107 to 153 form an integral part of these Financial Statements.

 

 

 

 

104


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

Group statement of financial position

 

 

31 December 2014    Note     

2014

$m

    2013
(restated1)
$m
    2012
(restated1)
$m
 
ASSETS                                  
Property, plant and equipment      10         741        1,169        1,056   
Goodwill      12         74        80        93   
Intangible assets      13         569        438        354   
Investment in associates and joint ventures      14         116        85        84   
Trade and other receivables      16         3                 
Retirement benefit assets      25         8        7        99   
Other financial assets      15         252        236        155   
Non-current tax receivable               34        16        24   
Deferred tax assets      7         87        108        204   
Total non-current assets               1,884        2,139        2,069   
Inventories               3        4        4   
Trade and other receivables      16         448        423        422   
Current tax receivable               4        12        31   
Derivative financial instruments      22         2        1        2   
Other financial assets      15         5        12        6   
Cash and cash equivalents      17         162        248        387   
Total current assets               624        700        852   
Assets classified as held for sale      11         310        228        534   
Total assets      2         2,818        3,067        3,455   
LIABILITIES                                  
Loans and other borrowings      21         (126     (130     (208
Trade and other payables      18         (769     (748     (709
Provisions      19         (1     (3     (1
Current tax payable               (47     (47     (54
Total current liabilities               (943     (928     (972
Loans and other borrowings      21         (1,569     (1,269     (1,242
Derivative financial instruments      22                (11     (19
Retirement benefit obligations      25         (146     (184     (187
Trade and other payables      18         (627     (574     (563
Provisions      19         (9            (1
Deferred tax liabilities      7         (147     (175     (93
Total non-current liabilities               (2,498     (2,213     (2,105
Liabilities classified as held for sale      11         (94            (61
Total liabilities      2         (3,535     (3,141     (3,138
Net (liabilities)/assets               (717     (74     317   
EQUITY                                  
Equity share capital      27         178        189        179   
Capital redemption reserve      27         12        12        11   
Shares held by employee share trusts      27         (35     (38     (48
Other reserves      27         (2,896     (2,906     (2,901
Unrealised gains and losses reserve      27         111        100        72   
Currency translation reserve      27         269        227        214   
Retained earnings               1,636        2,334        2,781   
IHG shareholders’ equity               (725     (82     308   
Non-controlling interest      27         8        8        9   
Total equity               (717     (74     317   

 

1 Restated for the adoption of ‘Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities’ (Amendments to IAS 32), see page 107.

Signed on behalf of the Board

Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson

16 February 2015

Notes on pages 107 to 153 form an integral part of these Financial Statements.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

105


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Group Financial Statements continued

Group statement of cash flows

 

 

                                           
For the year ended 31 December 2014    Note      2014
$m
    2013
$m
    2012
$m
 
Profit for the year               392        374        538   
Adjustments for:                                  

Net financial expenses

              80        73        54   

Income tax charge

     7         208        226        9   

Depreciation and amortisation

              96        85        94   

Impairment reversal

     5                       (23

Other exceptional operating items

              (29     (5     27   

Equity-settled share-based cost

     26         21        22        22   

Dividends from associates and joint ventures

     14         2        5        1   

Other items

              4        2        (3
Operating cash flow before movements in working capital               774        782        719   
Increase in trade and other receivables               (18     (9     (50
Net change in loyalty programme liability and System Fund surplus      32         58        61        57   
Increase in other trade and other payables               61        8        26   
Utilisation of provisions      19         (2     (3     (12
Retirement benefit contributions, net of costs               (6     (18     (95
Cash flows relating to exceptional operating items               (114     (33     (6
Cash flow from operations               753        788        639   
Interest paid               (76     (74     (50
Interest received               2        2        2   
Tax paid on operating activities      7         (136     (92     (119
Net cash from operating activities               543        624        472   
Cash flow from investing activities                                  
Purchase of property, plant and equipment               (84     (159     (44
Purchase of intangible assets               (162     (86     (84
Investment in other financial assets               (5     (154     (2
Investment in associates and joint ventures               (15     (10     (3
Loan advances to associates and joint ventures               (3              
Capitalised interest paid               (2              
Disposal of hotel assets, net of costs      11         345        460        4   
Proceeds from other financial assets               49        109        4   
Distribution from associate on sale of hotel                      17          
Proceeds from other associates and joint ventures                      3          
Tax paid on disposals      7                (5     (3
Net cash from investing activities               123        175        (128
Cash flow from financing activities                                  
Proceeds from the issue of share capital                      5        10   
Purchase of own shares               (110     (283     (107
Purchase of own shares by employee share trusts               (68     (44     (84
Dividends paid to shareholders      8         (942     (533     (679
Dividend paid to non-controlling interests               (1     (1       
Transaction costs relating to shareholder returns               (1            (2
Issue of long-term bonds                             632   
Increase/(decrease) in other borrowings               382        (1     (99
Close-out of currency swaps               4                 
Net cash from financing activities               (736     (857     (329
Net movement in cash and cash equivalents in the year               (70     (58     15   
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of the year      17         134        195        182   
Exchange rate effects               (9     (3     (2
Cash and cash equivalents at end of the year      17         55        134        195   

Notes on pages 107 to 153 form an integral part of these Financial Statements.

 

 

 

 

106


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

Accounting policies

 

General information

This document constitutes the Annual Report and Financial Statements in accordance with UK Listing Rules requirements and the Annual Report on Form 20-F in accordance with the US Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Prior to 2013 the Group issued separate documents.

The Consolidated Financial Statements of InterContinental Hotels Group PLC (the Group or IHG) for the year ended 31 December 2014 were authorised for issue in accordance with a resolution of the Directors on 16 February 2015. InterContinental Hotels Group PLC (the Company) is incorporated and domiciled in Great Britain and registered in England and Wales.

Changes in accounting policies

With effect from 1 January 2014, the Group has adopted ‘Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities’ (Amendments to IAS 32). The amendments clarify that to offset financial assets and financial liabilities, the Group’s right of offset must be legally enforceable in the normal course of business, in the event of default, and in the event of insolvency or bankruptcy of the Group and all of the counterparties. Following a detailed review of the Group’s cash pooling arrangements which have previously been presented net within cash and cash equivalents (see note 17), management have determined that the right of offset is not enforceable in all of the above circumstances. As a result, the overdrafts within the cash pools are now presented as current loans and other borrowings. The amendments to IAS 32 are applicable retrospectively, requiring the restatement of prior year comparatives and the presentation of a third statement of financial position as at 31 December 2012 as required by IAS 1 ‘Presentation of Financial Statements’. The adoption of the amendments to IAS 32 increases cash and cash equivalents and current loans and other borrowings by $107m in 2014 (2013 $114m, 2012 $192m) but has no impact on the net financial position of the Group nor the reporting of net debt. Cash and cash equivalents presented in the Group statement of cash flows continue to be presented net of overdrafts as permitted by IAS 7 ‘Statement of Cash Flows’.

In addition, with effect from 1 January 2014, the Group has adopted Amendment to IAS 36 ‘Impairment of Assets – Recoverable Amount Disclosures for Non-Financial Assets’, Amendment to IAS 39 ‘Novation of Derivatives and Continuation of Hedge Accounting’ and IFRIC 21 ‘Levies’. The adoption of these amendments to standards and interpretations has had no material impact on the Group’s financial performance or position and there has been no requirement to restate prior year comparatives.

Summary of significant accounting policies

Basis of preparation

The Consolidated Financial Statements of IHG have been prepared on a going concern basis and under the historical cost convention, except for available-for-sale equity securities and derivatives which are measured at fair value. The Consolidated Financial Statements have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRSs) as issued by the IASB and in accordance with IFRS as adopted by the European Union (EU) and as applied in accordance with the provisions of the Companies Act 2006. IFRS as adopted by the EU differs in certain respects from IFRS as issued by the IASB. However, the differences have no impact on the Consolidated Financial Statements for the years presented.

Presentational currency

The Consolidated Financial Statements are presented in millions of US dollars following a management decision to change the reporting currency from sterling during 2008. The change was made to reflect the profile of the Group’s revenue and operating profit which are primarily generated in US dollars or US dollar-linked currencies.

The currency translation reserve was set to nil at 1 January 2004 on transition to IFRS and this reserve is presented on the basis that the Group has reported in US dollars since this date. Equity share capital, the capital redemption reserve and shares held by employee share trusts are translated into US dollars at the rates of exchange on the last day of the period; the resultant exchange differences are recorded in other reserves.

The functional currency of the parent company remains sterling since this is a non-trading holding company located in the United Kingdom that has sterling denominated share capital and whose primary activity is the payment and receipt of sterling dividends and of interest on sterling denominated external borrowings and inter-company balances.

Basis of consolidation

The Consolidated Financial Statements comprise the Financial Statements of the parent company and entities controlled by the Group. Control exists when the Group has:

 

  power over an investee (i.e. existing rights that give it the current ability to direct the relevant activities of the investee);

 

  exposure, or rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the investee; and

 

  the ability to use its power over the investee to affect its returns.

All intra-group balances and transactions are eliminated on consolidation.

The assets, liabilities and results of those businesses acquired or disposed of are consolidated for the period during which they were under the Group’s control.

The Group operates a deferred compensation plan in the US which allows certain employees to make additional provision for retirement, through the deferral of salary with matching company contributions. Employees can draw down on the plan in certain limited circumstances during employment. The assets of the plan are held in a company-owned trust which is not consolidated as the relevant activity of the trust, being the investment of the funds in the trust, is directed by the participating employees of the plan and the company has no exposure to the gains and losses resulting from those investment decisions. The assets of the trust are held solely for the benefit of the participating employees and to pay plan expenses, other than in the case of a company insolvency in which case they can be claimed by the general creditors of the company. At 31 December 2014, the trust had assets with a fair value of $148m (2013 $135m).

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

107


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Accounting policies continued

 

 

Foreign currencies

Transactions in foreign currencies are translated to functional currency at the exchange rates ruling on the dates of the transactions. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are retranslated to the functional currency at the relevant rates of exchange ruling on the last day of the period. Foreign exchange differences arising on translation are recognised in the income statement except on foreign currency borrowings that provide a hedge against a net investment in a foreign operation. These are taken directly to the currency translation reserve until the disposal of the net investment, at which time they are recycled against the gain or loss on disposal.

The assets and liabilities of foreign operations, including goodwill, are translated into US dollars at the relevant rates of exchange ruling on the last day of the period. The revenues and expenses of foreign operations are translated into US dollars at average rates of exchange for the period. The exchange differences arising on the retranslation are taken directly to the currency translation reserve. On disposal of a foreign operation, the cumulative amount recognised in the currency translation reserve relating to that particular foreign operation is recycled against the gain or loss on disposal.

Property, plant and equipment

Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost less depreciation and any impairment.

Repairs and maintenance costs are expensed as incurred.

Land is not depreciated. All other property, plant and equipment are depreciated to a residual value over their estimated useful lives, namely:

 

  buildings – lesser of 50 years and unexpired term of lease; and

 

  fixtures, fittings and equipment – three to 25 years.

All depreciation is charged on a straight-line basis. Residual value is re-assessed annually.

Property, plant and equipment are tested for impairment when events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable. Assets that do not generate independent cash flows are combined into cash-generating units. If carrying values exceed their estimated recoverable amount, the assets or cash-generating units are written down to the recoverable amount. Recoverable amount is the greater of fair value less costs of disposal and value in use. Value in use is assessed based on estimated future cash flows discounted to their present value using a pre-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the asset. Impairment losses, and any subsequent reversals, are recognised in the income statement.

On adoption of IFRS, the Group retained previous revaluations of property, plant and equipment which are included at deemed cost as permitted by IFRS 1 ‘First-time Adoption of International Financial Reporting Standards’.

Goodwill

Goodwill arises on consolidation and is recorded at cost, being the excess of the cost of acquisition over the fair value at the date of acquisition of the Group’s share of identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities. Transaction costs are expensed and are not included in the cost of acquisition. Following initial recognition, goodwill is measured at cost less any accumulated impairment losses.

Goodwill is tested for impairment at least annually by comparing carrying values of cash-generating units with their recoverable amounts. Impairment losses cannot be subsequently reversed.

Intangible assets

Software

Acquired and internally developed software are capitalised on the basis of the costs incurred to acquire and bring to use the specific software. Costs are amortised over estimated useful lives of three to five years on a straight-line basis.

Internally generated development costs are expensed unless forecast revenues exceed attributable forecast development costs, in which case they are capitalised and amortised over the estimated useful life of the asset.

Management contracts

When assets are sold and a purchaser enters into a franchise or management contract with the Group, the Group capitalises as part of the gain or loss on disposal an estimate of the fair value of the contract entered into. The value of management contracts is amortised on a straight-line basis over the life of the contract including any extension periods at IHG’s option up to a maximum of 50 years.

Other intangible assets

Amounts paid to hotel owners to secure management contracts and franchise agreements are capitalised and amortised on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives up to a maximum of 50 years. In prior years this has been determined to be the shorter of the contracted period and 10 years. Following a detailed review in early 2014 and based on the Group’s experience of the actual contractual periods secured by these payments, the estimate of useful life has been re-assessed to comprise the full contract term, which is also consistent with the stated policy of other companies in the hotel industry. This revision to the estimate of expected useful lives has been applied prospectively in accordance with IAS 38 and results in the following (decrease)/ increase in the original amortisation profile of assets capitalised at 1 January 2014: 2014 $(5)m, 2015 $(5)m, 2016 $(4)m, 2017 $(3)m, 2018 and after $17m in total.

Intangible assets are reviewed for impairment when events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable.

 

 

 

 

108


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

Borrowing costs

Borrowing costs attributable to the acquisition or construction of property, plant and equipment or in respect of software projects that necessarily take a substantial period of time to prepare for their intended use, or sale, are capitalised as part of the asset cost. Borrowing costs consist of interest and other costs that an entity incurs in connection with the borrowing of funds. All borrowing costs relating to projects commencing before 1 January 2009 were expensed.

Associates and joint ventures

An associate is an entity over which the Group has significant influence. Significant influence is the power to participate in the financial and operating policy decisions of the entity, but is not control or joint control over those policies.

A joint venture exists when two or more parties have joint control over, and rights to the net assets of, the venture. Joint control is the contractually agreed sharing of control which only exists when decisions about the relevant activities require the unanimous consent of the parties sharing control.

Associates and joint ventures are accounted for using the equity method unless the associate or joint venture is classified as held for sale. Under the equity method, the Group’s investment is recorded at cost adjusted by the Group’s share of post-acquisition profits and losses and other movements in the investee’s reserves. When the Group’s share of losses exceeds its interest in an associate or joint venture, the Group’s carrying amount is reduced to $nil and recognition of further losses is discontinued except to the extent that the Group has incurred legal or constructive obligations or made payments on behalf of an associate or joint venture.

Financial assets

The Group classifies its financial assets into one of the two following categories: loans and receivables or available-for-sale financial assets. Management determines the classification of financial assets on initial recognition and they are subsequently held at amortised cost (loans and receivables) or fair value (available-for-sale financial assets). Interest on loans and receivables is calculated using the effective interest rate method and is recognised in the income statement as interest income. Changes in fair values of available-for-sale financial assets are recorded directly in equity within the unrealised gains and losses reserve. On disposal, the accumulated fair value adjustments recognised in equity are recycled to the income statement. Dividends from available-for-sale financial assets are recognised in the income statement as other operating income and expenses.

Financial assets are assessed for impairment at each period-end date. In the case of an equity investment classified as available-for-sale, a significant or prolonged decline in fair value below cost is evidence that the asset is impaired. If an available-for-sale financial asset is impaired, the difference between original cost and fair value is transferred from equity to the income statement to the extent of any cumulative loss recorded in equity, with any excess charged directly to the income statement. Subsequent impairment reversals relating to previously impaired equity instruments are recorded in equity.

Trade receivables

Trade receivables are recorded at their original amount less provision for impairment. It is the Group’s policy to provide for 100% of the previous month’s aged receivables balances which are more than 180 days past due. Adjustments to the policy may be made due to specific or exceptional circumstances. The carrying amount of the receivable is reduced through the use of a provision account and movements in the provision are recognised in the income statement within cost of sales. When a previously provided trade receivable is uncollectable, it is written off against the provision.

Cash and cash equivalents

Cash comprises cash in hand and demand deposits.

Cash equivalents are short-term highly liquid investments with an original maturity of three months or less that are readily convertible to known amounts of cash and subject to insignificant risk of changes in value.

In the statement of cash flows, cash and cash equivalents are shown net of short-term overdrafts which are repayable on demand and form an integral part of the Group’s cash management.

Assets held for sale

Assets and liabilities are classified as held for sale when their carrying amount will be recovered principally through a sale transaction rather than continuing use and a sale is highly probable and expected to complete within one year. For a sale to be highly probable, management need to be committed to a plan to sell the asset and the asset must be actively marketed for sale at a price that is reasonable in relation to its current fair value.

Assets designated as held for sale are held at the lower of carrying amount at designation and fair value less costs to sell.

Depreciation is not charged against property, plant and equipment classified as held for sale.

Financial liabilities

Financial liabilities are measured at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method. A financial liability is derecognised when the obligation under the liability expires, is discharged or is cancelled.

Offsetting of financial assets and financial liabilities

Financial assets and financial liabilities are offset and the net amount is reported in the Group statement of financial position if there is a currently enforceable legal right to offset the recognised amounts and there is an intention to settle on a net basis or to realise the assets and settle the liabilities simultaneously. To meet this criteria, the right of set-off must not be contingent on a future event and must be legally enforceable in all of the following circumstances: the normal course of business, the event of default and the event of insolvency or bankruptcy of the Group and all of the counterparties.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

109


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Accounting policies continued

 

Trade payables

Trade payables are non-interest-bearing and are stated at their nominal value.

Bank and other borrowings

Bank and other borrowings are initially recognised at the fair value of the consideration received less directly attributable transaction costs. They are subsequently measured at amortised cost. Finance charges, including the transaction costs and any discount or premium on issue, are recognised in the income statement using the effective interest rate method.

Borrowings are classified as non-current when the repayment date is more than 12 months from the period-end date or where they are drawn on a facility with more than 12 months to expiry.

Derivative financial instruments and hedging

Derivatives are initially recognised and subsequently re-measured at fair value. The method of recognising the re-measurement depends on whether the derivative is designated as a hedging instrument, and if so, the nature of the item being hedged.

Changes in the fair value of derivatives designated as cash flow hedges are recorded in other comprehensive income and the unrealised gains and losses reserve to the extent that the hedges are effective. When the hedged item is recognised, the cumulative gains and losses on the related hedging instrument are reclassified to the income statement.

Changes in the fair value of derivatives designated as net investment hedges are recorded in other comprehensive income and the currency translation reserve to the extent that the hedges are effective. The cumulative gains and losses remain in equity until a foreign operation is sold, at which point they are reclassified to the income statement.

Changes in the fair value of derivatives which have either not been designated as hedging instruments or relate to the ineffective portion of hedges are recognised immediately in the income statement.

Documentation outlining the measurement and effectiveness of any hedging arrangements is maintained throughout the life of the hedge relationship.

Interest arising from currency derivatives and interest rate swaps is recorded in either financial income or expenses over the term of the agreement, unless the accounting treatment for the hedging relationship requires the interest to be taken to reserves.

Self insurance

Liabilities in respect of self insured risks include projected settlements for known and incurred but not reported claims. Projected settlements are estimated based on historical trends and actuarial data.

Provisions

Provisions are recognised when the Group has a present obligation as a result of a past event, it is probable that a payment will be made and a reliable estimate of the amount payable can be made. If the effect of the time value of money is material, the provision is discounted using a current pre-tax discount rate that reflects the risks specific to the liability.

 

An onerous contract provision is recognised when the unavoidable costs of meeting the obligations under a contract exceed the economic benefits expected to be received under it.

In respect of litigation, provision is made when management consider it probable that payment may occur even though the defence of the related claim may still be ongoing through the court process.

Taxes

Current tax

Current income tax assets and liabilities for the current and prior periods are measured at the amount expected to be recovered from or paid to the tax authorities including interest. The tax rates and tax laws used to compute the amount are those that are enacted or substantively enacted at the end of the reporting period.

Deferred tax

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognised in respect of temporary differences between the tax base and carrying value of assets and liabilities including accelerated capital allowances, unrelieved tax losses, unremitted profits from subsidiaries, gains rolled over into replacement assets, gains on previously revalued properties and other short-term temporary differences.

Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that it is regarded as probable that the deductible temporary differences can be realised. The recoverability of all deferred tax assets is re-assessed at the end of each reporting period.

Deferred tax is calculated at the tax rates that are expected to apply in the periods in which the asset or liability will be settled, based on rates enacted or substantively enacted at the end of the reporting period.

Retirement benefits

Defined contribution plans

Payments to defined contribution schemes are charged to the income statement as they fall due.

Defined benefit plans

Plan assets, including qualifying insurance policies, are measured at fair value and plan liabilities are measured on an actuarial basis, using the projected unit credit method and discounting at an interest rate equivalent to the current rate of return on a high-quality corporate bond of equivalent currency and term to the plan liabilities. The difference between the value of plan assets and liabilities at the period-end date is the amount of surplus or deficit recorded in the statement of financial position as an asset or liability. An asset is recognised when the employer has an unconditional right to use the surplus at some point during the life of the plan or on its wind-up. If a refund would be subject to a tax other than income tax, as is the case in the UK, the asset is recorded at the amount net of the tax. A liability is also recorded for any such tax that would be payable in respect of funding commitments based on the accounting assumption that the related payments increase the asset.

 

 

 

 

110


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

The service cost of providing pension benefits to employees, together with the net interest expense or income for the year, is charged to the income statement within ‘administration expenses’. Net interest is calculated by applying the discount rate to the net defined benefit asset or liability, after any asset restriction. Past service costs and gains, which are the change in the present value of the defined benefit obligation for employee service in prior periods resulting from plan amendments, are recognised immediately the plan amendment occurs. Settlement gains and losses, being the difference between the settlement cost and the present value of the defined benefit obligations being settled, are recognised when the settlement occurs.

Re-measurements comprise actuarial gains and losses, the return on plan assets (excluding amounts included in net interest) and changes in the amount of any asset restrictions. Actuarial gains and losses may result from: differences between the actuarial assumptions underlying the plan liabilities and actual experience during the year or changes in the actuarial assumptions used in the valuation of the plan liabilities. Re-measurement gains and losses, and taxation thereon, are recognised in other comprehensive income and are not reclassified to profit or loss in subsequent periods.

Actuarial valuations are normally carried out every three years and are updated for material transactions and other material changes in circumstances (including changes in market prices and interest rates) up to the end of the reporting period.

Revenue recognition

Revenue arises from the sale of goods and provision of services where these activities give rise to economic benefits received and receivable by the Group on its own account and result in increases in equity.

Revenue is derived from the following sources: franchise fees; management fees; owned and leased properties and other revenues which are ancillary to the Group’s operations, including technology fee income.

Revenue is recorded (excluding VAT and similar taxes) net of discounts. The following is a description of the composition of revenues of the Group:

Franchise fees – received in connection with the licence of the Group’s brand names, usually under long-term contracts with the hotel owner. The Group charges franchise royalty fees as a percentage of rooms revenue. Revenue is recognised when the fee is earned in accordance with the terms of the contract.

Management fees – earned from hotels managed by the Group, usually under long-term contracts with the hotel owner. Management fees include a base fee, generally a percentage of hotel revenue, which is recognised when earned in accordance with the terms of the contract and an incentive fee, generally based on the hotel’s profitability or cash flows and recognised when the related performance criteria are met under the terms of the contract.

Owned and leased – primarily derived from hotel operations, including the rental of rooms and food and beverage sales from owned and leased hotels operated under the Group’s brand names. Revenue is recognised when rooms are occupied and food and beverages are sold.

Franchise fees and management fees include liquidated damages received from the early termination of contracts.

Other revenues are recognised when earned in accordance with the terms of the contract.

Government grants

Government grants are recognised in the period to which they relate when there is reasonable assurance that the grant will be received and that the Group will comply with the attached conditions. Government grants are recognised within other operating income and expenses in the Group income statement.

Share-based payments

The cost of equity-settled transactions with employees is measured by reference to fair value at the date at which the right to the shares is granted. Fair value is determined by an external valuer using option pricing models.

The cost of equity-settled transactions is recognised, together with a corresponding increase in equity, over the period in which any performance or service conditions are fulfilled, ending on the date on which the relevant employees become fully entitled to the award (vesting date).

The income statement charge for a period represents the movement in cumulative expense recognised at the beginning and end of that period. No expense is recognised for awards that do not ultimately vest, except for awards where vesting is conditional upon a market or non-vesting condition, which are treated as vesting irrespective of whether or not the market or non-vesting condition is satisfied, provided that all other performance and/or service conditions are satisfied.

Leases

Operating lease rentals are charged to the income statement on a straight-line basis over the term of the lease.

Assets held under finance leases, which transfer to the Group substantially all the risks and benefits incidental to ownership of the leased item, are capitalised at the inception of the lease, with a corresponding liability being recognised for the fair value of the leased asset or, if lower, the present value of the minimum lease payments. Lease payments are apportioned between the reduction of the lease liability and finance charges in the income statement so as to achieve a constant rate of interest on the remaining balance of the liability. Assets held under finance leases are depreciated over the shorter of the estimated useful life of the asset and the lease term.

Disposal of non-current assets

The Group recognises sales proceeds and any related gain or loss on disposal on completion of the sales process. In determining whether the gain or loss should be recorded, the Group considers whether it:

 

  has a continuing managerial involvement to the degree associated with asset ownership;

 

  has transferred the significant risks and rewards associated with asset ownership; and

 

  can reliably measure and will actually receive the proceeds.
 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

111


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Accounting policies continued

 

Fair value measurement

The Group measures available-for-sale equity securities and derivatives at fair value on a recurring basis and other assets when impaired by reference to fair value less costs of disposal. Additionally, the fair value of other financial assets and liabilities require disclosure.

Fair value is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants. Fair value is measured by reference to the principal market for the asset or liability assuming that market participants act in their economic best interests.

The fair value of a non-financial asset assumes the asset is used in its highest and best use, either through continuing ownership or by selling it.

The Group uses valuation techniques that maximise the use of relevant observable inputs using the following valuation hierarchy:

 

Level 1: quoted (unadjusted) prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities.
Level 2: other techniques for which all inputs which have a significant effect on the recorded fair value are observable, either directly or indirectly.
Level 3: techniques which use inputs which have a significant effect on the recorded fair value that are not based on observable market data.

Further disclosures on the particular valuation techniques used by the Group are provided in note 23.

For impairment testing purposes and where significant assets (such as property) are valued by reference to fair value less costs of disposal, an external valuation will normally be obtained using professional valuers who have appropriate market knowledge, reputation and independence.

Exceptional items

The Group discloses certain financial information both including and excluding exceptional items. The presentation of information excluding exceptional items allows a better understanding of the underlying trading performance of the Group and provides consistency with the Group’s internal management reporting. Exceptional items are identified by virtue of either their size or nature so as to facilitate comparison with prior periods and to assess underlying trends in financial performance. Exceptional items can include, but are not restricted to, gains and losses on the disposal of assets, impairment charges and reversals, restructuring costs and the release of tax provisions.

Treasury shares

Own shares repurchased by the Company and not cancelled (treasury shares) are recognised at cost and deducted from retained earnings. If reissued, any excess of consideration over carrying amount is recognised in the share premium reserve.

Critical accounting policies and the use of judgements, estimates and assumptions

In determining and applying the Group’s accounting policies, management are required to make judgements, estimates and assumptions. An accounting policy is considered to be critical if its selection or application could materially affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Management consider accounting for the System Fund to be a critical judgement and that critical estimates and assumptions are used in impairment testing and for measuring the loyalty programme liability, tax assets and liabilities, and litigation provisions, as discussed in further detail below. Estimates and assumptions are evaluated by management using historical experience and other factors believed to be reasonable based on current circumstances. Actual results could differ under different policies, judgements, estimates and assumptions or due to unforeseen circumstances.

System Fund – in addition to management or franchise fees, hotels within the IHG System pay cash assessments and contributions which are collected by IHG for specific use within the System Fund (the Fund). The Fund also receives proceeds from the sale of IHG Rewards Club points. IHG exerts significant influence over the operation of the Fund, however the Fund is managed for the benefit of hotels in the System with the objective of driving revenues for the hotels. The Fund is used to pay for marketing, the IHG Rewards Club loyalty programme and the global reservation system. The Fund is planned to operate at breakeven with any short-term timing surplus or deficit carried in the Group statement of financial position within working capital.

As all Fund income is designated for specific purposes and does not result in a profit or loss for the Group, the revenue recognition criteria as outlined in the accounting policy above are not met and therefore the income and expenses of the Fund are not included in the Group income statement.

The assets and liabilities relating to the Fund are included in the appropriate headings in the Group statement of financial position as the related legal, but not beneficial, rights and obligations rest with the Group. These assets and liabilities include the IHG Rewards Club liability, short-term timing surpluses and deficits and any receivables and payables related to the Fund.

The cash flows relating to the Fund are reported within ‘cash flow from operations’ in the Group statement of cash flows due to the close interrelationship between the Fund and the trading operations of the Group.

Further information on the Fund is included in note 32.

 

 

 

 

112


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

Loyalty programme – the hotel loyalty programme, IHG Rewards Club, enables members to earn points, funded through hotel assessments, during each qualifying stay at an IHG branded hotel and redeem points at a later date for free accommodation or other benefits. The future redemption liability is calculated by multiplying the number of points expected to be redeemed by the redemption cost per point. On an annual basis the Group engages an external actuary who uses statistical formulas to assist in the estimate of the number of points that will never be redeemed (‘breakage’). Actuarial gains and losses on the future redemption liability are borne by the System Fund and any resulting changes in the liability would correspondingly adjust the amount of short-term timing surpluses and deficits held in the Group statement of financial position. The future redemption liability, which is included in trade and other payables, was $725m at 31 December 2014. Based on the conditions existing at the balance sheet date, a 1% decrease in the breakage estimate would increase this liability by approximately $7m.

Impairment testing – intangible assets, property, plant and equipment are tested for impairment when events or circumstances indicate that their carrying value may not be recoverable. Goodwill is subject to an impairment test on an annual basis or more frequently if there are indicators of impairment. Assets that do not generate independent cash flows are combined into cash-generating units.

The impairment testing of individual assets or cash-generating units requires an assessment of the recoverable amount of the asset or cash-generating unit. If the carrying value of the asset or cash-generating unit exceeds its estimated recoverable amount, the asset or cash-generating unit is written down to its recoverable amount. Recoverable amount is the greater of fair value less costs of disposal and value in use. Value in use is assessed based on estimated future cash flows discounted to their present value using a pre-tax discount rate that is based on the Group’s weighted average cost of capital adjusted to reflect the risks specific to the business model and territory of the cash-generating unit or asset being tested. The outcome of such an assessment is subjective, and the result sensitive to the assumed future cash flows to be generated by the cash-generating units or assets and discount rates applied in calculating the value in use.

At 31 December 2014, the Group had intangible assets of $569m and property, plant and equipment of $741m, none of which were subject to an impairment charge during the year. In respect of those assets requiring an impairment test and depending on how recoverable amount was assessed, a 10% reduction in fair value or estimated future cash flows would have resulted in an impairment loss of $7m.

Information on impairment testing of goodwill, which had a net book value of $74m at 31 December 2014, is included in note 12.

Income taxes – deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that it is regarded as probable that deductible temporary differences can be realised. The Group estimates deferred tax assets and liabilities based on current tax laws and rates, and in certain cases, business plans, including management’s expectations regarding the manner and timing of recovery of the related assets. Changes in these estimates may affect the amount of deferred tax liabilities or the valuation of deferred tax assets and therefore the tax charge in the income statement.

Provisions for tax liabilities require judgements on the interpretation of tax legislation, developments in case law and the potential outcomes of tax audits and appeals which may be subject to significant uncertainty. Therefore the actual results may vary from expectations resulting in adjustments to provisions, the valuation of deferred tax assets, cash tax settlements, and therefore the tax charge in the income statement.

Exceptional tax charges and credits arose in 2013 and 2012 as explained in note 7.

Litigation – from time to time, the Group is subject to legal proceedings the ultimate outcome of each being always subject to many uncertainties inherent in litigation. A provision for litigation is made when it is considered probable that a payment will be made and the amount of the loss can be reasonably estimated. Significant judgement is made when evaluating, amongst other factors, the probability of unfavourable outcome and the ability to make a reasonable estimate of the amount of potential loss. Litigation provisions are reviewed at each accounting period and revisions made for changes in facts and circumstances.

New standards issued but not effective

The new and amended accounting standards discussed below are those which are expected to be relevant to the Group’s financial statements.

From 1 January 2015, the Group will apply the amendments to existing standards arising from the 2010-2012 and 2011-2013 annual improvements cycles.

From 1 January 2016, the Group will apply Amendments to IAS 16 and IAS 38 ‘Clarification of Acceptable Methods of Depreciation and Amortisation’ and Amendments to IFRS 11 ‘Accounting for Acquisition of Interests in Joint Operations’.

The above amendments are not expected to have a material impact on the Group’s reported performance or financial position.

IFRS 15 ‘Revenue from Contracts with Customers’ introduces a new five-step approach to measuring and recognising revenue and is effective from 1 January 2017.

IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments’ was issued as a final standard in July 2014 and is effective from 1 January 2018. The standard introduces new requirements for classification and measurement of financial assets and financial liabilities, impairment and hedge accounting.

The Group is currently assessing the impacts of IFRS 15 and IFRS 9 and plans to adopt both standards on the required effective dates.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

113


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements

 

1. Exchange rates

 

The results of operations have been translated into US dollars at the average rates of exchange for the year. In the case of sterling, the translation rate is $1=£0.61 (2013 $1=£0.64, 2012 $1=£0.63). In the case of the euro, the translation rate is $1=0.75 (2013 $1=0.75, 2012 $1=0.78).

Assets and liabilities have been translated into US dollars at the rates of exchange on the last day of the year. In the case of sterling, the translation rate is $1=£0.64 (2013 $1=£0.60, 2012 $1=£0.62). In the case of the euro, the translation rate is $1=0.82 (2013 $1=0.73, 2012 $1=0.76).

 

 

2. Segmental information

 

The management of the Group’s operations, excluding Central functions, is organised within four geographical regions:

 

  Americas;

 

  Europe;

 

  Asia, Middle East and Africa (AMEA); and

 

  Greater China.

These, together with Central functions, comprise the Group’s five reportable segments. No operating segments have been aggregated to form these reportable segments.

Central functions include costs of global functions including technology, sales and marketing, finance, human resources and corporate services; central revenue arises principally from technology fee income. Central liabilities include the loyalty programme liability and the cumulative short-term System Fund surplus.

Each of the geographical regions derives its revenues from either franchising, managing or owning hotels and additional segmental disclosures are provided accordingly.

Management monitors the operating results of the geographical regions and Central functions separately for the purpose of making decisions about resource allocation and performance assessment. Segmental performance is evaluated based on operating profit or loss and is measured consistently with operating profit or loss in the Consolidated Financial Statements, excluding exceptional items. Group financing activities and income taxes are managed on a group basis and are not allocated to reportable segments.

 

 

Year ended 31 December 2014    Americas
$m
    Europe
$m
    AMEA
$m
    Greater
China
$m
    Central
$m
    Group
$m
 
Revenue                                                 
Franchised      630        104        16        4               754   
Managed      103        159        187        99               548   
Owned and leased      138        111        39        139               427   
Central                                  129        129   
       871        374        242        242        129        1,858   
      Americas
$m
    Europe
$m
    AMEA
$m
    Greater
China
$m
    Central
$m
    Group
$m
 
Segmental result                                                 
Franchised      544        78        12        5               639   
Managed      47        30        88        63               228   
Owned and leased      18        14        3        42               77   
Regional and central      (65     (33     (19     (21     (155     (293
Reportable segments’ operating profit      544        89        84        89        (155     651   
Exceptional operating items (note 5)      110        (56                   (25     29   
Operating profit      654        33        84        89        (180     680   
                                         Group
$m
 
Reportable segments’ operating profit                                              651   
Exceptional operating items (note 5)                                              29   
Operating profit                                              680   
Net finance costs                                              (80
Profit before tax                                              600   
Tax                                              (208
Profit for the year                                              392   

All items above relate to continuing operations.

 

 

 

 

114


Table of Contents
 
2. Segmental information continued
 
31 December 2014    Americas
$m
    Europe
$m
    AMEA
$m
    Greater
China
$m
    Central
$m
    Group
$m
 
Assets and liabilities                                                 
Segment assets      919        316        244        394        346        2,219   
Assets classified as held for sale             310                             310   
       919        626        244        394        346        2,529   
Unallocated assets:                                                 

Non-current tax receivable

                                             34   

Deferred tax assets

                                             87   

Current tax receivable

                                             4   

Derivative financial instruments

                                             2   

Cash and cash equivalents

                                             162   
Total assets                                              2,818   
Segment liabilities      (430     (199     (61     (66     (796     (1,552
Liabilities classified as held for sale             (94                          (94
       (430     (293     (61     (66     (796     (1,646
Unallocated liabilities:                                                 

Current tax payable

                                             (47

Deferred tax liabilities

                                             (147

Loans and other borrowings

                                             (1,695
Total liabilities                                              (3,535
Year ended 31 December 2014    Americas
$m
    Europe
$m
    AMEA
$m
    Greater
China
$m
    Central
$m
    Group
$m
 
Other segmental information                                                 
Capital expenditure (see below)      75        37        11        6        123        252   
Non-cash items:                                                 

Depreciation and amortisation1

     22        18        8        15        33        96   

Share-based payments cost

                                 21        21   

Share of losses/(profits) of associates and joint ventures

     6               (2                   4   

 

1     Included in the $96m of depreciation and amortisation is $41m relating to administrative expenses and $55m relating to cost of sales.

        

      Americas
$m
    Europe
$m
    AMEA
$m
    Greater
China
$m
    Central
$m
    Group
$m
 
Reconciliation of capital expenditure                                                 
Capital expenditure per management reporting      75        37        11        6        123        252   
Management contracts acquired on disposal of hotels      50                                    50   
Capital contributions to associates      15                                    15   
Other financial assets relating to deferred consideration on disposals      27        25                             52   
Timing differences                           (1            (1
Additions per the Financial Statements      167        62        11        5        123        368   
Comprising additions to:                                                 

Property, plant and equipment

     45        12        2        5        15        79   

Assets classified as held for sale

     1        3                             4   

Intangible assets

     78        22        5               108        213   

Investment in associates and joint ventures

     15                                    15   

Other financial assets

     28        25        4                      57   
       167        62        11        5        123        368   

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

115


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

2. Segmental information continued

 
Year ended 31 December 2013    Americas
$m
    Europe
$m
    AMEA
$m
    Greater
China
$m
    Central
$m
    Group
$m
 
Revenue                                                 
Franchised      576        104        16        3               699   
Managed      128        156        170        92               546   
Owned and leased      212        140        44        141               537   
Central                                  121        121   
       916        400        230        236        121        1,903   
      Americas
$m
    Europe
$m
    AMEA
$m
    Greater
China
$m
    Central
$m
    Group
$m
 
Segmental result                                                 
Franchised      499        79        12        5               595   
Managed      74        30        92        51               247   
Owned and leased      30        30        4        47               111   
Regional and central      (53     (34     (22     (21     (155     (285
Reportable segments’ operating profit      550        105        86        82        (155     668   
Exceptional operating items (note 5)      6        19               (10     (10     5   
Operating profit      556        124        86        72        (165     673   
                                         Group
$m
 
Reportable segments’ operating profit                                              668   
Exceptional operating items (note 5)                                              5   
Operating profit                                              673   
Net finance costs                                              (73
Profit before tax                                              600   
Tax                                              (226
Profit for the year                                              374   

All items above relate to continuing operations.

 

 

 

 

116


Table of Contents
 
2. Segmental information continued
 
31 December 2013    Americas
$m
    Europe
$m
    AMEA
$m
    Greater
China
$m
    Central
$m
    Group
(restated1)
$m
 
Assets and liabilities                                                 
Segment assets      851        654        253        392        304        2,454   
Assets classified as held for sale      228                                    228   
       1,079        654        253        392        304        2,682   
Unallocated assets:                                                 

Non-current tax receivable

                                             16   

Deferred tax assets

                                             108   

Current tax receivable

                                             12   

Derivative financial instruments

                                             1   

Cash and cash equivalents

                                             248   
Total assets                                              3,067   
Segment liabilities      (364     (286     (56     (62     (741     (1,509
Unallocated liabilities:                                                 

Current tax payable

                                             (47

Deferred tax liabilities

                                             (175

Loans and other borrowings

                                             (1,399

Derivative financial instruments

                                             (11
Total liabilities                                              (3,141

1     Restated for the adoption of ‘Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities’ (Amendments to IAS 32), see page 107.

        

Year ended 31 December 2013    Americas
$m
    Europe
$m
    AMEA
$m
    Greater
China
$m
    Central
$m
   

Group

$m

 
Other segmental information                                                 
Capital expenditure (see below)      116        37        17        8        91        269   
Non-cash items:                                                 

Depreciation and amortisation1

     19        18        10        15        23        85   

Share-based payments cost

                                 22        22   

Share of profits of associates and joint ventures

     5               3                      8   

 

1     Included in the $85m of depreciation and amortisation is $34m relating to administrative expenses and $51m relating to cost of sales.

        

      Americas
$m
    Europe
$m
    AMEA
$m
    Greater
China
$m
    Central
$m
   

Group

$m

 
Reconciliation of capital expenditure                                                 
Capital expenditure per management reporting      116        37        17        8        91        269   
Management contract acquired on disposal of hotel             40                             40   
Other financial assets relating to pensions             48                      92        140   
Timing differences      8                      (1     8        15   
Additions per the Financial Statements      124        125        17        7        191        464   
Comprising additions to:                                                 

Property, plant and equipment

     93        22        8        7        20        150   

Assets classified as held for sale

     5        3                             8   

Intangible assets

     6        45        5               79        135   

Investment in associates and joint ventures

     6               4                      10   

Other financial assets

     14        55                      92        161   
       124        125        17        7        191        464   

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

117


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

2. Segmental information continued

 
Year ended 31 December 2012    Americas
$m
    Europe
$m
    AMEA
$m
    Greater
China
$m
    Central
$m
    Group
$m
 
Revenue                                                 
Franchised      541        91        18        3               653   
Managed      97        147        152        89               485   
Owned and leased      199        198        48        138               583   
Central                                  114        114   
       837        436        218        230        114        1,835   
      Americas
$m
    Europe
$m
    AMEA
$m
    Greater
China
$m
    Central
$m
    Group
$m
 
Segmental result                                                 
Franchised      466        65        12        4               547   
Managed      48        32        90        51               221   
Owned and leased      24        50        6        45               125   
Regional and central      (52     (35     (20     (19     (162     (288
Reportable segments’ operating profit      486        112        88        81        (162     605   
Exceptional operating items (note 5)      23        (4     (5            (18     (4
Operating profit      509        108        83        81        (180     601   
                                         Group
$m
 
Reportable segments’ operating profit                                              605   
Exceptional operating items (note 5)                                              (4
Operating profit                                              601   
Net finance costs                                              (54
Profit before tax                                              547   
Tax                                              (9
Profit for the year                                              538   
All items above relate to continuing operations.   
Year ended 31 December 2012    Americas
$m
    Europe
$m
    AMEA
$m
    Greater
China
$m
    Central
$m
    Group
$m
 
Other segmental information                                                 
Capital expenditure      25        19        6        7        76        133   
Non-cash items:                                                 

Depreciation and amortisation1

     20        23        14        15        22        94   

Reversal of previously recorded impairment

     (23                                 (23

Write-off of software

                                 18        18   

Demerger liability released

                                 (9     (9

Share-based payments cost

                                 22        22   

Share of profits of associates and joint ventures

                   (3                   (3

 

1 Included in the $94m of depreciation and amortisation is $31m relating to administrative expenses and $63m relating to cost of sales.

 

 

 

 

118


Table of Contents
 
2. Segmental information continued
 
Geographical information   

Year ended
31 December
2014

$m

    

Year ended
31 December
2013

$m

    

Year ended
31 December
2012

$m

 
Revenue                           
United Kingdom      75         90         152   
United States      786         843         769   
People’s Republic of China (including Hong Kong)      254         247         238   
Rest of World      743         723         676   
       1,858         1,903         1,835   

For the purposes of the above table, hotel revenue is determined according to the location of the hotel and other revenue is attributed to the country of origin. In addition to the United Kingdom, revenue relating to an individual country is separately disclosed when it represents 10% or more of total revenue.

 

     

31 December
2014

$m

    

31 December
2013

$m

 
Non-current assets                  
United Kingdom      136         131   
United States      811         705   
France              342   
People’s Republic of China (including Hong Kong)      318         326   
Rest of World      238         268   
       1,503         1,772   

For the purposes of the above table, non-current assets comprise property, plant and equipment, goodwill, intangible assets, investments in associates and joint ventures and trade and other receivables. In addition to the United Kingdom, non-current assets relating to an individual country are separately disclosed when they represent 10% or more of total non-current assets, as defined above.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

119


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

3. Staff costs and Directors’ emoluments

 

 

 

     

2014

$m

    

2013

$m

    

2012

$m

 

Staff

                          
Costs:                           

Wages and salaries

     577         580         547   

Social security costs

     42         41         44   

Pension and other post-retirement benefits:

                          

Defined benefit plans1 (note 25)

     10         10         13   

Defined contribution plans

     28         25         22   
       657         656         626   

1   Before exceptional items.

 

        
      2014      2013      2012  
Average number of employees, including part-time employees:                           

Americas

     2,191         2,548         2,552   

Europe

     1,557         1,602         1,866   

Asia, Middle East and Africa

     1,451         1,545         1,195   

Greater China

     1,092         1,083         1,051   

Central

     1,506         1,401         1,317   
       7,797         8,179         7,981   

The costs of the above employees are borne by IHG. Of these, 92% were employed on a full-time basis and 8% were employed on a part-time basis.

In addition to the above, the Group has employees who work directly on behalf of the System Fund and whose costs are borne by the Fund as disclosed in note 32. In line with IHG’s business model, IHG also employs 602 (2013 578, 2012 587) General Managers who work in the managed hotels and whose total costs of $142m (2013 $135m, 2012 $132m) are borne by those hotels and, in the US predominantly, there are 11,848 (2013 10,834, 2012 11,053) other hotel workers in the managed hotels who have contracts or letters of service with IHG whose total costs of $449m (2013 $383m, 2012 $437m) are borne by those hotels.

 

     

2014

$m

    

2013

$m

    

2012

$m

 
Directors’ emoluments                           
Base salaries, fees, performance payments and benefits¹      9.0              8.5         9.7   
Pension benefits under defined contribution plans           0.2         0.4              0.2   

¹ Excludes ICETUS cash-out payment of £9.4m (see Directors’ Remuneration Report, page 85).

More detailed information on the emoluments, pensions, option holdings and shareholdings for each Director is shown in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 76 to 91.

4. Auditor’s remuneration paid to Ernst & Young LLP

 

 

 

     

2014

$m

    

2013

$m

    

2012

$m

 
Audit of the Financial Statements      2.4         2.0         2.8   
Audit of subsidiaries      2.0         1.4         1.5   
Audit-related assurance services      0.2         0.5         1.0   
Other assurance services      0.9         1.2         1.4   
Tax compliance      0.2         0.2              0.3   
Tax advisory      0.3              0.4         0.2   
Other non-audit services not covered by the above           0.1         0.1           
       6.1         5.8         7.2   

Audit fees in respect of the pension scheme were not material.

 

 

 

120


Table of Contents
 
 

5. Exceptional items

 

 

      Note     

2014

$m

    

2013

$m

    

2012

$m

 
Exceptional operating items                                    
Administrative expenses:                                    

Venezuelan currency loss

     a         (14                

Pension settlement cost

     b         (6      (147        

Reorganisation costs

     c         (29              (16

UK portfolio restructuring

     d         (45                

Kimpton acquisition costs

     e         (7                

Litigation

     f                 (10        

Loyalty programme rebranding costs

     g                 (10        
                (101      (167      (16
Share of profits of associates and joint ventures:                                    

Share of gain on disposal of a hotel (note 14)

                      6           
Other operating income and expenses:                                    

Gain/(loss) on disposal of hotels (note 11)

              130         166         (2

Write-off of software

     h                         (18

Demerger liability released

     i                         9   
                130         166         (11
Reversals of previously recorded impairment:                                    

Property, plant and equipment

     j                         23   
                                23   
                29         5         (4
Tax                                    
Tax on exceptional operating items      k         (29      (6      1   
Exceptional tax      l                 (45      141   
                (29      (51      142   

All items above relate to continuing operations.

The above items are treated as exceptional by reason of their size or nature, as further described on page 112.

 

a Relates to the introduction of the SICAD II exchange rate on 24 March 2014 and its adoption by the Group. Of the three exchange rate mechanisms that currently exist in Venezuela, SICAD II is the most accessible to the Group for converting its bolivar earnings into US dollars. The exceptional loss arises from the one-off re-measurement of the Group’s bolivar assets and liabilities from the ‘official’ exchange rate ($1=6.3 VEF) to the SICAD II exchange rate (approximately $1=50 VEF). The Group has used the SICAD II exchange rate for translating the results of its Venezuelan operations since 1 April 2014.
b In 2014, results from a partial cash-out of the UK unfunded pension arrangements and, in 2013, resulted from a buy-in (and subsequent buy-out in 2014) of the Group’s UK funded defined benefit obligations with the insurer, Rothesay Life. See note 25 for further details.
c In 2014, relates primarily to costs incurred in introducing a new HR operating model across the business to provide enhanced management information and more efficient processes, and to implement more efficient processes and procedures in the Group’s Global Technology infrastructure to help mitigate future cost increases. In 2012, arose from a reorganisation of the Group’s support functions together with a restructuring within the AMEA region.
d Relates to the costs of securing a restructuring of the UK hotel portfolio which will result in the transfer of 61 managed hotels to franchise contracts.
e Relates to acquisition transaction costs incurred in the period to 31 December 2014 on the acquisition of Kimpton, which completed on 16 January 2015 (see note 33).
f Related to an agreed settlement in respect of a lawsuit filed against the Group in the Greater China region.
g Related to costs incurred in support of the worldwide rebranding of IHG Rewards Club that was announced 1 July 2013.
h Software disposals in 2012 included an exceptional write-off of $18m resulting from a re-assessment of the ongoing value of elements of the technology infrastructure.
i Resulted from a release of a liability no longer required which arose on the demerger of the Group from Six Continents PLC.
j In 2012, a previously recorded impairment charge relating to a North American hotel was reversed in full following a re-assessment of its recoverable amount, based on the market value of the hotel as determined by an independent professional property valuer.
k In 2014, the charge comprises $56m relating to the disposal of an 80.1% interest in the InterContinental New York Barclay offset by a credit of $27m relating to a restructuring of the UK hotel portfolio and other reorganisation costs.
l In 2013, comprised a deferred tax charge of $63m consequent on the disposal of the InterContinental London Park Lane hotel, together with charges and credits of $38m and $19m respectively from associated restructurings (including intra-group dividends) and refinancings, offset by the recognition of $37m of previously unrecognised tax credits. In 2012, represented the recognition of $104m of deferred tax assets, principally relating to pre-existing overseas tax losses, whose value had become more certain as a result of a change in law and the resolution of prior period tax matters, together with the associated release of $37m of provisions.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

121


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

6. Finance costs

 

 

     

2014

$m

    

2013

$m

    

2012

$m

 
Financial income                           
Interest income on deposits      2         4         2   
Unwinding of discount on other financial assets      1         1         1   
       3         5         3   
Financial expenses                           
Interest expense on borrowings      66         59         37   
Interest rate swaps fair value transferred from equity                      1   
Finance charge payable under finance leases      19         19         19   
Capitalised interest      (2                
       83         78         57   

Interest income and expense relate to financial assets and liabilities held at amortised cost, calculated using the effective interest rate method.

Included within interest expense is $2m (2013 $2m, 2012 $2m) payable to the IHG Rewards Club loyalty programme relating to interest on the accumulated balance of cash received in advance of the redemption of points awarded.

The rate used for capitalisation of interest was 4.4%.

7. Tax

 

 

Tax on profit    Note     

2014

$m

    

2013

$m

    

2012

$m

 
Income tax                                    
UK corporation tax at 21.50% (2013 23.25%, 2012 24.50%):                                    

Current period

              5         62         21   

Benefit of tax reliefs on which no deferred tax previously recognised

     a                 (49        

Adjustments in respect of prior periods

     b         2                 (34
                7         13         (13
Foreign tax:      c                              

Current period

              156         184         170   

Benefit of tax reliefs on which no deferred tax previously recognised

              (2      (42      (31

Adjustments in respect of prior periods

     b         (26      (17      (27
                128         125         112   
Total current tax               135         138         99   
Deferred tax:                                    

Origination and reversal of temporary differences

              68         122         7   

Changes in tax rates

              2         (1      (2

Adjustments to estimated recoverable deferred tax assets

              1         (39      (105

Adjustments in respect of prior periods

              2         6         10   
Total deferred tax               73         88         (90
Total income tax charge for the year               208         226         9   
Further analysed as tax relating to:                                    

Profit before exceptional items

              179         175         151   

Exceptional items:

                                   

Exceptional operating items (note 5)

              29         6         (1

Exceptional tax (note 5)

                      45         (141
                208         226         9   

All items above relate to continuing operations.

 

a In 2013, included $45m in respect of the utilisation of unrecognised capital losses against the gain on disposal of the InterContinental London Park Lane hotel.
b In 2012, included $37m of exceptional credits included within exceptional tax (see note 5) together with other releases relating to tax matters which have been settled or in respect of which the relevant statutory limitation period has expired.
c Represents corporate income taxes on profit taxable in foreign jurisdictions, a significant proportion of which relates to the Group’s US subsidiaries.

 

 

 

122


Table of Contents
 
7. Tax continued
 
     Total1      Before exceptional items2  
      2014
%
    

2013

%

     2012
%
    

2014

%

    

2013

%

    

2012

%

 
Reconciliation of tax charge, including gain on disposal of assets                                                      
UK corporation tax at standard rate      21.5         23.3         24.5         21.5         23.3         24.5   
Non-deductible expenditure and non-taxable income      4.9         16.6         2.0         1.0         1.9         1.0   
Non-recoverable withholding taxes      0.4         1.2         2.0         0.4         1.2         2.0   
Net effect of different rates of tax in overseas businesses      11.5         11.6         7.7         12.8         11.9         7.8   
Effect of changes in tax rates      0.3         (0.1      (0.3      0.1         (0.1      (0.1
Benefit of tax reliefs on which no deferred tax previously recognised      (0.4      (15.0      (5.6      (0.3      (1.1      (5.6
Effect of adjustments to estimated recoverable deferred tax assets      0.2         (6.4      (19.4      (0.2      (4.9      (0.2
Adjustment to tax charge in respect of prior periods      (3.7      (2.2      (9.8      (3.9      (2.1      (2.5
Deferred tax provision on unremitted earnings              10.5                                   
Other              (1.8      0.4                 (0.6      0.5   
       34.7         37.7         1.5         31.4         29.5         27.4   

 

1  Calculated in relation to total profits including exceptional items.
2  Calculated in relation to profits excluding exceptional items.

Tax paid

Total net tax paid during the year of $136m (2013 $97m, 2012 $122m) comprises $136m (2013 $92m, 2012 $119m) paid in respect of operating activities and $nil (2013 $5m, 2012 $3m) paid in respect of investing activities.

Tax paid represents an effective rate of 23% (2013 16%, 2012 22%) on total profits and is lower than the effective income statement tax rate of 31% (2013 29%, 2012 27%) primarily due to the impact of deferred taxes (including the realisation of assets such as tax losses), the receipt of refunds in respect of prior years and provisions for tax for which no payment of tax has currently been made.

Corporation tax liabilities did not arise in 2014 in the UK and are not expected to arise for a number of years thereafter due to expenses and associated tax losses attributable principally to employment matters, in particular additional shortfall contributions made to the UK pension plan in the years 2007 to 2013.

Deferred tax

 

     

Property,

plant and

equipment

$m

   

Deferred

gains on

loan notes

$m

   

Deferred

gains on

investments

$m

    

Losses

$m

   

Employee

benefits

$m

   

Intangible

assets

$m

   

Undistributed

earnings of

subsidiaries

$m

   

Other

short-term

temporary

differences1

$m

   

Total

$m

 
At 1 January 2013      236        114                (215     (63     33               (155     (50
Income statement      1        (8             20        2        2        63        8        88   
Statement of comprehensive income                                   24                             24   
Statement of changes in equity                                                        4        4   
Exchange and other adjustments      3        1                9               (1     3        (14     1   
At 31 December 2013      240        107                (186     (37     34        66        (157     67   
Income statement      (55            108         17        3        22        (19     (3     73   
Statement of comprehensive income                                   (8                   1        (7
Statement of changes in equity                                                        (3     (3
Exchange and other adjustments      (11     (2             15        1        (4     (3            (4
At 31 December 2014      174        105        108         (154     (41     52        44        (162     126   

1   Primarily relates to provisions, accruals, amortisation and share-based payments.

      

                                                       

2014

$m

   

2013

$m

 
Analysed as:                                                                          

Deferred tax assets

                                                              (87     (108

Deferred tax liabilities

                                                              147        175   

Liabilities held for sale

                                                              66          
                                                                126        67   

Deferred gains on loan notes includes $55m (2013 $55m) which is expected to fall due for payment in 2016.

The deferred tax asset recognised in respect of losses of $154m (2013 $186m) includes $50m (2013 $53m) in respect of capital losses available to be utilised against the realisation of capital gains which are recognised as a deferred tax liability and $104m (2013 $133m) in respect of revenue tax losses. Deferred tax assets of $20m (2013 $17m) are recognised in relation to legal entities which suffered a tax loss in the current or preceding period. These assets are recognised based upon future taxable profit forecasts for the entities concerned. Deferred gains on investments represent taxable gains which would crystallise upon a sale of a related joint venture, associate or other equity investment. The balance relates to the Barclay associate described in note 14.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

123


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

7. Tax continued

 

The Group has unrecognised deferred tax assets as follows:

 

      2014
$m
     2013
$m
 
Revenue losses      126         127   
Capital losses      130         85   
Total losses1      256         212   
Employee benefits      5         16   
Other2      58         55   
Total      319         283   

 

1  These may be carried forward indefinitely other than $11m which expires after two years, $1m which expires after six years, $8m which expires after seven years, $1m which expires after eight years and $2m which expires after nine years (2013 $12m which expires after three years and $1m which expires after seven years, $1m which expires after eight years and $9m which expires after nine years).
2  Primarily relates to provisions, accruals, amortisation and share-based payments.

These assets have not been recognised as the Group does not currently anticipate being able to offset these against future profits or gains in order to realise any economic benefit in the foreseeable future. However, future benefits may arise as a result of resolving tax uncertainties, or as a consequence of case law and legislative developments which make the value of the assets more certain.

The Group has provided deferred tax in relation to temporary differences associated with post-acquisition undistributed earnings of subsidiaries only to the extent that it is either probable that it will reverse in the foreseeable future or where the Group cannot control the timing of the reversal. The remaining unprovided liability that would arise on the reversal of these temporary differences is not expected to exceed $10m (2013 $10m).

Tax risks, policies and governance

Information concerning the Group’s tax governance can be found in the Taxation section of the Strategic Report on page 49.

8. Dividends and shareholder returns

 

 

      2014
cents per
share
     2013
cents per
share
     2012
cents per
share
     2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2012
$m
 
Paid during the year:                                                      

Final (declared for previous year)

     47.0         43.0         39.0         122         115         113   

Interim

     25.0         23.0         21.0         57         63         61   

Special (note 27)

     293.0         133.0         172.0         763         355         505   
       365.0         199.0         232.0         942         533         679   
Proposed (not recognised as a liability at 31 December):                                                      

Final

     52.0         47.0         43.0         122         121         115   

The final dividend of 33.8p (52.0¢ converted at the closing exchange rate on 13 February 2015) is proposed for approval at the Annual General Meeting (AGM) on 8 May 2015 and is payable on the shares in issue at 7 April 2015.

Under the $500m share repurchase programme announced 7 August 2012, in the year to 31 December 2014, 3.4m (2013 9.8m, 2012 4.1m) shares were repurchased for a consideration of $110m (2013 $283m, 2012 $107m), increasing the total amount repurchased to $500m. Of the 3.4m (2013 9.8m, 2012 4.1m) shares repurchased in 2014, 2.7m (2013 9.8m, 2012 nil) are held as treasury shares and 0.7m (2013 nil, 2012 4.1m) were cancelled. The cost of treasury shares has been deducted from retained earnings.

On 2 May 2014, the Company announced a $750m return to shareholders by way of a special dividend and share consolidation. On 30 June 2014, shareholders approved the share consolidation at a General Meeting of the Company on the basis of 12 new ordinary shares of 15 265329p per share for every 13 existing ordinary shares of 14 194329p each, which became effective on 1 July 2014. The special dividend of 293.0¢ per share was paid to shareholders on 14 July 2014.

 

 

 

124


Table of Contents
 
 

9. Earnings per ordinary share

 

Basic earnings per ordinary share is calculated by dividing the profit for the year available for IHG equity holders by the weighted average number of ordinary shares, excluding investment in own shares, in issue during the year.

Diluted earnings per ordinary share is calculated by adjusting basic earnings per ordinary share to reflect the notional exercise of the weighted average number of dilutive ordinary share awards outstanding during the year.

Adjusted earnings per ordinary share is disclosed in order to show performance undistorted by exceptional items, to give a more meaningful comparison of the Group’s performance.

 

Continuing and total operations    2014      2013      2012  
Basic earnings per ordinary share                           
Profit available for equity holders ($m)      391         372         537   
Basic weighted average number of ordinary shares (millions)      247         264         287   
Basic earnings per ordinary share (cents)      158.3         140.9         187.1   
Diluted earnings per ordinary share                           
Profit available for equity holders ($m)      391         372         537   
Diluted weighted average number of ordinary shares (millions)      250         267         292   
Diluted earnings per ordinary share (cents)      156.4         139.3         183.9   
Adjusted earnings per ordinary share                           
Profit available for equity holders ($m)      391         372         537   
Adjusting items (note 5):                           

Exceptional operating items ($m)

     (29      (5      4   

Tax on exceptional operating items ($m)

     29         6         (1

Exceptional tax ($m)

             45         (141
Adjusted earnings ($m)      391         418         399   
Basic weighted average number of ordinary shares (millions)      247         264         287   
Adjusted earnings per ordinary share (cents)      158.3         158.3         139.0   
Adjusted diluted earnings per ordinary share                           
Adjusted earnings ($m)      391         418         399   
Diluted weighted average number of ordinary shares (millions)      250         267         292   
Adjusted diluted earnings per ordinary share (cents)      156.4         156.6         136.6   
     

2014

millions

    

2013

millions

    

2012

millions

 
Diluted weighted average number of ordinary shares is calculated as:                           

Basic weighted average number of ordinary shares

     247         264         287   

Dilutive potential ordinary shares

     3         3         5   
       250         267         292   

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

125


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

10. Property, plant and equipment

 

 

      Land and
buildings
$m
    Fixtures,
fittings and
equipment
$m
    Total
$m
 
Cost                         
At 1 January 2013      995        824        1,819   
Additions      96        54        150   
Disposals      (2     (8     (10
Exchange and other adjustments      12        1        13   
At 31 December 2013      1,101        871        1,972   
Additions      27        52        79   
Transfers to non-current assets classified as held for sale      (276     (171     (447
Disposals      (144     (61     (205
Exchange and other adjustments      (8     (20     (28
At 31 December 2014      700        671        1,371   
Depreciation and impairment                         
At 1 January 2013      (146     (617     (763
Provided      (11     (35     (46
System Fund expense             (4     (4
Disposals      2        8        10   
Exchange and other adjustments      (1     1          
At 31 December 2013      (156     (647     (803
Provided      (11     (32     (43
System Fund expense             (4     (4
Transfers to non-current assets classified as held for sale      8        107        115   
Disposals      37        58        95   
Exchange and other adjustments             10        10   
At 31 December 2014      (122     (508     (630
Net book value                         
At 31 December 2014      578        163        741   
At 31 December 2013      945        224        1,169   
At 1 January 2013      849        207        1,056   

The Group’s property, plant and equipment mainly comprises hotels, but also offices, throughout the world. In addition to the hotels included above, there was one hotel (2013 one hotel) classified as held for sale at 31 December 2014 (see note 11). Including the hotels classified as held for sale, 75% (2013 81%) of the net book value relates to the three (2013 four) largest owned and leased hotels (in terms of net book value) of a total of 10 hotels (2013 12 hotels), nine of which are open (2013 nine open). At 31 December 2014, there was one hotel (2013 three hotels) with a net book value of $36m (2013 $70m) which is under construction, not yet in use and therefore not being depreciated.

The carrying value of property, plant and equipment held under finance leases at 31 December 2014 was $186m (2013 $187m).

Including assets classified as held for sale, 40% (2013 55%) of hotel properties by net book value were directly owned, with 22% (2013 39%) held under leases having a term of 50 years or longer.

All impairment charges and reversals are included within impairment on the face of the Group income statement.

There are no charges over the Group’s property, plant and equipment.

The table below analyses the net book value of the Group’s property, plant and equipment by operating segment at 31 December 2014:

 

      Americas
$m
     Europe
$m
     AMEA
$m
     Greater
China
$m
     Central
$m
     Total
$m
 
Land and buildings      302                 7         254         15         578   
Fixtures, fittings and equipment      40                 11         44         68         163   
       342                 18         298         83         741   

 

 

 

126


Table of Contents
 
11. Assets sold and held for sale
 

Assets sold

Principal disposals during the year ended 31 December 2014 were the sale of the InterContinental Mark Hopkins San Francisco on 27 March 2014 and the disposal of an 80.1% interest in the InterContinental New York Barclay on 31 March 2014. The Group’s 19.9% retained interest is accounted for as an associate as described in note 14. Both transactions took place in the Americas region.

During the year ended 31 December 2013, the Group sold one hotel in the Europe region, the InterContinental London Park Lane.

During the year ended 31 December 2012, the Group sold an interest in a hotel in the Europe region.

 

      2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2012
$m
 
Consideration                           
Current year disposals:                           

Cash consideration, net of costs paid

     345         460         4   

Other financial assets¹

     52                   

Intangible assets – management contracts

     50         40           

Investment in associate

     22                   
       469         500         4   
Net assets disposed:                           

Property, plant and equipment

     (110              (6

Non-current assets held for sale

     (228      (294        

Other financial asset

     (5                

Net current liabilities

     4         6           
       (339      (288      (6
Exchange losses recycled from currency translation reserve              (46        
Gain/(loss) on disposal of hotels from continuing operations      130         166         (2
Net cash inflow                           
Current year disposals:                           

Cash consideration, net of costs paid

     345         460         4   

Distribution from associate on sale of hotel

             17           

Tax

             (5        
Prior year disposals:                           

Tax

                     (3
       345         472         1   

 

1  Includes $27m deferred consideration subsequently received and included within Proceeds from other financial assets in the Group statement of cash flows.

Assets held for sale

One hotel, the InterContinental Paris – Le Grand, met the held for sale criteria of IFRS 5 at 31 December 2014. More information can be found in the performance section of the Strategic Report on page 34. One hotel, the InterContinental New York Barclay, was held for sale at 31 December 2013.

 

      2014
$m
     2013
$m
 
Assets and liabilities held for sale                  
Assets classified as held for sale:                  

Property, plant and equipment

     306         228   

Other assets

     4           
       310         228   
Liabilities classified as held for sale:                  

Deferred tax (note 7)

     (66        

Other liabilities

     (28        
       (94        

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

127


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

12. Goodwill

 

 

      2014
$m
     2013
$m
 
Cost                  
At 1 January      221         234   
Exchange adjustments      (6      (13
At 31 December      215         221   
Impairment                  
At 1 January and 31 December      (141      (141
Net book value                  
At 31 December      74         80   
At 1 January      80         93   

Goodwill arising on business combinations that occurred before 1 January 2005 was not restated on adoption of IFRS as permitted by IFRS 1.

All cumulative impairment losses relate to the Americas managed cash-generating unit (CGU).

Goodwill has been allocated to CGUs for impairment testing as follows:

 

             Cost                  Net book value  
      2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2014
$m
     2013
$m
 
AMEA franchised and managed operations      74         80                 74         80   
Americas managed operations      141         141                   
       215         221         74         80   

Asia, Middle East and Africa (AMEA) goodwill

The Group tests goodwill for impairment annually, or more frequently if there are any indications that an impairment may have arisen. The recoverable amounts of the CGUs are determined from value in use calculations. These calculations use pre-tax cash flow forecasts derived from the most recent financial budgets and strategic plans approved by management covering a five-year period using growth rates based on management’s past experience and industry growth forecasts.

At 31 December 2014, the recoverable amount of the CGU has been assessed based on the approved budget for 2015 and strategic plans covering a five-year period, a perpetual growth rate of 3.5% (2013 3.5%) and a discount rate of 13.7% (2013 15.5%). The perpetual growth rates do not exceed the average long-term growth rates for the relevant markets. Pre-tax discount rates are used to discount the cash flows based on the Group’s weighted average cost of capital adjusted to reflect the risks specific to the business model and territory of the CGU being tested.

Impairment was not required at either 31 December 2014 or 31 December 2013 and management have determined that the carrying value of the CGU would only exceed its recoverable amount in the event of highly unlikely changes in the key assumptions.

 

 

 

128


Table of Contents
 
13. Intangible assets
 
      Software
$m
    Management
contracts $m
    Other
intangibles
$m
    Total
$m
 
Cost                                 
At 1 January 2013      325        235        151        711   
Additions      79        40        16        135   
Disposals      (8            (7     (15
Exchange and other adjustments      (1     2        (1       
At 31 December 2013      395        277        159        831   
Additions      108        50        55        213   
Disposals      (31            (5     (36
Exchange and other adjustments      (1     (17     (2     (20
At 31 December 2014      471        310        207        988   
Amortisation and impairment                                 
At 1 January 2013      (163     (126     (68     (357
Provided      (21     (7     (11     (39
System Fund expense      (12                   (12
Disposals      8               7        15   
Exchange and other adjustments      (1     2        (1       
At 31 December 2013      (189     (131     (73     (393
Provided      (33     (9     (11     (53
System Fund expense      (15                   (15
Disposals      31               4        35   
Exchange and other adjustments      (1     6        2        7   
At 31 December 2014      (207     (134     (78     (419
Net book value                                 
At 31 December 2014      264        176        129        569   
At 31 December 2013      206        146        86        438   
At 1 January 2013      162        109        83        354   

Substantially all software additions are internally developed.

Additions to management contracts relate to contract values recognised as part of the proceeds for hotels sold (see note 11).

The weighted average remaining amortisation period for management contracts is 30 years (2013 24 years).

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

129


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

14. Investment in associates and joint ventures

 

 

      Associates
$m
    Joint
ventures
$m
          Total
$m
 
Cost                         
At 1 January 2013      59        28        87   
Additions      8        2        10   
Capital returns             (3     (3
Share of profits      2               2   
Dividends      (5            (5
Exchange and other adjustments      (3            (3
At 31 December 2013      61        27        88   
Initial retained interest in Barclay associate (note 11)      22               22   
Additions      15               15   
Share of (losses)/profits      (4            (4
Dividends      (2            (2
At 31 December 2014      92        27        119   
Impairment                         
At 1 January 2013, 31 December 2013 and 31 December 2014      (3            (3
Net book value                         
At 31 December 2014      89        27        116   
At 31 December 2013      58        27        85   
At 1 January 2013      56        28        84   

Barclay associate

The Group held one material associate investment at 31 December 2014, a 19.9% interest in 111 East 48th Street Holdings, LLC (‘the Barclay associate’) which owns the InterContinental New York Barclay, a hotel managed by the Group. The investment is classified as an associate and equity accounted as the Group has the ability to exercise significant influence through its involvement in the redevelopment of the hotel and certain decision rights.

Summarised financial information in respect of the Barclay associate is set out below:

 

     

31 December

2014

$m

 
Non-current assets      339   
Net current assets      2   
Non-current liabilities      (182
Equity      159   
Group carrying amount (19.9%)      32   
     

9 months to

31 December

2014

$m

 
Revenue      24   
Loss for the period      (26
Group’s share of loss for the period (19.9%)      (5

The Barclay associate classification was effective 31 March 2014.

Other associates and joint ventures

The summarised aggregated financial information for individually immaterial associates and joint ventures is set out below. These are mainly investments in entities that own hotels which the Group manages.

 

     Associates      Joint ventures      Total  
              2014
$m
     2013
$m
    

2012

$m

             2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2012
$m
             2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2012
$m
 
Share of profit/(loss)                                                                                 
Operating profit/(loss) before exceptional items      1         2         3                                 1         2         3   
Exceptional items              6                                                 6           
       1         8         3                                 1         8         3   

The exceptional profit in 2013 arose on the sale of a hotel owned by an associate investment that was classified as held for sale at 31 December 2012. Following completion of the sale, the Group received a $17m cash distribution from the associate, being the Group’s share of the net disposal proceeds.

 

 

 

130


Table of Contents
 
15. Other financial assets
 
      2014
$m
       2013
$m
 
Equity securities available-for-sale:                  

Quoted equity shares

     16         9   

Unquoted equity shares

     128         127   
       144         136   
Loans and receivables:                  

Trade deposits and loans

     43         20   

Restricted funds

     21         40   

Bank accounts pledged as security

     49         52   
       113         112   
Total other financial assets      257         248   
Analysed as:                  

Current

     5         12   

Non-current

     252         236   
       257         248   

Equity securities available-for-sale are measured at fair value (see note 23) and loans and receivables are held at amortised cost.

Equity securities available-for-sale were denominated in the following currencies: US dollars $94m (2013 $84m), Hong Kong dollars $34m (2013 $27m) and other currencies $16m (2013 $25m). Unlisted equity shares are mainly investments in entities that own hotels which the Group manages. Dividend income from available-for-sale equity securities of $10m (2013 $6m) is reported as other operating income and expenses in the Group income statement.

Trade deposits and loans include a deposit of $37m made in 2011 to a hotel owner in connection with the renegotiation of a management contract. The deposit is non-interest-bearing and repayable at the end of the management contract, and is therefore held at its discounted value of $13m (2013 $12m); the discount unwinds to the income statement within financial income over the period to repayment.

Restricted funds include cash held in bank accounts which is pledged as collateral to insurance companies for risks retained by the Group and other amounts held in escrow.

The bank accounts pledged as security (£31m) are subject to a charge in favour of the members of the UK unfunded pension arrangement (see note 25).

The movement in the provision for impairment of other financial assets during the year is as follows:

 

      2014
$m
       2013
$m
 
At 1 January      (25      (26
Amounts written off              1   
Exchange and other adjustments      (3        
At 31 December      (28      (25

The provision is used to record impairment losses unless the Group is satisfied that no recovery of the amount is possible; at that point the amount considered irrecoverable is either written off directly to the income statement or, if previously provided, against the financial asset with no impact on the income statement.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

131


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

16. Trade and other receivables

 

 

                     
     

2014

$m

    

2013

$m

 
Current                  
Trade receivables      327         336   
Other receivables      47         20   
Prepayments      63         65   
Receivables from associates      11         2   
       448         423   
Non-current                  
Loans to associates      3           

Trade and other receivables are designated as loans and receivables and are held at amortised cost.

Trade receivables are non-interest-bearing and are generally on payment terms of up to 30 days. The fair value of trade and other receivables approximates their carrying value.

The maximum exposure to credit risk for trade and other receivables, excluding prepayments, at the end of the reporting period by geographic region is:

 

      2014
$m
        2013
$m
 
Americas      221         193   
Europe      76         78   
Asia, Middle East and Africa      53         53   
Greater China      38         34   
       388         358   

The ageing of trade and other receivables, excluding prepayments, at the end of the reporting period is:

 

     2014     

 

   2013  
      Gross
$m
     Provision
$m
       Net
$m
           Gross
$m
     Provision
$m
       Net
$m
 
Not past due      275                   275              236                   236   
Past due 1 to 30 days      57         (3        54              66         (4        62   
Past due 31 to 180 days      57         (3        54              57         (3        54   
Past due more than 180 days      46         (41        5              42         (36        6   
       435         (47        388              401         (43        358   

The credit risk relating to balances not past due is not deemed to be significant.

The movement in the provision for impairment of trade and other receivables during the year is as follows:

 

                                
      2014
$m
    2013
$m
    2012
$m
 
At 1 January      (43     (47     (46
Provided      (22     (18     (18
Amounts written back      9        14        10   
Amounts written off      9        8        7   
At 31 December      (47     (43     (47

 

 

 

132


Table of Contents
 
 

17. Cash and cash equivalents

 

 

     

2014

$m

    

2013

(restated1)

$m

     2012
(restated1)
$m
 
Cash at bank and in hand      157         177         249   
Short-term deposits      5         71         138   
       162         248         387   

 

1  Restated for the adoption of ‘Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities’ (Amendments to IAS 32), see page 107.

Cash at bank and in hand includes bank balances of $108m (2013 $114m, 2012 $194m) which are matched by bank overdrafts of $107m (2013 $114m, 2012 $192m) under the Group’s cash pooling arrangements. Under these arrangements, each pool contains a number of bank accounts with the same financial institution and the Group pays interest on net overdraft balances within each pool. The cash pools are used for day-to-day cash management purposes and are managed as closely as possible to a zero balance on a net basis for each pool. Overseas subsidiaries are typically in a cash positive position with the matching overdrafts held by the Group’s central treasury company in the UK.

For the purposes of the Group statement of cash flows, cash and cash equivalents comprise the following:

 

      2014
$m
    2013
(restated1)
$m
    2012
(restated1)
$m
 
Cash at bank and in hand      157        177        249   
Short-term deposits      5        71        138   
       162        248        387   
Bank overdrafts (note 21)      (107     (114     (192
       55        134        195   

 

1  Restated for the adoption of ‘Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities’ (Amendments to IAS 32), see page 107.

Short-term deposits are highly liquid investments with an original maturity of three months or less.

Cash and cash equivalents includes $4m (2013 $12m, 2012 $7m) that is not available for use by the Group due to local exchange controls in Venezuela and Argentina.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

133


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

18. Trade and other payables

 

 

                         
      2014
$m
     2013
$m
 
Current                  
Trade payables      88         97   
Other tax and social security payable      49         32   
Other payables      317         335   
Accruals      315         284   
       769         748   
                   
Non-current                  
Other payables      627         574   

Trade payables are non-interest-bearing and are normally settled within an average of 45 days.

Other payables include $725m (2013 $649m) relating to the future redemption liability of the Group’s loyalty programme, of which $132m (2013 $120m) is classified as current and $593m (2013 $529m) as non-current.

19. Provisions

 

 

     

Onerous
management
contracts

$m

   

Litigation

$m

   

Total

$m

 
At 1 January 2013      2               2   
Provided             4        4   
Utilised      (1     (2     (3
At 31 December 2013      1        2        3   
Provided             9        9   
Utilised      (1     (1     (2
At 31 December 2014             10        10   
            

2014

$m

   

2013

$m

 
Analysed as:                         

Current

             1        3   

Non-current

             9          
               10        3   

The onerous management contracts provision relates to the unavoidable net cash outflows that are expected to be incurred under performance guarantees associated with certain management contracts.

Litigation during 2014 relates to actions brought against the Group in the Americas region relating to System Fund activity and, during 2013, largely relates to the Greater China region.

 

 

 

134


Table of Contents
 
20. Financial risk management
 

Overview

The Group’s treasury policy is to manage financial risks that arise in relation to underlying business needs. The activities of the treasury function are carried out in accordance with Board approved policies and are subject to regular audit. The treasury function does not operate as a profit centre.

The treasury function seeks to reduce the financial risks faced by the Group and manages liquidity to meet all foreseeable cash needs. Treasury activities may include money market investments, spot and forward foreign exchange instruments, currency swaps, interest rate swaps and forward rate agreements. One of the primary objectives of the Group’s treasury risk management policy is to mitigate the adverse impact of movements in interest rates and foreign exchange rates.

Market risk exposure

The US dollar is the predominant currency of the Group’s revenue and cash flows. Movements in foreign exchange rates can affect the Group’s reported profit, net assets and interest cover. To hedge translation exposure, wherever possible, the Group matches the currency of its debt (either directly or via derivatives) to the currency of its net assets, whilst maximising the amount of US dollars borrowed to reflect the predominant trading currency.

From time to time, foreign exchange transaction exposure is managed by the forward purchase or sale of foreign currencies. Most significant exposures of the Group are in currencies that are freely convertible.

A general strengthening of the US dollar (specifically a five cent fall in the sterling: US dollar rate) would increase the Group’s profit before tax by an estimated $4.5m (2013 $4.1m, 2012 $2.8m) and increase net assets by an estimated $29.1m (2013 $16.0m, 2012 $1.8m). Similarly, a five cent fall in the euro:US dollar rate would reduce the Group’s profit before tax by an estimated $2.2m (2013 $2.6m, 2012 $2.3m) and decrease net assets by an estimated $10.9m (2013 $14.8m, 2012 $16.1m).

Interest rate exposure is managed, using interest rate swaps if appropriate, within set parameters depending on the term of the debt, with a minimum fixed proportion of 25% of borrowings for each major currency. No interest rate swaps were used during 2013 or 2014. Based on the year-end net debt position plus the $400m bilateral term loan drawn in 2015 to finance the Kimpton acquisition (see note 21), a one percentage point rise in US dollar interest rates would increase the annual net interest charge by $6.7m. A similar rise in euro interest rates would increase the annual net interest charge by approximately $0.9m, and a similar rise in sterling interest rates would reduce the annual net interest charge by approximately $0.7m. 100% of borrowings in major currencies were fixed rate debt at 31 December 2013.

Liquidity risk exposure

The treasury function ensures that the Group has access to sufficient funds to allow the implementation of the strategy set by the Board. Medium and long-term borrowing requirements are met through the $1.07bn Syndicated Facility which expires in November 2016, through the £250m 6% bonds that are repayable on 9 December 2016 and through the £400m 3.875% bonds repayable on 28 November 2022. The bonds were issued under the Group’s £750m Medium Term Notes programme. Short-term borrowing requirements are met from drawings under bilateral bank facilities.

The Syndicated Facility contains two financial covenants: interest cover and net debt divided by earnings before interest, tax, depreciation and amortisation (EBITDA). The Group has been in compliance with all of the financial covenants in its loan documents throughout the year, none of which is expected to present a material restriction on funding in the near future.

At the year end, the Group had cash of $162m which is predominantly held in short-term deposits and cash funds which allow daily withdrawals of cash. The Group also had overdrafts of $107m as part of cash pooling arrangements (see note 17). Most of the Group’s funds are held in the UK or US, although $4m (2013 $12m) is held in countries where repatriation is restricted as a result of foreign exchange regulations.

The Group had net liabilities of $717m at 31 December 2014 reflecting that its brands, in accordance with accounting standards, are not recorded on the balance sheet.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

135


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

20. Financial risk management continued

 

Credit risk exposure

Credit risk on treasury transactions is minimised by operating a policy on the investment of surplus cash that generally restricts counterparties to those with an A credit rating or better or those providing adequate security. In order to manage the Group’s credit risk exposure, the treasury function sets counterparty exposure limits using metrics including credit ratings, the relative placing of credit default swap pricings, Tier 1 capital and share price volatility of the relevant counterparty.

The Group trades only with recognised, creditworthy third parties. It is the Group’s policy that all customers who wish to trade on credit terms are subject to credit verification procedures.

In respect of credit risk arising from financial assets, the Group’s exposure to credit risk arises from default of the counterparty, with a maximum exposure equal to the carrying amount of these instruments.

Capital risk management

The Group manages its capital to ensure that it will be able to continue as a going concern. The capital structure consists of net debt, issued share capital and reserves totalling $808m at 31 December 2014 (2013 $1,071m). The structure is managed to maintain an investment grade credit rating, to provide ongoing returns to shareholders and to service debt obligations, whilst maintaining maximum operational flexibility. A key characteristic of IHG’s managed and franchised business model is that it is highly cash generative, with a high return on capital employed. Surplus cash is either reinvested in the business, used to repay debt or returned to shareholders. The Group’s debt is monitored on the basis of a cash flow leverage ratio, being net debt divided by EBITDA, with the objective of maintaining an investment grade credit rating.

Hedging

Interest rate risk

The Group hedges its interest rate risk by ensuring that interest flows are fixed on at least 25% of its borrowings in major currencies. If required, the Group uses interest rate swaps to manage the exposure although none were held during 2013 or 2014. The Group designates interest rate swaps as cash flow hedges.

Foreign currency risk

The Group is exposed to foreign currency risk on income streams denominated in foreign currencies. From time to time, the Group hedges a portion of forecast foreign currency income by taking out forward exchange contracts. The designated risk is the spot foreign exchange risk. There were no such contracts in place at either 31 December 2014 or 31 December 2013.

Hedge of net investment in foreign operations

The Group designates its foreign currency bank borrowings and currency derivatives as net investment hedges of foreign operations. The designated risk is the spot foreign exchange risk for loans and short dated derivatives. The interest on these financial instruments is taken through financial income or expense.

At 31 December 2014, the Group held no currency swaps (2013 $415m) and short dated foreign exchange swaps with principals of 220m (2013 75m) and $31m (2013 $100m) (see note 22 for further details). The maximum amount of foreign exchange derivatives held during the year as net investment hedges and measured at calendar quarter ends were currency swaps with a principal of $415m (2013 $415m) and short dated foreign exchange swaps with principals of 220m (2013 75m) and $165m (2013 $310m).

Hedge effectiveness is measured at calendar quarter ends. No ineffectiveness arose in respect of either the Group’s cash flow or net investment hedges during the current or prior year.

 

 

 

136


Table of Contents
 
20. Financial risk management continued
 

Liquidity risk

The following are the undiscounted contractual cash flows of financial liabilities, including interest payments:

 

    

Less than
1 year

$m

   

Between 1 and
2 years

$m

   

Between 2 and
5 years

$m

   

More than
5 years

$m

    

Total

$m

 

31 December 2014

                                        
Non-derivative financial liabilities:                                         

Bank overdrafts

    107                              107   

Unsecured bank loans

    361                              361   

Secured bank loans

    3                              3   

£250m 6% bonds 2016

    23        414                       437   

£400m 3.875% bonds 2022

    24        24        73        697         818   

Finance lease obligations

    16        16        48        3,284         3,364   

Trade and other payables

    769        174        194        345         1,482   

Provisions

    1        9                       10   
Derivative financial liabilities:                                         

Forward foreign exchange contracts

    (2                           (2
    

Less than
1 year

$m

   

Between 1 and
2 years

$m

   

Between 2 and
5 years

$m

   

More than
5 years

$m

    

Total

$m

 
31 December 2013 (restated1)                                         
Non-derivative financial liabilities:                                         

Bank overdrafts

    114                              114   

Secured bank loans

           4                       4   

£250m 6% bonds 2016

    25        25        438                488   

£400m 3.875% bonds 2022

    26        26        77        764         893   

Finance lease obligations

    16        16        48        3,300         3,380   

Trade and other payables

    748        162        193        289         1,392   

Provisions

    3                              3   
Derivative financial liabilities:                                         

Forward foreign exchange contracts

    (1                           (1

Currency swaps – outflows

    26        26        441                493   

                           – inflows

    (25     (25     (438             (488

1   Restated for the adoption of ‘Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities’ (Amendments to IAS 32), see page 107.

Trade and other payables includes the cash flows relating to the future redemption liability of the Group’s loyalty programme. The repayment profile has been determined by actuaries based on expected redemption profiles and could in reality be different from expectations.

Credit risk

The carrying amount of financial assets represents the maximum exposure to credit risk.

 

                         
     

2014

$m

    

2013

(restated1)

$m

 
Cash and cash equivalents      162         248   
Equity securities available-for-sale      144         136   
Derivative financial instruments      2         1   
Loans and receivables:                  

Other financial assets

     113         112   

Trade and other receivables, excluding prepayments

     388         358   
       809         855   

1   Restated for the adoption of ‘Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities’ (Amendments to IAS 32), see page 107.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

137


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

21. Loans and other borrowings

 

 

    

2014

         

2013

(restated1)

 
     

Current

$m

    

Non-current

$m

    

Total

$m

          

Current

$m

    

Non-current

$m

    

Total

$m

 
Bank overdrafts      107                 107              114                 114   
Unsecured bank loans              359         359                                
Secured bank loan      3                 3                      4         4   
Finance lease obligations      16         202         218              16         199         215   
£250m 6% bonds 2016              390         390                      412         412   
£400m 3.875% bonds 2022              618         618                      654         654   
Total borrowings      126         1,569         1,695              130         1,269         1,399   
                                                            
Denominated in the following currencies:                                                           
Sterling      20         1,008         1,028              17         1,066         1,083   
US dollars      87         470         557              96         199         295   
Euros      12         91         103              11                 11   
Other      7                 7              6         4         10   
       126         1,569         1,695              130         1,269         1,399   

1   Restated for the adoption of ‘Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities’ (Amendments to IAS 32), see page 107.

Bank overdrafts

Bank overdrafts are matched by equivalent amounts of cash and cash equivalents under the Group’s cash pooling arrangements (see note 17 for further details).

Unsecured bank loans

Unsecured bank loans are borrowings under the Group’s Syndicated Facility. Amounts are classified as non-current when the facilities have more than 12 months to expiry. A variable rate of interest is payable on amounts drawn under the facility, which was 1.2% at 31 December 2014.

Secured bank loan

The secured bank loan relates to a New Zealand dollar mortgage which is secured on the related hotel property. $3m is repayable by instalments (2013 $4m).

Finance lease obligations

Finance lease obligations, which relate to the 99-year lease (of which 91 years remain) on the InterContinental Boston, are payable as follows:

 

     2014           2013  
     

Minimum

lease

payments

$m

   

Present

value of

payments

$m

          

Minimum

lease

payments

$m

   

Present

value of

payments

$m

 
Less than one year      16        16              16        16   
Between one and five years      64        48              64        48   
More than five years      3,284        154              3,300        151   
       3,364        218              3,380        215   
Less: amount representing finance charges      (3,146                  (3,165       
       218        218              215        215   

The Group has the option to extend the term of the lease for two additional 20-year terms. Payments under the lease step up at regular intervals over the lease term. Interest is payable on the obligation at a fixed rate of 9.7%.

£250m 6% bonds 2016

The 6% fixed interest sterling bonds were issued on 9 December 2009 and are repayable in full on 9 December 2016. Interest is payable annually on 9 December in each year commencing 9 December 2010 to the maturity date. The bonds were initially priced at 99.465% of face value and are unsecured. Currency swaps were transacted at the same time the bonds were issued in order to swap the proceeds and interest flows into US dollars and were subsequently closed out during 2014 (see note 22 for further details).

£400m 3.875% bonds 2022

The 3.875% fixed interest sterling bonds were issued on 28 November 2012 and are repayable on 28 November 2022. Interest is payable annually on 28 November in each year commencing 28 November 2013 to the maturity date. The bonds were initially priced at 98.787% of face value and are unsecured.

 

 

 

138


Table of Contents
 
21. Loans and other borrowings continued
 

Facilities provided by banks

 

     2014           2013  
     

Utilised

$m

    

Unutilised

$m

    

Total

$m

          

Utilised

$m

    

Unutilised

$m

    

Total

$m

 
Committed      364         709         1,073              4         1,070         1,074   
Uncommitted      4         62         66                      80         80   
       368         771         1,139              4         1,150         1,154   
                                           

2014

$m

    

2013

$m

 
Unutilised facilities expire:                                                           

Within one year

                                              62         80   

After two but before five years

                                              709         1,070   
                                                771         1,150   

Utilised facilities are calculated based on actual drawings and may not agree to the carrying value of loans held at amortised cost.

Kimpton acquisition

Subsequent to the year end, a $400m bilateral term loan was drawn down to finance the acquisition of Kimpton (see note 33). The loan has a term of six months plus two six-month extension periods. A variable rate of interest is payable on the loan which has identical covenants to the Syndicated Facility.

22. Derivative financial instruments

 

 

                     
     

2014

$m

   

2013

$m

 
Currency swaps             11   
Forward foreign exchange contracts      (2     (1
       (2     10   
Analysed as:                 

Current assets

     (2     (1

Non-current liabilities

            11   
       (2     10   

Derivatives are recorded at their fair values as set out in note 23.

Currency swaps

At 31 December 2014, the Group held no currency swaps. The currency swaps held at 31 December 2013 (with a principal of $415m) were transacted at the same time as the £250m 6% bonds were issued in December 2009 in order to swap the bonds’ proceeds and interest flows into US dollars. Under the terms of the swaps, $415m was borrowed and £250m deposited for seven years at a fixed exchange rate of £1=$1.66. The currency swaps were closed out in full during 2014 due to a reduction in the value of assets available for net investment hedging with $4m received as consideration on close of out the swaps. The interest expense and principal on the £250m 6% bonds are now subject to currency fluctuations. At 31 December 2013, the fair value of the currency swap comprised two components: $2m relating to the repayment of the underlying principal and $9m relating to interest payments. The element relating to the underlying principal was disclosed as a component of net debt in 2013 (see note 24). The currency swaps were designated as net investment hedges.

Forward foreign exchange contracts

At 31 December 2014, the Group held short dated foreign exchange swaps with total principal values of 220m (2013 75m) and $31m (2013 $100m). The swaps are used to manage sterling surplus cash and reduce euro and US dollar borrowings whilst maintaining operational flexibility. The foreign exchange swaps have been designated as net investment hedges.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

139


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

23. Fair value measurement

 

Fair values

The following table compares carrying amounts and fair values of the Group’s financial assets and liabilities:

 

            2014         

2013

(restated¹)

 
      Note     

Carrying
value

$m

   

Fair
value

$m

         

Carrying
value

$m

   

Fair
value

$m

 
Financial assets                                               
Cash and cash equivalents      17         162        162             248        248   
Equity securities available-for-sale2      15         144        144             136        136   
Loans and receivables:                                               

Other financial assets

     15         113        113             112        112   

Trade and other financial receivables, excluding prepayments

     16         388        388             358        358   
Derivatives2      22         2        2             1        1   
                809        809             855        855   
Financial liabilities                                               
£250m 6% bonds 2016      21         (390     (423          (412     (461
£400m 3.875% bonds 2022      21         (618     (659          (654     (650
Finance lease obligations      21         (218     (277          (215     (233
Unsecured bank loans      21         (359     (359                   
Secured bank loan      21         (3     (3          (4     (4
Bank overdrafts      21         (107     (107          (114     (114
Trade and other payables      18         (1,396     (1,396          (1,322     (1,322
Derivatives2      22                            (11     (11
Provisions      19         (10     (10          (3     (3
                (3,101     (3,234          (2,735     (2,798

1   Restated for the adoption of ‘Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities’ (Amendments to IAS 32), see page 107.

2   Financial assets and liabilities which are measured at fair value.

There are no other assets or liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring or non-recurring basis, or for which fair value is disclosed.

The fair value of cash and cash equivalents and bank overdrafts approximates book value due to the short maturity of the investments and deposits, and the fair value of other financial assets approximates book value based on prevailing market rates. The fair value of the secured and unsecured bank loans approximates book value as interest rates reset to market rates on a frequent basis. The fair value of trade and other receivables, trade and other payables and current provisions approximates to their carrying value, including the future redemption liability of the Group’s loyalty programme.

Fair value hierarchy

The following table provides the fair value measurement hierarchy of the above assets and liabilities, other than those with carrying amounts which are reasonable approximations of their fair values:

 

Level 1: quoted (unadjusted) prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities.

 

Level 2: other techniques for which all inputs which have a significant effect on fair value are observable, either directly or indirectly.

 

Level 3: techniques which use inputs which have a significant effect on the recorded fair value that are not based on observable market data.

 

       2014            2013  
       

Level 1

$m

    

Level 2

$m

    

Level 3

$m

      

Total

$m

           

Level 1

$m

    

Level 2

$m

    

Level 3

$m

      

Total

$m

 
Assets                                                                                    
Equity securities available-for-sale:                                                                                    

Quoted equity shares

       16                           16               9                           9   

Unquoted equity shares

                       128           128                               127           127   
Derivatives                2                   2                       1                   1   
Liabilities                                                                                    
£250m 6% bonds 2016        (423                        (423            (461                        (461
£400m 3.875% bonds 2022        (659                        (659            (650                        (650
Finance lease obligations                (277                (277                    (233                (233
Derivatives                                                        (11                (11

There were no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 fair value measurements during the year and no transfers into and out of Level 3.

 

 

 

140


Table of Contents
 
23. Fair value measurement continued
 

The fair value of quoted equity shares and the bonds is based on their quoted market price.

Derivatives are fair valued using discounted future cash flows, taking into consideration exchange rates prevailing on the last day of the reporting period and interest rates from observable swap curves. As the Group’s derivatives are not cash collaterised, a valuation adjustment is made for credit risk, being counterparty risks in respect of derivative assets and own credit risks in respect of derivative liabilities. At 31 December 2013, the interest rates used to fair value the currency swaps ranged from 1.4% to 2.5%, depending on the currency and the term of the derivative contract.

Finance lease obligations relate to the lease of the InterContinental Boston and are fair valued by discounting the future cash flows payable under the loan, which are fixed, at a risk adjusted long-term interest rate. The interest rate used to discount the cash flows at 31 December 2014 was 7.4% (2013 8.4%).

Unquoted equity shares are fair valued using the International Private Equity and Venture Capital Valuation Guidelines either by applying an average price-earnings (P/E) ratio for a competitor group to the earnings generated by the investment or by reference to share of net assets if the investment is currently loss-making or a recent property valuation is available. The average P/E ratio for the year was 24.0 and a non-marketability factor of 30% is applied. A 10% increase in the average P/E ratio would result in a $3m increase (2013 $5m) in the fair value of the investments and a 10% decrease in the average P/E ratio would result in a $3m decrease (2013 $5m) in the fair value of the investments. A 10% increase in net assets would result in a $7m increase (2013 $5m) in the fair value of the investments and a 10% decrease in net assets would result in a $7m decrease (2013 $5m) in the fair value of the investments.

The following table reconciles the movements in the fair values of investments classified as Level 3 during the year:

 

     

2014

$m

   

2013

$m

 
At 1 January      127        94   
Additions      5        8   
Repaid      (8       
Valuation gains recognised in other comprehensive income      7        25   
Exchange and other adjustments      (3       
At 31 December      128        127   
24. Net debt                 
     

2014

$m

   

2013

(restated1)

$m

 
Cash and cash equivalents      162        248   
Loans and other borrowings – current      (126     (130

                                          – non-current

     (1,569     (1,269
Derivatives hedging debt values (note 22)             (2
Net debt      (1,533     (1,153
Movement in net debt                 
Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents, net of overdrafts      (70     (58
Add back cash flows in respect of other components of net debt:                 

(Increase)/decrease in other borrowings

     (382     1   

Close-out of currency swaps

     (4       
Increase in net debt arising from cash flows      (456     (57
Non-cash movements:                 

Finance lease obligations

     (3     (3

Exchange and other adjustments

     79        (19
Increase in net debt      (380     (79
Net debt at beginning of the year      (1,153     (1,074
Net debt at end of the year      (1,533     (1,153

1   Restated for the adoption of ‘Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities’ (Amendments to IAS 32), see page 107.

In 2013, net debt included the exchange element of the fair value of currency swaps that fixed the value of the Group’s £250m 6% bonds at $415m. An equal and opposite exchange adjustment on the retranslation of the £250m 6% bonds was included in non-current loans and other borrowings. The currency swaps were closed out in 2014 (see note 22).

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

141


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

25. Retirement benefits

 

UK

Historically UK retirement and death in service benefits have been provided for eligible employees in the UK principally by the InterContinental Hotels UK Pension Plan, which has both defined benefit and defined contribution sections. The defined benefit section was subject to a buy-in transaction on 15 August 2013 whereby the assets of the plan were invested in a bulk purchase annuity policy with the insurer Rothesay Life under which the benefits payable to defined benefit members became fully insured. On 31 October 2014, the plan completed the move to a full buy-out of the defined benefit section, following which Rothesay Life has become fully and directly responsible for the pension obligations. On completion of the buy-out, the defined benefit assets (comprising the Rothesay Life insurance policy) and matching defined benefit liabilities were derecognised from the Group statement of financial position. The buy-out transaction also triggered the return to the Company of the £3m that remained in the IHG Funding Trust.

On 6 August 2014, members of the defined contribution section of the plan were transferred to a new mirror plan, the IHG UK Defined Contribution Pension Plan. Existing and new employees who are eligible for pension benefits in the UK, including those who have been auto-enrolled since 1 September 2013, are provided with defined contribution arrangements under this plan; benefits are based on each individual member’s personal account.

Both plans are HM Revenue & Customs registered and governed by a Trustee Board which comprises a combination of independent and company nominated trustees, assisted by professional advisers as and when required. The overall operation of the plans is subject to the oversight of The Pensions Regulator. The Trustee Board is currently in the process of winding-up the InterContinental Hotels UK Pension Plan.

In addition to the above, additional benefits are provided to members of an unfunded pension arrangement who were affected by lifetime or annual allowances under the former defined benefit arrangements. Accrual under this arrangement ceased with effect from 1 July 2013. In March 2014, the Company made an offer to each member to cash-out their pension entitlement by means of a one-off lump sum cash payment. Members had until 30 June 2014 to accept the offer with the Company reserving the right to revoke any acceptances up to the date of payment. In the event, cash payments totalling £27m were made to the accepting members on 28 July 2014 (with an additional £7m deferred for payment until 2015), thereby extinguishing approximately 70% of the unfunded pension obligations. A charge over certain ring-fenced bank accounts totalling £31m at 31 December 2014 (see note 15) is currently held as security on behalf of the remaining members of the unfunded arrangement.

US and other

The Group also maintains the following US-based defined benefit plans; the funded Inter-Continental Hotels Pension Plan, unfunded Inter-Continental Hotels Non-qualified Pension Plans and unfunded Inter-Continental Hotels Corporation Postretirement Medical, Dental, Vision and Death Benefit Plan. All plans are closed to new members. In respect of the funded plan, an Investment Committee has responsibility for the oversight and management of the plan’s assets, which are held in a separate trust. The Committee comprises senior company employees and is assisted by professional advisers as and when required. The company currently makes contributions that equal or exceed the minimum funding amounts required by the Employee Retirement Income and Security Act of 1974 (‘ERISA’). The investment objective is to achieve full funding over time by following a specified ‘glide path approach’ which results in a progressive switching from return seeking assets to liability-matching assets as the funded status of the plan increases. During the year, the funded status reached 85% which triggered a further de-risking of the investment portfolio.

The Group also operates a number of smaller pension schemes outside the UK, the most significant of which is a defined contribution scheme in the US; there is no material difference between the pension costs of, and contributions to, these schemes.

In respect of the defined benefit plans, the amounts recognised in the Group income statement, in administrative expenses, are:

 

     Pension plans                                                      
     UK           US and other          

Post-employment

benefits

          Total  
      2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2012
$m
           2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2012
$m
           2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2012
$m
           2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2012
$m
 
Current service cost              2         5              1         1         1                                           1         3         6   
Past service cost                                           1                                                           1           
Net interest expense      2                 1              3         3         3              1         1         1              6         4         5   
Administration costs      3         1         1                      1         1                                           3         2         2   
Operating profit before exceptional items      5         3         7              4         6         5              1         1         1              10         10         13   
Exceptional items:                                                                                                                           

Settlement cost

     6         147                                                                                6         147           
       11         150         7              4         6         5              1         1         1              16         157         13   

 

 

 

142


Table of Contents
 
25. Retirement benefits continued
 

The settlement cost in 2014 results from the partial cash-out of the UK unfunded pension arrangements and comprises transaction and related social security costs of $9m, offset by the $3m difference between the accounting value of the liabilities extinguished and the amount of the committed cash-out payments. In 2014, related cash payments of $53m are included in cash flows relating to exceptional operating items in the Group statement of cash flows.

The settlement cost in 2013 resulted from the buy-in transaction described on the previous page and comprised a past service cost of $5m relating to additional benefits secured by the transaction, the $137m difference between the cost of the insurance policy and the accounting value of the liabilities secured and transaction costs of $5m. As the policy was structured to enable the plan to move to a buy-out and the intention was to proceed on that basis, the buy-in transaction was accounted for as a settlement with the loss arising recorded in the income statement. The full buy-out was completed on 31 October 2014.

Re-measurement gains and losses recognised in the Group statement of comprehensive income are:

 

     2014     2013     2012  
      Plan
    assets
$m
    Plan
obligations
$m
    Total
$m
    Plan
    assets
$m
    Plan
obligations
$m
    Total
$m
    Plan
assets
$m
    Plan
obligations
$m
    Total
$m
 
Return on plan assets (excluding amounts included in interest)      88               88        2               2        22               22   
Actuarial gains and losses arising from changes in:                                                                         

Demographic assumptions

            (3     (3            12        12               (6     (6

Financial assumptions

            (113     (113            (57     (57            (25     (25

Experience adjustments

            4        4               (6     (6            17        17   
Change in asset restriction (excluding amounts included in interest)      (1            (1     89               89        (23            (23
Other comprehensive income      87        (112     (25     91        (51     40        (1     (14     (15
The assets and liabilities of the schemes and the amounts recognised in the Group statement of financial position are:   
           Pension plans                          
           UK     US and other     Post-employment
benefits
    Total  
            

2014

$m

          2013
$m
          2014
$m
   

2013

$m

   

      2014

$m

    2013
$m
   

2014

$m

          2013
$m
 
Retirement benefit assets                                                                         
Fair value of plan assets              8        582        16        17                      24        599   
Present value of benefit obligations                     (577     (13     (13                   (13     (590
Surplus in schemes              8        5        3        4                      11        9   
Asset restriction              (3     (2                                 (3     (2
Total retirement benefit assets              5        3        3        4                      8        7   
Retirement benefit obligations                                                                         
Fair value of plan assets                            151        142                      151        142   
Present value of benefit obligations              (31     (82     (242     (220     (24     (24     (297     (326
Total retirement benefit obligations              (31     (82     (91     (78     (24     (24     (146     (184
                                                                          
Total fair value of plan assets              8        582        167        159                      175        741   
Total present value of benefit obligations              (31     (659     (255     (233     (24     (24     (310     (916

The ‘US and other’ surplus of $3m (2013 $4m) relates to a defined benefit pension scheme in Hong Kong. Included within the ‘US and other’ deficit is $1m (2013 $2m) relating to a defined benefit pension plan in the Netherlands.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

143


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

25. Retirement benefits continued

 

Assumptions

The principal financial assumptions used by the actuaries to determine the benefit obligations are:

 

     Pension plans                       
     UK      US     

Post-employment

benefits

 
     

      2014

%

    

2013

%

    

2012

%

    

      2014

%

    

2013

%

    

2012

%

    

    2014

%

    

2013

%

    

2012

%

 
Wages and salaries increases                      4.5                                                 4.0   
Pensions increases      3.3         3.6         3.0                                                   
Discount rate      3.7         4.6         4.5         3.6         4.5         3.5         3.7         4.6         3.5   
Inflation rate      3.3         3.6         3.0                                                   
Healthcare cost trend rate assumed for next year:                                                                                 

Pre 65 (ultimate rate reached in 2021)

                                                           8.0         8.5         9.0   

Post 65 (ultimate rate reached in 2024)

                                                           12.5         17.5         11.8   
Ultimate rate that the cost trend rate trends to                                                            5.0         5.2         5.0   

Mortality is the most significant demographic assumption. The current assumptions for the UK are based on the S1NA tables with long cohort projections and a 1.25% per annum underpin to future mortality improvements with age rated down by three years for pensioners and non-pensioners. In the US, the current assumptions are based on the RP-2014 Employee/Healthy Annuitant Generationally Projected with Scale MP-2014 mortality tables.

In both territories, the assumptions have been revised during the year to reflect increased life expectancy at retirement age as follows:

 

          Pension plans  
          UK      US  
            2014
      Years
     2013
Years
     2012
Years
     2014
    Years
     2013
Years
     2012
Years
 
Current pensioners at 651    – male      26         24         24         22         21         19   
     – female      29         27         27         24         23         21   
Future pensioners at 652    – male      28         27         27         23         22         21   
     – female      31         30         30         25         25         22   

 

1  Relates to assumptions based on longevity (in years) following retirement at the end of the reporting period.
2  Relates to assumptions based on longevity (in years) relating to an employee retiring in 2034.

The assumptions allow for expected increases in longevity.

Sensitivities

Changes in assumptions used for determining retirement benefit costs and obligations may have a material impact on the income statement and the statement of financial position. The key assumptions are the pension increases, discount rate, the rate of inflation and the assumed mortality rate. The sensitivity analysis below is based on extrapolating reasonable changes in these assumptions, using year-end conditions and assuming no interdependency between the assumptions.

 

          UK     US  
           

Higher/

(lower)

    pension cost

$m

    

Increase/

(decrease)

in liabilities

$m

   

Higher/

(lower)

pension cost

$m

    

Increase/

(decrease)

in liabilities

$m

 
Pension increases    – 0.25% decrease              (1.1               
     – 0.25% increase              1.2                  
Discount rate    – 0.25% decrease              1.6                7.4   
     – 0.25% increase              (1.6             (7.0
Inflation rate    – 0.25% increase              1.2                  
     – 0.25% decrease              (1.1               
Mortality rate    – one year increase              0.6        0.3         9.4   

A one percentage point increase in assumed healthcare costs trend rate would increase the accumulated post-employment benefit obligations as at 31 December 2014 by $2.4m (2013 $2.8m, 2012 $2.6m) and a one percentage point decrease would decrease the obligations by $2.2m (2013 $2.3m, 2012 $2.3m).

 

 

 

144


Table of Contents
 
25. Retirement benefits continued
 
     Pension plans                              
     UK      US and other      Post-employment
benefits
     Total  
Movement in benefit obligation    2014
$m
     2013
$m
    

    2014

$m

     2013
$m
    

    2014

$m

    

2013

$m

     2014
$m
     2013
$m
 
Benefit obligation at 1 January      659         569         233         247         24         25         916         841   
Current service cost              2         1         1                         1         3   
Past service cost              5                 1                                 6   
Interest expense      24         26         10         7         1         1         35         34   
Settlement gain before costs      (3                                              (3        
Benefits paid      (18      (22      (14      (13      (1      (1      (33      (36
Committed cash-out payments      (57                                              (57        
Re-measurement losses/(gains)      86         62         26         (10              (1      112         51   
Derecognised on buy-out      (640                                              (640        
Exchange adjustments      (20      17         (1                              (21      17   
Benefit obligation at 31 December      31         659         255         233         24         24         310         916   
                                                                         
Comprising:                                                                        

Funded plans

             577         199         182                         199         759   

Unfunded plans

     31         82         56         51         24         24         111         157   
       31         659         255         233         24         24         310         916   
     Pension plans                              
     UK      US and other      Post-employment
benefits
     Total  
Movement in plan assets          2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2014
$m
     2013
$m
 
Fair value of plan assets at 1 January      582         695         159         149                         741         844   
Company contributions      3         20         11         10         1         1         15         31   
Benefits paid      (18      (22      (14      (13      (1      (1      (33      (36
Interest income      22         29         7         4                         29         33   
Settlement loss              (137                                              (137
Re-measurement gains/(losses)      83         (7      5         9                         88         2   
Administration costs      (3      (1              (1                      (3      (2
Derecognised on buy-out      (640                                              (640        
Exchange adjustments      (21      5         (1      1                         (22      6   
Fair value of plan assets at 31 December      8         582         167         159                         175         741   

Company contributions are expected to be $6m in 2015.

The plan assets are measured at fair value and comprise the following:

 

     UK      US and other  
            2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2014
$m
     2013
$m
 
Investments quoted in active markets                                    
Investment funds:                                    

Global equities

                     21         33   

Corporate bonds

                     131         107   

Property

                     2         4   
Unquoted investments                                    
Qualifying insurance policy              577         11         10   
Cash and other      8         5         2         5   
       8         582         167         159   

In accordance with accounting standards, the fair value of a qualifying insurance policy is deemed to be the present value of the pension obligations secured by that policy.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

145


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

25. Retirement benefits continued

 
     Pension plans                             
     UK     US and other         Post-employment
benefits
     Total  
Movement in asset restriction          2014
$m
     2013
$m
              2014
$m
     2013
$m
    2014
$m
     2013
$m
           2014
$m
     2013
$m
 
Balance at 1 January      2         91                                       2         91   
Interest expense              3                                               3   
Re-measurement gains/(losses)      1         (89                                    1         (89
Exchange adjustments              (3                                            (3
Balance at 31 December      3         2                                       3         2   
The asset restriction relates to tax that would be deducted at source in respect of a refund of a surplus taking into account amounts payable under funding commitments. As a result of the buy-in transaction, substantially all of the asset restriction was released through other comprehensive income during 2013.     
     Pension plans                             
     UK     US and other     Post-employment
benefits
     Total  
Estimated future benefit payments          2014
$m
     2013
$m
   

2014

$m

     2013
$m
    2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2014
$m
     2013
$m
 
Within one year              19        15         14        1         1         16         34   
Between one and five years      2         84        58         57        5         5         65         146   
After five years      11         123        78         76        7         7         96         206   
       13         226        151         147        13         13         177         386   
Average duration of obligation (years)      22.0         21.6        11.9         11.8        11.9         11.3                     

26. Share-based payments

 

Annual Performance Plan

Under the IHG Annual Performance Plan (APP), formerly the Annual Bonus Plan (ABP), eligible employees (including Executive Directors) can receive all or part of their bonus in the form of deferred shares. The deferred shares are released on the third anniversary of the award date. Under the terms of awards that are referred to in this note, a fixed percentage of the award is made in the form of shares with no voluntary deferral and no matching shares. Awards under the APP are conditional on the participants remaining in the employment of a participating company or leaving for a qualifying reason as per the plan rules. The award of deferred shares under the APP is at the discretion of the Remuneration Committee.

The number of shares is calculated by dividing a specific percentage of the participant’s annual performance-related award by the middle market quoted prices on the three consecutive dealing days immediately preceding the date of grant. A number of executives participated in the APP during the year and conditional rights over 305,345 (2013 318,911, 2012 340,924) shares were awarded to participants. New plan rules for the APP were approved by shareholders at the Annual General Meeting on 2 May 2014, and will apply to awards made in respect of the 2015 subsequent and financial years. The new plan rules contain substantially the same terms as the existing plan rules.

Long Term Incentive Plan

The Long Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) allows Executive Directors and eligible employees to receive share awards, subject to the achievement of performance conditions, set by the Remuneration Committee, which are normally measured over a three-year period. More detailed information on performance measures is shown in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 76 to 91. Awards are normally made annually and, except in exceptional circumstances, will not exceed three times salary for Executive Directors and four times salary in the case of other eligible employees. During the year, conditional rights over 2,171,390 (2013 2,227,293, 2012 2,698,714) shares were awarded to employees under the plan. The plan provides for the grant of ‘nil cost options’ to participants as an alternative to conditional share awards. New plan rules for the LTIP were approved by shareholders at the Annual General Meeting on 2 May 2014, and will apply to awards made in respect of the 2015-17 and subsequent LTIP cycles. The new plan rules contain substantially the same terms as the existing rules; one minor change is to limit the maximum award to three times salary for all employees.

Executive Share Option Plan

The plan was not operated during 2014 and no options were granted in the year under the plan, neither will any further options be granted under the plan. All options have now been exercised.

 

 

 

146


Table of Contents
 
26. Share-based payments continued
 

The Group recognised a cost of $21m (2013 $22m, 2012 $22m) in operating profit related to equity-settled share-based payment transactions during the year, net of amounts borne by the System Fund.

The aggregate consideration in respect of ordinary shares issued under option schemes during the year was $nil (2013 $5m, 2012 $10m).

The following table sets forth awards and options granted during 2014:

 

      APP      LTIP  
Number of shares awarded in 2014      305,345         2,171,390   
The Group uses separate option pricing models and assumptions depending on the plan. The following tables set out information about awards granted in 2014, 2013 and 2012:    
      APP      LTIP  
2014                  
Valuation model    Binomial      Monte Carlo
Simulation and
Binomial
 
                   
Weighted average share price      1,925.0p         1,916.0p   
Expected dividend yield      n/a         2.55%   
Risk-free interest rate               1.29%   
Volatility1               28%   
Term (years)      3.0         3.0   
      APP      LTIP  
2013                  
Valuation model    Binomial      Monte Carlo
Simulation and
Binomial
 
                   
Weighted average share price      1,928.0p         1,913.0p   
Expected dividend yield      2.63%         2.59%   
Risk-free interest rate               0.27%   
Volatility1               28%   
Term (years)      3.0         3.0   
      ABP      LTIP  
2012                  
Valuation model    Binomial      Monte Carlo
Simulation and
Binomial
 
                   
Weighted average share price      1,440.0p         1,440.0p   
Expected dividend yield      2.95%         2.99%   
Risk-free interest rate               0.59%   
Volatility1               31%   
Term (years)      3.0         3.0   

 

1  The expected volatility was determined by calculating the historical volatility of the Company’s share price corresponding to the expected life of the share award.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

147


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

26. Share-based payments continued

 

Movements in the awards and options outstanding under the schemes are as follows:

 

      APP
Number of
shares
thousands
           LTIP
Number of
shares
thousands
 
Outstanding at 1 January 2012      950                9,030   
Granted      341                2,699   
Vested      (643             (2,621
Share capital consolidation      (18               
Lapsed or cancelled      (8             (1,948
Outstanding at 31 December 2012      622                7,160   
Granted      319                2,227   
Vested      (72             (2,206
Lapsed or cancelled      (29             (406
Outstanding at 31 December 2013      840                6,775   
Granted      305                2,171   
Vested      (310             (1,447
Share capital consolidation      (38               
Lapsed or cancelled      (29             (1,379
Outstanding at 31 December 2014      768                6,120   

Fair value of awards granted during the year

      
2014      3,134.6¢                1,202.1¢   
2013      2,873.4¢                1,127.9¢   
2012      2,199.8¢                792.5¢   

Weighted average remaining contract life (years)

      
At 31 December 2014      1.1                1.1   
At 31 December 2013      1.1                1.1   
At 31 December 2012      1.6                1.2   

The above awards do not vest until the performance and service conditions have been met.

  

      Number of
shares
thousands
    Range of
option prices
pence
    Weighted
average
option price
pence
 
Executive Share Option Plan                         
Outstanding at 1 January 2012      2,170        308.5–619.8        497.0   
Exercised      (1,365     308.5–619.8        492.8   
Lapsed or cancelled      (107     434.2        434.2   
Outstanding at 31 December 2012      698        438.0–619.8        514.8   
Exercised      (638     438.0–619.8        512.3   
Outstanding at 31 December 2013      60        494.2–619.8        541.3   
Exercised      (60     494.2–619.8        541.3   
Outstanding at 31 December 2014             n/a          

Options exercisable

      
At 31 December 2014             n/a        n/a   
At 31 December 2013      60        494.2–619.8        541.3   
At 31 December 2012      698        438.0–619.8        514.8   

The weighted average share price at the date of exercise for share options vested during the year was 1,966.5p. The closing share price on 31 December 2014 was 2,595.0p and the range during the year was 1,866.0p to 2,710.0p per share.

 

 

 

148


Table of Contents
 
 

27. Equity

 

 

Equity share capital    Number of
shares
millions
    Nominal
value
$m
    Share
premium
$m
    Equity
share
capital
$m
 
Allotted, called up and fully paid                                 
At 1 January 2012 (ordinary shares of 13 2947p each)      290        61        101        162   
Share capital consolidation      (19                     
Issued on exercise of share options      1        1        9        10   
Repurchased and cancelled under repurchase programme      (4     (1            (1
Exchange adjustments             2        6        8   
At 31 December 2012 (ordinary shares of 14 194329p each)      268        63        116        179   
Issued on exercise of share options      1               5        5   
Exchange adjustments             2        3        5   
At 31 December 2013 (ordinary shares of 14 194329p each)      269        65        124        189   
Share capital consolidation      (20                     
Repurchased and cancelled under repurchase programme      (1                     
Exchange adjustments             (4     (7     (11
At 31 December 2014 (ordinary shares of 15 265329p each)      248        61        117        178   

The Company was incorporated and registered in England and Wales with registered number 5134420 on 21 May 2004 as a limited company under the Companies Act 1985 with the name Hackremco (No. 2154) Limited. On 24 March 2005 Hackremco (No. 2154) Limited changed its name to New InterContinental Hotels Group Limited. On 27 April 2005 New InterContinental Hotels Group Limited re-registered as a public limited company and changed its name to New InterContinental Hotels Group PLC. On 27 June 2005 New InterContinental Hotels Group PLC changed its name to InterContinental Hotels Group PLC.

On 7 August 2012, the Company announced a $1bn return of funds to shareholders comprising a $500m special dividend with share consolidation and a $500m share repurchase programme. The share consolidation was approved on 8 October 2012 at a General Meeting (GM) of the Company and became effective on 9 October 2012 on the basis of 14 new ordinary shares of 14 194329p each for every 15 existing ordinary shares of 13 2947p each. The special dividend of 172.0¢ per share was paid to shareholders on 22 October 2012 at a total cost of $505m. Under the authority granted by shareholders at the GM on 8 October 2012, the share repurchase programme commenced. In the year to 31 December 2014, 3.4m (2013 9.8m, 2012 4.1m) shares were repurchased for a consideration of $110m (2013 $283m, 2012 $107m), increasing the total amount repurchased to $500m and completing the programme. Of the 3.4m (2013 9.8m, 2012 4.1m) shares repurchased in 2014, 2.7m (2013 9.8m, 2012 nil) are held as treasury shares and 0.7m (2013 nil, 2012 4.1m) were cancelled. The cost of treasury shares has been deducted from retained earnings.

The authority given to the Company at the GM held on 30 June 2014 to purchase its own shares was still valid at 31 December 2014. A resolution to renew the authority will be put to shareholders at the Annual General Meeting on 8 May 2015.

On 6 August 2013, the Company announced a special dividend of 133.0¢ per share amounting to $355m which was paid to shareholders on 4 October 2013.

On 2 May 2014, the Company announced a $750m return to shareholders by way of a special dividend and share consolidation. On 30 June 2014, shareholders approved the share consolidation at a GM of the Company on the basis of 12 new ordinary shares of 15 265329p per share for every 13 existing ordinary shares of 14 194329p each, which became effective on 1 July 2014. The special dividend of 293.0¢ per share was paid to shareholders on 14 July 2014, at a total cost of $763m.

As a result of the 2014 share consolidation, the number of shares held in treasury reduced from 12.5m to 11.5m.

The balance classified as equity share capital includes the total net proceeds (both nominal value and share premium) on issue of the Company’s equity share capital, comprising 15 265329p shares. The share premium reserve represents the amount of proceeds received for shares in excess of their nominal value.

The Company no longer has an authorised share capital.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

149


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

27. Equity continued

 

The nature and purpose of the other reserves shown in the Group statement of changes in equity on pages 102 to 104 of the Financial Statements is as follows:

Capital redemption reserve

This reserve maintains the nominal value of the equity share capital of the Company when shares are repurchased or cancelled.

Shares held by employee share trusts

Comprises $34.5m (2013 $37.6m, 2012 $48.0m) in respect of 0.9m (2013 1.2m, 2012 1.8m) InterContinental Hotels Group PLC ordinary shares held by employee share trusts, with a market value at 31 December 2014 of $38.2m (2013 $39.8m, 2012 $50.1m).

Other reserves

Comprises the merger and revaluation reserves previously recognised under UK GAAP, together with the reserve arising as a consequence of the Group’s capital reorganisation in June 2005. Following the change in presentational currency to the US dollar in 2008 (see page 107), this reserve also includes exchange differences arising on the retranslation to period-end exchange rates of equity share capital, the capital redemption reserve and shares held by employee share trusts.

Unrealised gains and losses reserve

This reserve records movements in the fair value of available-for-sale financial assets and the effective portion of the cumulative net change in the fair value of the cash flow hedging instruments related to hedged transactions that have not yet occurred.

Currency translation reserve

This reserve records the movement in exchange differences arising from the translation of foreign operations and exchange differences on foreign currency borrowings and derivative instruments that provide a hedge against net investments in foreign operations. On adoption of IFRS, cumulative exchange differences were deemed to be $nil as permitted by IFRS 1.

The fair value of derivative instruments designated as hedges of net investments in foreign operations outstanding at 31 December 2014 was a $2m net asset (2013 $10m net liability, 2012 $17m net liability).

The currency translation reserve includes a cumulative loss of $3m relating to assets classified as held for sale.

Treasury shares

At 31 December 2014, 11.5m shares (2013 9.8m, 2012 nil) with a nominal value of $2.8m (2013 $2.4m, 2012 $nil) were held as treasury shares at cost and deducted from retained earnings.

Non-controlling interest

A non-controlling interest is equity in a subsidiary of the Group not attributable, directly or indirectly, to the Group. Non-controlling interests are not material to the Group.

 

 

 

150


Table of Contents
 
 

28. Operating leases

 

During the year ended 31 December 2014, $72m (2013 $67m, 2012 $64m) was recognised as an expense in the Group income statement in respect of operating leases, net of amounts borne directly by the System Fund. The expense includes contingent rents of $27m (2013 $24m, 2012 $19m). $4m (2013 $4m, 2012 $4m) was recognised as income from sub-leases.

Future minimum lease payments under non-cancellable operating leases are as follows:

 

      2014
$m
     2013
$m
 
Due within one year      40         42   
One to two years      34         33   
Two to three years      28         29   
Three to four years      27         23   
Four to five years      20         23   
More than five years      200         202   
       349         352   

In addition, in certain circumstances the Group is committed to making additional lease payments that are contingent on the performance of the hotels that are being leased.

The average remaining term of these leases, which generally contain renewal options, is approximately 17 years (2013 18 years). No material restrictions or guarantees exist in the Group’s lease obligations.

Total future minimum rentals expected to be received under non-cancellable sub-leases are $8m (2013 $10m).

29. Capital and other commitments

 

 

      2014
$m
     2013
$m
 
Contracts placed for expenditure not provided for in the Group Financial Statements:                  

Property, plant and equipment

     70         70   

Intangible assets

     47         13   
       117         83   

The Group has also committed to invest in a number of its associates, with an estimated outstanding commitment of $89m at 31 December 2014 (2013 $20m) based on current forecasts.

30. Contingencies and guarantees

 

At 31 December 2014, the Group had no contingent liabilities (2013 $nil).

In limited cases, the Group may provide performance guarantees to third-party hotel owners to secure management contracts. At 31 December 2014, the amount provided in the Financial Statements was $2m (2013 $6m) and the maximum unprovided exposure under such guarantees was $29m (2013 $48m).

At 31 December 2014, the Group had outstanding letters of credit of $40m (2013 $41m) mainly relating to self insurance programmes.

The Group may guarantee loans made to facilitate third-party ownership of hotels in which the Group has an equity interest. At 31 December 2014, there were guarantees of $20m in place (2013 $20m).

From time to time, the Group is subject to legal proceedings the ultimate outcome of each being always subject to many uncertainties inherent in litigation. In particular, the Group is currently subject to a claim by Pan American Life Insurance Company, a Competition and Markets Authority enquiry in the UK and a class action lawsuit in the US (see ‘Legal proceedings’ on page 170). The Group has also given warranties in respect of the disposal of certain of its former subsidiaries. It is the view of the Directors that, other than to the extent that liabilities have been provided for in these Financial Statements, it is not possible to quantify any loss to which these proceedings or claims under these warranties may give rise, however, as at the date of reporting, the Group does not believe that the outcome of these matters will have a material effect on the Group’s financial position.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

151


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Notes to the Group Financial Statements continued

 

31. Related party disclosures

 

 

      2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2012
$m
 
Total compensation of key management personnel¹                           
Short-term employment benefits      21.5         20.7         20.0   
Post-employment benefits      0.7         0.8         0.8   
Termination benefits                      0.6   
Equity compensation benefits      7.9         8.1         8.6   
       30.1         29.6         30.0   

 

1  Excludes ICETUS cash-out payment of £9.4m (see Directors’ Remuneration Report, page 85).

There were no other transactions with key management personnel during the years ended 31 December 2014, 2013 or 2012.

Key management personnel comprises the Board and Executive Committee.

Related party disclosures for associates and joint ventures are as follows:

 

     Associates          Joint ventures          Total  
      2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2012
$m
          2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2012
$m
          2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2012
$m
 
Revenue from associates and joint ventures      4         4         5                                         4         4         5   
Loans to associates      3                                                         3                   
Other amounts owed by associates and joint ventures      11         2         2                                         11         2         2   

In addition, loans both to and from the Barclay associate of $237m are offset in accordance with the provisions of IAS 32 and presented net in the Group statement of financial position. Interest payable and receivable under the loans is equivalent (average interest rate of 1.8% in 2014) and presented net in the Group income statement.

32. System Fund

 

The Group operates a System Fund (the Fund) to collect and administer assessments and contributions from hotel owners for specific use in marketing, the IHG Rewards Club loyalty programme and the global reservation system. The Fund and loyalty programme are accounted for in accordance with the accounting policies set out on page 112 of the Financial Statements.

The following information is relevant to the operation of the Fund:

 

      2014
$m
     2013
$m
     2012
$m
 
Income1:                           

Assessment fees and contributions received from hotels

     1,271         1,154         1,106   

Proceeds from sale of IHG Rewards Club points

     196         153         144   
Key elements of expenditure1:                           

Marketing

     267         245         250   

IHG Rewards Club

     296         219         250   

Payroll costs

     267         239         221   
Net (deficit)/surplus for the year1      (18      35         12   
Interest payable to the Fund      2         2         2   

 

1  Not included in the Group income statement in accordance with the Group’s accounting policies.

The payroll costs above relate to 4,975 (2013 4,615, 2012 4,431) employees whose costs are borne by the Fund.

The following liabilities relating to the Fund are included in the Group statement of financial position:

 

      2014
$m
     2013
$m
      2012
$m
 
Cumulative short-term net surplus      68         86         51   
Loyalty programme liability      725         649         623   
       793         735         674   

The net change in the loyalty programme liability and Fund surplus contributed an inflow of $58m (2013 $61m, 2012 $57m) to the Group’s cash flow from operations.

 

 

 

152


Table of Contents
 
 

33. Events after the reporting period

 

On 16 January 2015, the Group completed the acquisition of Kimpton Hotel & Restaurant Group, LLC (‘Kimpton’), an unlisted company based in the US, for $430m paid in cash. Kimpton is the world’s largest independent boutique hotel operator which, together with IHG’s Hotel Indigo and EVEN brands, creates a leading boutique and lifestyle hotel business.

The assets and liabilities acquired largely comprise intangible assets, being the Kimpton brand and management contracts, deferred tax assets and goodwill. Due to the close proximity of the acquisition date to the date of these financial statements, the initial accounting for the business combination is incomplete and the Group is unable to provide a quantification of the fair values of these assets. The fair value exercise is ongoing and it is expected that the Group will include an acquisition balance sheet with its interim results for 2015.

Acquisition transaction costs of $7m were incurred in the year to 31 December 2014 (see note 5).

If the acquisition had taken place on 1 January 2014, it is estimated that Group revenue and Group EBITDA for the year ended 31 December 2014 would have been $37m and $20m higher respectively.

34. Principal operating subsidiary undertakings

 

InterContinental Hotels Group PLC was the beneficial owner of all of the equity share capital, indirectly through subsidiary undertakings, of the following companies during the year:

Six Continents Limited1

IHG Hotels Limited1

Six Continents Hotels, Inc.2

Inter-Continental Hotels Corporation2

InterContinental Hotels Group Resources, Inc.2

InterContinental Hong Kong Limited3

Société Nouvelle du Grand Hotel SA4

The companies listed above include those which principally affect the amount of profit and assets of the Group.

1  Incorporated in Great Britain and registered in England and Wales.
2  Incorporated in the US.
3  Incorporated in Hong Kong.
4  Incorporated in France.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

153


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

Parent Company Financial Statements

 

 

 

 

Stay

 

LOGO

 

‘Guest Journey’ – Step four

•  The Stay phase of the ‘Guest Journey’ is where we welcome guests to our hotels and deliver our brand promise through our talented people.

 

•  This step includes the arrival and departure of our guests, as well as the stay in the hotel room itself; its public areas; food and beverage; and guest services.

Page 154: Crowne Plaza London – The City, UK

Page 155: Hotel Indigo Paris – Opera, France

 

154


Table of Contents
 
    

 

 

LOGO

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

155


Table of Contents
 
 

 

 

 

[THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]

 

 

 

 

156


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

[THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]

 

 

LOGO

 

 

157


Table of Contents
 

 

 

 

[THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]

 

 

 

158


Table of Contents
 
 
 

 

 

 

 

[THIS PAGE IS INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]

 

 

LOGO

 

 

159


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

Additional Information

 

 

162 Group information
162

History and developments

162

Risk factors

166

Executive Committee members’ shareholdings

166

Description of securities other than equity securities

167

Articles of Association

169

Working Time Regulations 1998

169

Material contracts

170

Legal proceedings

171 Shareholder information
171

Exchange controls and restrictions on payment of dividends

171

Taxation

173

Disclosure controls and procedures

173

Summary of significant corporate governance differences from NYSE listing standards

174

Selected five-year consolidated financial information

176

Return of funds

176

Purchases of equity securities by the Company and affiliated purchasers

177

Share price information

177

Dividend history

178

Shareholder profiles

179 Useful information
179

Investor information

180

Financial calendar

180

Contacts

181 Exhibits
182 Form 20-F cross-reference guide
184 Glossary
186 Forward-looking statements

 

Share

 

LOGO

 

‘Guest Journey’ – Step five

The Share phase of the ‘Guest Journey’ is when our guests share feedback about their experience, for example via social networks and directly with IHG and our hotels.

 

Page 160: Cypress, A Kimpton Hotel, Cupertino, California, US

Page 161: Hotel Indigo New Orleans Garden District, Louisiana, US

 

160


Table of Contents
 
    

 

 

LOGO

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

161


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Group information

History and developments

 

The Company was incorporated and registered in England and Wales with registered number 5134420 on 21 May 2004 as a limited company under the Companies Act 1985 with the name Hackremco (No. 2154) Limited. In 2004/05, as part of a scheme of arrangement to facilitate the return of capital to shareholders, the following structural changes were made to the Group: (i) on 24 March 2005, Hackremco (No. 2154) Limited changed its name to New InterContinental Hotels Group Limited; (ii) on 27 April 2005, New InterContinental Hotels Group Limited re-registered as a public limited company and changed its name to New InterContinental Hotels Group PLC; and (iii) on 27 June 2005, New InterContinental Hotels Group PLC changed its name to InterContinental Hotels Group PLC and became the holding company of the Group.

The Group, formerly known as Bass and, more recently, Six Continents, was historically a conglomerate operating as, among other things, a brewer, soft drinks manufacturer, hotelier, leisure operator, and restaurant, pub and bar owner. In the last several years, the Group has undergone a major transformation in its operations and organisation, as a result of the separation (as discussed below) and a number of significant disposals during this period, which has narrowed the scope of its business.

On 15 April 2003, following shareholder and regulatory approval, Six Continents PLC (as it then was) separated into two new listed groups, InterContinental Hotels Group PLC (as it then was), comprising the hotels and soft drinks businesses, and Mitchells & Butlers plc, comprising the retail and standard commercial property developments business.

The Group disposed of its interests in the soft drinks business by way of an initial public offering of Britvic (Britannia Soft Drinks Limited for the period up to 18 November 2005, and thereafter, Britannia SD Holdings Limited (renamed Britvic plc on 21 November 2005), which became the holding company of the Britvic Group on 18 November 2005), a manufacturer and distributor of soft drinks in the UK, in December 2005.

Following separation, the Group has undertaken an asset-disposal programme, realising, by the end of 2014, proceeds of $6.0 billion. This programme has significantly reduced the capital requirements of the Group whilst largely retaining the hotels in the IHG System.

A small number of hotels have been sold since the end of 2013, the most significant of which are set out below.

Recent acquisitions and divestitures

  The Group disposed of InterContinental Mark Hopkins San Francisco on 27 March 2014 for $120 million;

 

  the Group completed its disposal of 80 per cent of its interest in InterContinental New York Barclay on 31 March 2014 for $274 million (the Group continues to hold the remaining 20 per cent interest by way of a joint venture);

 

  the Group agreed to sell its 100 per cent interest in InterContinental Paris – Le Grand on 7 December 2014 for 330 million;

 

  the Group agreed to acquire Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants for $430 million on 15 December 2014, and the transaction was completed on 16 January 2015; and

 

  the Group also divested a number of investments for total proceeds of $16 million in 2014.

Capital expenditure

  Capital expenditure in 2014 totalled $271 million compared with $269 million in 2013 and $133 million in 2012;

 

  at 31 December 2014, capital committed, being contracts placed for expenditure on property, plant and equipment, and intangible assets not provided for in the Group Financial Statements, totalled $117 million; and

 

  the Group has also committed to invest in a number of its associates, with an estimated outstanding commitment of $89 million, based on current forecasts.
 

 

 

Risk factors

 

The Group is subject to a variety of inherent risks that may have an adverse impact on its business operations, financial condition, turnover, profits, brands and reputation. This section describes the main risks that could materially affect the Group’s business. The risks below are not the only ones that the Group faces. Some risks are not yet known to the Group and some that the Group does not currently believe to be material could later turn out to be material.

 

The risk factors below are listed in accordance with the strategic, tactical and operational risk framework explained on page 27. Although the Group has classified each risk under a single aspect of the framework, some risks relate to multiple aspects and accordingly should be read in the context of the whole framework. The risk factors should also be considered in connection with any financial and forward-looking information in this Annual Report and Form 20-F and the cautionary statements regarding forward-looking statements on page 186.

 

 

 

Strategic risks

 

The Group is exposed to the risks of political and economic developments

The Group is exposed to political, economic and financial market developments such as recession, inflation and availability of credit and currency fluctuations that could lower revenues and reduce income. The outlook for 2015 may worsen due to uncertainty in the Eurozone, impact of declining commodity prices on economies dependent on such exports and continued unrest in Russia, Ukraine, and parts of the Middle East and Africa. The interconnected nature of economies suggests any of these or other events could trigger a recession that reduces leisure and business travel to and from affected countries and adversely affects room rates and/or occupancy levels and other income-generating activities. This may result in deterioration of results of operations and potentially reduce the value of properties in affected economies. The owners or potential owners of hotels franchised or managed by the Group face similar risks that could adversely impact their solvency and the Group’s ability

 

 

 

162


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

 

to retain and secure franchise or management agreements. Specifically, the Group is most exposed to the US market and, increasingly, to Greater China.

 

Accordingly, the Group is particularly susceptible to adverse changes in these economies as well as changes in their currencies. In addition to trading conditions, the economic outlook also affects the availability of capital to current and potential owners, which could impact existing operations and health of the pipeline.

 

The Group is exposed to the risk of events that adversely impact domestic or international travel

The room rates and occupancy levels of the Group could be adversely impacted by events that reduce domestic or international travel, such as actual or threatened acts of terrorism or war, political or civil unrest, epidemics or threats thereof, travel-related accidents, travel-related industrial action, increased transportation and fuel costs, and natural disasters, resulting in reduced worldwide travel or other local factors impacting specific countries, cities or individual hotels. A decrease in the demand for hotel rooms as a result of such events may have an adverse impact on the Group’s operations and financial results. In addition, inadequate planning, preparation, response or recovery in relation to a major incident or crisis may cause loss of life, prevent operational continuity, or result in financial loss and consequently impact the value of the brands and/or the reputation of the Group.

 

The Group is exposed to the risks of the hotel industry supply and demand cycle

The future operating results of the Group could be adversely affected by industry overcapacity (by number of rooms) and weak demand due, in part, to the cyclical nature of the hotel industry, or other differences between planning assumptions and actual operating conditions. These conditions could result in reductions in room rates and occupancy levels, which would adversely impact the financial performance of the Group.

 

The Group is subject to a competitive and changing industry

The Group operates in a competitive industry and must compete effectively against traditional competitors such as other global hotel chains, local hotel companies and independent hotels to win the loyalty of guests, employees and owners. The competitive landscape also includes other types of businesses, such as web-based booking channels (which include online travel agents and intermediaries), and alternative sources of accommodation such as short-term lets of private property. In order to grow and maintain its competitiveness, the Group may consider undertaking strategic transactions, including acquisitions. Failure to compete effectively in traditional and emerging areas of the business could impact the Group’s market share, System size, profitability and relationships with owners and guests.

 

The Group is exposed to risks related to executing and realising benefits from strategic transactions, including acquisitions

The Group announced the acquisition of Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants in December 2014 and may seek to make other strategic transactions, including acquisitions, in the future. The Group may not be able to identify opportunities or complete transactions on commercially reasonable terms or at all and may not realise the anticipated benefits from such transactions.

 

 

 

Strategic transactions come with inherent valuation, financial and commercial risks, and regulatory and insider information risks during the execution of the transactions. In addition, the Group may face unforeseen costs and liabilities, divergence of management attention, as well as longer-term integration and operational risks, which could result in failure to realise benefits, financial losses, fall in employee morale and loss of talent.

 

The Group is dependent upon a wide range of external stakeholders and business partners

The Group is dependent upon the performance, behaviours and reputation of a wide range of business partners and external stakeholders, including, but not limited to, owners, contractors, lenders, suppliers, vendors, joint venture partners, online travel agents, third-party intermediaries and other business partners which may have different ethical values, interests and priorities. Further, the number and complexity of interdependencies with stakeholders is evolving. Breakdowns in relationships, contractual disputes, poor vendor performance, insolvency, stakeholder behaviours or adverse reputations, which may be outside of the Group’s control, could adversely impact on the Group’s performance and competitiveness, delivery of projects, guest experiences or the reputation of the Group or its brands.

 

The Group is exposed to increasing competition from online travel agents and intermediaries

A proportion of the Group’s bookings originate from large multinational, regional and local online travel agents and intermediaries with which the Group has contractual arrangements and to which it pays commissions. These websites offer a wide breadth of products, often across multiple brands, have growing booking and review capabilities, and may create the perception that they offer the lowest prices. Some of these online travel agents and intermediaries have strong marketing budgets and aim to create brand awareness and brand loyalty among consumers and may seek to commoditise hotel brands through price and attribute comparison. Further, if these companies continue to gain market share, they will impact the Group’s profitability, undermine the Group’s own booking channels and value to its hotel owners and may be able to increase commission rates and negotiate other favourable contract terms.

 

Tactical risks

 

The Group is exposed to a variety of risks related to identifying, securing and retaining franchise and management agreements

The Group’s growth strategy depends on its success in identifying, securing and retaining franchise and management agreements. This is an inherent risk for the hotel industry and franchise business model. Competition with other hotel companies may generally reduce the number of suitable franchise, management and investment opportunities offered to the Group and increase the bargaining position of property owners seeking to become a franchisee or engage a manager. The terms of new franchise or management agreements may not be as favourable as current arrangements; the Group may not be able to renew existing arrangements on similarly favourable terms or at all.

     

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

163


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Group information continued

 

 

There can also be no assurance that the Group will be able to identify, retain or add franchisees to the IHG System or to secure management contracts. For example, the availability of suitable sites, market saturation, planning and other local regulations or the availability and affordability of finance may all restrict the supply of suitable hotel development opportunities under franchise or management agreements. In connection with entering into franchise or management agreements, the Group may be required to make investments in, or guarantee the obligations of, third parties or guarantee minimum income to third parties. There are also risks that significant franchisees or groups of franchisees may have interests that conflict, or are not aligned, with those of the Group including, for example, the unwillingness of franchisees to support brand improvement initiatives. This could result in franchisees prematurely terminating contracts which would adversely impact the overall IHG System size and the Group’s financial performance.

 

The Group is exposed to inherent risks in relation to changing technology and systems

As the use of internet and mobile technology grows and customer needs evolve at pace, the Group may find that its evolving technology capability is not sufficient and may have to make substantial additional investments in new technologies or systems to remain competitive. Failure to keep pace with developments in technologies or systems may put the Group at a competitive disadvantage. In addition, the technologies or systems that the Group chooses to deploy may not be commercially successful or the technology or system strategy may not be sufficiently aligned with the needs of the business. As a result, this could adversely affect guest experiences, and the Group may lose customers, fail to attract new customers, incur substantial costs or face other losses. This could further impact the Group’s reputation in regards to innovation.

 

The Group is exposed to a variety of risks associated with its financial stability and ability to borrow and satisfy debt covenants

While the strategy of the Group is to extend the hotel network through activities that do not involve significant amounts of its own capital, the Group does require capital to fund some development opportunities, strategic acquisitions and to maintain and improve owned hotels. The Group is reliant upon having financial strength and access to borrowing facilities to meet these expected capital requirements. The majority of the Group’s borrowing facilities are only available if the financial covenants in the facilities are complied with. Non-compliance with covenants could result in the Group’s lenders demanding repayment of the funds advanced. If the Group’s financial performance does not meet market expectations, it may not be able to refinance existing facilities on terms considered favourable.

 

The Group is exposed to the risk of litigation

Certain companies in the Group are the subject of various claims and proceedings. The ultimate outcome of these matters is subject to many uncertainties, including future events and uncertainties inherent in litigation. In addition, the Group could be at risk of litigation claims made by many parties, including but not limited to: guests, customers, joint-venture partners, suppliers, employees, regulatory authorities, franchisees and/or the owners of the hotels it manages. Claims filed in the US may include requests for punitive damages as well as compensatory damages. Unfavourable outcomes of claims

 

 

 

or proceedings could have a material adverse impact on the Group’s results of operations, cash flow and/or financial position. Exposure to significant litigation or fines may also affect the reputation of the Group and its brands.

 

Operational risks

 

The Group is reliant on the reputation of its brands and exposed to inherent reputation risks, including those associated with intellectual property

Any event that materially damages the reputation of one or more of the Group’s existing or new brands and/or fails to sustain the appeal of the Group’s existing or new brands to its customers and owners may have an adverse impact on the value of that brand and subsequent revenues from that brand or business. In particular, if the Group is unable to create consistent, valued, and quality products and guest experiences across the owned, managed and franchised estates, or if the Group, its franchisees or business partners fail to act responsibly, this could result in an adverse impact on its brand reputation. In addition, the value of the Group’s brands could be influenced by a number of external factors outside the Group’s control, such as, but not limited to, changes in sentiments against global brands, changes in applicable regulations related to the hotel industry or to franchising, successful commoditisation of hotel brands by online travel agents and intermediaries, or changes in owners’ perceptions of the value of the Group. Furthermore, given the importance of brand recognition to the Group’s business, the protection of its intellectual property poses a risk due to the variability and changes in controls, laws and effectiveness of enforcement globally. Any widespread infringement, misappropriation or weakening of the control environment could materially harm the value of the Group’s brands and its ability to develop the business.

 

The Group is reliant upon the resilience of its reservations system and other key technology platforms and is exposed to risks that could cause the failure of these systems

The value of the Group is partly derived from the ability to drive reservations through its reservations system and technology platforms which are highly integrated with internal processes and linked to multiple sales channels, including the Group’s own websites, call centres, hotels, third-party intermediaries and travel agents.

 

Lack of resilience and operational availability of these systems provided by the Group or third-party technology providers could lead to prolonged service disruption and might result in significant business interruption, impact the guest booking experience and subsequently adversely impact Group revenues.

 

The Group is exposed to the risks related to information security and data privacy

The Group is increasingly dependent upon the availability, integrity and confidentiality of information, including, but not limited to, guest and employee credit card, financial and personal data; and business performance, financial reporting and commercial development. The information is sometimes held in different formats such as digital, paper, voice recordings and video and could be stored in many places, including facilities managed by third-party service providers. The threats towards the Group’s information are dynamic, and include

 

 

 

 

164


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

 

 

cyber attacks, fraudulent use, loss or misuse by employees and breaches of our vendors’ security arrangements amongst others. The legal and regulatory environment around data privacy and requirements set out by the payment card industry surrounding information security across the many jurisdictions in which the Group operates are constantly evolving. If the Group fails to appropriately protect information and ensure relevant controls are in place to enable the appropriate use and release of information through the appropriate channels in a timely and accurate manner, IHG System performance, guest experience and the reputation of the Group may be adversely affected. This can lead to revenue losses, fines, penalties, legal fees and other additional costs.

 

The Group is exposed to a variety of risks associated with safety, security and crisis management

There is a constant need to protect the safety and security of our guests, employees and assets against natural and man-made threats. These include, but are not limited to, exceptional events such as extreme weather, civil or political unrest, violence and terrorism, serious and organised crime, fraud, employee dishonesty, cyber crime, pandemics, fire and day-to-day accidents, incidents and petty crime which impact the guest or employee experience, could cause loss of life, sickness or injury and result in compensation claims, fines from regulatory bodies, litigation and impact reputation. Serious incidents or a combination of events could escalate into a crisis which, if managed poorly, could further expose the Group and its brands to significant reputational damage.

 

The Group requires the right people, skills and capability to manage growth and change

In order to remain competitive, the Group must employ the right people. This includes hiring and retaining highly skilled employees with particular expertise or leadership capability. The implementation of the Group’s strategic business plans could be undermined by failure to build a resilient corporate culture, failure to recruit or retain key personnel, unexpected loss of key senior employees, failures in the Group’s succession planning and incentive plans, or a failure to invest in the development of key skills.

 

Some of the markets in which the Group operates are experiencing economic growth, and the Group must compete against other companies inside and outside the hospitality industry for suitably qualified or experienced employees. Some emerging markets may not have the required local expertise to operate a hotel and may not be able to attract the right talent. Failure to attract and retain employees may threaten the success of the Group’s operations in these markets. Additionally, unless skills are supported by a sufficient infrastructure to enable knowledge and skills to be passed on, the Group risks losing accumulated knowledge if key employees leave the Group.

 

The Group is required to comply with existing and changing regulations across numerous countries, territories and jurisdictions

Government regulations affect countless aspects of the Group’s business ranging from corporate governance, health and safety, the environment, bribery and corruption, employment law and diversity, disability access, data privacy and information protection, financial, accounting and tax. Regulatory changes may require significant changes in the way the business operates and may inhibit the Group’s strategy, including the markets the

 

 

 

Group operates in, brand protection, and use or transmittal of customer data. If the Group fails to comply with existing or changing regulations, the Group may be subject to fines, prosecution, loss of licence to operate or reputational damage.

 

The Group is exposed to risks related to ethics and responsible business practices

The reputation of the Group and the value of its brands are influenced by a wide variety of factors, including the perception of stakeholder groups such as guests, owners, suppliers and communities in which the Group operates. The social and environmental impacts of its business are under increasing scrutiny, and the Group is exposed to the risk of damage to its reputation if it fails to (or fails to influence its business partners to) undertake responsible practices and engage in ethical behaviour, or fails to comply with relevant regulatory requirements.

 

The Group may face difficulties insuring its business

Historically, the Group has maintained insurance at levels determined to be appropriate in light of the cost of cover and the risk profile of the business. However, forces beyond the Group’s control, including market forces, may limit the scope of coverage the Group can obtain and the Group’s ability to obtain coverage at reasonable rates. Other forces beyond the Group’s control, such as terrorist attacks or natural disasters, may be uninsurable or simply too expensive to insure. Inadequate or insufficient insurance could expose the Group to large claims or could result in the loss of capital invested in properties, as well as the anticipated future revenue from properties, and could leave the Group responsible for guarantees, debt or other financial obligations related to such properties.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

165


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Group information continued

Executive Committee members’ shareholdings

Shares held by Executive Committee members (excluding the Executive Directors) as at 31 December

 

Executive                                                        

Committee

member

   Number of shares held outright      APP deferred share awards      LTIP share awards (unvested)      Total number of shares held  
      2014      2013      2014      2013      2014      2013      2014      2013  
Keith Barr      22,522         24,399         29,829         27,695         106,630         111,079         158,981         163,173   
Angela Brav      32,724         19,286         24,473         22,501         97,462         99,650         154,659         141,437   

Kenneth

Macpherson

     7,472         1,797         8,330         8,421         64,713         41,654         80,515         51,872   
Eric Pearson      1,998         65,293         25,021         22,356         102,940         103,553         129,959         191,202   
Jan Smits      30,476         106,350         32,037         28,738         104,445         116,234         166,958         251,322   
George Turner      0         3,277         30,896         35,893         95,399         106,100         126,295         145,270   

Details of the shares held by the Executive Directors can be found on page 74. These shareholdings include all beneficial interests and those held by Executive Committee members’ spouses and other connected persons.

For further details on the APP deferred share award and for the LTIP share award, see pages 80 and 82 to 85.

 

 

Description of securities other than equity securities

Fees and charges payable to a depositary

 

Category (as defined by SEC)

 

  

Depositary actions

 

  

Associated fee

 

(a) Depositing or substituting the underlying shares

  

Each person to whom ADRs are issued against deposits of shares, including deposits and issuances in respect of:

 

•   share distributions, stock split, rights, merger; and

 

•   exchange of securities or any other transactions or event or other distribution affecting the ADSs or the deposited securities

   $5 for each 100 ADSs (or portion thereof)

 

(b) Receiving or distributing dividends

  

 

Distribution of stock dividends

 

Distribution of cash

  

 

$5 for each 100 ADSs (or portion thereof)

 

$0.02 or less per ADS (or portion thereof)

 

(c)  Selling or exercising rights

  

 

Distribution or sale of securities, the fee being in an amount equal to the fee for the execution and delivery of ADSs which would have been charged as a result of the deposit of such securities

  

$5 for each 100 ADSs (or portion thereof)

 

 

(d) Withdrawing an underlying security

  

 

Acceptance of ADRs surrendered for withdrawal of deposited securities

  

 

$5 for each 100 ADSs (or portion thereof)

 

(e) Transferring, splitting or grouping receipts

  

 

Transfers, combining or grouping of depositary receipts

  

 

$1.50 per ADS

 

(f)   General depositary services, particularly those charged on an annual basis

  

 

Other services performed by the depositary in administering the ADRs

  

 

$0.02 per ADS (or portion thereof)1 not more than once each calendar year and payable at the sole discretion of the ADR Depositary by billing ADR holders or by deducting such charge from one or more cash dividends or other cash distributions

 

(g) Expenses of the depositary

  

 

Expenses incurred on behalf of ADR holders in connection with:

 

•   compliance with foreign exchange control regulations or any law or regulation relating to foreign investment;

 

•   the ADR Depositary’s or its custodian’s compliance with applicable law, rule or regulation;

 

•   stock transfer or other taxes and other governmental charges;

 

•   cable, telex, facsimile transmission/delivery;

 

•   transfer or registration fees in connection with the deposit and withdrawal of deposited securities;

 

•   expenses of the ADR Depositary in connection with the conversion of foreign currency into US dollars (which are paid out of such foreign currency); and

 

•   any other charge payable by the ADR Depositary or its agents

  

 

Expenses payable at the sole discretion of the Depositary by billing ADR holders or by deducting charges from one or more cash dividends or other cash distributions are $20 per transaction

1 These fees are not currently being charged by the ADR Depositary.

 

 

 

166


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

Fees and charges payable by a depositary

Direct payments

JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A. (JPMorgan or the ADR Depositary) is the depositary for IHG’s ADR Programme. The ADR Depositary’s principal executive office is at: J.P. Morgan Depositary Receipts, 4 New York Plaza, 12th Floor, New York, NY 10004 United States of America. The ADR Depositary has agreed to reimburse certain reasonable Company expenses related to the Company’s ADR Programme and incurred by the Company in connection with the ADR Programme. During the year ended 31 December 2014, the Company received $490,478.87 from the ADR Depositary in respect of legal, accounting and other fees incurred in connection with preparation of the Annual Report and Form 20-F, ongoing SEC compliance and listing requirements, investor relations programmes, and advertising and public relations expenditure.

Indirect payments

As part of its service to the Company, the ADR Depositary has agreed to waive fees for the standard costs associated with the administration of the ADR Programme, associated operating expenses and investor relations advice. In the year ended 31 December 2014, the ADR Depositary agreed to waive fees and expenses amounting to $20,000.

Articles of Association

The Company’s articles of association (the Articles) were adopted at the AGM held on 28 May 2010 and are available on the Company’s website at www.ihgplc.com/investors under corporate governance. The following summarises material rights of holders of the Company’s ordinary shares under the material provisions of the Articles and English law. This summary is qualified in its entirety by reference to the Companies Act and the Articles.

The Company’s shares may be held in certificated or uncertificated form. No holder of the Company’s shares will be required to make additional contributions of capital in respect of the Company’s shares in the future.

In the following description, a ‘shareholder’ is the person registered in the Company’s register of members as the holder of the relevant share.

Principal objects

The Company is incorporated under the name InterContinental Hotels Group PLC and is registered in England and Wales with registered number 5134420. The Articles do not restrict its objects or purposes.

Directors

Under the Articles, a Director may have an interest in certain matters (Permitted Interest) without the prior approval of the Board provided he has declared the nature and extent of such Permitted Interest at a meeting of the Directors or in the manner set out in Section 184 or Section 185 of the Companies Act.

Any matter which does not comprise a Permitted Interest must be authorised by the Board in accordance with the procedure and requirements contained in the Articles, including the requirement that a Director may not vote on a resolution to authorise a matter in which he is interested, nor may he count in the quorum of the meeting at which such business is transacted.

 

Further, a Director may not vote in respect of any proposal in which he, or any person connected with him, has any material interest other than by virtue of his interests in securities of, or otherwise in or through, the Company, nor may he count in the quorum of the meeting at which such business is transacted. This is subject to certain exceptions, including in relation to proposals: (a) indemnifying him in respect of obligations incurred on behalf of the Company; (b) indemnifying a third party in respect of obligations of the Company for which the Director has assumed responsibility under an indemnity or guarantee; (c) relating to an offer of securities in which he will be interested as an underwriter; (d) concerning another body corporate in which the Director is beneficially interested in less than one per cent of the issued shares of any class of shares of such a body corporate; (e) relating to an employee benefit in which the Director will share equally with other employees; and (f) relating to liability insurance that the Company is empowered to purchase for the benefit of Directors of the Company in respect of actions undertaken as Directors (or officers) of the Company.

The Directors have authority under the Articles to set their own remuneration (provided certain criteria is met). While an agreement to award remuneration to a Director is an arrangement with the Company that comprises a Permitted Interest (and therefore does not require authorisation by the Board in that respect), it is nevertheless a matter that would be expected to give rise to a conflict of interest between the Director concerned and the Company, and such conflict must be authorised by a resolution of the Board. The Director that is interested in such matter may neither vote on the resolution to authorise such conflict, nor count in the quorum of the meeting at which it was passed. Furthermore, as noted above, the interested Director is not permitted to vote in respect of any proposal in which he has any material interest (except in respect of the limited exceptions outlined above) nor may he count in the quorum of the meeting at which such business is transacted.

As such, a Director has no power, in the absence of an independent quorum, to vote on compensation to himself, but may vote on a resolution (and may count in the quorum of the meeting at which it was passed) to award compensation to Directors provided those arrangements do not confer a benefit on him.

The Directors are empowered to exercise all the powers of the Company to borrow money, subject to the limitation that the aggregate amount of all monies borrowed by the Company and its subsidiaries shall not exceed an amount equal to three times the Company’s share capital and consolidated reserves, unless sanctioned by an ordinary resolution of the Company.

Under the Articles, there are no age-limit requirements relating to a person’s qualification to hold office as a Director of the Company.

Directors are not required to hold any shares of the Company by way of qualification.

Rights attaching to shares

Dividend rights and rights to share in the Company’s profits

Under English law, dividends are payable on the Company’s ordinary shares only out of profits available for distribution, as determined in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the UK and by the Companies Act. No dividend will bear interest as against the Company.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

167


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Group information continued

 

Holders of the Company’s ordinary shares are entitled to receive such dividends as may be declared by the shareholders in general meeting, rateably according to the amounts paid up on such shares, provided that the dividend cannot exceed the amount recommended by the Directors.

The Company’s Board of Directors may declare and pay to shareholders such interim dividends as appear to them to be justified by the Company’s financial position. If authorised by an ordinary resolution of the shareholders, the Board of Directors may also direct payment of a dividend in whole or in part by the distribution of specific assets (and in particular of paid-up shares or debentures of any other company).

Any dividend unclaimed by a member (or by a person entitled by virtue of transmission on death or bankruptcy or otherwise by operation of law) after six years from the date the dividend was declared, or became due for payment, will be forfeited and will revert to the Company.

Voting rights

The holders of ordinary shares are entitled, in respect of their holdings of such shares, to receive notice of general meetings and to attend, speak and vote at such meetings in accordance with the Articles.

Voting at any general meeting of shareholders is by a show of hands unless a poll, which is a written vote, is duly demanded. On a show of hands, every shareholder who is present in person or by proxy at a general meeting has one vote regardless of the number of shares held. On a poll, every shareholder who is present in person or by proxy has one vote for every share held by that shareholder. A poll may be demanded by any of the following:

 

  the chairman of the meeting;

 

  at least five shareholders present in person or by proxy and entitled to vote at the meeting;

 

  any shareholder or shareholders present in person or by proxy representing in the aggregate not less than one-tenth of the total voting rights of all shareholders entitled to vote at the meeting; or

 

  any shareholder or shareholders present in person or by proxy holding shares conferring a right to vote at the meeting and on which there have been paid up sums in the aggregate at least equal to one-tenth of the total sum paid up on all the shares conferring that right.

A proxy form will be treated as giving the proxy the authority to demand a poll, or to join others in demanding one.

The necessary quorum for a general meeting is three persons carrying a right to vote upon the business to be transacted, whether present in person or by proxy.

Matters are transacted at general meetings of the Company by the proposing and passing of resolutions, of which there are two kinds:

 

  an ordinary resolution, which includes resolutions for the election of Directors, the approval of financial statements, the cumulative annual payment of dividends, the appointment of the auditor, the increase of authorised share capital or the grant of authority to allot shares; and

 

  a special resolution, which includes resolutions amending the Articles, disapplying statutory pre-emption rights, modifying the rights of any class of the Company’s shares at a meeting of the holders of such class or relating to certain matters concerning the Company’s winding up or changing the Company’s name.

An ordinary resolution requires the affirmative vote of a majority of the votes of those persons present and entitled to vote at a meeting at which there is a quorum.

Special resolutions require the affirmative vote of not less than three quarters of the persons present and entitled to vote at a meeting at which there is a quorum.

AGMs must be convened upon advance written notice of 21 days. Subject to law, other meetings must be convened upon advance written notice of 14 days. The days of delivery or receipt of the notice are not included. The notice must specify the nature of the business to be transacted. The Board of Directors may, if they choose, make arrangements for shareholders who are unable to attend the place of the meeting to participate at other places.

The Articles specify that each Director shall retire every three years at the AGM and, unless otherwise decided by the Directors, shall be eligible for re-election. However, the Code recommends that all directors of FTSE 350 companies submit themselves for election or re-election (as appropriate) by shareholders every year. Therefore, all Directors will retire and offer themselves for election or re-election at the 2015 AGM.

Variation of rights

If, at any time, the Company’s share capital is divided into different classes of shares, the rights attached to any class may be varied, subject to the provisions of the Companies Act, with the consent in writing of holders of three-quarters in nominal value of the issued shares of that class or upon the adoption of a special resolution passed at a separate meeting of the holders of the shares of that class. At every such separate meeting, all of the provisions of the Articles relating to proceedings at a general meeting apply, except that the quorum is to be the number of persons (which must be two or more) who hold or represent by proxy not less than one-third in nominal value of the issued shares of that class.

Rights in a winding-up

Except as the Company’s shareholders have agreed or may otherwise agree, upon the Company’s winding up, the balance of assets available for distribution:

 

  after the payment of all creditors including certain preferential creditors, whether statutorily preferred creditors or normal creditors; and

 

  subject to any special rights attaching to any class of shares, is to be distributed among the holders of ordinary shares according to the amounts paid up on the shares held by them. This distribution is generally to be made in cash. A liquidator may, however, upon the adoption of a special resolution of the shareholders, divide among the shareholders the whole or any part of the Company’s assets in kind.

Limitations on voting and shareholding

There are no limitations imposed by English law or the Articles on the right of non-residents or foreign persons to hold or vote the Company’s ordinary shares or ADSs, other than the limitations that would generally apply to all of the Company’s shareholders.

 

 

 

 

168


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

Working Time Regulations 1998

Under EU law, many employees of Group companies are now covered by the Working Time Regulations which came into force in the UK on 1 October 1998. These regulations implemented the European Working Time Directive and parts of the Young Workers Directive, and lay down rights and protections for employees in areas such as maximum working hours, minimum rest time, minimum days off and paid leave.

In the UK, there is in place a national minimum wage under the National Minimum Wage Act. At 31 December 2014, the minimum wage for individuals between 18 and under the age of 21 was £5.13 per hour and £6.50 per hour for individuals age 21 and above (in each case, excluding apprentices aged under 19 years or, otherwise, in the first year of their apprenticeships). This particularly impacts businesses in the hospitality and retailing sectors. Compliance with the National Minimum Wage Act is being monitored by the Low Pay Commission, an independent statutory body established by the UK government.

Less than five per cent of the Group’s UK employees are covered by collective bargaining agreements with trade unions.

Continual attention is paid to the external market in order to ensure that terms of employment are appropriate. The Group believes the Group companies will be able to conduct their relationships with trade unions and employees in a satisfactory manner.

Material contracts

The following contracts have been entered into otherwise than in the course of ordinary business by members of the Group: (i) in the two years immediately preceding the date of this document in the case of contracts which are or may be material; or (ii) that contain provisions under which any Group member has any obligation or entitlement that is material to the Group as at the date of this document. To the extent that these agreements include representations, warranties and indemnities, such provisions are considered standard in an agreement of that nature, save to the extent identified below.

Disposal of 80 per cent interest in InterContinental New York Barclay

On 19 December 2013, Constellation Barclay Holding US, LLC, which is an affiliate of Constellation Hotels Holding Limited, agreed to acquire, pursuant to a contribution agreement, an 80 per cent interest in a joint venture with IHG’s affiliates to own and refurbish the InterContinental New York Barclay hotel. The 80 per cent interest was acquired for gross cash proceeds of $274 million. IHG’s affiliates hold the remaining 20 per cent interest. The disposal was completed on 31 March 2014.

IHG’s management affiliate has also secured a 30-year management contract on the hotel, which commenced in 2014, with two 10-year extension rights at IHG’s discretion, giving an expected contract length of 50 years.

Constellation Barclay Holding US, LLC and IHG’s affiliates have agreed to invest through the joint venture in a significant refurbishment, repositioning and extension of the hotel. This commenced in 2014 and will take place over a period of approximately 18 months.

Under the contribution agreement, IHG’s affiliates gave certain customary warranties and indemnities to Constellation Barclay Holding US, LLC.

 

Disposal of interest in InterContinental Paris – Le Grand

On 7 December 2014, a share sale and purchase agreement was entered into between BHR Holdings BV (part of IHG) and Constellation Hotels France Grand SA. Under the agreement, BHR Holdings BV agreed to sell its 100 per cent interest in Société Des Hotels InterContinental France, the owner of InterContinental Paris – Le Grand, to Constellation Hotels France Grand SA. The gross sale proceeds agreed are 330 million in cash.

In connection with the sale, IHG secured a 30-year management contract on the hotel, with three 10-year extension rights at IHG’s discretion, giving an expected contract length of 60 years.

Under the agreement, BHR Holdings BV gave certain customary warranties and indemnities to Constellation Hotels France Grand SA.

Acquisition of the Kimpton Hotels & Restaurants business

On 15 December 2014, a share sale and purchase agreement was entered into between Kimpton Group Holding LLC and Dunwoody Operations, Inc., an affiliate of IHG. Under the agreement, Dunwoody Operations, Inc. agreed to buy a 100 per cent interest in Kimpton Hotel & Restaurant Group, LLC, the principal trading company of the Kimpton group, from Kimpton Group Holding LLC. The purchase completed on 16 January 2015.

Under the agreement, Dunwoody Operations, Inc. gave certain customary warranties and indemnities to the seller.

The purchase price payable by Dunwoody Operations, Inc. in respect of the acquisition was $430 million paid in cash.

£750 Million Euro Medium Term Note Programme

In 2012, the Group updated its Euro Medium Term Note programme (Programme) and issued a tranche of £400 million 3.875% notes due 28 November 2022.

On 9 November 2012, an amended and restated trust deed (Trust Deed) was executed by InterContinental Hotels Group PLC as issuer (Issuer), Six Continents Limited and InterContinental Hotels Limited as guarantors (Guarantors) and HSBC Corporate Trustee Company (UK) Limited as trustee (Trustee), pursuant to which the trust deed dated 29 November 2009, as supplemented by the first supplemental trust deed dated 7 July 2011 between the same parties relating to the Programme, was amended and restated. Under the Trust Deed, the Issuer may issue notes (Notes) unconditionally and irrevocably guaranteed by the Guarantors, up to a maximum nominal amount from time to time outstanding of £750 million (or its equivalent in other currencies). Notes are to be issued in series (each a Series) in bearer form. Each Series may comprise one or more tranches (each a Tranche) issued on different issue dates. Each Tranche of Notes will be issued on the terms and conditions set out in the updated base prospectus dated 9 November 2012 (Base Prospectus) as amended and/or supplemented by a document setting out the final terms (Final Terms) of such Tranche or in a separate prospectus specific to such Tranche.

Under the Trust Deed, each of the Issuer and the Guarantors has given certain customary covenants in favour of the Trustee.

Final Terms were issued (pursuant to the previous base prospectus dated 27 November 2009) on 9 December 2009 in respect of the issue of a Tranche of £250 million 6% Notes due 9 December 2016 (2009 Issuance). Final Terms were issued pursuant to the Base Prospectus on 26 November 2012 in respect of the issue of a

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

169


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Group information continued

 

Tranche of £400 million 3.875% Notes due 28 November 2022 (2012 Issuance).

The Final Terms issued under each of the 2009 Issuance and the 2012 Issuance provide that the holders of the Notes have the right to repayment if the Notes: (a) become non-investment grade within the period commencing on the date of announcement of a change of control and ending 90 days after the change of control (Change of Control Period) and are not subsequently, within the Change of Control Period, reinstated to investment grade; (b) are downgraded from a non-investment grade and are not reinstated to its earlier credit rating or better within the Change of Control Period; or (c) are not credit rated and do not become investment-grade credit rated by the end of the Change of Control Period.

Further details of the Programme and the Notes are set out in the Base Prospectus, a copy of which is available (as is a copy of each of the Final Terms dated 7 December 2009 relating to the 2009 Issuance and the Final Terms dated 26 November 2012 relating to the 2012 Issuance) on the Company’s website at www.ihgplc.com/ investors under financial library for 2009. The Notes issued pursuant to the 2009 Issuance and the Notes issued pursuant to the 2012 Issuance are referred to as ‘£250 million 6% bonds’ and the ‘£400 million 3.875% bonds’ respectively in the Group Financial Statements.

On 27 November 2009, the Issuer and the Guarantors entered into an agency agreement (Agency Agreement) with HSBC Bank plc as principal paying agent and the Trustee, pursuant to which the Issuer and the Guarantors appointed paying agents and calculation agents in connection with the Programme and the Notes.

Under the Agency Agreement, each of the Issuer and the Guarantors has given a customary indemnity in favour of the paying agents and the calculation agents. There was no change to the Agency Agreement in 2011 or 2012.

On 9 November 2012, the Issuer and the Guarantors entered into a dealer agreement (Dealer Agreement) with HSBC Bank plc as arranger and Citigroup Global Markets Limited, HSBC Bank plc, Lloyds TSB Bank plc, Merrill Lynch International, Mitsubishi UFJ Securities International plc and The Royal Bank of Scotland plc as dealers (Dealers), pursuant to which the Dealers were appointed in connection with the Programme and the Notes.

Under the Dealer Agreement, each of the Issuer and the Guarantors has given customary warranties and indemnities in favour of the Dealers.

Syndicated Facility

On 7 November 2011, the Company signed a five-year $1.07 billion bank facility agreement with The Royal Bank of Scotland plc, NB International Finance B.V., Citigroup Global Markets Limited, HSBC Bank plc, Lloyds TSB Bank plc and The Bank of Tokyo-Mitsubishi UFJ, Ltd., all acting as mandated lead arrangers and Banc of America Securities Limited as facility agent (Syndicated Facility).

The interest margin payable on borrowings under the Syndicated Facility is linked to IHG’s consolidated net debt to consolidated EBITDA ratio. The margin can vary between LIBOR + 0.90% and LIBOR + 1.70% depending on the level of the ratio. At 31 December 2014, tranches in the sums of US$270m and 75m had been drawn down under the Syndicated Facility.

 

$400 Million Term Loan Facility

On 13 January 2015, the Company signed a six-month $400 million term loan facility agreement with Bank of America Merrill Lynch International Limited as arranger, facility agent and lender. The Company may elect to extend the repayment date by up to two further periods of six months.

The interest margin payable on borrowings is LIBOR + 0.6%, increasing to LIBOR + 0.8% and LIBOR +1.0% for the first and second six-month extension periods respectively. The facility was fully drawn at 16 February 2015.

Legal proceedings

Group companies have extensive operations in the UK, as well as internationally, and are involved in a number of legal claims and proceedings incidental to those operations. It is the Company’s view that such proceedings, either individually or in the aggregate, have not in the recent past and are not likely to have a significant effect on the Group’s financial position or profitability. Notwithstanding the above, the Company notes the matters set out below. Litigation is inherently unpredictable and, as at 16 February 2015, the outcome of these matters cannot be reasonably determined.

A claim was filed on 9 July 2013 by Pan-American Life Insurance Company against Louisiana Acquisitions Corp. and InterContinental Hotels Corporation (IHC). The claimant identified eight causes of action: breach of contract; breach of partnership, fiduciary duties and good faith obligations; fraud; civil conspiracy; conversion; unfair trade practices; unjust enrichment; and alter ego. As at 16 February 2015, the likelihood of a favourable or unfavourable result cannot be reasonably determined and it is not possible to determine whether any loss is probable or to estimate the amount of any loss.

On 31 July 2012, the UK’s Office of Fair Trading (OFT) issued a Statement of Objections alleging that the Company (together with Booking.com B.V. and Expedia, Inc.) had infringed competition law in relation to the online supply of room-only hotel accommodation by online travel agents.

The Company has co-operated fully with the investigation. On 31 January 2014, the OFT announced its decision to accept a series of commitments and to conclude its investigation without any finding of infringement or wrongdoing, or the imposition of any fine. On 26 September 2014, the Competition Appeal Tribunal allowed an appeal brought by Skyscanner Limited and quashed the decision to accept the commitments. The Competition and Markets Authority (the OFT’s successor) has decided not to appeal the judgment of the Competition Appeal Tribunal. As at 16 February 2015, the likelihood of a favourable or unfavourable result cannot be reasonably determined and it is not possible to determine whether any loss is probable or to estimate the amount of any loss.

A class-action claim was filed on 3 July 2012 by two claimants alleging that InterContinental Hotels of San Francisco, Inc. and InterContinental Hotels Group Resources, Inc. violated California Penal Code 632.7, based upon the alleged improper recording of cellular phone calls originating from California to IHG customer care and reservations centres. The claimants subsequently amended the claim to include Six Continents Hotels, Inc. We are currently involved in settlement discussions with respect to this claim.

 

 

 

 

170


Table of Contents
 
    
 

Shareholder information

 

Exchange controls and restrictions on payment of dividends

There are no restrictions on dividend payments to US citizens.

Although there are currently no UK foreign exchange control restrictions on the export or import of the capital or the payment of dividends on the ordinary shares or the ADSs, economic sanctions which may be in force in the UK from time to time impose restrictions on the payment of dividends to persons resident (or treated as so resident) in or governments of (or persons exercising public functions in) certain countries.

Other than economic sanctions which may be in force in the UK from time to time, there are no restrictions under the Articles or under English law that limit the right of non-resident or foreign owners to hold or vote the ordinary shares or the ADSs. In addition, the Articles contain certain limitations on the voting and other rights of any holder of ordinary shares whose holding may, in the opinion of the Directors, result in the loss or failure to secure the reinstatement of any licence or franchise from any US governmental agency held by Six Continents Hotels, Inc. or any subsidiary thereof.

Taxation

This section provides a summary of material US federal income tax and UK tax consequences to the US holders, described below, of owning and disposing of ordinary shares or ADSs of the Company. This section addresses only the tax position of a US holder who holds ordinary shares or ADSs as capital assets. This section does not, however, discuss all of the tax considerations that may be relevant to any particular US holder, such as the provisions of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (IR Code) known as the Medicare Contribution tax or tax consequences to US holders subject to special rules, such as:

 

  certain financial institutions;

 

  insurance companies;

 

  dealers and traders in securities who use a mark-to-market method of tax accounting;

 

  persons holding ordinary shares or ADSs as part of a straddle, conversion transaction, integrated transaction or wash sale, or persons entering into a constructive sale with respect to the ordinary shares or ADSs;

 

  persons whose functional currency for US federal income tax purposes is not the US dollar;

 

  partnerships or other entities classified as partnerships for US federal income tax purposes;

 

  persons liable for the alternative minimum tax;

 

  tax-exempt organisations;

 

  persons who acquired the Company’s ADSs or ordinary shares pursuant to the exercise of any employee stock option or otherwise in connection with employment; or

 

  persons who, directly or indirectly, own 10 per cent or more of the Company’s voting stock.

This section does not generally deal with the position of a US holder who is resident in the UK for UK tax purposes or who is subject to UK taxation on capital gains or income by virtue of carrying on a trade, profession or vocation in the UK through a branch, agency or permanent establishment to which such ADSs or ordinary shares are attributable (‘trading in the UK’).

As used herein, a ‘US holder’ is a person who, for US federal income tax purposes, is a beneficial owner of ordinary shares or ADSs and is: (i) a citizen or individual resident of the US; (ii) a corporation, or other entity taxable as a corporation, created or organised in or under the laws of the US or any political subdivision thereof; (iii) an estate whose income is subject to US federal income tax regardless of its source; or (iv) a trust, if a US court can exercise primary supervision over the trust’s administration and one or more US persons are authorised to control all substantial decisions of the trust.

This section is based on the IR Code, its legislative history, existing and proposed regulations, published rulings and court decisions, and on UK tax laws and the published practice of HM Revenue and Customs (HMRC), all as of the date hereof. These laws, and that practice, are subject to change, possibly on a retroactive basis.

This section is further based in part upon the representations of the ADR Depositary and assumes that each obligation in the deposit agreement and any related agreement will be performed in accordance with its terms. For US federal income tax purposes, an owner of ADRs evidencing ADSs will generally be treated as the owner of the underlying shares represented by those ADSs. For UK tax purposes, in practice, HMRC will also regard holders of ADSs as the beneficial owners of the ordinary shares represented by those ADSs (although case law has cast some doubt on this). The discussion below assumes that HMRC’s position is followed.

Generally, exchanges of ordinary shares for ADSs, and ADSs for ordinary shares, will not be subject to US federal income tax or UK taxation on capital gains, although UK stamp duty reserve tax (SDRT) may arise as described below.

The US Treasury has expressed concerns that parties to whom ADRs are pre-released may be taking actions that are inconsistent with the claiming of foreign tax credits by US holders of ADSs. Such actions would also be inconsistent with the claiming of the preferential rates of tax, described below, for qualified dividend income. Accordingly, the availability of the preferential rates of tax for qualified dividend income described below could be affected by actions taken by parties to whom the ADRs are pre-released.

The following discussion assumes that the Company is not, and will not become, a passive foreign investment company (PFIC), as described below.

Investors should consult their own tax advisors regarding the US federal, state and local, the UK and other tax consequences of owning and disposing of ordinary shares or ADSs in their particular circumstances.

Taxation of dividends

UK taxation

Under current UK tax law, the Company will not be required to withhold tax at source from dividend payments it makes.

A US holder who is not resident for UK tax purposes in the UK and who is not trading in the UK will generally not be liable for UK taxation on dividends received in respect of the ADSs or ordinary shares.

US federal income taxation

A US holder is subject to US federal income taxation on the gross amount of any dividend paid by the Company out of its current or accumulated earnings and profits (as determined for US federal income tax purposes). Distributions in excess of the Company’s current and accumulated earnings and profits, as determined for US federal income tax purposes, will be treated as a return of

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

171


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Shareholder information continued

 

capital to the extent of the US holder’s basis in the shares or ADSs and thereafter as capital gain. Because the Company has not historically maintained, and does not currently maintain, books in accordance with US tax principles, the Company does not expect to be in a position to determine whether any distribution will be in excess of the Company’s current and accumulated earnings and profits as computed for US federal income tax purposes. As a result, it is expected that amounts distributed will be reported to the Internal Revenue Service (IRS) as dividends.

Subject to applicable limitations and the discussion above regarding concerns expressed by the US Treasury, dividends paid to certain non-corporate US holders will be taxable at the preferential rates applicable to long-term capital gain if the dividends constitute “qualified dividend income”. The Company expects that dividends paid by the Company with respect to the ADSs will constitute qualified dividend income. US holders should consult their own tax advisors to determine whether they are subject to any special rules that limit their ability to be taxed at these preferential rates.

Dividends must be included in income when the US holder, in the case of shares, or the ADR Depositary, in the case of ADSs, actually or constructively receives the dividend, and will not be eligible for the dividends-received deduction generally allowed to US corporations in respect of dividends received from other US corporations. For foreign tax credit limitation purposes, dividends will generally be income from sources outside the US.

The amount of any dividend paid in pounds sterling will be the US dollar value of the sterling payments made, determined at the spot sterling/US dollar rate on the date the dividend distribution is includible in income, regardless of whether the payment is in fact converted into US dollars. If the dividend is converted into US dollars on that date, a US holder should not be required to recognise foreign currency gain or loss in respect of the dividend income. Generally, any gain or loss resulting from currency exchange fluctuations during the period from the date the dividend payment is includible in income to the date the payment is converted into US dollars will be treated as ordinary income or loss, from sources within the US.

Taxation of capital gains

UK taxation

A US holder who is not resident for UK tax purposes in the UK and who is not trading in the UK will not generally be liable for UK taxation on capital gains, or eligible for relief for allowable losses, realised or accrued on the sale or other disposal of ADSs or ordinary shares. A US holder of ADSs or ordinary shares who is an individual and who, broadly, has temporarily ceased to be resident in the UK or has become temporarily treated as non-resident for UK tax purposes for a period of not more than five years (or, for departures before 6 April 2013, ceases to be resident or ordinarily resident or becomes treated as non-resident for less than five years of assessment) and who disposes of ordinary shares or ADSs during that period may, for the year of assessment when that individual becomes resident again in the UK, be liable to UK tax on capital gains (subject to any available exemption or relief), notwithstanding the fact that such US holder was not treated as resident in the UK at the time of the sale or other disposal.

US federal income taxation

A US holder who sells or otherwise disposes of ordinary shares or ADSs will recognise a capital gain or loss for US federal income tax purposes equal to the difference between the amount realised and its tax basis in the ordinary shares or ADSs, each determined in US dollars. Such capital gain or loss will be long-term capital gain or loss where the US holder has a holding period greater than one year. Losses may also be treated as long-term capital losses to the extent of certain “extraordinary dividends” that qualified for the preferential tax rates on qualified dividend income described above. The capital gain or loss will generally be income or loss from sources within the US for foreign tax credit limitation purposes. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations.

PFIC rules

The Company believes that it was not a PFIC for US federal income tax purposes for its 2014 taxable year. However, this conclusion is an annual factual determination and thus may be subject to change. If the Company were to be treated as a PFIC, gain realised on the sale or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs would, in general, not be treated as capital gain. Instead, gain would be treated as if the US holder had realised such gain rateably over the holding period for the ordinary shares or ADSs and, to the extent allocated to the taxable year of the sale or other exchange and to any year before the Company became a PFIC, would be taxed as ordinary income. The amount allocated to each other taxable year would be taxed at the highest tax rate in effect for each such year to which the gain was allocated, together with an interest charge in respect of the tax attributable to each such year. In addition, similar rules would apply to any “excess distribution” received on the ordinary shares or ADSs (generally, the excess of any distribution received on the ordinary shares or ADSs during the taxable year over 125 per cent of the average amount of distributions received during a specified prior period), and the preferential rates for qualified dividend income received by certain non-corporate US holders would not apply.

Certain elections may be available (including a market-to-market election) to US holders that would result in alternative treatments of the ordinary shares or ADSs. If the Company were to be treated as a PFIC in any taxable year in which a US holder held ordinary shares or ADSs, a US holder will generally be required to file IRS Form 8621 with their annual US federal income tax returns, subject to certain exceptions.

Additional tax considerations

UK inheritance tax

An individual who is neither domiciled nor deemed domiciled in the UK (under certain UK rules relating to previous domicile or long residence) is only chargeable to UK inheritance tax to the extent the individual owns assets situated in the UK. As a matter of UK law, it is not clear whether the situs of an ADS for UK inheritance tax purposes is determined by the place where the depositary is established and records the entitlements of the deposit holders, or by the situs of the underlying share which the ADS represents, but the UK tax authorities may take the view that the ADSs, as well as the ordinary shares, are or represent UK situs assets.

 

 

 

 

172


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

 

However, an individual who is domiciled in the US (for the purposes of the Estate and Gift Tax Convention (Convention), and is not a UK national as defined in the Convention will not be subject to UK inheritance tax (to the extent UK inheritance tax applies) in respect of the ordinary shares or ADSs on the individual’s death or on a transfer of the ordinary shares or ADSs during their lifetime, provided that any applicable US federal gift or estate tax is paid, unless the ordinary shares or ADSs are part of the business property of a UK permanent establishment or pertain to a UK fixed base of an individual used for the performance of independent personal services. Where the ordinary shares or ADSs have been placed in trust by a settlor, they may be subject to UK inheritance tax unless, when the trust was created, the settlor was domiciled in the US and was not a UK national. If no relief is given under the Convention, inheritance tax may be charged on death and also on the amount by which the value of an individual’s estate is reduced as a result of any transfer made by way of gift or other undervalue transfer, broadly within seven years of death, and in certain other circumstances. Where the ordinary shares or ADSs are subject to both UK inheritance tax and to US federal gift or estate tax, the Convention generally provides for either a credit against US federal tax liabilities for UK inheritance tax paid or for a credit against UK inheritance tax liabilities for US federal tax paid, as the case may be.

UK stamp duty and SDRT

Neither stamp duty nor SDRT will generally be payable in the UK on the purchase or transfer of an ADS, provided that the ADS and any separate instrument or written agreement of transfer are executed and remain at all times outside the UK. UK legislation does however provide for stamp duty (in the case of transfers) or SDRT to be payable at the rate of 1.5 per cent on the amount or value of the consideration (or, in some cases, the value of the ordinary shares) where ordinary shares are issued or transferred to a person (or a nominee or agent of a person) whose business is or includes issuing depositary receipts or the provision of clearance services. In accordance with the terms of the deposit agreement, any tax or duty payable on deposits of ordinary shares by the depositary or by the custodian of the depositary will typically be charged to the party to whom ADSs are delivered against such deposits.

Following litigation on the subject, HMRC has accepted that it will no longer seek to apply the 1.5 per cent SDRT charge when new shares are issued to a clearance service or depositary receipt system on the basis that the charge is not compatible with EU law. In HMRC’s view, the 1.5 per cent SDRT or stamp duty charge will continue to apply to transfers of shares into a clearance service or depositary receipt system unless they are an integral part of an issue of share capital. This view is currently being challenged in further litigation. Accordingly, specific professional advice should be sought before paying the 1.5 per cent SDRT or stamp duty charge in any circumstances.

A transfer of the underlying ordinary shares will generally be subject to stamp duty or SDRT, normally at the rate of 0.5 per cent of the amount of value of the consideration (rounded up to the next multiple of £5 in the case of stamp duty). A transfer of ordinary shares from a nominee to its beneficial owner, including the transfer of underlying ordinary shares from the depositary to an ADS holder, under which no beneficial interest passes, will not be subject to stamp duty or SDRT.

 

US backup withholding and information reporting

Payments of dividends and other proceeds with respect to ADSs and ordinary shares may be reported to the IRS and to the US holder. Backup withholding may apply to these reportable payments if the US holder fails to provide an accurate taxpayer identification number or certification of exempt status or fails to report all interest and dividends required to be shown on its US federal income tax returns. Certain US holders (including, among others, corporations) are not subject to information reporting and backup withholding. The amount of any backup withholding from a payment to a US holder will be allowed as a credit against the holder’s US federal income tax liability and may entitle the holder to a refund, provided that the required information is timely furnished to the IRS. US holders should consult their tax advisors as to their qualification for exemption from backup withholding and the procedure for obtaining an exemption.

Disclosure controls and procedures

As of the end of the period covered by this report, the Group carried out an evaluation under the supervision and with the participation of the Group’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of the design and operation of the Group’s disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) of the Securities Exchange Act 1934). These are defined as those controls and procedures designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in reports filed under the Securities Exchange Act 1934 is recorded, processed, summarised and reported within the specified periods. Based on that evaluation, the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that the Group’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective.

Summary of significant corporate governance differences from NYSE listing standards

The Group’s statement of compliance with the principles and provisions specified in the UK Corporate Governance Code issued by the Financial Reporting Council in the UK in 2012 (the Code) is set out on pages 70 to 72.

IHG has also adopted the corporate governance requirements of the US Sarbanes-Oxley Act and related rules and of the NYSE, to the extent that they are applicable to it as a foreign private issuer. As a foreign private issuer, IHG is required to disclose any significant ways in which its corporate governance practices differ from those followed by US companies. These are as follows:

Basis of regulation

The Code contains a series of principles and provisions. It is not, however, mandatory for companies to follow these principles. Instead, companies must disclose how they have applied them and disclose, if applicable, any areas of non-compliance along with an explanation for the non-compliance. In contrast, US companies listed on the NYSE are required to adopt and disclose corporate governance guidelines adopted by the NYSE.

 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

173


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Shareholder information continued

 

Independent Directors

The Code’s principles recommend that at least half the Board, excluding the Chairman, should consist of independent Non-Executive Directors. As at 16 February 2015, the Board consisted of the Chairman, independent at the time of his appointment, three Executive Directors and seven independent Non-Executive Directors. NYSE listing rules applicable to US companies state that companies must have a majority of independent directors. The NYSE set out five bright line tests for director independence. The Board’s judgement is that all of its Non-Executive Directors are independent. However, it did not explicitly take into consideration the NYSE’s tests in reaching this determination.

Chairman and Chief Executive Officer

The Code recommends that the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer should not be the same individual to ensure that there is a clear division of responsibility for the running of the Company’s business. There is no corresponding requirement for US companies. The roles of Chairman and Chief Executive Officer were, as at 16 February 2015 and throughout 2014, fulfilled by separate individuals.

Committees

The Company has a number of Board Committees which are similar in purpose and constitution to those required for domestic companies under NYSE rules. The NYSE requires US companies to have both remuneration and nominating/corporate governance committees composed entirely of independent directors, as defined under the NYSE rules. The Company’s Nomination Committee consists only of Non-Executive Directors and the Company’s Audit and Remuneration Committees consists entirely of Non-Executive Directors who are independent under the standards of the Code, which may not necessarily be the same as the NYSE independence standards. The nominating/governance committee is responsible for identifying individuals qualified to become Board members and to recommend to the Board a set of corporate governance principles. As the Company is subject to the Code, the Company’s Nomination Committee is only responsible for nominating, for approval of the Board, candidates for appointment to the Board, though it also assists in developing the role of the Senior Independent Director. The Company’s Nomination Committee consists of the Chairman of the Company and all the independent Non-Executive Directors.

The Chairman of the Company is not a member of either of the Remuneration or the Audit Committees. As set out on page 65, the Audit Committee is chaired by an independent Non-Executive Director who, in the Board’s view, has the experience and qualifications to satisfy the criteria under US rules for an “audit committee financial expert”.

Non-Executive Director meetings

Non-management directors of US companies must meet on a regular basis without management present, and independent directors must meet separately at least once per year. The Code requires: (i) the Board Chairman to hold meetings with the Non-Executive Directors without the Executive Directors present; and (ii) the Non-Executive Directors to meet at least annually without the Chairman present to appraise the Chairman’s performance. The Company’s Non-Executive Directors have met without Executive Directors being present, and intend to continue this practice, after every Board meeting if possible.

Shareholder approval of equity compensation plans

The NYSE rules require that shareholders must be given the opportunity to vote on all equity compensation plans and material revisions to those plans. The Company complies with UK requirements which are similar to the NYSE rules. The Board does not, however, explicitly take into consideration the NYSE’s detailed definition of “material revisions”.

Code of Conduct

The NYSE requires companies to adopt a code of business conduct and ethics, applicable to directors, officers and employees. Any waivers granted to directors or officers under such a code must be promptly disclosed. As set out on page 74, IHG’s Code of Conduct is applicable to all Directors, officers and employees, and further information on the Code of Conduct is available on the Company’s website at www.ihgplc.com/investors under corporate governance. No waivers have been granted under the Code of Conduct.

Compliance certification

Each Chief Executive of a US company must certify to the NYSE each year that he or she is not aware of any violation by the Company of any NYSE corporate governance listing standard. As the Company is a foreign private issuer, the Company’s Chief Executive Officer is not required to make this certification. However, he is required to notify the NYSE promptly in writing after any of the Company’s executive officers become aware of any non-compliance with those NYSE corporate governance rules applicable to the Company.

 

 

 

Selected five-year consolidated financial information

The selected consolidated financial data set forth in the table on the next page for the years ended 31 December 2010, 2011, 2012, 2013 and 2014 has been prepared in accordance with IFRS as issued by the IASB and in accordance with IFRS as adopted by the EU, and is derived from the Group Financial Statements, which have been audited by its independent registered public accounting firm, Ernst & Young LLP.

IFRS as adopted by the EU differs in certain respects from IFRS as issued by the IASB. However, the differences have no impact on the Group Financial Statements for the years presented. The selected consolidated financial data set forth on the next page should be read in conjunction with, and is qualified in its entirety by reference to, the Group Financial Statements and Notes thereto included elsewhere in this Annual Report and Form 20-F.

 

 

 

174


Table of Contents
 
Group income statement data
 
For the year ended 31 December    2014      2013      2012      2011      2010  
     

 

($m, except earnings per ordinary share)

 
Revenue1      1,858         1,903         1,835         1,768             1,628   
Total operating profit before exceptional operating items      651         668         605         548         438   
Exceptional operating items1      29         5         (4      57         (7
Total operating profit1      680         673         601         605         431   
Financial income      3         5         3         2         2   
Financial expenses      (83      (78      (57      (64      (64
Profit before tax      600         600         547         543         369   
Tax:                                             
On profit before exceptional items      (179      (175      (151      (117      (96
On exceptional operating items      (29      (6      1         (4      1   
Exceptional tax              (45      141         43           
       (208      (226      (9      (78      (95
Profit after tax:      392         374         538         465         274   
Gain on disposal of discontinued operations, net of tax                                      2   
Profit for the year      392         374         538         465         276   
                                              
Attributable to:                                             

Equity holders of the parent

     391         372         537         465         276   

Non-controlling interest

     1         2         1                   
Profit for the year      392         374         538         465         276   
Earnings per ordinary share:                                             
Continuing operations:                                             

Basic

     158.3¢             140.9¢             187.1¢             160.9¢         95.1¢   

Diluted

     156.4¢         139.3¢         183.9¢         157.1¢         92.6¢   
Total operations:                                             

Basic

     158.3¢         140.9¢         187.1¢         160.9¢         95.8¢   

Diluted

     156.4¢         139.3¢         183.9¢         157.1¢         93.2¢   

 

1 Relates to continuing operations.

 

Group statement of financial position data

 

  

  

31 December    2014      2013
(restated1)
     2012
(restated1)
     2011
(restated1)
     2010
(restated1)
 
     

 

($m, except number of shares)

 
Goodwill and intangible assets      643         518         447         400         358   
Property, plant and equipment      741         1,169         1,056         1,362         1,690   
Investments and other financial assets      368         321         239         243         178   
Non-current trade and other receivables      3                                   
Retirement benefit assets      8         7         99         21         5   
Non-current tax receivable      34         16         24         41           
Deferred tax assets      87         108         204         106         88   
Current assets      624         700         852         784         659   
Assets classified as held for sale      310         228         534         217           
Total assets      2,818         3,067         3,455         3,174         2,978   
Current liabilities      943         928         972         1,066         1,136   
Long-term debt      1,569         1,269         1,242         670         776   
Net (liabilities) / assets      (717      (74      317         555         278   
Equity share capital      178         189         179         162         155   
IHG shareholders’ equity      (725      (82      308         547         271   
Number of shares in issue at end of the year (millions)      248         269         268         290         289   

1 Restated for the adoption of ‘Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities’ (Amendments to IAS 32), see page 107.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

175


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Shareholder information continued

 

Return of funds

Since March 2004, the Group has returned over £4.8bn of funds to shareholders by way of special dividends, capital returns and share repurchase programmes.

On 2 May 2014, the Company announced a $750m return of funds to shareholders via special dividend with share consolidation. The special dividend was paid on 14 July 2014.

 

Return of funds programme    Timing    Total return    Returned to date
£501m special dividend1    Paid in December 2004    £501m    £501m
£250m share buyback    Completed in 2004    £250m    £250m
£996m capital return1    Paid in July 2005    £996m    £996m
£250m share buyback    Completed in 2006    £250m    £250m
£497m special dividend1    Paid in June 2006    £497m    £497m
£250m share buyback    Completed in 2007    £250m    £250m
£709m special dividend1    Paid in June 2007    £709m    £709m
£150m share buyback    n/a2    £150m    £120m
$500m special dividend1,3    Paid in October 2012    £315m4 ($500m)    £315m ($505m)5
$500m share buyback    Completed in 2014    £315m4 ($500m)    £315m ($500m)6
$350m special dividend    Paid in October 2013    £229m7 ($350m)    £228m ($355m)8
$750m special dividend1    Paid in July 2014    £447m9 ($750m)    £446m ($763m)10
Total         £4,909m    £4,877m

 

1  Accompanied by a share consolidation.
2  This programme was superseded by the share buyback programme announced on 7 August 2012.
3  IHG changed the reporting currency of its Consolidated Financial Statements from sterling to US dollars effective from the Half-Year Results as at 30 June 2008.
4  The dividend was first determined in US dollars and converted to sterling immediately before announcement at the rate of $1=£0.63, as set out in the circular detailing the special dividend and share buyback programme published on 14 September 2012.
5  Sterling dividend translated at $1=£0.624.
6  Translated into US dollars at the average rates of exchange for the relevant years (2014 $1=£0.61; 2013 $1=£0.64; 2012 $1 = £0.63).
7  The dividend was first determined in US dollars and converted to sterling immediately before announcement at the rate of $1=£0.65, as announced in the Half-Year Results to 30 June 2013.
8  Sterling dividend translated at $1=£0.644.
9  The dividend was first determined in US dollars and converted to sterling immediately before announcement at the rate translated at $1=£0.597.
10  Sterling dividend translated at $1=£0.5845.

 

 

Purchases of equity securities by the Company and affiliated purchasers

The Group’s $500m share repurchase programme was announced on 7 August 2012 and completed on 29 May 2014. As at 31 December 2014, 17,339,845 shares had been repurchased at an average price of 1,811.7674 pence per share (approximately £314m).

 

Period of financial year   (a) Total number of shares
(or units) purchased
    (b) Average price paid
per share (or unit)
    (c) Total number of shares
(or units) purchased as
part of publicly
announced plans or
programmes
    (d) Maximum number
(or approximate dollar value)
of shares (or units) that may yet
be purchased under the plans
or programmes
 
Month 1     350,249        2,007.8500        nil        18,855,0081   
Month 2     1,617,551        1,950.2062        770,412        18,084,5961   
Month 3     2,354,577        1,914.9212        2,354,577        15,730,0191   
Month 4 (no purchases this month)     nil        nil        nil        15,730,0191   
Month 5     296,984        2,259.9608        296,984        25,620,0462   
Month 6     8        2,311.0000        nil        23,611,7253   
Month 7 (no purchases this month)     nil        nil        nil        23,611,7253   
Month 8 (no purchases this month)     nil        nil        nil        23,611,7253   
Month 9 (no purchases this month)     nil        nil        nil        23,611,7253   
Month 10 (no purchases this month)     nil        nil        nil        23,611,7253   
Month 11 (no purchases this month)     nil        nil        nil        23,611,7253   
Month 12     461,815        2,580.3724        nil        23,611,7253   

 

1  Reflects the resolution passed at the Company’s AGM held on 24 May 2013.
2  Reflects the resolution passed at the Company’s AGM held on 2 May 2014.
3  Reflects the resolution passed at the Company’s General Meeting held on 30 June 2014.

During the financial year ended 31 December 2014, 1,659,203 ordinary shares were purchased by the Company’s Employee Share Ownership Trust, at prices ranging from 1,928 pence to 2,633 pence per share, for the purpose of satisfying future share awards to employees.

 

 

 

176


Table of Contents
 
Share price information
 

The principal trading market for the Company’s ordinary shares is the London Stock Exchange (LSE). The ordinary shares are also listed on the NYSE trading in the form of ADSs evidenced by ADRs. Each ADS represents one ordinary share. The Company has a sponsored ADR facility with JPMorgan as ADR Depositary. The following table shows, for the financial periods indicated, the reported high and low middle market quotations (which represent an average of closing bid and ask prices) for the ordinary shares on the LSE, as derived from the Official List of the UK Listing Authority, and the highest and lowest sales prices of the ADSs as reported on the NYSE composite tape.

 

                                                                   
      £ per ordinary share      $ per ADS1  
Year ended 31 December    high      low      high      low  
2010      12.66         8.87         20.04         13.84   
2011      14.35         9.55         23.28         15.27   
2012      17.25         11.57         27.82         17.99   
2013      20.39         17.07         33.54         26.90   
2014      27.10         18.66         42.51         30.88   
Quarters in the year ended 31 December                                    
2013                                    
First quarter      20.22         17.07         30.64         27.82   
Second quarter      20.39         17.37         30.61         26.90   
Third quarter      20.30         17.88         31.08         27.77   
Fourth quarter      20.25         17.63         33.54         28.27   
2014                                    
First quarter      20.47         18.66         34.08         30.88   
Second quarter      24.21         19.04         41.51         31.60   
Third quarter      24.75         21.99         42.51         36.84   
Fourth quarter      27.10         21.20         42.38         34.03   
2015                                    
First quarter (to 16 February 2015)      27.56         25.33         41.57         38.32   
Month ended                                    
August 2014      23.75         21.99         40.02         37.15   
September 2014      24.45         22.85         39.85         36.84   
October 2014      23.69         21.20         38.01         34.03   
November 2014      27.10         24.03         42.38         38.25   
December 2014      26.39         24.17         41.30         37.63   
January 2015      27.56         25.33         41.57         38.32   
February 2015 (to 16 February 2015)      26.76         25.88         41.37         39.24   

 

1  Fluctuations in the exchange rates between sterling and the US dollar will affect the dollar equivalent of the sterling price of the ordinary shares on the LSE and, as a result, are likely to affect the market price of ADSs.

 

 

Dividend history

The table below sets forth the amounts of ordinary dividends on each ordinary share and special dividends, in respect of each financial year indicated.

 

                                                                                                                                                                       
      Interim dividend      Final dividend      Total dividend      Special dividend  
      pence      cents      pence      cents      pence      cents      pence     cents  
2014      14.8         25.0         33.8         52.0         48.6         77.0         174.9 1      293.0 1 
2013      15.1         23.0         28.1         47.0         43.2         70.0         87.1        133.0   
2012      13.5         21.0         27.7         43.0         41.2         64.0         108.4 1      172.0 1 
2011      9.8         16.0         24.7         39.0         34.5         55.0                  
2010      8.0         12.8         22.0         35.2         30.0         48.0                  
2009      7.3         12.2         18.7         29.2         26.0         41.4                  
20082      6.4         12.2         20.2         29.2         26.6         41.4                  
2007      5.7         11.5         14.9         29.2         20.6         40.7         200 1        
2006      5.1         9.6         13.3         25.9         18.4         35.5         118 1        
2005      4.6         8.1         10.7         18.7         15.3         26.8                  
2004      4.3         7.7         10.0         19.1         14.3         26.8         72.0 1        
2003      4.05         6.8         9.45         17.4         13.5         24.2                  

 

1  Accompanied by a share consolidation.
2  IHG changed the reporting currency of its Consolidated Financial Statements from sterling to US dollars effective from the Half-Year Results as at 30 June 2008. Starting with the interim dividend for 2008, all dividends have first been determined in US dollars and converted into sterling immediately before announcement.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

177


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

Shareholder information continued

Shareholder profiles

Shareholder profile by type as at 31 December 2014

 

Category of

shareholdings

   Number of
shareholders
        Percentage total of
shareholders
        Number of ordinary
shares
              Percentage
of issued
share capital
See chart g
 
¢ Private individuals      41,572        92.77        13,885,472        5.88   
¢ Nominee companies      1,428        3.18        194,775,369        82.49   
¢ Limited and public limited
    companies
     1,647        3.68        12,813,041        5.43   
¢ Other corporate bodies      159        0.35        14,004,127        5.93   

¢ Pension funds, insurance

    companies and banks

     7        0.02        639,247        0.27   
Total      44,813        100        236,117,256        100   

Shareholder profile by size as at 31 December 2014

 

  

 

Range of

shareholdings

   Number of
shareholders
    Percentage total of
shareholders
    Number of ordinary
shares
    Percentage
of issued
share capital
See chart  g
 
¢ 1 – 199      28,412        63.40        1,801,918        0.76   
¢ 200 – 499      8,696        19.41        2,774,193        1.17   
¢ 500 – 999      4,029        8.99        2,820,987        1.19   
¢ 1,000 – 4,999      2,808        6.27        5,309,076        2.25   
¢ 5,000 – 9,999      237        0.53        1,666,106        0.71   
¢ 10,000 – 49,999      306        0.68        7,239,768        3.07   
¢ 50,000 – 99,999      95        0.21        6,746,779        2.86   
¢ 100,000 – 499,999      146        0.33        31,810,194        13.47   
¢ 500,000 – 999,999      42        0.09        30,898,339        13.09   
¢ 1,000,000 and above      42        0.09        145,049,896        61.43   
Total      44,813        100        236,117,256        100   

Shareholder profile by geographical location as at 31 December 2014

 

  

 

Country/

Jurisdiction

                        Percentage 
of issued 
share capital1
See chart g 
 
¢ UK                              50.3   
¢ Rest of Europe                              12.1   
¢ US (including ADRs)                              33.6   
¢ Rest of World                              4.0   
Total                              100   

 

1  The geographical profile presented is based on an analysis of shareholders (by manager) of 40,000 shares or above where geographical ownership is known. This analysis only captures 88.8% of total issued share capital. Therefore, the known percentage distributions have been multiplied by 100/88.8 (1.126) to achieve the figures shown in the table above.

As of 13 February 2015, 15,835,637 ADSs equivalent to 15,835,637 ordinary shares, or approximately 6.7 per cent of the total issued share capital, were outstanding and were held by 685 holders. Since certain ordinary shares are registered in the names of nominees, the number of shareholders on record may not be representative of the number of beneficial owners.

As of 13 February 2015, there were a total of 44,627 record holders of ordinary shares, of whom 249 had registered addresses in the US and held a total of 670,170 ordinary shares (0.27 per cent of the total issued share capital).

 

 

LOGO

 

 

LOGO

 

 

LOGO

 

 

 

178


Table of Contents
 
    

 

 

Useful information

Investor information

 

Website and electronic communication

As part of IHG’s commitment to reduce the cost and environmental impact of producing and distributing printed documents in large quantities, this Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014 has been made available to shareholders through our website at www.ihgplc.com/investors under financial library.

Shareholders may electronically appoint a proxy to vote on their behalf at the 2015 AGM. Shareholders who hold their shares through CREST may appoint proxies through the CREST electronic proxy appointment service, by using the procedures described in the CREST Manual.

Shareholder hotel discount

IHG offers discounted hotel stays (subject to availability) for registered shareholders only, through a controlled access website. This is not available to shareholders who hold shares through nominee companies, ISAs or ADRs. For further details please contact the Company Secretariat department (see page 180).

Responsible Business Report

In line with our commitment to responsible business practices, this year we have decided to produce a broader Responsible Business Report showcasing our approach to responsible business and progress against our corporate responsibility targets. This can be viewed at www.ihgplc.com/responsiblebusiness

IHG® Shelter in a Storm

IHG Shelter in a Storm enables IHG to support our hotels and local communities, employees and guests when a disaster occurs, by providing immediate and vital assistance.

To make a donation to the programme, visit the secure payment page at www.ihgshelterinastorm.com

Registrar

For information on a range of shareholder services, including enquiries concerning individual shareholdings, notification of a shareholder’s change of address and amalgamation of shareholder accounts (in order to avoid duplicate mailing of shareholder communications), shareholders should contact the Company’s Registrar, Equiniti, on 0871 384 21321,2 (calls from within the UK) or +44 (0) 121 415 7034 (calls from outside the UK).

Dividend services

Dividend Reinvestment Plan (DRIP)

The Company offers a DRIP for shareholders to purchase additional IHG shares with their cash dividends. For further information about the DRIP, please contact our Registrar helpline on 0871 384 22681,2. A DRIP application form and information booklet are available at www.shareview.co.uk/products/pages/applyforadrip.aspx

Bank mandate

We encourage shareholders to have their dividends paid directly into their UK bank or building society account, to ensure efficient payment and clearance of funds on the payment date. For further information, please contact our Registrar (see page 180).

Overseas payment service

It is also possible for shareholders to have their dividends paid direct to their bank account in a local currency. Charges are payable for this service. Further information is available at www.shareview.co.uk/shareholders/pages/

overseaspayments.aspx

Out-of-date/unclaimed dividends

If you think that you have out-of-date dividend cheques or unclaimed dividend payments, please contact our Registrar (see page 180).

Individual Savings Account (ISA)

Equiniti offers a Stocks and Shares ISA that can invest in IHG shares. For further information, please contact Equiniti on 0871 384 22441,2.

Share dealing services

Equiniti offers the following share dealing facilities:

Postal dealing

For more information, call 0871 384 22481,2

Telephone dealing

For more information, call 0845 603 70371,3

Internet dealing

For more information, visit www.shareview.co.uk

Changes to the base cost of IHG shares

Details of all the changes to the base cost of IHG shares held from April 2003 to December 2014, for UK Capital Gains Tax purposes, may be found on our website at www.ihgplc.com/investors under shareholder centre/tax information.

‘Gone away’ shareholders

Working with ProSearch (an asset reunification company), we continue to look for shareholders who have not kept their contact details up to date. We have funds waiting to be claimed and are committed to doing what we can to pay these to their rightful owners. For further details, please contact ProSearch on 01732 741 411 or email info@prosearchassets.com

Shareholder security

Many companies have become aware that their shareholders have received unsolicited telephone calls or correspondence concerning investment matters. These are typically from ‘brokers’ who target UK shareholders, offering to sell them what often turn out to be worthless or high-risk shares in US or UK investments. These operations are commonly known as ‘boiler rooms’. More detailed information on this or similar activity can be found on the Financial Conduct Authority website at www.fca.org.uk/consumers/scams. Details of any share dealing facilities that the Company endorses will be included in Company mailings.

American Depositary Receipts (ADRs)

The Company’s shares are listed on the NYSE in the form of American Depositary Shares, evidenced by ADRs and traded under the symbol ‘IHG’. Each ADR represents one ordinary share. All enquiries regarding ADR holder accounts and payment of dividends should be directed to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., our ADR Depositary bank (contact details shown on page 180).

Documents on display

Documents referred to in this Annual Report and Form 20-F that are filed with the SEC can be found at the SEC’s public reference room located at 100 F Street, NE Washington, D.C. 20549, for further information and copy charges please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. The Company’s SEC filings since 22 May 2002 are also publicly available through the SEC’s website at www.sec.gov. Copies of the Company’s Articles can be obtained via the website at www.ihgplc.com/investors under corporate governance or from the Company’s registered office on request.

 

1  Calls cost 8p per minute plus network extras.
2  Lines are open from 8.30am to 5.30pm Monday to Friday, excluding UK public holidays.
3  Lines are open from 8.00am to 4.30pm Monday to Friday, excluding UK public holidays.
 

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

179


Table of Contents
 

IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

 

Useful information continued

Financial calendar

 

          2014 
Special dividend of 174.9p per share (293¢ per ADR):   Payment date   14 July 
Interim dividend of 14.8p per share (25.0¢ per ADR):   Payment date   26 September 
Financial year end       31 December 
          2015 
Announcement of Preliminary Results for 2014       17 February 
2014 Final dividend of 33.8p per share (52.0¢ per ADR):   Ex-dividend date   2 April 
    Record date   7 April 
Announcement of 2015 First Quarter Interim Management Statement       8 May 
Annual General Meeting       8 May 
2014 Final dividend of 33.8p per share (52.0¢ per ADR):   Payment date   15 May 
Announcement of Half-Year Results for 2015       30 July 
2015 Interim dividend:   Payment date   October 
Announcement of 2015 Third Quarter Interim Management Statement       20 October 
Financial year end       31 December 
          2016 
Announcement of Preliminary Results for 2015       February 

Contacts

 

 

Registered office

Broadwater Park, Denham,

Buckinghamshire, UB9 5HR, UK

 

Telephone:

+44 (0) 1895 512 000

 

Fax :

+44 (0) 1895 512 101

 

www.ihgplc.com

 

For general information about the Group’s business, please contact the Corporate Affairs department at the above address. For all other enquiries, please contact the Company Secretariat department at the above address.

 

Registrar

Equiniti, Aspect House, Spencer Road,

Lancing, West Sussex, BN99 6DA, UK

 

Telephone:

0871 384 21321,2 (UK calls)

 

+44 (0) 121 415 7034 (non-UK calls)

 

www.shareview.co.uk

     

 

ADR Depositary

JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A.

PO Box 64504, St. Paul

MN 55120-0854, USA

 

Telephone:

+1 800 990 1135 (US calls) (toll-free)

+1 651 453 2128 (non-US calls)

 

Email: jpmorgan.adr@wellsfargo.com

 

www.adr.com

 

Auditor

Ernst & Young LLP

 

Investment bankers

Bank of America Merrill Lynch

Goldman Sachs

 

Solicitors

Freshfields Bruckhaus Deringer LLP

 

Stockbrokers

Bank of America Merrill Lynch

Goldman Sachs

     

 

IHG® Rewards Club

If you wish to enquire about,

or join IHG Rewards Club, visit

www.ihg.com/rewardsclub or telephone:

 

0871 226 11113 (Europe)

 

+1 888 211 98744 (US and Canada)

 

+1 800 272 92734 (Mexico)

 

+1 801 975 30635 (English) (Central and South America)

 

+1 801 975 30135 (Spanish) (Central and South America)

 

+971 4 429 05305 (Middle East and Africa)

 

+02 9935 83625 (Australia)

 

+86 21 2033 48485 (Mandarin and Cantonese) (China and Hong Kong)

 

+81 3 5767 93255 (Japan)

 

+63 2 857 87785 (Korea)

 

+63 2 857 87885 (all other countries in Asia Pacific)

 

 

1  For those with hearing difficulties a text phone is available on 0871 384 22552 for UK callers with compatible equipment.
2  Calls cost 8p per minute plus network extras. Lines are open from 8.30am to 5.30pm Monday to Friday, excluding UK public holidays.
3  Telephone calls to this number are charged at 10p per minute. Standard network rates apply. Calls from mobiles will be higher.
4  Toll free.
5  Toll charges apply.

 

 

 

180


Table of Contents
 
    
 
Exhibits   

The following exhibits are filed as part of this Annual Report on Form 20-F with the SEC:

 

Exhibit 11    Articles of Association of the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 1 of the InterContinental Hotels Group PLC Annual Report on Form 20-F (File No. 1-10409) dated 11 April 2011)
Exhibit 4(a)(i)    $400 million bank facility agreement dated 13 January 2015, among InterContinental Hotels Group PLC and certain of its subsidiaries, and Bank of America Merrill Lynch International Limited
Exhibit 4(a)(ii)    Share sale and purchase agreement between Kimpton Group Holding LLC and Dunwoody Operations, Inc. dated 15 December 2014
Exhibit 4(a)(iii)    Share sale and purchase agreement relating to InterContinental Paris – Le Grand, between BHR Holdings BV and Constellation Hotels France Grand SA dated 7 December 2014
Exhibit 4(a)(iv)1    Contribution agreement relating to InterContinental New York Barclay, between Barclay Operating Corp., InterContinental Hotels Group Resources, Inc., Constellation Barclay Holding US, LLC, and 111 East 48th Street Holdings, LLC dated 19 December 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(a)(i) of the InterContinental Hotels Group PLC Annual Report on Form 20-F (File No. 1-10409) dated 26 February 2014)
Exhibit 4(a)(v)1    Asset sale and purchase agreement relating to Intercontinental Hotel, Park Lane, London, between Hotel Inter-Continental London Limited, Constellation Hotel (Opco) UK S.A., and Six Continents Limited dated 27 March 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(a)(ii) of the InterContinental Hotels Group PLC Annual Report on Form 20-F (File No. 1-10409) dated 26 February 2014)
Exhibit 4(a)(vi)1    Five-year $1,070 million bank facility agreement dated 7 November 2011, among The Royal Bank of Scotland plc, NB International Finance B.V., Citigroup Global Markets Limited, HSBC Bank plc, Lloyds TSB Bank plc and The Bank of Tokyo-Mitsubishi UFJ, Ltd. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(a)(i) of the InterContinental Hotels Group PLC Annual Report on Form 20-F (File No. 1-10409) dated 29 March 2012)
Exhibit 4(a)(vii)1    First supplemental trust deed dated 7 July 2011 modifying and restating the Euro Medium Term Note programme governed by a trust deed dated 29 November 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(a)(ii) of the InterContinental Hotels Group PLC Annual Report on Form 20-F (File No. 1-10409) dated 29 March 2012)
Exhibit 4(a)(viii)1    Amended and restated trust deed dated 9 November 2012 relating to a £750 million Euro Medium Term Note Programme, among InterContinental Hotels Group PLC, Six Continents Limited, InterContinental Hotels Limited and HSBC Corporate Trustee Company (UK) Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(a)(iii) of the InterContinental Hotels Group PLC Annual Report on Form 20-F (File No. 1-10409) dated 26 March 2013)
Exhibit 4(c)(i)1    Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson’s service contract dated 6 December 2013, commencing on 1 January 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(c)(i) of the InterContinental Hotels Group PLC Annual Report on Form 20-F (File No. 1-10409) dated 26 February 2014)
Exhibit 4(c)(ii)1    Tracy Robbins’ service contract dated 9 August 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(c)(i) of the InterContinental Hotels Group PLC Annual Report on Form 20-F (File No. 1-10409) dated 29 March 2012)
Exhibit 4(c)(iii)1    Tom Singer’s service contract dated 26 July 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(c)(ii) of the InterContinental Hotels Group PLC Annual Report on Form 20-F (File No. 1-10409) dated 29 March 2012)
Exhibit 4(c)(iv)1    Kirk Kinsell’s service contract commencing on 1 August 2010, as amended by a letter dated 5 July 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(c)(ii) of the InterContinental Hotels Group PLC Annual Report on Form 20-F (File No. 1-10409) dated 11 April 2011)
Exhibit 4(c)(v)1    Richard Solomons’ service contract dated 16 March 2011, commencing on 1 July 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(c)(iii) of the InterContinental Hotels Group PLC Annual Report on Form 20-F (File No. 1-10409) dated 11 April 2011)
Exhibit 4(c)(vi)1    Rules of the InterContinental Hotels Group Long Term Incentive Plan as amended on 26 September 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(c)(v) of the InterContinental Hotels Group PLC Annual Report on Form 20-F (File No. 1-10409) dated 26 March 2013)
Exhibit 4(c)(vii)1    Rules of the InterContinental Hotels Group Annual Bonus Plan as amended on 26 September 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(c)(vi) of the InterContinental Hotels Group PLC Annual Report on Form 20-F (File No. 1-10409) dated 26 March 2013)
Exhibit 4(c)(ix)    Rules of the InterContinental Hotels Group Long Term Incentive Plan as amended on 2 May 2014
Exhibit 4(c)(x)    Rules of the InterContinental Hotels Group Annual Performance Plan as amended on 2 May 2014
Exhibit 8    List of subsidiaries as at 31 December 2014
Exhibit 12(a)    Certification of Richard Solomons filed pursuant to 17 CFR 240.13a-14(a)
Exhibit 12(b)    Certification of Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson filed pursuant to 17 CFR 240.13a-14(a)
Exhibit 13(a)    Certification of Richard Solomons and Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson furnished pursuant to 17 CFR 240.13a-14(b) and 18 U.S.C.1350
Exhibit 15(a)    Consent of independent registered public accounting firm, Ernst & Young LLP

 

1  Incorporated by reference.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

181


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014
 

Form 20-F cross-reference guide

 

Item    Form 20-F caption    Location in this document    Page
1    Identity of directors, senior management and advisers    Not applicable   
2    Offer statistics and expected timetable    Not applicable   
3    Key information:          
   3A – Selected financial data    Shareholder information: Selected five-year consolidated financial information    174-175
          Shareholder information: Dividend history    177
     3B – Capitalisation and indebtedness    Not applicable   
     3C – Reason for the offer and use of proceeds    Not applicable   
     3D – Risk factors    Group information: Risk factors    162-165
4    Information on the Company          
   4A – History and development of the Company    Group information: History and developments    162
      Shareholder information: Return of funds    176
          Useful information: Contact details    180
   4B – Business overview    Strategic Report    2-51
          Group information: Working Time Regulations 1998    169
     4C – Organisational structure    Group Financial Statements: Note 34 – Principal operating subsidiary undertakings    153
   4D – Property, plants and equipment    Strategic Report: Doing business responsibly – IHG’s global greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions    25
          Group Financial Statements: Note 10 – Property, plant and equipment    126
4A    Unresolved staff comments    None   
5    Operating and financial review and prospects          
   5A – Operating results    Strategic Report: Performance    34-51
          Group Financial Statements: Accounting policies    107-113
   5B – Liquidity and capital resources    Strategic Report: Performance – Liquidity and capital resources    50-51
      Group Financial Statements: Note 17 – Cash and cash equivalents    133
      Group Financial Statements: Note 20 – Financial risk management    135-137
      Group Financial Statements: Note 21 – Loans and other borrowings    138-139
      Group Financial Statements: Note 22 – Derivative financial instruments    139
          Group Financial Statements: Note 23 – Fair value measurement    140-141
    

5C – Research and development; intellectual

         property

   Not applicable   
     5D – Trend information    Strategic Report: Performance    34-51
     5E – Off-balance sheet arrangements    Strategic Report: Performance – Liquidity and capital resources    50-51
     5F – Tabular disclosure of contractual obligations    Strategic Report: Performance – Liquidity and capital resources    50-51
     5G – Safe harbour    Additional Information: Forward-looking statements    186
6    Directors, senior management and employees          
     6A – Directors and senior management    Corporate Governance: Who is on our Board of Directors and Who is on our Executive Committee    57-61
   6B – Compensation    Directors’ Remuneration Report    76-91
      Group Financial Statements: Note 25 – Retirement benefits    142-146
          Group Financial Statements: Note 26 – Share-based payments    146-148
     6C – Board practices    Corporate Governance    54-72
   6D – Employees    Strategic Report: Disciplined Execution – Investment in developing great talent    23
      Group Financial Statements: Note 3 – Staff costs and Directors’ emoluments    120
          Group information: Working Time Regulations 1998    169
   6E – Share ownership    Directors’ Report: Director and Executive Committee shareholdings    74
      Directors’ Remuneration Report: Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration – Scheme interests awarded during 2014    86
      Directors’ Remuneration Report: Annual Report on Directors’ Remuneration – Statement of Directors’ shareholdings and share interests    88
      Group Financial Statements: Note 26 – Share-based payments    146-148
          Group information: Executive Committee members’ shareholdings    166
7    Major shareholders and related party transactions          
   7A – Major shareholders    Directors’ Report: Major institutional shareholders    73
          Shareholder information: Shareholder profiles    178
   7B – Related party transactions    Group Financial Statements: Note 14 – Investment in associates and joint ventures    130
          Group Financial Statements: Note 31 – Related party disclosures    152
     7C – Interests of experts and counsel    Not applicable   
8    Financial Information          
   8A – Consolidated statements and other    Directors’ Report: Dividends    73
            financial information    Group Financial Statements    92-153
          Group information: Rights attaching to shares    167-168
     8B – Significant changes    None   

 

 

 

182


Table of Contents
 
    
 

 

Item    Form 20-F caption    Location in this document    Page
9    The offer and listing          
     9A – Offer and listing details    Shareholder information: Share price information    177
     9B – Plan of distribution    Not applicable   
     9C – Markets    Shareholder information: Share price information    177
     9D – Selling shareholders    Not applicable   
     9E – Dilution    Not applicable   
     9F – Expenses of the issue    Not applicable   
10    Additional information          
     10A – Share capital    Not applicable   
     10B – Memorandum and articles of association    Group information: Articles of Association    167-168
     10C – Material contracts    Group information: Material contracts    169-170
     10D – Exchange controls    Shareholder information: Exchange controls and restrictions on payment of dividends    171
     10E – Taxation    Shareholder information: Taxation    171-173
     10F – Dividends and paying agents    Not applicable   
     10G – Statement by experts    Not applicable   
     10H– Documents on display    Useful information: Investor information – Documents on display    179
     10I – Subsidiary information    Not applicable   
11    Quantitative and qualitative disclosures about market risk    Group Financial Statements: Note 20 – Financial risk management    135-137
12    Description of securities other than equity securities          
     12A – Debt securities    Not applicable   
     12B – Warrants and rights    Not applicable   
     12C – Other securities    Not applicable   
     12D – American depositary shares    Group information: Description of securities other than equity securities    166-167
13    Defaults, dividend arrearages and delinquencies    Not applicable   
14    Material modifications to the rights of security holders and use of proceeds    Not applicable   
15    Controls and Procedures          
     15A – Controls and Procedures    Shareholder information: Disclosure controls and procedures    173
    

15B – Management’s annual report on internal control over financial reporting

   Group Financial Statements: Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities – Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting    94
    

15C – Attestation report

   Group Financial Statements: Independent Auditor’s US Report    99
    

15D – Changes in internal controls over financial reporting

   Group Financial Statements: Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities: Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting    94
16    16A – Audit committee financial expert   

Corporate Governance: Audit Committee Report

Shareholder information: Summary of significant corporate governance differences from NYSE listing standards – Committees

  

65

174

     16B – Code of ethics    Strategic Report: Doing business responsibly    24-25, 74
   16C – Principal accountant fees and services    Corporate Governance: Audit Committee Report – External Auditor    66-67
      Corporate Governance: Audit Committee Report – Non-audit services    67
          Group Financial Statements: Note 4 – Auditor’s remuneration paid to Ernst & Young LLP    120
    

16D – Exemptions from the listing standards for audit committees

   Not applicable   
    

16E – Purchase of equity securities by the issuer and affiliated purchasers

   Shareholder information: Purchases of equity securities by the Company and affiliated purchasers    176
    

16F – Change in registrant’s certifying accountant

   Not applicable   
     16G – Corporate governance    Shareholder information: Summary of significant corporate governance differences from NYSE listing standards    173-174
     16H – Mine safety disclosure    Not applicable   
17    Financial statements    Not applicable   
18    Financial statements    Group Financial Statements    92-153
19    Exhibits    Additional information: Exhibits    181

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

183


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

 

Glossary

 

adjusted

excluding the effect of exceptional items and any relevant tax.

 

ADR

an American Depositary Receipt, being a receipt evidencing title to an ADS.

 

ADR Depositary (JPMorgan)

JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A.

 

ADS

an American Depositary Share as evidenced by an ADR, being a registered negotiable security, listed on the New York Stock Exchange, representing one ordinary share of 15 265329 pence each of the Company.

 

AGM

Annual General Meeting.

 

AMEA

Asia, Middle East and Africa.

 

Annual Report

The Annual Report and Form 20-F in relation to the years ending 31 December 2013 or 2014, as relevant.

 

APP

Annual Performance Plan.

 

Articles

the Articles of Association of the Company for the time being in force.

 

average daily rate or average room rate

rooms revenue divided by the number of room nights sold.

 

basic earnings per ordinary share

profit available for IHG equity holders divided by the weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue during the year.

 

capital expenditure

purchases of property, plant and equipment, intangible assets, associate and joint venture investments, and other financial assets.

 

cash-generating units (CGUs)

the smallest identifiable groups of assets that generate cash inflows that are largely independent of the cash inflows from other assets or groups of assets.

 

Code

UK Corporate Governance Code issued in September 2012 by the Financial Reporting Council in the UK.

 

Companies Act

the Companies Act 2006, as amended from time to time.

 

Company

InterContinental Hotels Group PLC.

comparable RevPAR

a comparison for a grouping of hotels that have traded in all months in both financial years being compared. Principally excludes new hotels, hotels closed for major refurbishment and hotels sold in either of the two years.

 

constant currency

a current year value translated using the previous year’s exchange rates.

 

contingencies

liabilities that are contingent upon the occurrence of one or more uncertain future events.

 

continuing operations

operations not classified as discontinued.

 

currency swap

an exchange of a deposit and a borrowing, each denominated in a different currency, for an agreed period of time.

 

derivatives

a financial instrument used to reduce risk, the price of which is derived from an underlying asset, index or rate.

 

direct channels

digital and voice.

 

discontinued operations

hotels or operations sold or those classified as held for sale when the results relate to a separate line of business, geographical area of operations, or where there is a co-ordinated plan to dispose of a separate line of business or geographical area of operations.

 

Employee Engagement survey

twice a year, we ask our employees and those who work in our managed hotels (excluding our joint venture hotels) to participate in an Employee Engagement survey, to measure employee engagement.

 

EU

the European Union.

 

euro or

the currency of the European Economic and Monetary Union.

 

exceptional items

items that are disclosed separately because of their size or nature.

extended-stay

hotels designed for guests staying for periods of time longer than a few nights and tending to have a higher proportion of suites than normal hotels (Staybridge Suites and Candlewood Suites).

 

fee margin

operating profit as a percentage of revenue, excluding revenue and operating profit from owned and leased hotels, managed leases and significant liquidated damages.

 

fee revenue

Group revenue excluding revenue from owned and leased hotels, managed leases and significant liquidated damages.

 

franchisee

an operator who uses a brand under licence from the brand owner, IHG.

 

franchisor

the brand owner, IHG, who licenses brands for use by operators.

 

goodwill

the difference between the consideration given for a business and the total of the fair values of the separable assets and liabilities comprising that business.

 

Group or IHG

the Company and its subsidiaries.

 

Guest Heartbeat

IHG’s guest satisfaction measurement tool to measure brand preference and guest satisfaction.

 

hedging

the reduction of risk, normally in relation to foreign currency or interest rate movements, by making offsetting commitments.

 

IASB

International Accounting Standards Board.

 

ICETUS

InterContinental Executive Top-Up Scheme.

 

IC Plan

InterContinental Hotels UK Pension Plan.

 

IFRS

International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the EU and issued by the IASB.

 

IHG System

Hotels operating under franchise and management agreements together with IHG owned and leased hotels.

 

 

 

184


Table of Contents
 
    

 

 

 

IHG System size

the number of hotels/rooms franchised, managed, owned and leased by IHG.

 

indirect channels

online travel intermediaries and business and leisure travel agents.

 

interest rate swap

an agreement to exchange fixed for floating interest rate streams (or vice versa) on a notional principal.

 

liquidated damages

payments received in respect of the

early termination of management and franchise contracts, where applicable.

 

LTIP

Long Term Incentive Plan.

 

managed leases

properties structured for legal reasons as operating leases but with the same characteristics as management contracts.

 

management contract

a contract to operate a hotel on behalf of the hotel owner.

 

market capitalisation

the value attributed to a listed company by multiplying its share price by the number of shares in issue.

 

net debt

borrowings less cash and cash equivalents, including the exchange element of the fair value of currency swaps hedging the borrowings.

 

net rooms supply

net total number of IHG hotel rooms.

 

NYSE

New York Stock Exchange.

 

occupancy rate

rooms occupied by hotel guests, expressed as a percentage of rooms that are available.

 

ordinary share

from 9 October 2012 until 30 June 2014, the ordinary shares of 14 194329 pence each in the Company; and from 1 July 2014, the ordinary shares of 15 265329 pence each in the Company.

 

owner

the ultimate owner of a hotel property.

 

pipeline

hotels/rooms that will enter the IHG System at a future date. A new hotel only enters the pipeline once a contract has been signed and the appropriate fees paid. In rare circumstances, a hotel will not open for reasons such as the financing being withdrawn.

RevPAR or revenue per available room

rooms revenue divided by the number of room nights that are available (can be mathematically derived from occupancy rate multiplied by average daily rate).

 

room count

number of rooms franchised, managed, owned or leased by IHG.

 

rooms revenue

revenue generated from the sale of room nights.

 

royalty revenues

rooms revenue that a franchisee pays to the brand owner for use of the brand name.

 

SCETUS

Six Continents Executive Top-Up Scheme.

 

SEC

US Securities and Exchange Commission.

 

Six Continents

Six Continents Limited; previously Six Continents PLC and re-registered as a private limited company on 6 June 2005.

 

sterling or pounds sterling, £, pence or p

the pound sterling, the currency of the United Kingdom.

 

subsidiary undertaking

a company over which the Group exercises control.

 

system contribution to revenue

per cent of rooms revenue delivered through IHG’s direct and indirect systems and channels.

 

System Fund or Fund

assessment fees and contributions collected from hotels within the IHG System for the specific use of marketing, the IHG Rewards Club loyalty programme and the global reservations system.

 

technology income

income received from hotels under franchise and management agreements for the use of IHG’s proprietary reservations system.

 

total gross revenue

total rooms revenue from franchised hotels and total hotel revenue from managed, owned and leased hotels. It is not revenue attributable to IHG, as it is derived from hotels owned by third parties.

 

TSR or Total Shareholder Return

the theoretical growth in value of a shareholding over a period, by reference to the beginning and ending share price, and assuming that dividends, including special dividends, are reinvested to purchase additional units of the equity.

UK

the United Kingdom.

 

UK DB Plan

the Defined Benefit section of the IC Plan.

 

UK DC Plan

the Defined Contribution section of the IC Plan.

 

UK GAAP

United Kingdom Generally Accepted Accounting Practice.

 

US

the United States of America.

 

US 401(k) Plan

the Defined Contribution 401(k) plan.

 

US Deferred Compensation Plan

the Defined Contribution Deferred Compensation Plan.

 

US dollars, US$, $ or ¢

the currency of the United States of America.

 

working capital

the sum of inventories, receivables and payables of a trading nature, excluding financing and taxation items.

 

 

 

LOGO

 

 

185


Table of Contents
 
IHG  Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014

 

 

Forward-looking statements

The Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014 contain certain forward-looking statements as defined under US legislation (section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934) with respect to the financial condition, results of operations and business of InterContinental Hotels Group and certain plans and objectives of the Board of Directors of InterContinental Hotels Group PLC with respect thereto. Such statements include, but are not limited to, statements made in the Chairman’s Statement and in the Chief Executive Officer’s Review. These forward-looking statements can be identified by the fact that they do not relate only to historical or current facts. Forward-looking statements often use words such as ‘anticipate’, ‘target’, ‘expect’, ‘estimate’, ‘intend’, ‘plan’, ‘goal’, ‘believe’, or other words of similar meaning. These statements are based on assumptions and assessments made by InterContinental Hotels Group’s management in light of their experience and their perception of historical trends, current conditions, expected future developments and other factors, they believe to be appropriate.

By their nature, forward-looking statements are inherently predictive, speculative and involve risk and uncertainty. There are a number of factors that could cause actual results and developments to differ materially from those expressed in, or implied by, such forward-looking statements, including, but not limited to: the risks of the effect of political and economic developments; the risk of events that adversely impact domestic or international travel; the risks of the hotel industry supply and demand cycle; the Group being subject to a competitive and changing industry; the Group’s exposure to risks related to executing and realising benefits from strategic transactions, including acquisitions; the Group’s dependence upon a wide range of external stakeholders and business partners; the Group’s exposure to increasing competition from online travel agents and intermediaries; the risks related to identifying, securing and retaining franchise and management agreements; the risks in relation to changing technology and systems; the risks associated with the Group’s financial stability and its ability to borrow and satisfy debt covenants; the risk of litigation; the Group’s reliance on the reputation of its brands and exposure to inherent reputation risks, including those associated with intellectual property; the risks involved in the Group’s reliance upon its reservations system and other key technology platforms, and the risks that could cause the failure of these systems; the risks related to information security and data privacy; the risks associated with safety, security and crisis management; the ability to acquire and retain the right people, skills and capability to manage growth and change; compliance with existing and changing regulations across numerous countries, territories and jurisdictions; the risks related to ethics and responsible business practices; and the risks associated with insuring its business.

The main factors that could affect the business and financial results are described in the Strategic Report of the Annual Report and Form 20-F 2014.

 

 

 

Designed and produced

by Addison Group

 

www.addison-group.net

 

Managed by RR Donnelley

 

This Report is printed on Satimatt Green
which is manufactured using 75%
post-consumer recycled fibre and 25%
FSC® certified virgin fibre. Both the
manufacturing mills and printer are
ISO 14001 and FSC® certified.

 

LOGO

 

 

 

 

186


Table of Contents

InterContinental Hotels Group PLC

Broadwater Park, Denham,

Buckinghamshire UB9 5HR

United Kingdom

Tel +44 (0) 1895 512 000

Fax +44 (0) 1895 512 101

Web www.ihgplc.com

Make a booking at www.ihg.com


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this Annual Report on its behalf.

 

INTERCONTINENTAL HOTELS GROUP PLC

(Registrant)

By:  

/s/    Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson

  Name:    Paul Edgecliffe-Johnson
  Title:    Chief Financial Officer

Date: February 26, 2015